ASDA A2 Manual

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 583
At a glance
Powered by AI
The manual discusses how to properly install, operate and maintain AC servo drives and motors. It provides information on installation, configuration, parameter settings, troubleshooting and application examples.

The manual discusses installation of drives and motors, configuration and wiring, trial run steps, control functions, parameter settings, communication protocols, inspection, maintenance and troubleshooting.

Safety precautions include not using the product in explosive environments, ensuring proper grounding, not modifying wiring when powered, ensuring emergency stops can be activated, and not touching devices during operation.

ASDA-A2_M_EN_20110128

Preface

Thank you very much for purchasing DELTAs AC servo products. This manual will be helpful in the installation, wiring, inspection, and operation of Delta AC servo drive and motor. Before using the product, please read this user manual to ensure correct use. You should thoroughly understand all safety precautions (DANGERS, WARNINGS and STOPS) before proceeding with the installation, wiring and operation. If you do not understand please contact your local Delta sales representative. Place this user manual in a safe location for future reference.

Using This Manual

Contents of this manual


This manual is a user guide that provides the information on how to install, operate and maintain ASDA-A2 series AC servo drives and ECMA series AC servo motors. The contents of this manual are including the following topics: Installation of AC servo drives and motors Configuration and wiring Trial run steps Control functions and adjusting methods of AC servo drives Parameter settings Communication protocol Inspection and maintenance Troubleshooting Application examples

Who should use this manual


This user manual is intended for the following users: Those who are responsible for designing. Those who are responsible for installing or wiring. Those who are responsible for operating or programming. Those who are responsible for maintaining or troubleshooting.

Important precautions
Before using the product, please read this user manual thoroughly to ensure correct use and store this manual in a safe and handy place for quick reference whenever necessary. Besides, please observe the following precautions: Do not use the product in a potentially explosive environment. Install the product in a clean and dry location free from corrosive and inflammable gases or liquids.
Revision January 2011

Preface

Do not connect a commercial power supply to the U, V, W terminals of motor. Failure to observe this precaution will damage either the Servo motor or drive. Ensure that the motor and drive are correctly connected to a ground. The grounding method must comply with the electrical standard of the country (Please refer to NFPA 70: National Electrical Code, 2005 Ed.).

Do not disconnect the AC servo drive and motor while the power is ON. Do not attach, modify and remove wiring when power is applied to the AC servo drive and motor. Before starting the operation with a mechanical system connected, make sure the emergency stop equipment can be energized and work at any time. Do not touch the drive heat sink or the servo motor during operation. Otherwise, it may result in serious personnel injury.

PLEASE READ PRIOR TO INSTALLATION FOR SAFETY. Carefully note and observe the following safety precautions when receiving, inspecting, installing, operating, maintaining and troubleshooting. The following words, DANGER, WARNING and STOP are used to mark safety precautions when using the Deltas servo product. Failure to observe these precautions may void the warranty! ASDA-A2 series drives are high-resolution, open type servo drives and must be installed in an NEMA enclosure such as a protection control panel during operation to comply with the requirements of the international safety standards. They are provided with precise feedback control and high-speed calculation function incorporating DSP (Digital Signal Processor) technology, and intended to drive three-phase permanent magnet synchronous motors (PMSM) to achieve precise positioning by means of accurate current output generated by IGBT (Insulated Gate Bipolar Transistor). ASDA-A2 series drives can be used in industrial applications and for installation in an end-use enclosure that do not exceed the specifications defined in the ASDA-A2 series user manual (Drives, cables and motors are for use in a suitable enclosure with a minimum of a UL50 type 1 or NEMA 250 Type 1 rating). The words, DANGER, WARNING and STOP, have the following meaning: Indicates a potentially hazardous situation and if not avoided, may result in serious injury or death. Indicates a potentially hazardous situation and if not avoided, may result in minor to moderate injury or serious damage to the product. Indicates an improper action that it is not recommended to do and if doing it may cause damage, malfunction and inability.

ii

Revision January 2011

Preface

Unpacking Check
Please ensure that both the servo drive and motor are correctly matched for size (power rating). Failure to observe this precaution may cause fire, seriously damage the drive / motor or cause personal injury.

Installation
Do not install the product in a location that is outside the stated specification for the drive and motor. Failure to observe this caution may result in electric shock, fire, or personal injury.

Wiring
Connect the ground terminals to a class-3 ground (Ground resistance should not exceed 100 ). Improper grounding may result in electric shock or fire. Do not connect any power supplies to the U, V, W terminals. Failure to observe this precaution may result in serious injury, damage to the drive or fire. Ensure that all screws, connectors and wire terminations are secure on the power supply, servo drive and motor. Failure to observe this caution may result in damage, fire or personal injury. In order to prevent fire hazard and accidents, please form the wiring by the cable specifications outlined in this user manual.

Operation
Before starting the operation with a mechanical system connected, change the drive parameters to match the user-defined parameters of the mechanical system. Starting the operation without matching the correct parameters may result in servo drive or motor damage, or damage to the mechanical system. Ensure that the emergency stop equipment or device is connected and working correctly before operating the motor that is connected to a mechanical system. Do not approach or touch any rotating parts (e.g. shaft) while the motor is running. Failure to observe this precaution may cause serious personal injury. In order to prevent accidents, the initial trial run for servo motor should be conducted under no load conditions (separate the motor from its couplings and belts). For the initial trial run, do not operate the servo motor while it is connected to its mechanical system. Connecting the motor to its mechanical system may cause damage or result in personal injury during the trail run. Connect the servo motor once it has successfully completed a trail run. Caution: Please perform trial run without load first and then perform trial run with load connected. After the servo motor is running normally and regularly without load, then run servo motor with load connected. Ensure to perform trial run in this order to prevent unnecessary danger. Do not touch either the drive heat sink or the motor during operation as they may become hot and personal injury may result.

Maintenance and Inspection


Do not touch any internal or exposed parts of servo drive and servo motor as electrical shock may result. Do not remove the operation panel while the drive is connected to an electrical power source otherwise electrical shock may result. Wait at least 10 minutes after power has been removed before touching any drive or motor terminals or performing any wiring and/or inspection as an electrical charge may still remain in the servo drive and servo motor with hazardous voltages even after power has been removed. Do not disassemble the servo drive or motor as electric shock may result. Do not connect or disconnect wires or connectors while power is applied to the drive and motor. Only qualified personnel who have electrical knowledge should conduct maintenance and inspection. Ensure that the Charge indicator ceases when performing any maintenance, inspection or repairing.

Revision January 2011

iii

Preface

Main Circuit Wiring


Install the encoder cables in a separate conduit from the motor power cables to avoid signal noise. Separate the conduits by 30cm (11.8inches) above. Use multi-stranded twisted-pair wires or multi-core shielded-pair wires for signal, encoder (PG) feedback cables. The maximum length of command input cable is 3m (9.84ft.) and the maximum length of encoder (PG) feedback cables is 20m (65.62ft.). As a charge may still remain in the drive with hazardous voltages even after power has been removed, be sure to wait at least 10 minutes after power has been removed before performing any wiring and/or inspection. It is not recommended to frequently power the drive on and off. Do not turn the drive off and on more than once per minute as high charging currents within the internal capacitors may cause damage.

Main Circuit Terminal Wiring


Please perform the wiring after the terminal blocks are all removed from the drive. Insert only one wire into one terminal on the terminal block. When inserting wires, please ensure that the conductors are not shorted to adjacent terminals or wires. Ensure to double check the wiring before applying power to the drive.

NOTE

1) In this manual, actual measured values are in metric units. Dimensions in (imperial units) are for reference only. Please use metric for precise measurements. 2) The content of this manual may be revised without prior notice. Please consult our distributors or download the most updated version at http://www.delta.com.tw/industrialautomation. .

iv

Revision January 2011

Chapter 1 Unpacking Check and Model Explanation

1.1 Unpacking Check


After receiving the AC servo drive, please check for the following:

Ensure that the product is what you have ordered.


Verify the part number indicated on the nameplate corresponds with the part number of your order (Please refer to Section 1.2 for details about the model explanation).

Ensure that the servo motor shaft rotates freely.


Rotate the motor shaft by hand; a smooth rotation will indicate a good motor. However, a servo motor with an electromagnetic brake can not be rotated manually.

Check for damage.


Inspect the unit to insure it was not damaged during shipment.

Check for loose screws.


Ensure that all necessary screws are tight and secure. If any items are damaged or incorrect, please inform the distributor whom you purchased the product from or your local Delta sales representative. A complete and workable AC servo system should include the following parts: Part I : Delta standard supplied parts 220V series (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) (9) (10) (11) Servo drive Servo motor 6 PIN Terminal Block (for L1c, L2c, , R, S, T) (available for 200W ~ 1.5kW models)

3 PIN Terminal Block (for R, S, T) (available for 2kW ~ 3kW models) 3 PIN Terminal Block (for L1c, L2c, 6 PIN Terminal Block (for L1c, L2c, 3 PIN Quick Connector (for U, V, W) 3 PIN Quick Connector (for P , D, C) One operating lever (for wire to terminal block insertion) One jumper bar (installed at pins P and D of the 3 PIN Terminal Block for P , D, C) ) (available for 2kW ~ 3kW models) , R, S, T) (available for 4.5kW ~ 7.5kW models)

Instruction Sheets (Multilingual version)

Revision January 2011

1-1

Chapter 1 Unpacking Check and Model Explanation

400V series (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) (9) (10) Servo drive Servo motor 3 PIN Terminal Block (for R, S, T) (available for 750W ~ 1.5kW models) 3 PIN Terminal Block (for DC24V, DC0V, ) (available for 750W ~ 1.5kW models)

Terminal Block (for DC24V, DC0V, R, S, T) (available for 2kW ~ 7.5kW models) 3 PIN Quick Connector (for U, V, W) 3 PIN Quick Connector (for P , D, C) One operating lever (for wire to terminal block insertion) One jumper bar (installed at pins P and D of the 3 PIN Terminal Block for P , D, C)

Instruction Sheets (Multilingual version)

Part II : Optional parts (Refer to Appendix A) (1) One power cable, which is used to connect servo motor to U, V, W terminals of servo drive. This power cable includes a green grounding cable. Please connect the green grounding cable to the ground terminal of the servo drive. (2) One encoder cable, which is used to connect the encoder of servo motor to the CN2 terminal of servo drive. (3) (4) (5) CN1 Connector: 50 PIN Connector (3M type analog product) CN2 Connector: 20 PIN Connector (3M type analog product) CN3 Connector: 6 PIN Connector (IEEE1394 analog product) for general communication (RS-485) (6) (7) CN4 Connector: 4 PIN Connector (USB Type B product) CN6 Connector: RJ45 Connector for high-speed communication (CANopen)

1-2

Revision January 2011

Chapter 1 Unpacking Check and Model Explanation

1.2 Model Explanation 1.2.1 Nameplate Information


ASDA-A2 Series Servo Drive

Nameplate Explanation

Serial Number Explanation

ECMA Series Servo Motor

Nameplate Explanation

Serial Number Explanation

Revision January 2011

1-3

Chapter 1 Unpacking Check and Model Explanation

1.2.2 Model Name Explanation


ASDA-A2 Series Servo Drive

Model Type Type M U F L Full-Close Control Yes Yes Yes Yes CANopen Yes No No No DMCNET No No Yes No Extension Port for Digital Input No Yes No No

NOTE
15kW models will be available soon. The models above 15kW are in the process of development.

1-4

Revision January 2011

Chapter 1 Unpacking Check and Model Explanation

ECMA Series Servo Motor

NOTE
15kW models will be available soon. The models above 15kW are in the process of development.

Revision January 2011

1-5

Chapter 1 Unpacking Check and Model Explanation

1.3 Servo Drive and Servo Motor Combinations


The table below shows the possible combination of Delta ASDA-A2 series servo drives and ECMA series servo motors. (Please refer to Section 1.2 for model explanation)

1.3.1 220V Series


Power 100W 200W Servo Drive ASD-A2-0121- ASD-A2-0221- Servo Motor ECMA-C10401S (S=8mm) ECMA-C10602S (S=14mm) ECMA-C10604S (S=14mm) ECMA-C108047 (7=14mm) ECMA-E11305S (S=22mm) ECMA-G11303S (S=22mm) ECMA-C10807S (S=19mm) ECMA-G11306S (S=22mm) ECMA-C11010S (S=22mm) ECMA-E11310S (S=22mm) ECMA-G11309S (S=22mm) ECMA-E11315S (S=22mm) ECMA-C11020S (S=22mm) ECMA-E11320S (S=22mm) ECMA-E11820S (S=35mm) ECMA-E11830S (S=35mm) ECMA-F11830S (S=35mm) ECMA-F11845S (S=35mm) ECMA-F118553 (3=42mm) ECMA-F118753 (3=42mm)

400W

ASD-A2-0421-

750W

ASD-A2-0721-

1000W 1500W 2000W

ASD-A2-1021- ASD-A2-1521- ASD-A2-2023-

3000W 4500W 5500W 7500W

ASD-A2-3023- ASD-A2-4523- ASD-A2-5523- ASD-A2-7523-

NOTE
1) The boxes () at the ends of the servo drive model names are for optional configurations (Fullclose control, CANopen, DMCNET and extension port for digital input). For the actual model name, please refer to the ordering information of the actual purchased product. 2) The boxes () in the servo motor model names are for optional configurations (keyway, brake and oil seal).

The drives shown in the above table are designed according to the three multiple of rated current of motors shown in the above table. If the drives which are designed according to the six multiple of rated current of motors are needed, please contact our distributors or your local Delta sales representative.

1-6

Revision January 2011

Chapter 1 Unpacking Check and Model Explanation

1.3.2 400V Series


Power 750W 1000W 1500W 2000W 3000W 4500W 5500W *7500W Servo Drive ASD-A2-0743- ASD-A2-1043- ASD-A2-1543- ASD-A2-2043- ASD-A2-3043- ASD-A2-4543- ASD-A2-5543- ASD-A2-7543- Servo Motor ECMA-J10807S (S=19mm) ECMA-K11310S (S=22mm) ECMA-K11315S (S=22mm) ECMA-K11320S (S=22mm) ECMA-L11830S (S=35mm) ECMA-L11845S (S=35mm) ECMA-L118553 (3=42mm) ECMA-L118753 (3=42mm)

*7.5kW models will be available soon.

NOTE
1) The boxes () at the ends of the servo drive model names are for optional configurations (Fullclose control, CANopen, DMCNET and extension port for digital input). For the actual model name, please refer to the ordering information of the actual purchased product. 2) The boxes () in the servo motor model names are for optional configurations (keyway, brake and oil seal).

The drives shown in the above table are designed according to the three multiple of rated current of motors shown in the above table. If the drives which are designed according to the six multiple of rated current of motors are needed, please contact our distributors or your local Delta sales representative.

The servo drives shown in the above two tables are designed for use in combination with the specific servo motors. Check the specifications of the drives and motors you want to use. Also, please ensure that both the servo drive and motor are correctly matched for size (power rating). If the power of motor and drive is not within the specifications, the drive and motor may overheat and servo alarm would be activated. For the detail specifications of servo drives and motors, please refer to Chapter 12 Specifications.

Revision January 2011

1-7

Chapter 1 Unpacking Check and Model Explanation

1.4 Servo Drive Features 1.4.1 220V Series


220V Series - Front View

1-8

Revision January 2011

Chapter 1 Unpacking Check and Model Explanation

220V Series - Top View

Revision January 2011

1-9

Chapter 1 Unpacking Check and Model Explanation

220V Series - Bottom View

1-10

Revision January 2011

Chapter 1 Unpacking Check and Model Explanation

1.4.2 400V Series


400V Series - Front View

Revision January 2011

1-11

Chapter 1 Unpacking Check and Model Explanation

400V Series - Top View

1-12

Revision January 2011

Chapter 1 Unpacking Check and Model Explanation

400V Series - Bottom View

Revision January 2011

1-13

Chapter 1 Unpacking Check and Model Explanation

This page intentionally left blank

1-14

Revision January 2011

Chapter 2 Installation and Storage

2.1 Installation Notes


Please pay close attention on the following installation notes:

Do not bend or strain the connection cables between servo drive and motor. When mounting the servo drive, make sure to tighten all screws to secure the drive in
place.

If the servo motor shaft is coupled directly to a rotating device ensure that the alignment
specifications of the servo motor, coupling, and device are followed. Failure to do so may cause unnecessary loads or premature failure to the servo motor.

If the length of cable connected between servo drive and motor is more than 20m, please
increase the wire gauge of the encoder cable and motor connection cable (connected to U, V, W terminals).

Make sure to tighten the screws for securing motor.

2.2 Storage Conditions


The product should be kept in the shipping carton before installation. In order to retain the warranty coverage, the AC servo drive should be stored properly when it is not to be used for an extended period of time. Some storage suggestions are:

Store in a clean and dry location free from direct sunlight. Store within an ambient temperature range of -20C to +65C (-4F to 149F). Store within a relative humidity range of 0% to 90% and non-condensing. Do not store in a place subjected to corrosive gases and liquids. Correctly packaged and placed on a solid surface.

Revision January 2011

2-1

Chapter 2 Installation and Storage

2.3 Installation Conditions


Operating Temperature ASDA-A2 Series Servo Drive : ECMA Series Servo Motor : 0C to 55C (32F to 131F) 0C to 40C (32F to 104F)

The ambient temperature of servo drive for long-term reliability should be under 45C (113F). If the ambient temperature of servo drive is greater than 45C (113F), please install the drive in a well-ventilated location and do not obstruct the airflow for the cooling fan. Caution The servo drive and motor will generate heat. If they are installed in a control panel, please ensure sufficient space around the units for heat dissipation. Pay particular attention to vibration of the units and check if the vibration has impacted the electric devices in the control panel. Please observe the following precautions when selecting a mounting location. Failure to observe the following precautions may void the warranty!

Do not mount the servo drive or motor adjacent to heat-radiating elements or in direct
sunlight.

Do not mount the servo drive or motor in a location subjected to corrosive gases, liquids,
or airborne dust or metallic particles.

Do not mount the servo drive or motor in a location where temperatures and humidity will
exceed specification.

Do not mount the servo drive or motor in a location where vibration and shock will exceed
specification.

Do not mount the servo drive or motor in a location where it will be subjected to high
levels of electromagnetic radiation.

2-2

Revision January 2011

Chapter 2 Installation and Storage

2.4 Installation Procedure and Minimum Clearances


Installation Procedure Incorrect installation may result in a drive malfunction or premature failure of the drive and or motor. Please follow the guidelines in this manual when installing the servo drive and motor. The ASDA-A2 servo drive should be mounted perpendicular to the wall or in the control panel. In order to ensure the drive is well ventilated, ensure that the all ventilation holes are not obstructed and sufficient free space is given to the servo drive. Do not install the drive in a horizontal position or malfunction and damage will occur.

Drive Mounting The ASDA-A2 Servo drives must be back mounted vertically on a dry and solid surface such as a NEMA enclosure. A minimum spacing of two inches must be maintained above and below the drive for ventilation and heat dissipation. Additional space may be necessary for wiring and cable connections. Also, as the drive conducts heat away via the mounting, the mounting plane or surface should not conduct heat into the drive from external sources

Motor Mounting The ECMA Servo motors should be mounted firmly to a dry and solid mounting surface to ensure maximum heat transfer for maximum power output and to provide a good ground. For the dimensions and weights specifications of servo drive or motor, please refer to Chapter 12 Specifications".

Revision January 2011

2-3

Chapter 2 Installation and Storage

Minimum Clearances Install a fan to increase ventilation to avoid ambient temperatures that exceed the specification. When installing two or more drives adjacent to each other please follow the clearances as shown in the following diagram.

Minimum Clearances
750W ~ 1.5kW models: 2kW ~ 5.5kW models:

NOTE
The scale of the clearances does not match the dimensions as shown in the drawing above. In the event of any discrepancy between the clearances and the dimensions, the dimensions shall prevail.

2-4

Revision January 2011

Chapter 2 Installation and Storage

Side by Side Installation


750W ~ 1.5kW models:

NOTE
The scale of the clearances does not match the dimensions as shown in the drawing above. In the event of any discrepancy between the clearances and the dimensions, the dimensions shall prevail.

Revision January 2011

2-5

Chapter 2 Installation and Storage

2kW ~ 5.5kW models:

NOTE
The scale of the clearances does not match the dimensions as shown in the drawing above. In the event of any discrepancy between the clearances and the dimensions, the dimensions shall prevail.

2-6

Revision January 2011

Chapter 2 Installation and Storage

2.5 Circuit Interrupter and Fuse Current Recommended Value


Caution: Please use circuit interrupter and fuse which are recognized by and comply with the UL or CSA standards.

220V Series Servo Drive Model Operation Mode ASD-A2-0121- ASD-A2-0221- ASD-A2-0421- ASD-A2-0721- ASD-A2-1021- ASD-A2-1521- ASD-A2-2023- ASD-A2-3023- ASD-A2-4523- ASD-A2-5523- ASD-A2-7523- 400V Series Servo Drive Model Operation Mode ASD-A2-0743- ASD-A2-1043- ASD-A2-1543- ASD-A2-2043- ASD-A2-3043- ASD-A2-4543- ASD-A2-5543- ASD-A2-7543- Recommended Breaker General 10A 15A 20A 30A 30A 70A 75A 95A Recommended Fuse (Class T) General 20A 25A 40A 50A 70A 140A 150A 175A Recommended Breaker General 5A 5A 10A 10A 15A 20A 30A 30A 70A 75A 95A Recommended Fuse (Class T) General 5A 5A 10A 20A 25A 40A 50A 70A 140A 150A 175A

NOTE
When using a GFCI (Ground Fault Circuit Interrupter), select a current sensor with sensitivity of equal to or more than 200mA, and not less than 0.1-second detection time to avoid nuisance tripping.

Revision January 2011

2-7

Chapter 2 Installation and Storage

2.6 EMI Filter Selection


AC Servo Drive - EMI Filter Cross Reference 220V Series Item 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 400V Series Item 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 Power 750W 1000W 1500W 2000W 3000W 4500W 5500W 7500W Servo Drive Model ASD-A2-0743- ASD-A2-1043- ASD-A2-1543- ASD-A2-2043- ASD-A2-3043- ASD-A2-4543- ASD-A2-5543- ASD-A2-7543- Recommended EMI Filter 11TDT1W4S 11TDT1W4S 11TDT1W4S 20TDT1W4D 20TDT1W4D 20TDT1W4D RF075M43BA RF075M43BA FootPrint N N N N N N Y Y Power 100W 200W 400W 750W 1000W 1500W 2000W 3000W 4500W 5500W 7500W Servo Drive Model ASD-A2-0121- ASD-A2-0221- ASD-A2-0421- ASD-A2-0721- ASD-A2-1021- ASD-A2-1521- ASD-A2-2023- ASD-A2-3023- ASD-A2-4523- ASD-A2-5523- ASD-A2-7523- Recommended EMI Filter 08TDT1W4S 08TDT1W4S 08TDT1W4S 11TDT1W4S 11TDT1W4S 11TDT1W4S 20TDT1W4D 20TDT1W4D 20TDT1W4D RF075M43BA RF075M43BA FootPrint N N N N N N N N N Y Y

NOTE
The boxes () in the model names are for optional configurations. (Please refer to section 1.2 for model explanation.)

2-8

Revision January 2011

Chapter 2 Installation and Storage

Installation All electrical equipment, including AC servo drives, will generate high-frequency/lowfrequency noise and will interfere with peripheral equipment by radiation or conduction when in operation. By using an EMI filter with correct installation, much of the interference can be eliminated. It is recommended to use Deltas EMI filter to have the best interference elimination performance. We assure that it can comply with following rules when AC servo drive and EMI filter are installed and wired according to user manual:

EN61000-6-4 (2001) EN61800-3 (2004) PDS of category C2 EN55011+A2 (2007) Class A Group 1
General Precaution To ensure the best interference elimination performance when using Deltas EMI filter, please follow the guidelines in this user manual to perform wiring and/or installation. In addition, please also observe the following precautions:

EMI filter and AC servo drive should be installed on the same metal plate. Please install AC servo drive on same footprint with EMI filter or install EMI filter as close
as possible to the AC servo drive.

All wiring should be as short as possible. Metal plate should be grounded. The cover of EMI filter and AC servo drive or grounding should be fixed on the metal plate
and the contact area should be as large as possible. Choose Suitable Motor Cable and Precautions Improper installation and choice of motor cable will affect the performance of EMI filter. Be sure to observe the following precautions when selecting motor cable.

Use the cable with shielding (double shielding is the best). The shielding on both ends of the motor cable should be grounded with the minimum
length and maximum contact area.

Remove any paint on metal saddle for good ground contact with the plate and shielding
(Please refer to Figure 1 on page B-3).

The connection between the metal saddle and the shielding on both ends of the motor
cable should be correct and well installed. Please refer to Figure 2 on page B-3 for correct wiring method.

Revision January 2011

2-9

Chapter 2 Installation and Storage

Figure 1

Saddle on both ends

Saddle on one end

Figure 2

2-10

Revision January 2011

Chapter 2 Installation and Storage

Dimensions Delta Part Number: 08TDT1W4S

Delta Part Number: 11TDT1W4S

Revision January 2011

2-11

Chapter 2 Installation and Storage

Delta Part Number: 20TDT1W4D

Delta Part Number: RF075M43BA

60.0 (2.36) 30.0 (1.18)

125.0 (4.92) 85.0 (3.35)

15.0 (0.52) 30.0 (1.18)

282.0 (11.10)

5.5 (0.22)

2-12

282.0 (1.10) 295.0 (11.61)

Revision January 2011

Chapter 2 Installation and Storage

2.7 Regenerative Resistors


Built-in Regenerative Resistor When the output torque of servo motor in reverse direction of motor rotation speed, it indicates that regenerative power has returned from the load to the servo drive. This power will be transmitted into the capacitance of the DC Bus and result in rising voltage. When the voltage rises too high, the servo system need to dissipate the extra energy by using a regenerative resistor. The ASDA-A2 series servo drive provides a built-in regenerative resistor which is equipped as standard (400W~5.5kW models only). Users can also connect an external regenerative resistor if more regenerative capacity is needed. The following table shows the specifications of the servo drives built-in regenerative resistor and the amount of regenerative power (average value) that it can process. 220V Series Specifications of Built-in Regenerative Resistors Servo Drive (kW) 0.1 0.2 0.4 0.75 1.0 1.5 2.0 3.0 4.5 5.5 7.5 400V Series Specifications of Built-in Regenerative Resistors Servo Drive (kW) 0.75 1.0 1.5 2.0 3.0 4.5 5.5 7.5 Resistance (Ohm) (Parameter P1-52) 80 80 80 Capacity (Watt) (Parameter P1-53) 100 100 100 Min. Allowable Resistance (Ohm) 60 60 40 40 30 20 20 15 Resistance (Ohm) (Parameter P1-52) 40 40 40 20 20 20 Capacity (Watt) (Parameter P1-53) 60 60 60 100 100 100 Regenerative Power processed by built-in regenerative resistor (Watt) *1 30 30 30 50 50 50 Min. Allowable Resistance (Ohm) 30 30 30 20 20 20 10 10 10 8 8

Revision January 2011

2-13

Chapter 2 Installation and Storage

When the regenerative power exceeds the processing capacity of the servo drive, install an external regenerative resistor. Please pay close attention to the following notes when using a regenerative resistor. 1. Make sure the settings of resistance (parameter P1-52) and capacity (parameter P1-53) are set correctly. 2. When installing an external regenerative resistor, make sure that its resistance value is the same as the resistance of the built-in regenerative resistor. If combining multiple small-capacity regenerative resistors in parallel to increase the regenerative resistor capacity, make sure that the resistance value of the regenerative resistor complies with the specifications listed in the table above. 3. In general, when the amount of regenerative power (average value) that can be processed is used at or below the rated load ratio, the resistance temperature will increase to 120C or higher (when the regeneration occurs continuously). For safety reasons, forced air cooling is a good way to reduce the temperature of the regenerative resistors. We also recommend using regenerative resistors with thermal switches. As for the load characteristics of the regenerative resistors, please check with the manufacturer.

External Regenerative Resistor When using an external regenerative resistor, connect it to P circuit between P and C, and make sure the and D is open. We recommend using external regenerative resistors

with resistance values that follow the table above (Specifications of Built-in Regenerative Resistors). We ignore the dissipative power of IGBT (Insulated Gate Bipolar Transistor) in order to let the users easily calculate the capacity of regenerative resistor. In the following sections, we will describe Regenerative Power Calculation Method and Simple Calculation Method for calculating the regenerative power capacity of external regenerative resistors.

Regenerative Power Calculation Method (1) Without Load When there is no external load torque, if the servo motor repeats operation, the returned regenerative power generated when braking will transmitted into the capacitance of DC bus. After the capacitance voltage exceeds some high value, regenerative resistor can dissipate the remained regenerative power. Use the table and procedure described below to calculate the regenerative power.

2-14

Revision January 2011

Chapter 2 Installation and Storage

220V Series Regenerative power Rotor Inertia from empty load 2 J ( 10-4kg.m ) 3000r/min to stop Eo (joule) 0.037 0.177 0.277 0.68 1.13 2.65 4.45 8.17 8.41 11.18 14.59 34.68 54.95 54.95 77.75 99.78 142.7 8.17 8.41 11.18 0.18 0.87 1.37 3.36 5.59 13.1 22.0 40.40 41.59 55.28 72.15 171.50 217.73 217.73 384.47 493.40 705.66 40.40 41.59 55.29 Max. regenerative power of capacitance Ec (joule) 3 4 8 14 18 21 8 18 18 21 28 28 25 27 93 8 14 18

Servo Drive (kW) 0.1 0.2 Low Inertia 0.4 0.75 1.0 2.0 0.4 1.0 Medium Inertia 1.5 2.0 3.0 3.0 Medium- 4.5 High 5.5 Inertia 7.5 High Inertia 0.4 0.75 1.0

Servo Motor

ECMA-C10402 ECMA-C10602 ECMA-C10604 ECMA-C10804 ECMA-C10807 ECMA-C11010 ECMA-C11020 ECMA-E11305 ECMA-E11310 ECMA-E11315 ECMA-E11320 ECMA-E11820 ECMA-F11830 ECMA-F11830 ECMA-F11845 ECMA-F11855 ECMA-F11875 ECMA-G11303 ECMA-G11306 ECMA-G11309

Eo = J x wr2/182 (joule) 400V Series

, Wr : r/min

Servo Drive (kW) Low Inertia Medium Inertia

Servo Motor

Regenerative power Rotor Inertia from empty load 2 J ( 10-4kg.m ) 3000r/min to stop Eo (joule) 1.13 8.41 11.18 14.59 54.95 77.75 99.78 142.7 5.59 18.48 24.57 18.04 67.93 96.12 123.35 176.41

Max. regenerative power of capacitance Ec (joule) 42.43 51.17 57.41 34.94 42.43 51.17 57.41 62.40

0.75 1.0 1.5 2.0 3.0

ECMA-J10807 ECMA-K11310 ECMA-K11315 ECMA-K11320 ECMA-L11830 ECMA-L11845 ECMA-L11855 ECMA-L11875

Medium- 4.5 High 5.5 Inertia 7.5

Eo = J x wr2/182 (joule)

, Wr : r/min

Revision January 2011

2-15

Chapter 2 Installation and Storage

If the load inertia is N motor inertia, the regenerative power will be (N+1) x E0 when servo motor brakes from 3000r/min to 0. Then, the regenerative resistor can dissipate: (N+1) x E0 - Ec (joule). If the time of repeat operation cycle is T sec, then the regenerative power = 2 x ((N+1) x E0 - Ec) / T. The calculating procedure is as follows: Step 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 Procedure Set the capacity of regenerative resistor to the maximum Set the operation cycle T Set motor speed Wr Set load/motor inertia ratio N Calculate the max. regenerative power Eo Set the regenerative power Ec that can be absorbed Calculate the required regenerative power capacity Equation and Setting Method Change the value of P1-53 to maximum Input by the users Input by the users or read via P0-02 Drive State Display Input by the users or read via P0-02 Drive State Display Eo = J x wr2/182 Refer to the table above 2 x (N+1) x EoEc/ T

For example: If we use 400W servo drive, the time of repeat operation cycle is T = 0.4 sec, max. motor speed is 3000r/min, the load inertia = 7 motor inertia, then the necessary the power of regenerative resistor = 2 x ( (7+1) 1.68 - 8) / 0.4 = 27.2W. If the calculation result is smaller than regenerative power, we recommend the users to use the built-in 60W regenerative resistor. Usually the built-in regenerative resistor provided by ASDA-A2 series servo drives can meet the requirement of general application when the external load inertia is not excessive. The users can see when the capacity of regenerative resistor is too small, the accumulated power will be larger and the temperature will also increase. The fault, AL005 may occur if the temperature is over high. The following figure shows the actual operation of regenerative resistor. (2) With Load When there is an external load torque, servo motor is in reverse rotation when external load greater than motor torque. Servo motor is usually in forward rotation and the motor torque output direction is the same as the rotation direction. However, there is still some special condition. If the motor output torque is in the reverse direction of rotation, the servo motor is also in the reverse direction of rotation. The external power is input into the servo drive through servo motor. The Figure 6.21 below is an example. The users can see the motor is in forward rotation at constant speed when a sudden external load torque change and great power is transmitted to regenerative resistor rapidly.

2-16

Revision January 2011

Chapter 2 Installation and Storage


Motor Rotation Speed

External Load Torque

Motor Output Torque

Reverse Rotation

Forward Rotation

Reverse Rotation

Forward Rotation

External load torque in reverse direction: TL x Wr

TL : External load torque

For the safety, we strongly recommend the users should select the proper resistance value according to the load. For example: When external load torque is a +70% rated torque and rotation speed reaches 3000r/min, if using 400W servo drive (rated torque: 1.27Nt-m), then the users need to connect a external regenerative resistor which power is 2 x (0.7 x 1.27) x (3000 x 2 x / 60) = 560W, 40. Simple Calculation Method The users can select the adequate regenerative resistors according to the allowable frequency required by actual operation and the allowable frequency when the servo motor runs without load. The allowable frequency when the servo motor run without load is the maximum frequency that can be operated during continuous operation when servo motor accelerate from 0r/min to rated speed and decelerate from rated speed down to 0r/min. The allowable frequencies when the servo motor run without load are summarized in the following table.
Allowable frequency when the servo motor runs without load (times/min) and uses a built-in regenerative resistor Motor Capacity 600W 750W 900W 1.0kW 1.5kW 2.0kW 2.0kW 3.0kW 4.5kW 5.5kW 7.5kW Servo Motor ECMAC ECMAE 06 07 312 09 10 137 42 15 32 20 83 (F100) 20 30 11 45 55 75 -

24 10 (F130) (F180)

Revision January 2011

2-17

Chapter 2 Installation and Storage

Allowable frequency when the servo motor runs without load (times/min) and uses a built-in regenerative resistor Motor Capacity 600W 750W 900W 1.0kW 1.5kW 2.0kW 2.0kW 3.0kW 4.5kW 5.5kW 7.5kW Servo Motor ECMAF ECMAG ECMAJ ECMAK ECMAL 06 42 07 537 09 31 10 162 15 122 20 20 30 11 45 8 55 75 -

When the servo motor runs with load, the allowable frequency will change according to the changes of the load inertia and rotation speed. Use the following equation to calculate the allowable frequency.
Allowable fr equency = Allowable frequency when serv o motor run without load m+1 x Rated s peed Operating speed
2

times mi n.

m = load/motor inertia ratio The users can select the adequate external regenerative resistors according to the allowable frequency by referring to the table below:
Allowable frequency when the servo motor run without load (times/min) and uses external regenerative resistor Motor Capacity Recommended Regenerative Resistor Specifications BR400W040 (400W 40) BR1K0W020 (1kW 20) Motor Capacity Recommended Regenerative Resistor Specifications BR400W040 (400W 40) BR1K0W020 (1kW 20) BR1K5W005 (3kW 10) Motor Capacity Recommended Regenerative Resistor Specifications BR1K5W005 (3kW 10) 3.0KW 30 331 0.5kW 05 291 729 1kW 1.0 283 708 100W 01 200W 02 400W (F60) 04 8608 ECMAC 400W (F80) 04 3506 8765 ECMAE 1.5kw 15 213 533 2.0kW (F130) 20 163 408 2.0kW (F180) 20 68 171 3.0kW 30 331 750W 07 2110 5274 1.0kW 10 925 2312 2.0kW 20 562 1406

ECMAF 4.5KW 45 234 5.5KW 55 182 7.5kW 75 127

2-18

Revision January 2011

Chapter 2 Installation and Storage

Allowable frequency when the servo motor run without load (times/min) and uses external regenerative resistor Motor Capacity Recommended Regenerative Resistor Specifications BR400W040 (400W 40) BR1K0W020 (1kW 20) Motor Capacity Recommended Regenerative Resistor Specifications BR400W040 (400W 40) Motor Capacity Recommended Regenerative Resistor Specifications BR400W040 (400W 40) BR1K0W020 (1kW 20) 3.0KW 30 177 1.0kW 10 0.3kW 03 292 729 ECMAG 0.6kW 06 283 708 ECMAK 1.5kW 15 488 ECMAL 4.5KW 45 312 5.5KW 55 243 7.5kW 75 170 2.0kW 20 665 0.9kW 09 213 533

When the regenerative resistor capacity is not enough, the users can connect to multiple the same capacity regenerative resistors in parallel to increase it.

Revision January 2011

2-19

Chapter 2 Installation and Storage

Dimensions Delta Part NumberBR400W040400W 40 L1 265 L2 250 H 30 D 5.3 W 60 MAX. WEIGHT(g) 930

Delta Part NumberBR1K0W0201kW 20 L1 400 L2 385 H 50 D 5.3 W 100 MAX. WEIGHT(g) 2800

2-20

Revision January 2011

Chapter 2 Installation and Storage

Delta Part NumberBR1K5W0053kW 10

Revision January 2011

2-21

Chapter 2 Installation and Storage

This page intentionally left blank

2-22

Revision January 2011

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

This chapter provides information on wiring ASDA-A2 series products, the descriptions of I/O signals and gives typical examples of wiring diagrams.

3.1 Connections - 220V series 3.1.1 Connecting to Peripheral Devices


Figure 3.1 Configuration

Revision January 2011

3-1

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

3.1.2 Servo Drive Connectors and Terminals


Terminal Identification L1c, L2c R, S, T Terminal Description Control circuit terminal Main circuit terminal Notes Used to connect single-phase AC control circuit power depending on connecting servo drive model. Used to connect three-phase AC main circuit power depending on connecting servo drive model. Used to connect servo motor Terminal Symbol U, V, W FG ( ) U Servo motor output V W FG( ) Wire Color Red White Black Green Description Connecting to threephase motor main circuit cable. Connecting to ground terminal ( of the servo drive. )

Internal resistor

Ensure the circuit is closed between P and D, and the circuit is open between P and C.

Connect regenerative resistor to External resistor P and C, and ensure an open circuit between P and D. P , D, C, Regenerative resistor terminal or braking unit Connect braking unit to P and , and ensure an open circuit between P and D, and P and C. External braking (N terminal is built in L1C, L2C, , and R, S, T.) unit P : Connecting to (+) terminal of V_BUS voltage. : Connecting to (-) terminal of V_BUS voltage. Used to connect grounding wire of power supply and servo motor. Used to connect external controllers. Please refer to section 3.3 for details. Used to connect encoder of servo motor. Please refer to section 3.4 for details. Terminal Symbol Encoder connector (Optional Part) T+ TReserved Reserved +5V GND Wire Color Blue Blue/Black Red & Red/White Black & Black/White Pin No. 5 4 14, 16 13, 15

two places Ground terminal CN1 I/O connector (Optional Part)

CN2

3-2

Revision January 2011

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

Terminal Identification CN3

Terminal Description Communication connector (Optional Part) USB connector (Type B) (Optional Part) Position feedback signal connector (for full-closed loop) (Optional Part) CANopen communication port (Optional Part) Extension digital input terminal (Optional Part) Reserved connector Communication extension connector (Optional Part)

Notes Used for RS-485 or RS-232 communication connection. Please refer to section 3.5 for details. Used to connect personal computer (PC or notebook). Please refer to section 3.6 for details.

CN4

CN5

Used to connect to linear scale or encoder to constitute a full-closed loop. Please refer to section 3.7 for details.

CN6

RJ45 connector, used for CANopen communication. Please refer to section 3.8 for details.

CN7

Used to connect to extension digital inputs. Please refer to section 3.9 for details. Reserved

CN8

CN9

Used to connect to other extension cards (will be available soon).

Wiring Notes Please observe the following wiring notes while performing wiring and touching any electrical connections on the servo drive or servo motor. 1. Ensure to check if the power supply and wiring of the "power" terminals (R, S, T, L1C, L2C, U, V, & W) is correct. 2. Please use shielded twisted-pair cables for wiring to prevent voltage coupling and eliminate electrical noise and interference. 3. As a residual hazardous voltage may remain inside the drive, please do not immediately touch any of the "power" terminals (R, S, T, L1C, L2C, U, V, & W) and/or the cables connected to them after the power has been turned off and the charge LED is lit. (Please refer to the Safety Precautions on page ii). 4. The cables connected to R, S, T and U, V, W terminals should be placed in separate conduits from the encoder or other signal cables. Separate them by at least 30cm (11.8 inches). 5. If the encoder cable (CN2) or the cable for position feedback signal connector (CN5) is too short, please use a twisted-shield signal wire with grounding conductor. The wire length should be 20m (65.62ft.) or less. For lengths greater than 20m (65.62ft.), the wire gauge should be doubled in order to lessen any signal
Revision January 2011

3-3

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

attenuation. For the encoder cable specification, please use AWG26 wire size and the Metal braided shield twisted-pair cable which meets the UL2464 specification. 6. When using CANopen communication, please use the shielded twisted-pair cables to ensure the communication quality. 7. The shield of shielded twisted-pair cables should be connected to the SHIELD end (terminal marked 8. ) of the servo drive.

For the connectors and cables specifications, please refer to section 3.1.6 for details.

3.1.3 Wiring Methods


For servo drives from 200W to 1.5kW the input power can be either single or three-phase. However, single -phase connections are for servo drives 1.5kW and below only. In the wiring diagram figures 3.2 & 3.3: Power ON : contact a (normally open) Power OFF /ALRM_RY : contact b (normally closed) MC : coil of electromagnetic contactor, self-holding power, contact of main circuit power

Figure 3.2 Single-Phase Power Supply Connection (for 1.5kW and below models)

3-4

Revision January 2011

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

Figure 3.3 Three-Phase Power Supply Connection (for all models)

Revision January 2011

3-5

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

3.1.4 Motor Power Cable Connector Specifications


The boxes () in the model names are for optional configurations. (Please refer to section 1.2 for model explanation.)
Motor Model Name U, V, W / Electromagnetic Brake Connector Terminal Identification

ECMA-C10401S (100W) ECMA-C10602S (200W) ECMA-C10604S (400W) ECMA-C108047 (400W) ECMA-C10807S (750W) HOUSING: JOWLE (C4201H00-2*2PA)

ECMA-C10401S (100W) ECMA-C10602S (200W) ECMA-C10604S (400W) ECMA-C108047 (400W) ECMA-C10807S (750W) * : with brake HOUSINGJOWLE (C4201H00-2*3PA)

ECMA-G11303S (300W) ECMA-E11305S (500W) ECMA-G11306S (600W) ECMA-G11309S (900W) ECMA-C11010S (1000W) ECMA-E11310S (1000W) ECMA-E11315S (1500W) ECMA-C11020S (2000W) ECMA-E11320S (2000W)

ECMA-E11820S (2000W) ECMA-E11830S (3000W) ECMA-F11830S (3000W) ECMA-F11845S (4500W) ECMA-F118553 (5500W)

3-6

Revision January 2011

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

Motor Model Name

U, V, W / Electromagnetic Brake Connector

Terminal Identification

ECMA-F118553 (5500W) ECMA-F118753 (7500W)

Motor Model Name

U, V, W / Electromagnetic Brake Connector

Terminal Identification

ECMA-F218553(5500W) ECMA-F218753(7500W)

Terminal Identification A B C D E Terminal Identification F

U (Red) 1 1 F D A BRAKE1 A

V (White) 2 2 I E B

W (Black) 3 4 B F C BRAKE2 B

CASE GROUND (Green) 4 5 E G D

BRAKE1 (Yellow) 3 G A -

BRAKE2 (Blue) 6 H B -

NOTE
1) The coil of brake has no polarity. The names of terminal identification are BRAKE1 (Yellow) and BRAKE2 (Blue). 2) The power supply for brake is DC24V. Never use it for VDD, the +24V source voltage.

Revision January 2011

3-7

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

3.1.5 Encoder Connector Specifications


The boxes () in the model names are for optional configurations. (Please refer to section 1.2 for model explanation.)
Motor Model Name Encoder Connector Terminal Identification

ECMA-C10401S (100W) ECMA-C10602S (200W) ECMA-C10604S (400W) ECMA-C108047 (400W) ECMA-C10807S (750W) HOUSINGAMP (1-172161-9) ECMA-G11303S (300W) ECMA-E11305S (500W) ECMA-G11306S (600W) ECMA-G11309S (900W) ECMA-C11010S (1000W) ECMA-E11310S (1000W) ECMA-E11315S (1500W) ECMA-C11020S (2000W) ECMA-E11320S (2000W) ECMA-E11820S (2000W) ECMA-E11830S (3000W) ECMA-F11830S (3000W) ECMA-F11845S (4500W) ECMA-F118553 (5500W) ECMA- F118753 (7500W)

Terminal Identification A B

T+

T-

Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved

DC+5V

GND

BRAID SHELD 9 L

4 1 (Blue/ (Blue) Black) A B

7 8 (Red & (Black & Red/White) Black/White) S R

3-8

Revision January 2011

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

3.1.6 Cable Specifications for Servo Drive


Power Cable
Servo Drive and Servo Motor ASD-A2-0121- ECMA-C10401S ASD-A2-0221- ECMA-C10602S ECMA-C10604S ASD-A2-0421- ECMA-C108047 ECMA-E11305S ECMA-G11303S ASD-A2-0721- ECMA-C10807S ECMA-G11306S ECMA-C11010S ASD-A2-1021- ASD-A2-1521- ASD-A2-2023- ECMA-E11310S ECMA-G11309S ECMA-E11315S ECMA-C11020S ECMA-E11320S ECMA-E11820S ASD-A2-3023- ASD-A2-4523- ASD-A2-5523- ASD-A2-7523- ECMA-E11830S ECMA-F11830S ECMA-F11845S ECMA-F118553 ECMA-F118753 Power Cable - Wire Gauge AWG (mm2) L1C, L2C 1.3 (AWG16) 1.3 (AWG16) 1.3 (AWG16) 1.3 (AWG16) 1.3 (AWG16) 1.3 (AWG16) 1.3 (AWG16) 1.3 (AWG16) 1.3 (AWG16) 1.3 (AWG16) 1.3 (AWG16) 1.3 (AWG16) 1.3 (AWG16) 1.3 (AWG16) 1.3 (AWG16) 1.3 (AWG16) 1.3 (AWG16) 1.3 (AWG16) 1.3 (AWG16) R, S, T U, V, W P ,C 2.1 (AWG14) 0.82 (AWG18) 2.1 (AWG14) 2.1 (AWG14) 0.82 (AWG18) 2.1 (AWG14) 2.1 (AWG14) 0.82 (AWG18) 2.1 (AWG14) 2.1 (AWG14) 0.82 (AWG18) 2.1 (AWG14) 2.1 (AWG14) 0.82 (AWG18) 2.1 (AWG14) 2.1 (AWG14) 0.82 (AWG18) 2.1 (AWG14) 2.1 (AWG14) 0.82 (AWG18) 2.1 (AWG14) 2.1 (AWG14) 0.82 (AWG18) 2.1 (AWG14) 2.1 (AWG14) 2.1 (AWG14) 2.1 (AWG14) 2.1 (AWG14) 2.1 (AWG14) 2.1 (AWG14) 2.1 (AWG14) 2.1 (AWG14) 2.1 (AWG14) 3.3 (AWG12) 5.3 (AWG10) 1.3 (AWG16) 1.3 (AWG16) 1.3 (AWG16) 1.3 (AWG16) 2.1 (AWG14) 2.1 (AWG14) 3.3 (AWG12) 3.3 (AWG12) 3.3 (AWG12) 8.4 (AWG8) 13.3 (AWG6) 13.3 (AWG6) 2.1 (AWG14) 2.1 (AWG14) 2.1 (AWG14) 2.1 (AWG14) 2.1 (AWG14) 2.1 (AWG14) 2.1 (AWG14) 2.1 (AWG14) 2.1 (AWG14) 3.3 (AWG12) 3.3 (AWG12) 3.3 (AWG12)

1.3 (AWG16) 3.3 (AWG12)

Revision January 2011

3-9

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

Encoder Cable
Servo Drive ASD-A2-0121- ASD-A2-0221- ASD-A2-0421- ASD-A2-0721- ASD-A2-1021- ASD-A2-1521- ASD-A2-2023- ASD-A2-3023- ASD-A2-4523- ASD-A2-5523- ASD-A2-7523- Encoder Cable - Wire Gauge AWG (mm2) Wire Size 0.13 (AWG26) 0.13 (AWG26) 0.13 (AWG26) 0.13 (AWG26) 0.13 (AWG26) 0.13 (AWG26) 0.13 (AWG26) 0.13 (AWG26) 0.13AWG26 0.13AWG26 0.13AWG26 Wire Size 10 core (4 pair) 10 core (4 pair) 10 core (4 pair) 10 core (4 pair) 10 core (4 pair) 10 core (4 pair) 10 core (4 pair) 10 core (4 pair) 10 core (4 pair) 10 core (4 pair) 10 core (4 pair) Wire Size UL2464 UL2464 UL2464 UL2464 UL2464 UL2464 UL2464 UL2464 UL2464 UL2464 UL2464 Wire Size 3m (9.84ft.) 3m (9.84ft.) 3m (9.84ft.) 3m (9.84ft.) 3m (9.84ft.) 3m (9.84ft.) 3m (9.84ft.) 3m (9.84ft.) 3m (9.84ft.) 3m (9.84ft.) 3m (9.84ft.)

NOTE
1) 2) 3) 4) Please use shielded twisted-pair cables for wiring to prevent voltage coupling and eliminate electrical noise and interference. The shield of shielded twisted-pair cables should be connected to the SHIELD end (terminal marked ) of the servo drive. In order to prevent fire hazard and accidents, please form the wiring by following the cable specifications outlined above. The boxes () at the ends of the servo drive model names represent the model type of ASDA-A2 series. For the actual model name, please refer to the ordering information of the actual purchased product. 5) The boxes () in the servo motor model names are for optional configurations (keyway, brake and oil sea).

3-10

Revision January 2011

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

3.2 Connections - 400V series 3.2.1 Connecting to Peripheral Devices


Figure 3.4 Configuration

Revision January 2011

3-11

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

3.2.2 Servo Drive Connectors and Terminals


Terminal Identification DC24V, DC0V R, S, T Terminal Description Control circuit terminal Main circuit terminal Notes Used to connect single-phase AC control circuit power depending on connecting servo drive model. Used to connect three-phase AC main circuit power depending on connecting servo drive model. Used to connect servo motor Terminal Symbol U, V, W FG ( ) U Servo motor output V W FG( ) Wire Color Red White Black Green Description Connecting to threephase motor main circuit cable. Connecting to ground terminal ( of the servo drive. )

Internal resistor

Ensure the circuit is closed between P and D, and the circuit is open between P and C.

Connect regenerative resistor to External resistor P and C, and ensure an open circuit between P and D. P , D, C, Regenerative resistor terminal or braking unit Connect braking unit to P and , and ensure an open circuit between P and D, and P and C. External braking (N terminal is built in L1C, L2C, , and R, S, T.) unit P : Connecting to (+) terminal of V_BUS voltage. : Connecting to (-) terminal of V_BUS voltage. Used to connect grounding wire of power supply and servo motor. Used to connect external controllers. Please refer to section 3.3 for details. Used to connect encoder of servo motor. Please refer to section 3.4 for details. Terminal Symbol Encoder connector (Optional Part) T+ TReserved Reserved +5V GND Wire Color Blue Blue/Black Red & Red/White Black & Black/White Pin No. 5 4 14, 16 13, 15

two places Ground terminal CN1 I/O connector (Optional Part)

CN2

3-12

Revision January 2011

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

Terminal Identification CN3

Terminal Description Communication connector (Optional Part) USB connector (Type B) (Optional Part) Position feedback signal connector (for full-closed loop) (Optional Part) CANopen communication port (Optional Part) Extension digital input terminal (Optional Part) Reserved connector Communication extension connector (Optional Part)

Notes Used for RS-485 or RS-232 communication connection. Please refer to section 3.5 for details. Used to connect personal computer (PC or notebook). Please refer to section 3.6 for details.

CN4

CN5

Used to connect to linear scale or encoder to constitute a full-closed loop. Please refer to section 3.7 for details.

CN6

RJ45 connector, used for CANopen communication. Please refer to section 3.8 for details.

CN7

Used to connect to extension digital inputs. Please refer to section 3.9 for details. Reserved

CN8

CN9

Used to connect to other extension cards (will be available soon).

Wiring Notes Please observe the following wiring notes while performing wiring and touching any electrical connections on the servo drive or servo motor. 1. Ensure to check if the power supply and wiring of the "power" terminals (R, S, T, DC24V & DC0V) is correct. 2. Please use shielded twisted-pair cables for wiring to prevent voltage coupling and eliminate electrical noise and interference. 3. As a residual hazardous voltage may remain inside the drive, please do not immediately touch any of the "power" terminals (R, S, T, DC24V & DC0V) and/or the cables connected to them after the power has been turned off and the charge LED is lit. (Please refer to the Safety Precautions on page ii). 4. The cables connected to R, S, T and U, V, W terminals should be placed in separate conduits from the encoder or other signal cables. Separate them by at least 30cm (11.8 inches). 5. If the encoder cable (CN2) or the cable for position feedback signal connector (CN5) is too short, please use a twisted-shield signal wire with grounding conductor. The wire length should be 20m (65.62ft.) or less. For lengths greater than 20m

Revision January 2011

3-13

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

(65.62ft.), the wire gauge should be doubled in order to lessen any signal attenuation. For the encoder cable specification, please use AWG26 wire size and the Metal braided shield twisted-pair cable which meets the UL2464 specification. 6. When using CANopen communication, please use the shielded twisted-pair cables to ensure the communication quality. 7. The shield of shielded twisted-pair cables should be connected to the SHIELD end (terminal marked 8. ) of the servo drive.

For the connectors and cables specifications, please refer to section 3.1.6 for details.

3.2.3 Wiring Methods


For 400V series servo drives from 750W to 7.5kW the input power can be three-phase only. Single -phase connections are for 200V series servo drives 1.5kW and below only. In the wiring diagram figures 3.5: Power ON : contact a (normally open) Power OFF /ALRM_RY : contact b (normally closed) MC : coil of electromagnetic contactor, self-holding power, contact of main circuit power Figure 3.5 Three-Phase Power Supply Connection (for all models)

3-14

Revision January 2011

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

3.2.4 Motor Power Cable Connector Specifications


The boxes () in the model names are for optional configurations. (Please refer to section 1.2 for model explanation.)
Motor Model Name U, V, W / Electromagnetic Brake Connector Terminal Identification

ECMA-J10807S (750W)

HOUSING: JOWLE (C4201H00-2*2PA)

ECMA-J10807S (750W) B *with brake

HOUSINGJOWLE (C4201H00-2*3PA)

ECMA-K11310S (1000W) ECMA-K11315S (1500W) ECMA-K11320S (2000W)

ECMA-L11830S (3000W) ECMA-L11845S (4500W) ECMA-L118553 (5500W) ECMA-L118753 (7500W)

Revision January 2011

3-15

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

Motor Model Name

U, V, W / Electromagnetic Brake Connector

Terminal Identification

ECMA-F118553 (5500W) ECMA-F118753 (7500W)

ECMA-F218553(5500W) ECMA-F218753(7500W)

Terminal Identification A B C D E Terminal Identification F

U (Red) 1 1 F D A BRAKE1 A

V (White) 2 2 I E B

W (Black) 3 4 B F C BRAKE2 B

CASE GROUND (Green) 4 5 E G D

BRAKE1 (Yellow) 3 G A -

BRAKE2 (Blue) 6 H B -

NOTE
1) The coil of brake has no polarity. The names of terminal identification are BRAKE1 (Yellow) and BRAKE2 (Blue). 2) The power supply for brake is DC24V. Never use it for VDD, the +24V source voltage.

3-16

Revision January 2011

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

3.2.5 Encoder Connector Specifications


The boxes () in the model names are for optional configurations. (Please refer to section 1.2 for model explanation.)
Motor Model Name Encoder Connector Terminal Identification

ECMA-J10807S (750W)

HOUSINGAMP (1-172161-9)

ECMA-K11310S (1000W) ECMA-K11315S (1500W) ECMA-K11320S (2000W) ECMA-L11830S (3000W) ECMA-L11845S (4500W) ECMA-L118553 (5500W) ECMA-L118753 (7500W)

Terminal Identification A B

T+

T-

Reserved

Reserved

Reserved

Reserved

DC+5V

GND

BRAID SHELD 9 L

4 1 (Blue/ (Blue) Black) A B

7 8 (Red & (Black & Red/White) Black/White) S R

Revision January 2011

3-17

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

3.2.6 Cable Specifications for Servo Drive


Power Cable
Servo Drive and Servo Motor ASD-A2-0743- ASD-A2-1043- ASD-A2-1543- ASD-A2-2043- ASD-A2-3043- ASD-A2-4543- ASD-A2-5543- ASD-A2-7543- ECMA-J10807S ECMA-K11310S ECMA-K11315S ECMA-K11320S ECMA-L11830S ECMA-L11845S ECMA-L118553 ECMA-L118753 Power Cable - Wire Gauge AWG (mm2) DC24V, DC0V 1.3 (AWG16) 1.3 (AWG16) 1.3 (AWG16) 1.3 (AWG16) 1.3 (AWG16) 1.3 (AWG16) 1.3 (AWG16) 1.3 (AWG16) R, S, T 2.1 (AWG14) 2.1 (AWG14) 2.1 (AWG14) 2.1 (AWG14) 3.3 (AWG12) 3.3 (AWG12) 5.3 (AWG10) U, V, W 1.3 (AWG16) 1.3 (AWG16) 2.1 (AWG14) 3.3 (AWG12) 8.4 (AWG8) 13.3 (AWG6) 13.3 (AWG6) P ,C 2.1 (AWG14) 2.1 (AWG14) 2.1 (AWG14) 2.1 (AWG14) 3.3 (AWG12) 3.3 (AWG12) 3.3 (AWG12) 2.1 (AWG14) 0.82 (AWG18) 2.1 (AWG14)

Encoder Cable
Servo Drive ASD-A2-0743- ASD-A2-1043- ASD-A2-1543- ASD-A2-2043- ASD-A2-3043- ASD-A2-4543- ASD-A2-5543- ASD-A2-7543- Encoder Cable - Wire Gauge AWG (mm2) Wire Size 0.13 (AWG26) 0.13 (AWG26) 0.13 (AWG26) 0.13 (AWG26) 0.13 (AWG26) 0.13 (AWG26) 0.13 (AWG26) 0.13AWG26 Wire Size 10 core (4 pair) 10 core (4 pair) 10 core (4 pair) 10 core (4 pair) 10 core (4 pair) 10 core (4 pair) 10 core (4 pair) 10 core (4 pair) Wire Size UL2464 UL2464 UL2464 UL2464 UL2464 UL2464 UL2464 UL2464 Wire Size 3m (9.84ft.) 3m (9.84ft.) 3m (9.84ft.) 3m (9.84ft.) 3m (9.84ft.) 3m (9.84ft.) 3m (9.84ft.) 3m (9.84ft.)

NOTE
1) 2) 3) 4) Please use shielded twisted-pair cables for wiring to prevent voltage coupling and eliminate electrical noise and interference. The shield of shielded twisted-pair cables should be connected to the SHIELD end (terminal marked ) of the servo drive. In order to prevent fire hazard and accidents, please form the wiring by following the cable specifications outlined above. The boxes () at the ends of the servo drive model names represent the model type of ASDA-A2 series. For the actual model name, please refer to the ordering information of the actual purchased product. 5) The boxes () in the servo motor model names are for optional configurations (keyway, brake and oil sea).

3-18

Revision January 2011

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

3.3 Basic Wiring 3.3.1 220V series


Figure 3.6 Basic Wiring Schematic of 400W and below models (Without built-in regenerative resistor)

Revision January 2011

3-19

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

Figure 3.7 Basic Wiring Schematic of 750W to 4.5kW models (With built-in regenerative resistor and fan)

3-20

Revision January 2011

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

Figure 3.8 Basic Wiring Schematic of 5.5kW to 7.5kW models (With built-in fan but no regenerative resistor)

Revision January 2011

3-21

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

3.3.2 400V series


Figure 3.9 Basic Wiring Schematic of 750W to 1.5kW models (With built-in regenerative resistor and fan)

3-22

Revision January 2011

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

Figure 3.10 Basic Wiring Schematic of 2kW to 5.5kW models (With built-in fan but no regenerative resistor)

Revision January 2011

3-23

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

3.4 Input / Output Interface Connector -CN1


The CN1 Interface Connector provides access to three signal groups: i General interface for the analog speed and torque control, encoder reference signal from the motor, pulse / direction inputs, and reference voltages. ii 8 programmable Digital Inputs (DI), can be set via parameters P2-10 ~ P2-17

iii 5 programmable Digital Outputs (DO), can be set via parameters P2-18 ~ P2-22 A detailed explanation of each group is available in Section 3.3.2, Tables 3.A, 3.B & 3.C.

3.4.1 CN1 Terminal Identification


Figure 3.11 The Layout of CN1 Drive Connector

CN1 Drive Connector

Side View

Rear View

3-24

Revision January 2011

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

CN1 Terminal Signal Identification


1 2 DO3Digital output 3 4 DO2Digital output 5 6 DO1Digital output 7 8 DI4Digital input 9 10 DI2Digital input 11 COM+ Power input (12~24V) 12 GND Analog input signal ground No Connection DI1Digital input 35 PULL HI_S (SIGN) 37 SIGN 13 GND Analog input signal ground 15 MON2 Analog monitor output 2 17 VDD +24V power output (for external I/O) 19 GND Analog input signal ground 21 OA Encoder A pulse output 23 /OB Encoder /B pulse output 25 OB Encoder B pulse output 49 COM47 COMVDD(24V) power ground VDD(24V) power ground 50 OZ 48 OCZ 45 COMVDD(24V) power ground 46 HSIGN High-speed position sign (+) Encoder Z pulse opencollector output Encoder Z pulse linedriver output 43 /PULSE Pulse input (-) 44 GND 39 PULL HI_P (PULSE) 41 PULSE Position sign (+) Pulse applied Power (PULSE) Pulse input (+) 42 V_REF Pulse applied power (SIGN) 36 /SIGN Position sign (-) 38 HPULSE High-speed position pulse (+) 40 /HSIGN High-speed position sign (-) Analog speed input (+) Analog input signal ground DO1+ Digital output 33 DI5Digital input 34 DI3Digital input DO2+ Digital output 31 DI7DO3+ Digital output 29 /HPULSE High-speed position pulse (-) Digital input 32 DI6Digital input 30 DI8Digital input DO4+ Digital output 27 DO5Digital output 28 DO5+ Digital output 26 DO4Digital output

14 NC

16 MON1 Analog monitor output 1 18 T_REF Analog torque Input 20 VCC +12V power output (for analog command) 22 /OA Encoder /A pulse output 24 /OZ Encoder /Z pulse output

NOTE
1) The terminal marked "NC" must be left unconnected (No Connection). The NC terminal is used within the servo drive. Any outside connection to the NC terminal will result in damage to the drive and void the warranty!

Revision January 2011

3-25

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

3.4.2 Signals Explanation of Connector CN1


The Tables 3.A, 3.B, & 3.C detail the three groups of signals of the CN1 interface. Table 3.A details the general signals. Table 3.B details the Digital Output (DO) signals and Table 3.C details the Digital Input (DI) signals. The General Signals are set by the factory and can not be changed, reprogrammed or adjusted. Both the Digital Input and Digital Output signals can be programmed by the users.
Table 3.A General Signals Signal Pin No Details 1. Motor speed command: -10V to +10V, corresponds to -3000 ~ +3000 r/min speed command (Factory default setting). 2. Motor speed command: -10V to +10V, corresponds to -3 ~ +3 rotations position command (Factory default setting). Motor torque command: -10V to +10V, corresponds to -100% to +100% rated torque command. Monitor operation status: Motor characteristics such as speed and current can be represented by analog voltages. The drive provides two channels which can be configured with the parameter P0-03 to output the desired characteristics. Please reference the parameter P0-03 for monitoring commands and P1-04 / P1-05 for scaling factors. Output voltage is reference to the power ground. The drive can accept two different types of pulse inputs: Line-driver input (max. input frequency is 500Kpps) and Open-collector input (max. input frequency is 200Kpps). Three different pulse commands can be selected via parameter P1-00. They are A phase + B phase (Quadrature), CW pulse + CCW pulse, and Pulse + Direction. When an Open-collector type of pulse is used, this terminal must be connected to a pull-up power supply. The drive can accept two different types of high-speed pulse inputs: +5V input and Linedriver input. The max. input frequency is 4MHz. Three different pulse commands can be selected via parameter P1-00. They are A phase + B phase (Quadrature), CW pulse + CCW pulse, and Pulse + Direction. Wiring Diagram (Refer to 3.3.4)

Analog Signal Input

V_REF

42

C1

T_REF

18

C1

Analog Monitor Output

MON1 MON2

16 15

C2

Position Pulse Input

PULSE /PULSE SIGN /SIGN

43 41 36 37

C3/C4

PULL HI_P PULL HI_S

39 35

C3/C4

HighHSIGN speed /HSIGN Position HPULSE Pulse /HPULSE Input

46 40 38 29

C4-2

3-26

Revision January 2011

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

Signal OA /OA Position Pulse Output OB /OB OZ /OZ OCZ VDD

Pin No 21 22 25 23 50 24 48 17

Details

Wiring Diagram (Refer to 3.3.4)

Encoder signal output A, B, Z (Line-driver output). The motor encoder signals are available through these terminals.

C13/C14

Encoder signal output Z (Open-collector output). VDD is the +24V source voltage provided by the drive. Maximum permissible current 500mA. COM+ is the common voltage rail of the Digital Input (DI) and Digital Output (DO) signals. When using VDD, VDD should be connected to COM+. If not using VDD, the users should add an external applied power (+12V to +24V). The positive end of this applied power should be connected to COM+ and the negative end of this applied power should be connected to COM-. VCC is a +12V power rail provided by the drive. It is used for providing simple analog command (analog speed or analog torque command). Maximum permissible current 100mA.

COM+ COMPower

11 45 47 49

VCC

20

GND Other NC

12,13, The polarity of VCC is with respect to Ground 19,44 (GND). 14 See previous note for NC terminal description of CN1 connector on page 3-13.

The Digital Input (DI) and Digital Output (DO) have factory default settings which correspond to the various servo drive control modes. (See section 6.1). However, both the DI's and DO's can be programmed independently to meet the requirements of the users. Detailed in Tables 3.B and 3.C are the DO and DI functions with their corresponding signal name and wiring schematic. The factory default settings of the DI and DO signals are detailed in Table 3.G and 3.H. All of the DI's and DO's and their corresponding pin numbers are factory set and nonchangeable, however, all of the assigned signals and control modes are user changeable. For Example, the factory default setting of DO5 (pins 28/27) can be assigned to DO1 (pins 7/6) and vise versa.

Revision January 2011

3-27

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

The following Tables 3.B and 3.C detail the functions, applicable operational modes, signal name and relevant wiring schematic of the default DI and DO signals. Table 3.B DO Signals
Assigned Pin No. DO Signal Control (Default) Mode + SRDY ALL 7 6 Details SRDY is activated when the servo drive is ready to run. All fault and alarm conditions, if present, have been cleared. SON is activated when control power is applied the servo drive. The drive may or may not be ready to run as a fault / alarm condition may exist. Servo ON (SON) is "ON" with control power applied to the servo drive, there may be a fault condition or not. The servo is not ready to run. Servo ready (SRDY) is "ON" where the servo is ready to run, NO fault / alarm exists. ZSPD is activated when the drive senses the motor is equal to or below the Zero Speed Range setting as defined in parameter P1-38. For Example, at factory default ZSPD will be activated when the drive detects the motor rotating at speed at or below 10 r/min, ZSPD will remain activated until the motor speed increases above 10 r/min. TSPD is activated once the drive has detected the motor has reached the Target Rotation Speed setting as defined in parameter P1-39. TSPD will remain activated until the motor speed drops below the Target Rotation Speed. Wiring Diagram (Refer to 3.3.4)

SON

Not assigned

ZSPD

ALL

TSPD

ALL (except PT, PR)

C5/C6/C7/C8

TPOS

PT, PR, PT-S, PT-T, PR-S, PR-T

TQL

Not assigned

1. When the drive is in PT mode, TPOS will be activated when the position error is equal and below the setting value of P154. 2. When the drive is in PR mode, TPOS will be activated when the drive detects that 26 the position of the motor is in a -P1-54 to +P1-54 band of the target position. For Example, at factory default TPOS will activate once the motor is in -99 pulses range of the target position, then deactivate after it reaches +99 pulses range of the desired position. TQL is activated when the drive has detected that the motor has reached the torques limits set by either the parameters P1-12 ~ P1-14 of via an external analog voltage. ALRM is activated when the drive has detected a fault condition. (However, when Reverse limit error, Forward limit error, Emergency 27 stop, Serial communication error, and Undervoltage these fault occur, WARN is activated first.)

ALRM

ALL

28

3-28

Revision January 2011

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

Assigned Pin No. DO Signal Control (Default) Mode + BRKR HOME ALL ALL 3 2

Details BRKR is activated actuation of motor brake. HOME is activated when the servo drive has detected that the "HOME" sensor (ORGP, digital input 0x24) has been detected. OLW is activated when the servo drive has detected that the motor has reached the output overload level set by the parameter P156. Servo warning output. WARN is activated when the drive has detected Reverse limit error, Forward limit error, Emergency stop, Serial communication error, and Undervoltage these fault conditions. Position command overflow. OVF is activated when the servo drive has detected that a position command overflows. Reverse software limit. SNL is activated when the servo drive has detected that reverse software limit is reached. Forward software limit. SPL is activated when the servo drive has detected that forward software limit is reached. Internal position command completed output. CMDOK is activated when the servo drive has detected that the internal position command has been completed. Capture operation completed output. CAP_OK is activated when the servo drive has detected that capture operation has been completed. Motion control completed output. MC_OK is activated when CMD_OK and TPOS are both ON. It indicates MC_OK is activated only when the servo drive has detected that the position command has been given and the positioning has been completed also. If only CMD_OK or TPOS is ON, MC_OK will not be activated. CAM_AREA is activated when the servo drive has detected the master position of E-CAM (electronic CAM) is within the setting area. SP_OK will be activated when the speed error is equal and below the setting value of P1-47. Output the status of bit00 of P4-06. Output the status of bit01 of P4-06. Output the status of bit02 of P4-06. Output the status of bit03 of P4-06.

Wiring Diagram (Refer to 3.3.4)

OLW

ALL

WARN

ALL

OVF SNL (SCWL) SPL (SCCWL)

ALL

PR

PR

C5/C6/C7/C8

CMD_OK

PR

CAP_OK

PR

MC_OK

PR

CAM_AREA

PR

SP_OK SDO_0 SDO_1 SDO_2 SDO_3

S, Sz ALL ALL ALL ALL

Revision January 2011

3-29

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

Assigned Pin No. DO Signal Control (Default) Mode + SDO_4 SDO_5 SDO_6 SDO_7 SDO_8 SDO_9 SDO_A SDO_B SDO_C SDO_D SDO_E SDO_F ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL -

Details Output the status of bit04 of P4-06. Output the status of bit05 of P4-06. Output the status of bit06 of P4-06. Output the status of bit07 of P4-06. Output the status of bit08 of P4-06. Output the status of bit09 of P4-06. Output the status of bit10 of P4-06. Output the status of bit11 of P4-06. Output the status of bit12 of P4-06. Output the status of bit13 of P4-06. Output the status of bit14 of P4-06. Output the status of bit15 of P4-06.

Wiring Diagram (Refer to 3.3.4)

C5/C6/C7/C8

NOTE
1) PINS 3 & 2 can either be TSPD or HOME dependent upon control mode selected. 2) The DO signals that do not have pin numbers in Tables 3.B are not default DO signals. If the users want to use these non-default DO signals, the users need to change the settings of parameters P2-18 ~ P2-22. The state of the output function may be turned ON or OFF as it will be dependant on the settings of parameters P2-18 ~ P2-22. Please refer to section 3.3.3 for details.

3-30

Revision January 2011

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

Table 3.C DI Signals


DI Signal SON Assigned Pin No. Control Mode (Default) ALL 9 Details Servo On. Switch servo to "Servo Ready". A number of Faults (Alarms) can be cleared by activating ARST. Please see table 10-3 for applicable faults that can be cleared with the ARST command. However, please investigate Fault or Alarm if it does not clear or the fault description warrants closer inspection of the drive system. Gain switching When CCLR is activated, the setting parameter P2-50 Pulse Clear Mode is executed. When this signal is On and the motor speed value is lower than the setting value of P138, it is used to lock the motor in the instant position while ZCLAMP is On. When this signal is On, the motor is in reverse rotation. When the drive is in PR mode and CTRG is activated, the drive will command the motor to move the stored position which correspond the POS 0 ~ POS 5 settings. Activation is triggered on the rising edge of the pulse. ON indicates the torque limit command is valid. ON indicates the speed limit command is valid. Wiring Diagram (Refer to 3.3.4)

ARST

ALL

33

GAINUP CCLR

ALL PT, PR

10

ZCLAMP

ALL

CMDINV

PR, T, S PR, PR-S, PR-T, S, Sz S, Sz T, Tz

CTRG

10

C9/C10/C11 /C12

TRQLM SPDLM POS0 POS1 POS2 POS3 POS4 POS5 STOP SPD0 SPD1

10 10 34 8

PR, PR-S, PR-T

When the PR Control Mode is selected, the 64 stored positions are programmed via a combination of the POS 0 ~ POS 5 commands. See table 3.D.

S, Sz, PTS, PR-S, S-T

34 8

Motor stop. Select the source of speed command: See table 3.E.

Revision January 2011

3-31

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

DI Signal TCM0 TCM1 S-P S-T T-P PT-PR

Assigned Pin No. Control Mode (Default) PT, T, Tz, PT-T, PRT, S-T PT-S, PRS S-T PT-T, PRT PT, PR 34 8 31 31 31 -

Details

Wiring Diagram (Refer to 3.3.4)

Select the source of torque command: See table 3.F. Speed / Position mode switching OFF: Speed, ON: Position Speed / Torque mode switching OFF: Speed, ON: Torque Torque / Position mode switching OFF: Torque, ON: Position Internal position (PR) and external pulse (PT) mode switching. OFF: PT, ON: PR External command source selection: pulse and analog voltage switching. OFF: The command source is external pulse. ON: The command source is external analog voltage. External command source selection: highspeed / low-speed pulse switching OFF: The command source is low-speed pulse (PULSE, /PULSE, SIGN, /SIGN). ON: The command source is high-speed pulse (HPULSE, /HPULSE, HSIGN, /HSIGN). When high-speed pulse is selected, the users can add an external manual pulse generator and use this DI signal to switch the command source. It should be contact b and normally ON or a fault (AL013) will display. Reverse inhibit limit. It should be contact b and normally ON or a fault (AL014) will display. Forward inhibit limit. It should be contact b and normally ON or a fault (AL015) will display. When ORGP is activated, the drive will command the motor to start to search the reference Home sensor. When SHOM is activated, the drive will command the motor to move to Home. Electronic cam engaging control. [see P5-88] Forward JOG input. When JOGU is activated, the motor will JOG in forward direction. [see P4-05]

PTAS

PT

PTCMS

PT

C9/C10/C11 /C12

EMGS NL(CWL)

ALL PT, PR, S, T, Sz, Tz PT, PR, S, T, Sz, Tz PR PR PR ALL

30 32

PL(CCWL)

31

ORGP SHOM CAM JOGU

3-32

Revision January 2011

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

DI Signal JOGD EV1 EV2 EV3

Assigned Pin No. Control Mode (Default) ALL PR PR PR -

Details Reverse JOG input. When JOGD is activated, the motor will JOG in reverse direction. [see P4-05] Event trigger command 1. Event trigger command 2. Event trigger command 3. (available for ASDA-A2 firmware version V1.008 sub04 or later) Event trigger command 4. (available for ASDA-A2 firmware version V1.008 sub04 or later) Electronic gear ratio (Numerator) selection 0. [See P2-60~P2-62] Electronic gear ratio (Numerator) selection 1. [See P2-60~P2-62] Pulse inhibit input. When the drive is in position mode, if INHP is activated, the external pulse input command is not valid.

Wiring Diagram (Refer to 3.3.4)

EV4

PR PT, PR, PT-S, PRS PT, PR, PT-S, PRS PT, PT-S

C9/C10/C11 /C12

GNUM0

GNUM1

INHP

NOTE
1) The DI signals that do not have pin numbers in Tables 3.C are not default DI signals. If the users want to use these non-default DI signals, the users need to change the settings of parameters P2-10 ~ P2-17. The state of the output function may be turned ON or OFF as it will be dependant on the settings of parameters P2-10 ~ P2-17. Please refer to section 3.3.3 for details.

Revision January 2011

3-33

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

Table 3.D Source of Position Command


Position Command P1 P2 ~ P50 P51 ~ P64 OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF ON ON ON ON OFF OFF ON OFF POS5 ON ON POS4 ON ON POS3 ON ON POS2 ON ON POS1 ON ON POS0 ON OFF CTRG Parameters P6-00 P6-01 P6-02 P6-03 ~ P6-98 P6-99 P7-00 P7-01 ~ P7-26 P7-27

Table 3.E Source of Speed Command


SPD1 OFF OFF ON ON SPD0 OFF ON OFF ON Parameters S mode: analog input Sz mode: 0 P1-09 P1-10 P1-11

Table 3.F Source of Torque Command


TCM1 OFF OFF ON ON TCM0 OFF ON OFF ON Parameters T mode: analog input Tz mode: 0 P1-12 P1-13 P1-14

The default DI and DO signals in different control mode are listed in the following table 3.G and table 3.H. Although the content of the table 3.G and table 3.H do not provide more information than the table 3.B and table 3.C above, as each control mode is separated and listed in different row, it is easy for user to view and can avoid confusion. However, the Pin number of each signal can not be displayed in the table 3.G and table 3.H.

3-34

Revision January 2011

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

Table 3.G Default DI signals and Control modes


Signal SON ARST GAINUP CCLR ZCLAMP CMDINV DI Code Function PT PR S T Sz Tz PT-S PTPRPR-S S-T T T

0x01 Servo On 0x02 Reset 0x03 Gain switching 0x04 Pulse clear 0x05 Low speed CLAMP 0x06 Command input reverse control

DI1 DI1 DI1 DI1 DI1 DI1 DI1 DI1 DI1 DI1 DI1 DI5 DI5 DI5 DI5 DI5 DI5

DI2

DI2 DI2

Reserved 0x07 Reserved CTRG TRQLM SPDLM POS0 POS1 POS2 POS3 POS4 POS5 STOP SPD0 SPD1 TCM0 TCM1 S-P 0x08 Command triggered 0x09 Torque limit enabled 0x10 Speed limit enabled 0x11 0x12 0x13 0x1A 0x1B 0x1C Position command selection 0 (1~64) Position command selection 1 (1~64) Position command selection 2 (1~64) Position command selection 3 (1~64) Position command selection 4 (1~64) Position command selection 5 (1~64) DI3 DI4 DI2 DI2 DI2 DI2 DI2 DI3 DI3 DI4 DI4 DI2 DI2

0x46 Motor stop 0x14 0x15 0x16 0x17 Speed command selection 0 (1~4) Speed command selection 1 (1~4) Torque command selection 0 (1~4) Torque command selection 1 (1~4) DI3 DI4 DI3 DI4 DI3 DI4 DI3 DI4 DI3 DI4 DI7 DI3 DI4 DI3 DI4 DI7 DI5 DI6 DI3 DI4 DI5 DI5 DI6 DI6

Position / Speed mode 0x18 switching (OFF: Speed, ON: Position) Speed / Torque mode 0x19 switching (OFF: Speed, ON: Torque) Torque / Position 0x20 mode switching (OFF: Torque, ON: Position)

S-T

DI7

T-P

DI7

DI7

Revision January 2011

3-35

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

Signal

DI Code

Function

PT

PR

Sz

Tz PT-S

PTPRPR-S S-T T T

PT-PR

Internal position (PR) and external pulse (PT) 0x2B mode switching (OFF: PT, ON: PR) External command source selection: pulse 0x2C and analog voltage switching (in PT mode only) External command source selection: high0x2 speed / low-speed D pulse switching (in PT mode only) 0x21 Emergency stop 0x22 Reverse inhibit limit DI8 DI8 DI8 DI8 DI8 DI8 DI8 DI8 DI8 DI8 DI8 DI6 DI6 DI6 DI6 DI6 DI6 DI7 DI7 DI7 DI7 DI7 DI7

PTAS

PTCMS

EMGS NL(CWL)

PL(CCWL) 0x23 Forward inhibit limit ORGP SHOM CAM JOGU JOGD EV1 0x24 Reference Home sensor

0x27 Move to Home 0x36 Electronic cam engaging control

0x37 Forward JOG input 0x38 Reverse JOG input Event trigger 0x39 command 1 [see P5-98, P5-99] Event trigger 0x3A command 2 [see P5-98, P5-99] Event trigger command 1 0x3B (available for ASDA-A2 firmware version V1.008 sub04 or later) Event trigger command 2 0x3C (available for ASDA-A2 firmware version V1.008 sub04 or later) Electronic gear ratio 0x43 (Numerator) selection 0 Electronic gear ratio 0x44 (Numerator) selection 1 0x45 Pulse inhibit input
Revision January 2011

EV2

EV3

EV4

GNUM0

GNUM1 INHP 3-36

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

NOTE
1) For Pin numbers of DI1~DI8 signals, please refer to section 3.3.1.

Table 3.H Default DO signals and Control modes


Signal SRDY SON ZSPD TSPD TPOS TQL ALRM BRKR HOME OLW WARN OVF SNL (SCWL) SPL (SCCWL) CMD_OK CAP_OK MC_OK DO Code Function PT PR S T Sz Tz PT-S PT-T PR-S PR-T S-T

0x01 Servo ready 0x02 Servo On 0x03 At Zero speed 0x04 At Speed reached 0x05 At Positioning completed

DO1 DO1 DO1 DO1 DO1 DO1 DO1 DO1 DO1 DO1 DO1

DO2 DO2 DO2 DO2 DO2 DO2 DO2 DO2 DO2 DO2 DO2 DO3 DO3 DO3 DO3 DO3 DO3 DO3 DO3 DO3 DO4 DO4 DO4 DO4 DO4 DO4 DO4

0x06 At Torques limit 0x07 0x08 Servo alarm (Servo fault) activated Electromagnetic brake control DO3 DO3 DO5 DO5 DO5 DO5 DO5 DO5 DO5 DO5 DO5 DO5 DO5 DO4 DO4 DO4 DO4

0x09 Homing completed 0x10 0x11 0x12 0x13 0x14 Output overload warning Servo warning activated Position command overflow Reverse software limit Forward software limit

Internal position 0x15 command completed output 0x16 0x17 Capture operation completed output Motion control completed output

Master position of ECAM_AREA 0x18 CAM (electronic CAM) SP_OK SDO_0 0x19 0x30 Speed reached output Output the status of bit00 of P4-06.

Revision January 2011

3-37

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

Signal SDO_1 SDO_2 SDO_3 SDO_4 SDO_5 SDO_6 SDO_7 SDO_8 SDO_9 SDO_A SDO_B SDO_C SDO_D SDO_E SDO_F

DO Code 0x31 0x32 0x33 0x34 0x35 0x36 0x37 0x38 0x39 0x3A 0x3B 0x3C 0x3D 0x3E 0x3F

Function Output the status of bit01 of P4-06. Output the status of bit02 of P4-06. Output the status of bit03 of P4-06. Output the status of bit04 of P4-06. Output the status of bit05 of P4-06. Output the status of bit06 of P4-06. Output the status of bit07 of P4-06. Output the status of bit08 of P4-06. Output the status of bit09 of P4-06. Output the status of bit10 of P4-06. Output the status of bit11 of P4-06. Output the status of bit12 of P4-06. Output the status of bit13 of P4-06. Output the status of bit14 of P4-06. Output the status of bit15 of P4-06.

PT

PR

Sz

Tz PT-S PT-T PR-S PR-T S-T

NOTE
1) For Pin numbers of DO1~DO5 signals, please refer to section 3.3.1.

3-38

Revision January 2011

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

3.4.3 User-defined DI and DO signals


If the default DI and DO signals could not be able to fulfill users requirements, there are still user-defined DI and DO signals. The setting method is easy and they are all defined via parameters. The user-defined DI and DO signals are defined via parameters P2-10 to P2-17 and P2-18 to P2-22. Please refer to the following Table 3.I for the settings. Table 3.I User-defined DI and DO signals
Signal Name DI1DI2DI3DI4Standard DI DI5DI6DI7DI8EDI9 EDI10 Extension DI EDI11 EDI12 EDI13 EDI14 Pin No. Pin 9 of CN1 Pin 10 of CN1 Pin 34 of CN1 Pin 8 of CN1 Pin 33 of CN1 Pin 32 of CN1 Pin 31 of CN1 Pin 30 of CN1 Pin 2 of CN7 Pin 3 of CN7 Pin 4 of CN7 Pin 5 of CN7 Pin 6 of CN7 Pin 7 of CN7 Parameters P2-10 P2-11 P2-12 P2-13 P2-14 P2-15 P2-16 P2-17 P2-36 P2-37 P2-38 P2-39 P2-40 P2-41 Standard DO Signal Name DO1+ DO1DO2+ DO2DO3+ DO3DO4+ DO4DO5+ DO5Pin No. Pin 7 of CN1 Pin 6 of CN1 Pin 5 of CN1 Pin 4 of CN1 Pin 3 of CN1 P2-20 Pin 2 of CN1 Pin 1 of CN1 Pin 26 of CN1 Pin 28 of CN1 Pin 27 of CN1 P2-21 P2-18 Parameters

P2-19

P2-22

Revision January 2011

3-39

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

3.3.4 Wiring Diagrams of I/O Signals (CN1)


The valid voltage range of analog input command in speed and torque mode is -10V ~+10V. The command value can be set via relevant parameters. The value of input impedance is 10k.
C1: Speed / Torque analog signal input

C2: Analog monitor output (MON1, MON2)

3-40

Revision January 2011

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

There are two kinds of pulse inputs, Line driver input and Open-collector input. Max. input pulse frequency of Line-driver input is 500kpps and max. input pulse frequency of Open-collector input is 200kpps.
C3-1: Pulse input, for the use of internal power supply (Open-collector input)

Revision January 2011

3-41

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

C3-2: Pulse input, for the use of external power supply (Open-collector input)

Caution: Do not use dual power supply. Failure to observe this caution may result in damage to the servo drive and servo motor.

3-42

Revision January 2011

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

C4-1: Pulse input (Line driver input). It requires 5V power supply only. Never apply a 24V power supply.

Revision January 2011

3-43

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

C4-2: High-speed pulse input (Line driver). It requires 5V power supply only. Never apply a 24V power supply.

Caution: Ensure that the ground terminal of the controller and the servo drive should be connected to each other.

Be sure to connect a diode when the drive is applied to inductive load. (Permissible current: 40mA, Instantaneous peak current: max. 100mA)
C5: Wiring of DO signal, for the use of internal power supply, general load C6: Wiring of DO signal, for the use of internal power supply, inductive load

3-44

Revision January 2011

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

C7: Wiring of DO signal, for the use of external C8: Wiring of DO signal, for the use of external power supply, general load power supply, inductive load

Use a relay or open-collector transistor to input signal. NPN transistor with multiple emitter fingers (SINK Mode)
C9: Wiring of DI signal, for the use of internal power supply C10: Wiring of DI signal, for the use of external power supply

PNP transistor with multiple emitter fingers (SOURCE Mode)


C11: Wiring of DI signal, for the use of internal power supply C12: Wiring of DI signal, for the use of external power supply

Caution: Do not use dual power supply. Failure to observe this caution may result in damage to the servo drive and servo motor.

Revision January 2011

3-45

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

C13: Encoder output signal (Line driver)

C14: Encoder output signal (Photocoupler)

C15: Encoder OCZ output (Open-collector Z-pulse output

3-46

Revision January 2011

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

3.5 Encoder Connector CN2


Feedback to the amplifier of the UVW signals for commutation is via the ABZ encoder signal wires. Following rotor position sensing the amplifier automatically switches to encoding for commutation control. The 20-bit encoder is automatically multiplied to 1280000ppr for increased control accuracy. Figure 3.12 The layout of CN2 Drive Connector

CN2 Drive Connector

Side View

Rear View

Layout of CN2 Drive Connector

Figure 3.13 The layout of CN2 Motor Connector

Quick Connector HOUSING: AMP (1-172161-9) Military Connector 3106A-20-29S

Revision January 2011

3-47

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

CN2 Terminal Signal Identification Drive Connector PIN No. Terminal Identification T+ Description Serial communication signal input / output (+) Serial communication signal input / output (-) Reserved Reserved +5V power supply Ground Shielding Military Connector A Motor Connector Quick Connector 1 Color

Blue

4 14,16 13,15 -

T+5V GND -

B S R L

4 7 8 9

Blue/Black Red & Red/White Black & Black/White -

3-48

Revision January 2011

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

3.6 Serial Communication Connector CN3 3.6.1 CN3 Terminal Layout and Identification
The servo drive can be connected to a PC or controller via this serial communication connector CN3. Users can operate the servo drive through PC software supplied by Delta. The communication connector/port of Delta servo drive can provide two common serial communication interfaces: RS-232 and RS-485 connection. RS-232 is mostly be used but is somewhat limited. The maximum cable length for an RS-232 connection is 15 meters (50 feet). Using RS-485 interface can allow longer distance for transmission and support multiple drives to be connected simultaneously. Figure 3.14 The layout of CN3 Drive Connector

CN3 Drive Connector

Side View

Rear View

Revision January 2011

3-49

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

CN3 Terminal Signal Identification PIN No. 1 2 3 4 5 6 Signal Name Grounding RS-232 data transmission RS-232 data receiving RS-485 data transmission RS-485 data transmission Terminal Identification GND RS-232_TX RS-232_RX RS-485(+) RS-485(-) Ground For data transmission of the servo drive. Connected to the RS-232 interface of PC. Reserved For data receiving of the servo drive. Connected to the RS-232 interface of PC. For data transmission of the servo drive (differential line driver + end) For data transmission of the servo drive (differential line driver - end) Description

NOTE
1) 2) For the connection of RS-485, please refer to page 9.3. There are two kinds of IEEE1394 communication cables available on the market. If the user uses one kind of cable, which its GND terminal (Pin 1) and its shielding is short-circuited, the communication may be damaged. Never connect the case of the terminal to the ground of this kind of communication cable.

3.6.2 Connection between PC and Connector CN3

3-50

Revision January 2011

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

3.7 Serial Communication Connector CN4 (USB)


The servo drive can be connected to a PC via this serial communication connector CN4. Users can operate the servo drive through PC software supplied by Delta. The USB transmission speed can reach up to 1MB. Therefore, the users can easily monitor the servo drive data in real time by using Data Scope function provided by Delta PC software. Figure 3.15 The layout of CN4 Drive Connector

CN4 Terminal Signal Identification PIN No. 1 2 3 4 Signal Name V bus DD+ GND Description DC +5V (external power supply) DataData+ Ground

Revision January 2011

3-51

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

3.8 Position Feedback Signal Connector CN5 (for Full-close Control)


The servo drive can be connected to a linear scale or external encoder to constitute a fullclosed loop via this position feedback signal connector CN5. In position mode, the pulse position commands given by the external controller just refer to the control loop structure of the external linear scale. Please refer to Chapter 6 for more descriptions. Figure 3.16 The layout of CN5 Drive Connector

CN5 Terminal Signal Identification PIN No. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 Signal Name /Z phase input /B phase input B phase input A phase input /A phase input Terminal Identification Opt_/Z Opt_/B Opt_B Opt_A Opt_/A Description Linear scale /Z phase output Linear scale /B phase output Linear scale B phase output Linear scale A phase output Linear scale /A phase output Ground Ground Linear scale 5V power Linear scale Z phase output

Encoder grounding GND Encoder grounding GND Encoder power Z phase input +5V Opt_Z

3-52

Revision January 2011

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

3.9 CANopen Communication Connector CN6


CANopen Communication Connector CN6 is designed in accordance with CANopen DS301 and DS402 implementation. With this connector CN6, the servo drive can be connected to a CAN device so as to perform position, speed and torque control, or read and monitor the status of the servo drive through CANopen communication. The station numbers of CANopen communication are the same as RS-232 and RS-485 communication and all be determined by parameter P3-00. The transmission speed can be reached up to 1Mbps. There are two communication ports of connector CN6, one is for transmission and the other is for receiving, convenient for connecting to more than one servo drives in serial. Ensure to connect a termination resistor to the last connected servo drive. Figure 3.17 The layout of CN6 Drive Connector

CN6 Terminal Signal Identification PIN No. 1, 9 2, 10 3, 11 4, 12 5, 13 6, 14 7, 15 8, 16 Signal Name CAN_H CAN_L CAN_GND Description CAN_H bus line (dominant high) CAN_H bus line (dominant low) Ground / 0 V / V Reserved Reserved Reserved Ground / 0 V / V Reserved

CAN_GND -

Revision January 2011

3-53

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

Figure 3.18 Connecting more than one servo drives via CANopen communication

3-54

Revision January 2011

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

3.10 Extension digital input connector CN7


ASDA-A2 series provides single-axis point-to-point position control function and the position numbers can be up to 64 points. When internal 8 programmable Digital Inputs (DI) which can be set via parameters P2-10 ~ P2-17 can not satisfied, the users can use this extension digital input connector CN7 to increase more digital inputs. Up to 6 programmable external Digital Inputs (DI) could be added. Figure 3.19 The layout of CN7 Drive Connector

CN7 Terminal Signal Identification PIN No. 1


(NOTE)

Signal Name VDD 24V power Extension DI9 Extension DI10 Extension DI11 Extension DI12 Extension DI13 Extension DI14

Terminal Identification COM+ EDI 9EDI 10EDI 11EDI 12EDI 13EDI 14-

Description VDD (24V) power supply, same as Pin 11 of CN1 Digital input DI9Digital input DI10Digital input DI11Digital input DI12Digital input DI13Digital input DI14-

2 3 4 5 6 7

Caution: Do not use dual power supply. Failure to observe this caution may result in damage to the servo drive and servo motor.

Revision January 2011

3-55

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

3.11 Standard Connection Example 220V series 3.11.1 Position (PT) Control Mode

Please note: *1 Please refer to C3 ~ C4 wiring diagrams in section 3.4.4. *2 Please refer to C3 ~ C4 wiring diagrams in section 3.4.4. *3 Please refer to C9 ~ C12 wiring diagrams (SINK / SOURCE mode) in section 3.4.4. *4 400W and below drives do not provide built-in regenerative resistor. *5 The coil of brake has no polarity. *6 For extension digital inputs (DI) connections (CN7 is a optional part, not Delta standard supplied part.). *7 For USB connection. It is used to connect to personal computer or notebook. *8 Single -phase connections are for servo drives 1.5kW and below only.

3-56

Revision January 2011

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

3.11.2 Position (PR) Control Mode

Please note: *1 Please refer to C9 ~ C12 wiring diagrams (SINK / SOURCE mode) in section 3.4.4. *2 400W and below drives do not provide built-in regenerative resistor. *3 The coil of brake has no polarity. *4 For extension digital inputs (DI) connections (CN7 is a optional part, not Delta standard supplied part.). *5 For USB connection. It is used to connect to personal computer or notebook. *6 Single -phase connections are for servo drives 1.5kW and below only.

Revision January 2011

3-57

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

3.11.3 Speed Control Mode

Please note: *1 Please refer to C9 ~ C12 wiring diagrams (SINK / SOURCE mode) in section 3.4.4. *2 400W and below drives do not provide built-in regenerative resistor. *3 The coil of brake has no polarity. *4 For extension digital inputs (DI) connections (CN7 is a optional part, not Delta standard supplied part.). *5 For USB connection. It is used to connect to personal computer or notebook. *6 Single -phase connections are for servo drives 1.5kW and below only.

3-58

Revision January 2011

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

3.11.4 Torque Control Mode

Please note: *1 Please refer to C9 ~ C12 wiring diagrams (SINK / SOURCE mode) in section 3.4.4. *2 400W and below drives do not provide built-in regenerative resistor. *3 The coil of brake has no polarity. *4 For extension digital inputs (DI) connections (CN7 is a optional part, not Delta standard supplied part.). *5 For USB connection. It is used to connect to personal computer or notebook. *6 Single -phase connections are for servo drives 1.5kW and below only.

Revision January 2011

3-59

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

3.11.5 CANopen Communication Mode

Please note: *1 Please refer to C9 ~ C12 wiring diagrams (SINK / SOURCE mode) in section 3.4.4. *2 400W and below drives do not provide built-in regenerative resistor. *3 The coil of brake has no polarity. *4 For USB connection. It is used to connect to personal computer or notebook. *5 Single -phase connections are for servo drives 1.5kW and below only.

3-60

Revision January 2011

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

3.12 Standard Connection Example 400V series 3.12.1 Position (PT) Control Mode

Please note: *1 Please refer to C3 ~ C4 wiring diagrams in section 3.4.4. *2 Please refer to C3 ~ C4 wiring diagrams in section 3.4.4. *3 Please refer to C9 ~ C12 wiring diagrams (SINK / SOURCE mode) in section 3.4.4. *4 400W and below drives do not provide built-in regenerative resistor. *5 The coil of brake has no polarity. *6 For extension digital inputs (DI) connections (CN7 is a optional part, not Delta standard supplied part.). *7 For USB connection. It is used to connect to personal computer or notebook.

Revision January 2011

3-61

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

3.12.2 Position (PR) Control Mode

Please note: *1 Please refer to C9 ~ C12 wiring diagrams (SINK / SOURCE mode) in section 3.4.4. *2 400W and below drives do not provide built-in regenerative resistor. *3 The coil of brake has no polarity. *4 For extension digital inputs (DI) connections (CN7 is a optional part, not Delta standard supplied part.). *5 For USB connection. It is used to connect to personal computer or notebook.

3-62

Revision January 2011

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

3.12.3 Speed Control Mode

Please note: *1 Please refer to C9 ~ C12 wiring diagrams (SINK / SOURCE mode) in section 3.4.4. *2 400W and below drives do not provide built-in regenerative resistor. *3 The coil of brake has no polarity. *4 For extension digital inputs (DI) connections (CN7 is a optional part, not Delta standard supplied part.). *5 For USB connection. It is used to connect to personal computer or notebook.

Revision January 2011

3-63

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

3.12.4 Torque Control Mode

Please note: *1 Please refer to C9 ~ C12 wiring diagrams (SINK / SOURCE mode) in section 3.4.4. *2 400W and below drives do not provide built-in regenerative resistor. *3 The coil of brake has no polarity. *4 For extension digital inputs (DI) connections (CN7 is a optional part, not Delta standard supplied part.). *5 For USB connection. It is used to connect to personal computer or notebook.

3-64

Revision January 2011

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

3.12.5 CANopen Communication Mode

Please note: *1 Please refer to C9 ~ C12 wiring diagrams (SINK / SOURCE mode) in section 3.4.4. *2 400W and below drives do not provide built-in regenerative resistor. *3 The coil of brake has no polarity. *4 For USB connection. It is used to connect to personal computer or notebook.

Revision January 2011

3-65

Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring

This page intentionally left blank.

3-66

Revision January 2011

Chapter 4 Display and Operation

This chapter describes the basic operation of the digital keypad and the features it offers.

4.1 Description of the Digital Keypad


The digital keypad includes the display panel and function keys. The Figure 4.1 shows all of the features of the digital keypad and an overview of their functions. Figure 4.1 Keypad Features

Name LCD Display Charge LED MODE Key

Function The LCD Display (5-digit, 7-step display panel) shows the monitor codes, parameter settings and operation values of the AC servo drive. The Charge LED lights to indicate the power is applied to the circuit. MODE Key. Pressing MODE key can enter or exit different parameter groups, and switch between Monitor mode and Parameter mode. SHIFT Key. Pressing SHIFT key can scrolls through parameter groups. After a parameter is selected and its value displayed, pressing SHIFT key can move the cursor to the left and then change parameter settings (blinking digits) by using arrow keys. UP and DOWN Key. Pressing the UP and DOWN key can scroll through and change monitor codes, parameter groups and various parameter settings. SET Key. Pressing the SET key can display and save the parameter groups, the various parameter settings. In monitor mode, pressing SET key can switch decimal or hexadecimal display. In parameter mode, pressing SET key can enter into parameter setting mode. During diagnosis operation, pressing SET key can execute the function in the last step. (The parameter settings changes are not effective until the SET key is pressed.)

SHIFT Key

UP and DOWN Key

SET Key

Revision January 2011

4-1

Chapter 4 Display and Operation

4.2 Display Flowchart


Figure 4.2 Keypad Operation

1.

When the power is applied to the AC servo drive, the LCD display will show the monitor function codes for approximately one second, then enter into the monitor mode.

2.

In monitor mode, pressing MODE key can enter into parameter mode. In parameter mode, pressing MODE key can return to monitor mode.

3.

No matter working in which mode, when an alarm occurs, the system will enter into fault mode immediately. In fault mode, pressing MODE key can switch to other modes. In other modes, if no key is pressed for over 20 seconds, the system will return to fault mode automatically.

4.

In monitor mode, pressing UP or DOWN arrow key can switch monitor parameter code. At this time, monitor display symbol will display for approximately one second.

5.

In monitor mode, pressing MODE key can enter into parameter mode. In parameter mode, pressing SHIFT key can switch parameter group and pressing UP or DOWN arrow key can change parameter group code.

6.

In parameter mode, the system will enter into the setting mode immediately after the Set key is pressed. The LCD display will display the corresponding setting value of this parameter simultaneously. Then, users can use UP or DOWN arrow key to change parameter value or press MODE key to exit and return back to the parameter mode.

7.

In parameter setting mode, the users can move the cursor to left by pressing SHIFT key and change the parameter settings (blinking digits) by pressing the UP or DOWN arrow key.

8.

After the setting value change is completed, press SET key to save parameter settings or execute command.

9.

When the parameter setting is completed, LCD display will show the end code SAVED and automatically return back to parameter mode.

4-2

Revision January 2011

Chapter 4 Display and Operation

4.3 Status Display 4.3.1 Save Setting Display


After the SET key is pressed, LCD display will show the following display messages for approx. one second according to different status. Display Message Description The setting value is saved correctly. [Saved) This parameter is read only. Write-protected. (Read-Only) Invalid password or no password was input. (Locked) The setting value is error or invalid. (Out of Range) The servo system is running and it is unable to accept this setting value to be changed. (Servo On) This parameter is valid after restarting the drive. (Power On)

4.3.2 Decimal Point Display


Display Message Description High/Low byte display. When the data is a decimal 32-bit data, these two digits are used to show if the display is high byte or low byte. Negative value display. When the data is displayed in decimal format, the most left two digits represent negative sign no matter it is a 16-bit or 32-bit data. If the data is displayed in hexadecimal format, it is a positive value always and no negative sign is displayed.

4.3.3 Fault Message Display


Display Message Description When the AC servo drive has a fault, LCD display will display ALnnn. AL indicates the alarm and nnn indicates the drive fault code. For the list of drive fault code, please refer to parameter P0-01 in Chapter 8 (Servo Parameters) or refer to Chapter 11 (Troubleshooting).

4.3.4 Polarity Setting Display


Display Message Description Positive value display. When entering into parameter setting mode, pressing UP or DOWN arrow key can increase or decrease the display value. SHIFT key is used to change the selected digit (The selected digit will blink).

Revision January 2011

4-3

Chapter 4 Display and Operation

Display Message

Description Negative value display. Continuously press SHIFT key for two seconds and then the positive(+) or negative(-) sign can be switched. When the setting value exceeds its setting range, the positive(+) and negative(-) sign can not be switched. (The negative value display is for a decimal negative value only. There is no negative value display for a hexadecimal negative value.)

4.3.5 Monitor Setting Display


When the AC servo drive is applied to power, the LCD display will show the monitor function codes for approximately one second and then enter into the monitor mode. In monitor mode, in order to change the monitor status, the users can press UP or DOWN arrow key or change parameter P0-02 directly to specify the monitor status. When the power is applied, the monitor status depends on the setting value of P0-02. For example, if the setting value of P0-02 is 4 when the power is applied, the monitor function will be input pulse number of pulse command, the C-PLS monitor codes will first display and then the pulse number will display after. P0-02 Setting 0 1 Display Message Description Motor feedback pulse number (after electronic gear ratio is set) Input pulse number of pulse command (after electronic gear ratio is set) Position error counts between control command pulse and feedback pulse Motor feedback pulse number (encoder unit, 1280000 pulse/rev) Input pulse number of pulse command (before electronic gear ratio is set) Position error counts Input frequency of pulse command Motor rotation speed Speed input command Speed input command Torque input command Unit [user unit] [user unit]

2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10

[user unit] [pulse] [pulse] [pulse] [Kpps] [r/min] [Volt] [r/min] [Volt]

4-4

Revision January 2011

Chapter 4 Display and Operation

P0-02 Setting 11 12 13 14

Display Message

Description Torque input command Average load Peak load Main circuit voltage Ratio of load inertia to Motor inertia (Please note that if the display is 130, it indicates that the actual inertia is 13.0) IGBT temperature Resonance frequency (The low byte is the first resonance point and the high byte is the second resonance point.) Absolute pulse number relative to encoder (use Z phase as home). The value of Z phase home point is 0, and it can be the value from -5000 to +5000 pulses. Mapping Parameter 1: Display the content of parameter P0-25 (mapping target is specified by parameter P0-35) Mapping Parameter 2: Display the content of parameter P0-26 (mapping target is specified by parameter P0-36) Mapping Parameter 3: Display the content of parameter P0-27 (mapping target is specified by parameter P0-37) Mapping Parameter 4: Display the content of parameter P0-28 (mapping target is specified by parameter P0-38) Status Monitor 1: Display the content of parameter P0-09 (the monitor status is specified by parameter P0-17) Status Monitor 2: Display the content of parameter P0-10 (the monitor status is specified by parameter P0-18)

Unit [%] [%] [] [Volt]

15

[0.1times]

16

[oC]

17

[Hz]

18

19

20

21

22

23

24

Revision January 2011

4-5

Chapter 4 Display and Operation

P0-02 Setting 25

Display Message

Description Status Monitor 3: Display the content of parameter P0-11 (the monitor status is specified by parameter P0-19) Status Monitor 4: Display the content of parameter P0-12 (the monitor status is specified by parameter P0-20)

Unit

26

The following table lists the display examples of monitor value: Display Message (Dec.) (Hex.) (Dec. High Byte) (Dec. Low Byte) (Hex. High Byte) (Hex. Low Byte) 32-bit Data 16-bit Data Description Decimal display. When the actual value is 1234, the display is 01234. Hexadecimal display. When the actual value is 0x1234, the display is 1234. Decimal display. When the actual value is 1234567890, the display of high byte is 1234.5 and the display of low byte is 67890. Hexadecimal display. When the actual value is 0x12345678, the display of high byte is h1234 and the display of low byte is L5678.

Negative value display. When the actual value is 12345, the display is 1.2.345. (The negative value display is displayed to indicate a decimal negative value. There is no negative value display for a hexadecimal negative value.)

NOTE
1) Dec. represents Decimal display and Hex. represents Hexadecimal display. 2) The above display methods are both available in monitor mode and parameter setting mode. 3) All monitor variables are 32-bit data. The users can switch to high byte or low byte and display format (Dec. or Hex.) freely. Regarding the parameters listed in Chapter 8, for each parameter, only one kind of display format is available and cannot be changed.

4-6

Revision January 2011

Chapter 4 Display and Operation

4.4 General Function Operation 4.4.1 Fault Code Display Operation


After entering the parameter mode P4-00 to P4-04 (Fault Record), press SET key to display the corresponding fault code history for the parameter. Please refer to the Figure 4.3. Figure 4.3

4.4.2 JOG Operation


After entering parameter mode P4-05, the users can follow the following steps to perform JOG operation. (Please also refer to Figure 4.4). Step1. Press the SET key to display the JOG r/min speed. (The default value is 20 r/min). Step2. Press the UP or DOWN arrow keys to increase or decrease the desired JOG speed. (This also can be undertaken by using the SHIFT key to move the cursor to the desired unit column (the effected number will blink) then changed using the UP and DOWN arrow keys. The example display in Figure 4.4 is adjusted as 100 r/min.) Step3. Press the SET key when the desired JOG speed is set. The Servo Drive will display "JOG". Step4. Press the UP or DOWN arrow keys to jog the motor either N(CW) and P(CCW) direction. The motor will only rotate while the arrow key is activated. Step5. To change JOG speed again, press the MODE key. The servo Drive will display "P4 05". Press the SET key and the JOG r/min speed will displayed again. Refer back to #2 and #3 to change speed.

NOTE
1) JOG operation is effective only when Servo On (when the servo drive is enabled).

Revision January 2011

4-7

Chapter 4 Display and Operation

Figure 4.4

4.4.3 Force Output Control Operation


For testing, the digital outputs can be forced to be activated (ON) or inactivated (OFF) by using parameter P2-08 and P4-06. First, set P2-08 to 406 to enable the force output control function and then using P4-06 to force the digital outputs to be activated. Follow the setting method in Figure 4.6 to enter into Force Output Control operation mode. When P4-06 is set to 2, the digital output, DO2 is activated. When P4-06 is set to 5, the digital outputs, DO1 and DO3 are both activated. The parameter setting value of P4-06 is not retained when power is off. After re-power the servo drive, all digital outputs will return to the normal status. If P2-08 is set to 400, it also can switch the Force Output Control operation mode to normal Digital Output (DO) Control operation mode. 1The DO function and status is determined by P2-18 to P2-22. This function is enabled only when Servo Off (the servo drive is disabled).

4-8

Revision January 2011

Chapter 4 Display and Operation

Figure 4.6

NOTE
1) As the display of P4-06 is hexadecimal, 0(zero) of the fifth digit will not show on the LED display.

4.4.4 DI Diagnosis Operation


Following the setting method in Figure 4.7 can perform DI diagnosis operation (parameter P4-07, Input Status). According to the ON and OFF status of the digital inputs DI1 to DI8, the corresponding status will display on the servo drive LED display. When the Bit is set to 1, it means that the corresponding digital input signal is ON. (Please also refer to Figure 4.7) For example: Suppose that the servo drive LED display is 3FE1. E is hexadecimal, which is equal to 1110 in binary system, and it means that the digital inputs DI6 ~ DI8 are ON.

Revision January 2011

4-9

Chapter 4 Display and Operation

Figure 4.7

4.4.5 DO Diagnosis Operation


Following the setting method in Figure 4.8 can perform DO diagnosis operation (parameter P4-09, Output Status Display). According to the ON and OFF status of the digital outputs DO1 to DO5, the corresponding status will display on the servo drive LED display. When the Bit is set to 1, it means that the corresponding digital output signal is ON. (Please also refer to Figure 4.8) For example: Suppose that the servo drive LED display is 1F. F is hexadecimal, which is equal to 1111 in binary system, and it means that the digital outputs DO1 ~ DO4 are ON. Figure 4.8

4-10

Revision January 2011

Chapter 5 Trial Run and Tuning Procedure

This chapter, which is divided into two parts, describes trial run for servo drive and motor. One part is to introduce the trial run without load, and the other part is to introduce trial run with load. Ensure to complete the trial run without load first before performing the trial run with load.

5.1 Inspection without Load


In order to prevent accidents and avoid damaging the servo drive and mechanical system, the trial run should be performed under no load condition (no load connected, including disconnecting all couplings and belts). Do not run servo motor while it is connected to load or mechanical system because the unassembled parts on motor shaft may easily disassemble during running and it may damage mechanical system or even result in personnel injury. After removing the load or mechanical system from the servo motor, if the servo motor can runs normally following up the normal operation procedure (when trial run without load is completed), then the users can connect to the load and mechanical system to run the servo motor.
In order to prevent accidents, the initial trial run for servo motor should be conducted under no load conditions (separate the motor from its couplings and belts). Caution: Please perform trial run without load first and then perform trial run with load connected. After the servo motor is running normally and regularly without load, then run servo motor with load connected. Ensure to perform trial run in this order to prevent unnecessary danger.

After power in connected to AC servo drive, the charge LED will light and it indicates that AC servo drive is ready. Please check the followings before trial run: 1. Inspection before operation (Control power is not applied)

Inspect the servo drive and servo motor to insure they were not damaged. Ensure that all wiring terminals are correctly insulated. Ensure that all wiring is correct or damage and or malfunction may result. Visually check to ensure that there are not any unused screws, metal strips, or any
conductive or inflammable materials inside the drive.

Make sure control switch is OFF. Never put inflammable objects on servo drive or close to the external regenerative
resistor.

If the electromagnetic brake is being used, ensure that it is correctly wired. If required, use an appropriate electrical filter to eliminate noise to the servo drive.

Revision January 2011

5-1

Chapter 5 Trial Run and Tuning Procedure

Ensure that the external applied voltage to the drive is correct and matched to the
controller. 2. Inspection during operation (Control power is applied)

Ensure that the cables are not damaged, stressed excessively or loaded heavily. When
the motor is running, pay close attention on the connection of the cables and notice that if they are damaged, frayed or over extended.

Check for abnormal vibrations and sounds during operation. If the servo motor is
vibrating or there are unusual noises while the motor is running, please contact the dealer or manufacturer for assistance.

Ensure that all user-defined parameters are set correctly. Since the characteristics of
different machinery equipment are not the same, in order to avoid accident or cause damage, do not adjust the parameter abnormally and ensure the parameter setting is not an excessive value.

Ensure to reset some parameters when the servo drive is off (Please refer to Chapter 8).
Otherwise, it may result in malfunction.

If there is no contact sound or there be any unusual noises when the relay of the servo
drive is operating, please contact your distributor for assistance or contact with Delta.

Check for abnormal conditions of the power indicators and LED display. If there is any
abnormal condition of the power indicators and LED display, please contact your distributor for assistance or contact with Delta.

5-2

Revision January 2011

Chapter 5 Trial Run and Tuning Procedure

5.2 Applying Power to the Drive


The users please observe the following steps when applying power supply to the servo drive. 1. Please check and confirm the wiring connection between the drive and motor is correct. 1) Terminal U, V, W and FG (frame ground) must connect to Red, White, Black and Green cables separately (U: Red, V: White, W: Black, FG: Green). If not connect to the specified cable and terminal, then the drive cannot control motor. The motor grounding lead, FG must connect to grounding terminal. For more information of cables, please refer to section 3.1. 2) Ensure to connect encoder cable to CN2 connector correctly. If the users only desire to execute JOG operation, it is not necessary to make any connection to CN1 and CN3 connector. For more information of the connection of CN2 connector, please refer to Section 3.1 and 3.4.
Do not connect the AC input power (R, S, T) to the (U, V, W) output terminals. This will damage the AC servo drive.

2. Main circuit wiring Connect power to the AC servo. For three-phase input power connection and single-phase input power connection, please refer to Section 3.1.3. 3. Turn the Power On The Power includes control circuit power (L1c, L2c) and main circuit power (R, S, T). When the power is on, the normal display should be shown as the following figure:

As the default settings of digital input signal, DI6, DI7 and DI8 are Reverse Inhibit Limit (NL), Forward Inhibit Limit (PL) and Emergency Stop (EMGS) respectively, if the users do not want to use the default settings of DI6 ~ DI8, the users can change their settings by using parameters P2-15 to P2-17 freely. When the setting value of parameters P2-15 to P2-17 is 0, it indicates the function of this DI signal is disabled. For more information of parameters P2-15 to P2-17, please refer to Chapter 8 Parameters. If the parameter P0-02 is set as motor speed (06), the normal display should be shown as the following figure:

If there is no text or character displayed on the LED display, please check if the voltage of the control circuit terminal ((L1c, L2c) is over low.

Revision January 2011

5-3

Chapter 5 Trial Run and Tuning Procedure

1) When display shows:

Overvoltage: The main circuit voltage has exceeded its maximum allowable value or input power is error (Incorrect power input). Corrective Actions: Use voltmeter to check whether the main circuit input voltage falls within the rated input voltage. Use voltmeter to check whether the input voltage is within the specified limit.

2) When display shows:

Encoder error: Check if the wiring is correct. Check if the encoder wiring (CN2) of servo motor is loose or incorrect. Corrective Actions: Check if the users perform wiring recommended in the user manual. Examine the encoder connector and cable. Inspect whether wire is loose or not. Check if the encoder is damaged.

3) When display shows:

Emergency stop activated: Please check if any of digital inputs DI1 ~ DI8 signal is set to Emergency Stop (EMGS). Corrective Actions: If it does not need to use Emergency Stop (EMGS) as input signal, the users only need to confirm that if all of the digital inputs DI1 ~ DI8 are not set to Emergency Stop (EMGS). (The setting value of parameter P2-10 to P2-17 is not set to 21.)
5-4
Revision January 2011

Chapter 5 Trial Run and Tuning Procedure

If it is necessary to use Emergency Stop (EMGS) as input signal, the users only need to confirm that which of digital inputs DI1 ~ DI8 is set to Emergency Stop (EMGS) and check if the digital input signal is ON (It should be activated).

4) When display shows:

Reverse limit switch error: Please check if any of digital inputs DI1 ~ DI8 signal is set to Reverse inhibit limit (NL) and check if the signal is ON or not. Corrective Actions: If it does not need to use Reverse inhibit limit (NL) as input signal, the users only need to confirm that if all of the digital inputs DI1 ~ DI8 are not set to Reverse inhibit limit (NL). (The setting value of parameter P2-10 to P2-17 is not set to 22.) If it is necessary to use Reverse inhibit limit (NL) as input signal, the users only need to confirm that which of digital inputs DI1 ~ DI8 is set to Reverse inhibit limit (NL) and check if the digital input signal is ON (It should be activated). 5) When display shows:

Forward limit switch error: Please check if any of digital inputs DI1 ~ DI8 signal is set to Forward inhibit limit (PL) and check if the signal is ON or not. Corrective Actions: If it is no need to use Forward inhibit limit (PL) as input signal, the users only need to confirm that if all of the digital inputs DI1 ~ DI8 are not set to Forward inhibit limit (PL). (The setting value of parameter P2-10 to P2-17 is not set to 23.) If it is necessary to use Forward inhibit limit (PL) as input signal, the users only need to confirm that which of digital inputs DI1 ~ DI8 is set to Forward inhibit limit (PL) and check if the digital input signal is ON (It should be activated).

Revision January 2011

5-5

Chapter 5 Trial Run and Tuning Procedure

When Digital Input 1 (DI1) is set to Servo On (SON), if DI1 is set to ON (it indicates that Servo On (SON) function is enabled) and the following fault message shows on the display: 6) When display shows:

Overcurrent: Corrective Actions: Check the wiring connections between the servo drive and motor. Check if the circuit of the wiring is closed. Remove the short-circuited condition and avoid metal conductor being exposed.

7) When display shows:

Undervoltage: Corrective Actions: Check whether the wiring of main circuit input voltage is normal. Use voltmeter to check whether input voltage of main circuit is normal. Use voltmeter to check whether the input voltage is within the specified limit.

NOTE
1) If there are any unknown fault codes and abnormal display when applying power to the drive or servo on is activated (without giving any command), please inform the distributor or contact with Delta for assistance.

5-6

Revision January 2011

Chapter 5 Trial Run and Tuning Procedure

5.3 JOG Trial Run without Load


It is very convenient to use JOG trial run without load to test the servo drive and motor as it can save the wiring. The external wiring is not necessary and the users only need to connect the digital keypad to the servo drive. For safety, it is recommended to set JOG speed at low speed. Please refer to the following steps to perform JOG trial run without load. STEP 1: Turn the drive ON through software. Ensure that the setting value of parameter P230 should be set to 1 (Servo On). STEP 2: Set parameter P4-05 as JOG speed (unit: r/min). After the desired JOG speed is set, and then press SET key, the drive will enter into JOG operation mode automatically STEP 3: The users can press UP and DOWN key to change JOG speed and press SHIFT key to adjust the digit number of the displayed value. STEP 4: Pressing SET key can determine the speed of JOG operation. STEP 5: Pressing UP key and the servo motor will run in P(CCW) direction. After releasing UP key, the motor will stop running. STEP 6: Pressing DOWN key and the servo motor will run in N(CW) direction. After releasing DOWN key, the motor will stop running. N(CW) and P(CCW) Definition: P(CCW, Counterclockwise): when facing the servo motor shaft, P is running in counterclockwise direction. N(CW, Clockwise): when facing the servo motor shaft, N is running in clockwise direction. STEP 7: When pressing MODE key, it can exit JOG operation mode.

Revision January 2011

5-7

Chapter 5 Trial Run and Tuning Procedure

In the example below, the JOG speed is adjusted from 20r/min (Default setting) to 100r/min.

5-8

Revision January 2011

Chapter 5 Trial Run and Tuning Procedure

5.4 Speed Trial Run without Load


Before speed trial run, fix and secure the motor as possible to avoid the danger from the reacting force when motor speed changes. STEP 1: Set the value of parameter P1-01 to 02 and it is speed (S) control mode. After selecting the operation mode as speed (S) control mode, please restart the drive as P1-01 is effective only after the servo drive is restarted (after switching power off and on). STEP 2: In speed control mode, the necessary Digital Inputs are listed as follows: Digital Input DI1 DI2 DI3 DI4 DI5 DI6 DI7 DI8 EDI9 EDI10 EDI11 EDI12 EDI13 EDI14 Parameter Setting Value P2-10=101 P2-11=109 P2-12=114 P2-13=115 P2-14=102 P2-15=0 P2-16=0 P2-17=0 P2-36=0 P2-37=0 P2-38=0 P2-39=0 P2-40=0 P2-41=0 Sign SON TRQLM SPD0 SPD1 ARST Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Function Description Servo On Torque limit enabled Speed command selection Speed command selection Reset This DI function is disabled This DI function is disabled This DI function is disabled This DI function is disabled This DI function is disabled This DI function is disabled This DI function is disabled This DI function is disabled This DI function is disabled CN1 PIN No. DI1-=9 DI2-=10 DI3-=34 DI4-=8 DI5-=33 CN7=2 CN7=3 CN7=4 CN7=5 CN7=6 CN7=7

By default, DI6 is the function of reverse inhibit limit, DI7 is the function of forward inhibit limit and DI6 is the function of emergency stop (DI8), if the users do not set the setting value of parameters P2-15 to P2-17 and P2-36 to P2-41 to 0 (Disabled), the faults (AL013, 14 and 15) will occur (For the information of fault messages, please refer to Chapter 11). Therefore, if the users do not need to use these three digit inputs, please set the setting value of parameters P2-15 to P2-17 and P2-36 to P2-41 to 0 (Disabled) in advance. All the digital inputs of Delta ASDA-A2 series are user-defined, and the users can set the DI signals freely. Ensure to refer to the definitions of DI signals before defining them (For the description of DI signals, please refer to Table 8.A in Chapter 8). If any alarm code displays after the setting is completed, the users can restart the drive or set DI5 to be activated to clear the fault. Please refer to section 5.2.

Revision January 2011

5-9

Chapter 5 Trial Run and Tuning Procedure

The speed command is selected by SPD0, SPD1. Please refer to the following table: DI signal of CN1 Speed Command No. SPD1 SPD0 S1 S2 S3 S4 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 Internal parameter Command Source External analog command Content Voltage between V-REF and GND P1-09 P1-10 P1-11 Range -10V ~ +10V -60000 ~ 60000 -60000 ~ 60000 -60000 ~ 60000

0: indicates OFF (Normally Open); 1: indicates ON (Normally Closed) The range of internal parameter is from -60000 to 60000. Setting value of speed command = Setting range x unit (0.1 r/min). For example: If P1-09 is set to +30000, the setting value of speed command = +30000 x 0.1 r/min = +3000 r/min. The settings of speed command: P1-09 is set to +30000 P1-10 is set to +1000 P1-11 is set to -30000 STEP 3: 1. 2. The users can use DI1 to enable the servo drive (Servo On). If DI3 (SPD0) and DI4 (SPD1) are OFF both, it indicates S1 command is selected. At this time, the motor is operating according to external analog command. 3. If only DI3 is ON (SPD0), it indicates S2 command (P1-09 is set to +30000) is selected, and the motor speed is 3000r/min at this time. 4. If only DI4 is ON (SPD1), it indicates S3 command (P1-10 is set to +1000) is selected, and the motor speed is 100r/min at this time. 5. If DI3 (SPD0) and DI4 (SPD1) are ON both, it indicates S4 command (P1-11 is set to 30000) is selected, and the motor speed is -3000r/min at this time. 6. 7. Repeat the action of (3), (4), (5) freely. When the users want to stop the speed trial run, use DI1 to disable the servo drive (Servo Off). Input value command + Rotation direction N(CW) P(CCW)

5-10

Revision January 2011

Chapter 5 Trial Run and Tuning Procedure

5.5 Position Trial Run without Load


Before position trial run, fix and secure the motor as possible to avoid the danger from the reacting force when the motor speed changes. STEP 1: Set the value of parameter P1-01 to 01 and it is position (PR) control mode. After selecting the operation mode as position (PR) control mode, please restart the drive and the setting would be valid. STEP 2: In position control mode, the necessary DI setting is listed as follows: Digital Input DI1 DI2 DI3 DI4 DI5 DI6 DI7 DI8 EDI9 EDI10 EDI11 EDI12 EDI13 EDI14 Parameter Setting Value P2-10=101 P2-11=108 P2-12=111 P2-13=112 P2-14=102 P2-15=0 P2-16=0 P2-17=0 P2-36=0 P2-37=0 P2-38=0 P2-39=0 P2-40=0 P2-41=0 Sign SON CTRG POS0 POS1 ARST Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled Function Description Servo On Command trigged Position command selection Position command selection Reset This DI function is disabled This DI function is disabled This DI function is disabled This DI function is disabled This DI function is disabled This DI function is disabled This DI function is disabled This DI function is disabled This DI function is disabled CN1 PIN No. DI1-=9 DI2-=10 DI3-=34 DI4-=8 DI5-=33 CN7=2 CN7=3 CN7=4 CN7=5 CN7=6 CN7=7

By default, DI6 is the function of reverse inhibit limit, DI7 is the function of forward inhibit limit and DI6 is the function of emergency stop (DI8), if the users do not set the setting value of parameters P2-15 to P2-17 and P2-36 to P2-41 to 0 (Disabled), the faults (AL013, 14 and 15) will occur (For the information of fault messages, please refer to Chapter 11). Therefore, if the users do not need to use these three digit inputs, please set the setting value of parameters P2-15 to P2-17 and P2-36 to P2-41 to 0 (Disabled) in advance. All the digital inputs of Delta ASDA-A2 series are user-defined, and the users can set the DI signals freely. Ensure to refer to the definitions of DI signals before defining them (For the description of DI signals, please refer to Table 8.A in Chapter 8). If any alarm code displays after the setting is completed, the users can restart the drive or set DI5 to be activated to clear the fault. Please refer to section 5.2. For the information of wiring diagrams, please refer to Section 3.10.2 (Wiring of position (PR) control mode). Because POS2 is not the default DI, the users need to change the value of parameter P2-14 to 113.

Revision January 2011

5-11

Chapter 5 Trial Run and Tuning Procedure

Please refer to the following table for 64 groups of position commands and position command selection from POS0 to POS5. Position Command P1 P2 ~ P50 P51 ~ P64 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 0 1 POS5 0 0 POS4 0 0 POS3 0 0 POS2 0 0 POS1 0 0 POS0 0 1 CTRG Parameters P6-00 P6-01 P6-02 P6-03 ~ P6-98 P6-99 P7-00 P7-01 ~ P7-26 P7-27

0: indicates OFF (Normally Open); 1: indicates ON (Normally Closed) The users can set the value of these 64 groups of commands (P6-00 ~ P7-27) freely. The command can be absolute position command as well.

5-12

Revision January 2011

Chapter 5 Trial Run and Tuning Procedure

5.6 Tuning Procedure


Table 5.A Estimate the ratio of Load Inertia to Servo Motor Inertia (J_load /J_motor): JOG Mode Tuning Procedure
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. After wiring is completed, when power in connected to the AC servo drive, the right side display will show on the LCD display. Press MODE key to enter into parameter mode. Press SHIFT key twice to select parameter group. Press UP key to view each parameter and select parameter P2-17. Press SET key to display the parameter value as shown on the right side. Press SHIFT key twice to change the parameter values. Use UP key to cycle through the available settings and then press SET key to determine the parameter settings. Press UP key to view each parameter and select parameter P2-30. Press SET key to display the parameter value as shown on the right side. Select parameter value 1. Use UP key to cycle through the available settings.

Display

7. 8. 9.

10. At this time, the servo drive is ON and the right side display will appear next. 11. Press DOWN key three times to select the ratio of Load Inertia to Servo Motor Inertia (J_load /J_motor). 12. Display the current ratio of Load Inertia to Servo Motor Inertia (J_load /J_motor). (5.0 is default setting.) 13. Press MODE key to select parameter mode. 14. Press SHIFT key twice to select parameter group. 15. Press UP key to select user parameter P4-05. 16. Press SET key and JOG speed 20 r/min will be displayed. Press UP and DOWN key to increase and decrease JOG speed. To press SHIFT key one time can add one digit number.

17. Select desired JOG speed, press SET key and it will show the right side display. 18. Pressing UP key is forward rotation and pressing DOWN key is reverse rotation. 19. Execute JOG operation in low speed first. After the machine is running smoothly, then execute JOG operation in high speed.

20. The ratio of Load Inertia to Servo Motor Inertia (J_load /J_motor) cannot be shown in the display of JOG parameter P4-05 operation. Please press MODE key twice continuously and the users can see the ratio of Load Inertia to Servo Motor Inertia (J_load /J_motor). Then, execute JOG operation again, press MODE key once and press SET key twice to view the display on the keypad. Check if the value of J_load /J_motor is adjusted to a fixed value and displayed on the keypad after acceleration and deceleration repeatedly.

Revision January 2011

5-13

Chapter 5 Trial Run and Tuning Procedure

5.6.1 Tuning Flowchart

5-14

Revision January 2011

Chapter 5 Trial Run and Tuning Procedure

5.6.2 Load Inertia Estimation Flowchart

Revision January 2011

5-15

Chapter 5 Trial Run and Tuning Procedure

5.6.3 Auto Mode Tuning Flowchart


Set P2-32 to 1 (1: Auto Mode [Continuous adjustment] ) The servo drive will continuously estimate the system inertia, save the measured load inertia value automatically and memorized in P1-37 every 30 minutes by referring to the frequency response settings of P2-31.

P2-31 : Auto Mode Stiffness Setting (Default setting: 80) In Auto mode and Semi-Auto mode, the speed loop frequency response settings are as follows: 1 ~ 50Hz : Low stiffness and low frequency response 51 ~ 250Hz : Medium stiffness and medium frequency response 251 ~ 850Hz : High stiffness and high frequency response 851 ~ 1000Hz : Extremely high stiffness and extremely high frequency response Adjust P2-31: Increase the setting value of P2-31 to enhance the stiffness or reduce the noise. Continuously perform the adjustment until the satisfactory performance is achieved.

5-16

Revision January 2011

Chapter 5 Trial Run and Tuning Procedure

Revision January 2011

5-17

Chapter 5 Trial Run and Tuning Procedure

5.6.4 Semi-Auto Mode Tuning Flowchart


Set P2-32 to 2 (2: Semi-Auto Mode [Non-continuous adjustment] ) The servo drive will continuously perform the adjustment for a period of time. After the system inertia becomes stable, it will stop estimating the system inertia, save the measured load inertia value automatically, and memorized in P1-37. When switching from other modes, such as Manual Mode or Auto Mode, to Semi-Auto Mode, the servo drive will perform continuous adjustment for estimating the load inertia (P1-37) again. The servo drive will refer to the frequency response settings of P2-31 when estimating the system inertia.

P2-31 : Auto Mode Stiffness Setting (Default setting: 80) In Auto mode and Semi-Auto mode, the speed loop frequency response settings are as follows: 1 ~ 50Hz : Low stiffness and low frequency response 51 ~ 250Hz : Medium stiffness and medium frequency response 251 ~ 850Hz : High stiffness and high frequency response 851 ~ 1000Hz : Extremely high stiffness and extremely high frequency response Adjust P2-31: Increase the setting value of P2-31 to enhance the frequency response or reduce the noise. Continuously perform the adjustment until the satisfactory performance is achieved.

5-18

Revision January 2011

Chapter 5 Trial Run and Tuning Procedure

NOTE
1) When bit0 of P2-33 is set to 1, it indicates that the system inertia estimation of semi-auto mode has been completed and the measured load inertia value is saved and memorized in P137 automatically. 2) If reset bit0 of P2-33 to 0, it will start estimating the system inertia again.

Revision January 2011

5-19

Chapter 5 Trial Run and Tuning Procedure

5.6.5 Limit of Load Inertia Estimation


The accel. / decel. time for reaching 2000r/min must be below 1 second. The rotation speed must be above 200 r/min. The load inertia must be 100 multiple or less of motor inertia. The change of external force and the inertia ratio can not be too much. In Auto Mode (P2-32 is set to 1), the measured load inertia value will be saved automatically and memorized in P1-37 every 30 minutes. In Semi-Auto Mode, it will stop estimating the load inertia after a period of continuous adjustment time when the system inertia becomes stable. The measured load inertia value will be saved automatically and memorized in P137 when load inertia estimation is stopped.

5-20

Revision January 2011

Chapter 5 Trial Run and Tuning Procedure

NOTE
1) Parameters P2-44 and P2-46 are used to set notch filter attenuation rate. If the resonance can not be suppressed when the setting values of P2-44 and P2-46 are set to 32bB (the maximum value), please decrease the speed loop frequency response. After setting P2-47, the users can check the setting values of P2-44 and P2-46. If the setting value of P2-44 is not 0, it indicates that one resonance frequency exists in the system and then the users can read P2-43, i.e. the frequency (unit is Hz) of the resonance point. When there is any resonance point in the system, its information will be shown in P2-45 and P2-46 as P2-43 and P2-44. 2) If the resonance conditions are not improved when P2-47 is set to 1 for over three times, please adjust notch filters (resonance suppression parameters) manually to or eliminate the resonance.

Revision January 2011

5-21

Chapter 5 Trial Run and Tuning Procedure

5.6.6 Mechanical Resonance Suppression Method


In order to suppress the high frequency resonance of the mechanical system, ASDA-A2 series servo drive provides three notch filters (resonance suppression parameters) for resonance suppression. Two notch filters can be set to suppress the resonance automatically. If the users do not want to suppress the resonance automatically, these two notch filter can also be set to or eliminate the resonance manually. Please refer to the following flowchart for manual adjustment.

5-22

Revision January 2011

Chapter 5 Trial Run and Tuning Procedure

5.6.7 Relationship between Tuning Modes and Parameters


Tuning Mode P2-32 AutoSet Parameter User-defined Parameter P1-37 (Ratio of Load Inertia to Servo Motor Inertia [J_load / J_motor]) P2-00 (Proportional Position Loop Gain) P2-04 (Proportional Speed Loop Gain) P2-06 (Speed Integral Compensation) P2-25 (Low-pass Filter Time Constant of Resonance Suppression) P2-26 (External Anti-Interference Gain) Gain Value

Manual Mode

0 (Default setting)

None

Fixed

Auto Mode [Continuous Adjustment]

P1-37 P2-00 P2-02 P2-04 P2-06 P2-25 P2-26 P2-49 P1-37 P2-00 P2-02 P2-04 P2-06 P2-25 P2-26 P2-49

P2-31 (Auto Stiffness and Frequency response Level)

Continuous Adjusting (every 30 minutes)

Semi-Auto Mode [Non-continuous Adjustment]

P2-31 (Auto Stiffness and Frequency response Level)

Noncontinuous Adjusting (stop after a period of time)

When switching mode #1 to #0, the setting value of P2-00, P2-02, P2-04, P2-06, P2-25, P2-26 and P2-49 will change to the value that measured in #1 auto-tuning mode. When switching mode #2 to #0, the setting value of P2-00, P2-02, P2-04, P2-06, P2-25, P2-26 and P2-49 will change to the value that measured in #2 semi-auto tuning mode.

Revision January 2011

5-23

Chapter 5 Trial Run and Tuning Procedure

5.6.8 Gain Adjustment in Manual Mode


The position and speed frequency response selection is depending on and determined by the the control stiffness of machinery and conditions of applications. Generally, high reponsiveness is essential for the high frequency positioning control of mechanical facilities and the applications of high precision process system. However, the higher frequency response may easily result in the resonance of machinery system. Therefore, for the applications of high frequency response, the machinery system with control stiffness is needed to avoid the resonance. Especially when adjusting the frequency response of unfamiliar machinery system, the users can gradually increase the gain setting value to improve frequency response untill the resonance occurs, and then decrease the gain setting value. The relevant parameters and gain adjusting methods are described as follows: KPP, Parameter P2-00 Proportional Position Loop Gain This parameter is used to determine the frequency response of position loop (position loop gain). It could be used to increase stiffness, expedite position loop response and reduce position error. When the setting value of KPP is higher, the response to the position command is quicker, the position error is less and the settling time is also shorter. However, if the setting value is over high, the machinery system may generate vibration or noise, or even overshoot during positioning. The position loop frequency response is calculated as follows:

KVP, Parameter P2-04 Proportional Speed Loop Gain This parameter is used to determine the frequency response of speed loop (speed loop gain). It could be used to expedite speed loop response. When the setting value of KVP is higher, the response to the speed command is quicker. However, if the setting value is over high, it may result in the resonance of machinery system. The frequency response of speed loop must be higher than the 4~6 times of the frequency response of position loop. If frequency response of position loop is higher than the frequency response of speed loop, the machinery system may generate vibration or noise, or even overshoot during positioning. The speed loop frequency JM: Motor Inertia response is calculated as follows: JL: Load Inertia
P1-37: 0.1 times

5-24

Revision January 2011

Chapter 5 Trial Run and Tuning Procedure

When the value of P1-37 (no matter it is the measured load inertia value or the set load inertia value) is equal to the actual load inertia value, the actual speed loop frequency response will be:
= K VP Hz 2 .

KVI, Parameter P2-06 Speed Integral Compensation If the setting value of KVI is higher, the capability of decreasing the speed control deviation is better. However, if the setting value is over high, it may easily result in the vibration of machinery system. The recommended setting value is as follows:

NLP, Parameter P2-25 Low-pass Filter Time Constant of Resonance Suppression When the value of (J_load / J_motor) is high, the frequency response of speed loop may decrease. At this time, the users can increase the setting value of KVP (P2-04) to keep the frequency response of speed loop. However, when increasing the setting value of KVP (P2-04), it may easily result in the vibration of machinery system. Please use this parameter to suppress or eliminate the noise of resonance. If the setting value of NLP is higher, the capability of improving the noise of resonance is better. However, if the setting value is over high, it may easily lead to the instability of speed loop and overshoot of machinery system. The recommended setting value is as follows:

DST, Parameter P2-26 External Anti-Interference Gain This parameter is used to enhance the anti-interference capability and reduce the occurrence of overshoot. The default setting is 0 (Disabled). It is not recommended to use it in manual mode only when performing a few tuning on the value gotten through P2-32 Auto Mode.

PFG, Parameter P2-02 Position Feed Forward Gain This parameter is used to reduce position error and shorten the positioning settling time. However, if the setting value is over high, it may easily lead to the overshoot of machinery system. If the value of electronic gear ratio (1-44/1-45) is over than 10, the machinery system may also easily generate vibration or noise.

Revision January 2011

5-25

Chapter 5 Trial Run and Tuning Procedure

This page intentionally left blank.

5-26

Revision January 2011

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

6.1 Control Modes of Operation


The Delta ASDA-A2 series can be programmed to provide six single, eight dual modes and two multiple modes of operation. Their operation and description is listed in the following table. Mode External Position Control Internal Position Control Mode PT Code 00 Description Position control for the servo motor is achieved via an external pulse command. Position control for the servo motor is achieved via by internal position commands stored within the servo controller. Execution of the 64 positions is via Digital Input (DI) signals. Speed control for the servo motor can be achieved via parameters set within the controller or from an external analog -10 ~ +10 Vdc command. Control of the internal speed parameters is via the Digital Inputs (DI). (A maximum of three speeds can be stored internally). Speed control for the servo motor is only achieved via parameters set within the controller. Control of the internal speed parameters is via the Digital Inputs (DI). (A maximum of three speeds can be stored internally). Torque control for the servo motor can be achieved via parameters set within the controller or from an external analog -10 ~ +10 Vdc command. Control of the internal torque parameters is via the Digital Inputs (DI). (A maximum of three torque levels can be stored internally). Torque control for the servo motor is only achieved via parameters set within the controller. Control of the internal torque parameters is via the Digital Inputs (DI). (A maximum of three torque levels can be stored internally).

PR

01

Speed Control

02

Single Mode

Internal Speed Control

Sz

04

Torque Control

03

Internal Torque Control

Tz

05

Revision January 2011

6-1

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

Mode

Mode PT-S PT-T PR-S PR-T

Code 06 07 08 09
0A 0B 0C 0D 0E 0F

Description Either PT or S control mode can be selected via the Digital Inputs (DI) Either PT or T control mode can be selected via the Digital Inputs (DI). Either PR or S control mode can be selected via the Digital Inputs (DI). Either PR or T control mode can be selected via the Digital Inputs (DI).
Either S or T control mode can be selected via the Digital Inputs (DI). CANopen communication control is achieved via the commands from the host (external) controller. Reserved Either PT or PR control mode can be selected via the Digital Inputs (DI). Either PT or PR or S control mode can be selected via the Digital Inputs (DI). Either PT or PR or T control mode can be selected via the Digital Inputs (DI).

Dual Mode
S-T CANopen Reserved PT-PR PT-PR-S Multiple Mode PT-PR-T

The steps of changing mode: (1) (2) (3) Switching the servo drive to Servo Off status. Turning SON signal of digit input to be off can complete this action. Using parameter P1-01. (Refer to chapter 8). After the setting is completed, cut the power off and restart the drive again.

The following sections describe the operation of each control mode, including control structure, command source and loop gain adjustment, etc.

6-2

Revision January 2011

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

6.2 Position Control Mode


The position control mode (PT or PR mode) is usually used for the applications requiring precision positioning, such as industry positioning machine, indexing table etc. Delta ASDAA2 series servo drives support two kinds of command sources in position control mode. One is an external pulse train (PT: Position Terminals, External Position Control) and the other is internal parameter (PR: Position Register, i.e. internal parameters P6-00 to P7-27, Internal Position Control). The external pulse train with direction which can control the rotation angle of servo motor. The max. input frequency for the external pulse command is 4MKpps. In order to provide a convenient position control function, Delta servo drive provides 64 internal preset parameters for position control. There are two setting methods of internal parameters, one is to set different position command into these 64 internal parameters before operation and then use POS0~POS5 of DI signals of CN1 to perform positioning control. The other setting method is to use serial communication to change the setting value of these eight internal parameters. To make the servo motor and load operate more smoothly, Delta servo drive also provide complete Position Spine Line (P-curve) profile for position control mode. For the closed-loop positioning, speed control loop is the principal part and the auxiliary parameters are position loop gain and feed forward compensation. The users can also select two kinds of tuning mode (Manual/Auto modes) to perform gain adjustment. This Section 6.2 mainly describes the applicability of loop gain adjustment and feed forward compensation of Delta servo system.

Revision January 2011

6-3

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

6.2.1 Command Source of Position (PT) Control Mode


The command source of P mode is external pulse train input form terminals. There are three types of pulse input and each pulse type is withlogic type (positive (+), negative (-)). They all can be set in parameter P1-00. Please refer to the following relevant parameters: Relevant Parameter: P1 - 00 PTT External Pulse Input Type Address: 0100H, 0101H Related Section: Section 6.2.1

Default: 0x2 Applicable Control Mode: PT Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 1132 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings: A: Input pulse type

0: AB phase pulse (4x) (Quadrature Input)


A B C D not used

1: Clockwise (CW) + Counterclockwise(CCW) pulse 2: Pulse + Direction 3: Other settings:

B: Input pulse filter This setting is used to suppress or reduce the chatter caused by the noise, etc. However, if the instant input pulse filter frequency is over high, the frequency that exceeds the setting value will be regarded as noise and filtered. Setting Value 0 1 2 3 4 Low Filter 1.66Mpps 416Kpps 208Kpps 104Kpps No Filter Function Setting Value 0 1 2 3 4 High Filter 6.66Mpps 1.66Mpps 833Kpps 416Kpps No Filter Function

6-4

Revision January 2011

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

C: Input polarity Logic Pulse Type AB phase pulse Forward Reverse

Positive Logic

CW + CCW pulse Pulse + Direction AB phase pulse

Negative Logic

CW + CCW pulse Pulse + Direction

Pulse specification High-speed pulse Low-speed pulse Line driver Line driver Open collector

Max. input pulse frequency 4Mpps 500Kpps 200Kpps

Min. time width T1 62.5ns 0.5s 1.25s T2 125ns 1 s 2.5s T3 250ns 2 s 5 s T4 200ns 2 s 5 s T5 125ns 1 s 2.5s T6 125ns 1 s 2.5s

Pulse specification High-speed pulse Low-speed pulse Line driver Line driver Open collector

Max. input pulse frequency 4Mpps 500Kpps 200Kpps

Voltage specification 5V 2.8V ~ 3.7V 24V (Max.)

Forward specification < 25mA < 25mA < 25mA

Revision January 2011

6-5

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

D: Source of pulse command Setting value 0 1 Input pulse interface Open collector for low-speed pulse Line driver for high-speed pulse Remark CN1 Terminal Identification: PULSE, SIGN CN1 Terminal Identification: PULSE_D, SIGN_D

Position pulse can be input from these terminals, PULSE (41), /PULSE (43), HPULSE (38), /HPULSE (29), SIGN (37), /SIGN (36) and HSIGN (46), /HSIGN (40). It can be an open-collector circuit or line driver circuit. For the detail wiring, please refer to 3.10.1.

6-6

Revision January 2011

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

6.2.2 Command Source of Position (PR) Control Mode


The command sources of PR mode are (P6-00, P6-01) ~ (P7-26, P7-27) these 64 built-in parameters. Using with external I/O signals (CN1, POS 0 to POS 5 and CTRG) can select one of the 64 built-in parameters to be position command. Please refer to the table below: Position Command P1 P2 ~ P50 P51 ~ P64 OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF ON ON ON ON OFF OFF ON OFF POS5 ON ON POS4 ON ON POS3 ON ON POS2 ON ON POS1 ON ON POS0 ON OFF CTRG Parameters P6-00 P6-01 P6-02 P6-03 ~ P6-98 P6-99 P7-00 P7-01 ~ P7-26 P7-27

State of POS0~5: 0 indicates the contact is OFF (Normally Open) 1 indicates the contact is ON (Normally Closed) CTRG : the instant time when the contact changes from 0 (open) to 1 (closed). The application of absolute and incremental position control is various and multiple. This kind of position control is equal to a simple sequence control. Users can easily complete the cycle running by using the above table. For example, the position command, P1 is 10 turns and P2 is 20 turns. Give the position command P1 first and then give the position command P2. The difference between absolute and incremental position control is shown as the figure below:

Absolute Type

Incremental Type

20 turns 20 turns 10 turns 10 turns

Revision January 2011

6-7

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

6.2.3 Structure of Position Control Mode


Basic Structure:

In order to pursue the goal of perfection in position control, the pulse signal should be modified through position command processing and the structure is shown as the figure below: ASDA-A2 Series:

Using parameter can select PR mode and PT mode. Electronic gear ratio can be set in both two modes to set proper position revolution. ASDA-A2 series servo drives also provide Scurve and low-pass filter, which are used whenever the motor and load need to be operated more smoothly. As for the information of electronic gear ratio, S-curve and lowpass filter, please refer to the following sections 6.2.4, 6.2.5 and 6.2.6.

6-8

Revision January 2011

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

Pulse Inhibit Input Function (INHIBIT)

This function is activated via digital inputs (Please refer to parameter P2-10 ~ P2-17 and DI INHP in Table 8.A).When the drive is in position mode, if INHP is activated, the external pulse input command is not valid and the motor will stop (Please note that only DI8 supports this function).
INHP ON OFF ON

Pulse command

6.2.4 S-curve Filter for Position Control


The S-curve filter is for the position smoothing of motion command. Using S-curve filter can run the servo motor more smoothly in response to a sudden position command. Since the speed and acceleration curve are both continuous and the time for the servo motor to accelerate is short, using S-curve filter not only can improve the performance when servo motor accelerate or decelerate but also can make motor to operate more smoothly (from mechanical view). When the load is change, the motor usually run not smoothly when starts to run and stop due to the friction and inertia change. At this moment, users can increase Accel/Decel S-curve constant (TSL), Accel time constant (TACC) and Decel time constant (TDEC) to improve the performance. Because the speed and angle acceleration are continuous when position command is changed to pulse signal input, so it is not needed to use S-curve filter.

Revision January 2011

6-9

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

Relevant Parameters: P1 - 34 TACC Acceleration Time Address: 0144H, 0145H Related Section: Section 6.3.3,

Default: 200 Applicable Control Mode: S Unit: msec Range: 1 ~ 65500 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to determine the acceleration time to accelerate from 0 to its rated motor speed. The functions of parameters P1-34, P1-35 and P1-36 are each individual. When P1-36 is set to 0 (Disabled), the settings of P1-34, P1-35 are still effective. It indicates that the parameters P1-34 and P1-35 will not become disabled even when P1-36 is disabled. Please note: 1. When the source of speed command is analog command, the maximum setting value of P1-36 is set to 0, the acceleration and deceleration function will be disabled. 2. When the source of speed command is analog command, the maximum setting value of P1-34 is limited to 20000 automatically.

6-10

Revision January 2011

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

P1 - 35

TDEC

Deceleration Time

Address: 0146H, 0147H Related Section: Section 6.3.3,

Default: 200 Applicable Control Mode: S Unit: msec Range: 1 ~ 65500 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to determine the acceleration time to accelerate from 0 to its rated motor speed. The functions of parameters P1-34, P1-35 and P1-36 are each individual. When P1-36 is set to 0 (Disabled), the settings of P1-34, P1-35 are still effective. It indicates that the parameters P1-34 and P1-35 will not become disabled even when P1-36 is disabled. Please note: 1. When the source of speed command is analog command, the maximum setting value of P1-36 is set to 0, the acceleration and deceleration function will be disabled. 2. When the source of speed command is analog command, the maximum setting value of P1-35 is limited to 20000 automatically.

P1 - 36

TSL

Accel /Decel S-curve

Address: 0148H, 0149H Related Section: Section 6.3.3,

Default: 0 Unit: msec Applicable Control Mode: S, PR Unit: msec Range: 0 ~ 65500 (0: Disabled) Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to make the motor run more smoothly when startup and windup. Using this parameter can improve the motor running stability.

TACC: P1-34, Acceleration time TDEC: P1-35, Deceleration time

Revision January 2011

6-11

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

TSL: P1-36, Accel /Decel S-curve Total acceleration time = TACC + TSL Total deceleration time = TDEC + TSL The functions of parameters P1-34, P1-35 and P1-36 are each individual. When P136 is set to 0 (Disabled), the settings of P1-34, P1-35 are still effective. It indicates that the parameters P1-34 and P1-35 will not become disabled even when P1-36 is disabled. Please note: 1. When the source of speed command is analog command, the maximum setting value of P1-36 is set to 0, the acceleration and deceleration function will be disabled. 2. When the source of speed command is analog command, the maximum setting value of P1-36 is limited to 10000 automatically.

6.2.5 Electronic Gear Ratio


Relevant parameters: P1 - 44 GR1 Electronic Gear Ratio (1st Numerator) (N1) Address: 0158H, 0159H Related Section: Section 6.2.5

Default: 128 Applicable Control Mode: PT, PR Unit: pulse Range: 1 ~ (229-1) Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the numerator of the electronic gear ratio. The denominator of the electronic gear ratio is set by P1-45. P2-60 ~ P2-62 are used to set the additional numberators. Please note: 1. In PT mode, the setting value of P1-44 can be changed only when the servo drive is enabled (Servo On). 2. In PR mode, the setting value of P1-44 can be changed only when the servo drive is disabled (Servo Off).

6-12

Revision January 2011

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

P1 - 45 GR2

Electronic Gear Ratio (Denominator) (M)

Address: 015AH, 015BH Related Section: Section 6.3.6

Default: 10 Applicable Control Mode: PT, PR Unit: pulse Range: 1 ~ (231-1) Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the denominator of the electronic gear ratio. The numerator of the electronic gear ratio is set by P1-44. P2-60 ~ P2-62 are used to set the additional numberators. As the wrong setting may cause motor to run chaotically (out of control) and it may lead to personnel injury, therefore, ensure to observe the following rule when setting P1-44, P1-45. The electronic gear ratio setting (Please also see P1-44, P2-60 ~ P2-62):
Pulse input f1 N M Position command N f2 = f1 x M

f1: Pulse input P2-60 ~ P2-62

f2: Position command

N: Numerator, the setting value of P1-44 or M: Denominator, the setting value of P1-45

The electronic gear ratio setting range must be within: 1/50<N/M<25600. Please note: 1. In PT and PR mode, the setting value of P1-45 can not be changed when the servo drive is enabled (Servo On).

The electronic gear function provides easy travel distance ratio change. However, the over high electronic gear ratio will command the motor to move not smoothly. At this time, the users can use low-pass filter parameter to improve this kind of situation. For example, assume that the electronic gear ratio is equal to 1 and the encoder pulse per revolution is 10000ppr, if the electronic gear ratio is changed to 0.5, then the motor will rotate one pulse when the command from external controller is two pulses. For example, after the proper electronic gear ratio is set, the reference travel distance is 1 m/pulse, the machinery will become easier to be used.

Revision January 2011

6-13

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

Electronic Gear Ratio When the electronic gear ratio is not used When the electronic gear ratio is not used
=

Corresponding travel distance per pulse


= 3x 100 0 300 0 = 4x 250 0 100 00 m

1 1

1000 0 300 0

=1 m

6.2.6 Low-pass Filter


Relevant parameters: P1 - 08 PFLT Smooth Constant of Position Command (Low-pass Filter) Address: 0110H, 0111H Related Section: Section 6.2.6

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PT/PR Unit: 10msec Range: 0 ~ 1000 (0: Disabled) Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal
Position Tar get pos ition

Time (ms) PF LT

6-14

Revision January 2011

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

6.2.7 Timing Chart of Position (PR) Control Mode


In PR mode, position command source is DI signal from CN1, i.e. selected by POS0~POS5 and CTRG. Please refer to 6-2-2 to see the relationship between DI signals and parameters. The following figure is shown the timing chart of PR mode:

Revision January 2011

6-15

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

6.2.8 Position Loop Gain Adjustment


Before performing position control (setting position control block diagram), the users should complete the speed control setting by using Manual mode (parameter P-32) since the position loop contains speed loop. Then, adjust the Proportional Position Loop Gain, KPP (parameter P2-00) and Position Feed Forward Gain, PFG (parameter P2-02). Or use Auto mode to adjust the gain of speed and position control block diagram automatically. 1) Proportional Position Loop Gain: To increase this gain can enhance the position loop responsiveness. 2) Position Feed Forward Gain: To increase this gain can reduce the position track error during operation. The position loop responsiveness cannot exceed the speed loop responsiveness, and it is recommended that the speed loop responsiveness should be at least four times faster than the position loop responsiveness. This also means that the setting value of Proportional Speed Loop Gain, KVP should be at least four times faster than Proportional Position Loop Gain, KPP. The equation is shown as follows:

fp < fv 4 , fv : Speed Loop Responsiveness (Hz), fp : Position Loop Responsiveness (Hz)


KPP = 2 fp. For example, the desired position loop responsiveness is equal to 20 Hz. Then, KPP = 2 20= 125 rad/s. Relevant parameters: P2 - 00 KPP Proportional Position Loop Gain Address: 0200H, 0201H Related Section: Section 6.2.8

Default: 35 Applicable Control Mode: PT, PR Unit: rad/s Range: 0 ~ 2047 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the position loop gain. It can increase stiffness, expedite position loop response and reduce position error. However, if the setting value is over high, it may generate vibration or noise.

6-16

Revision January 2011

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

P2 - 02

PFG

Position Feed Forward Gain

Address: 0204H, 0205H Related Section: Section 6.2.8

Default: 50 Applicable Control Mode: PT, PR Unit: % Range: 0 ~ 100 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the feed forward gain when executing position control command. When using position smooth command, increase gain can improve position track deviation. When not using position smooth command, decrease gain can improve the resonance condition of mechanical system.

When the value of Proportional Position Loop Gain, KPP is too great, the position loop responsiveness will be increased and it will result in small phase margin. If this happens, the rotor of motor will oscillate. At this time, the users have to decrease the value of KPP until the rotor of motor stop oscillating. When there is an external torque command interrupted, over low KPP value will let the motor cannot overcome the external strength and fail to meet the requirement of reasonable position track error demand. Adjust feed forward gain, PFG (P2-02) to efficiently reduce the dynamic position track error.

Revision January 2011

6-17

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

6.2.9 Low-frequency Vibration Suppression


If the stiffness of the mechanical system is not sufficient, after the positioning command has completed, continuous vibration of the mechanical system may occur still even when the motor has almost stopped. At this time, using low-frequency vibration suppression function can suppress the low-frequency vibration of mechanical system. The range of frequency setting is from 1.0 to 100.0Hz. Besides, two modes (Manual/Auto) of lowfrequency vibration suppression function are available for the users to select. Auto Mode

If the users know the point where the low-frequency occurs, we recommend the users can use this mode to find the low-frequency of the mechanical vibration automatically. When P1-29 is set to 1, the system will disable the filter function and find the vibration frequency of low-frequency automatically. After the detected frequency becomes fixed and stable, the system will set P1-29 to 0, save the first measured low-frequency value automatically into P1-25 and set P1-26 to 1; then save the second measured lowfrequency value automatically into P1-27 and set P1-28 to 1. If any low-frequency vibration occurs after P1-29 is set to 0 automatically, please examine if the function of P1-26 or P1-28 is enabled or not. When the setting value of P1-26 or P1-28 is 0, it indicates that there is no frequency is detected. Please decrease the setting value of P130 (Low-frequency Vibration Detection Level) and set P1-29 to 1 to find the low-frequency again. Please pay close attention on the setting value of P1-30 as if the setting value of P1-30 is too low, it is easy to regard the interference as the low-frequency and results in erroneous measurement.

6-18

Revision January 2011

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

Please note: 1. When P1-26 and P1-28 are both set to 0, it indicates that the system could not find the frequency. Please check the setting value of P1-30 because when the setting value of P1-30 is too high, it may causes that the frequency becomes difficult to be found. 2. When P1-26 and P1-28 are both set to a non-zero value, if the vibration condition can not be improved, please check the setting value of P1-30 as the low setting value of P1-30 may result in erroneous measurement. The system may regard the interference as a low-frequency. 3. When the vibration still exists and can not be suppressed after using auto lowfrequency vibration suppression function, if the users know the vibration frequency, please set P1-25 and P1-27 manually to improve the vibration condition. Relevant parameters: P1 - 29 AVSM Auto Low-frequency Vibration Suppression Mode Selection Address: 013AH, 013BH Related Section: Section 6.2.9

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PT/PR Unit: Range: 0 ~ 1 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

0: Normal mode (Disable Auto Low-frequency Vibration Suppression Mode). 1: Auto mode (Enable Auto Low-frequency Vibration Suppression Mode). Explanation: If P1-29 is set to 0, the setting of low-frequency vibration suppression is fixed and will not change automatically. If P1-29 is set to 1, when there is no low-frequency vibration or the low-frequency vibration becomes less and stable, the system will set P1-29 to 0, save the measured low-frequency value automatically and memorize it in P1-25.

P1 - 30

VCL

Low-frequency Vibration Detection Level

Address: 013CH, 013DH Related Section: Section 6.2.9

Default: 500 Applicable Control Mode: PT/PR Unit: pulse Range: 1 ~ 8000 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

Revision January 2011

6-19

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

Settings: When P1-29 is set to 1, the system will find this detection level automatically. If the setting value of P1-30 is too low, the detection of frequency will become sensitive and result in erroneous measurement. If the setting value of P1-30 is too high, although the probability of erroneous measurement will decrease, the frequency will become difficult to be found especially when the vibration of mechanical system is less. The setting value of P1-30 indicates the range of vibration frequency. When the vibration can not be detected (out of range), it indicates that the setting value of P1-30 is too high and we recommend the users can decrease the setting value of P1-30. The users can also use the Scope function provided in ASDA-A2 configuration software to observe the vibration during positioning operation so as to set P1-30 appropriately. Manual Mode

There area two groups of low-frequency vibration suppression parameters. The first group is P1-25 and P1-26 and the second group is P1-27 and P1-28. Using these two groups of parameters can improve the vibration condition of two different low frequencies. P1-25 and P1-26 are used to set the occurred vibration frequency and P1-26 and P1-28 are used to set the frequency response after filter function is used. When the setting values of P1-26 and P1-28 are higher, the performance of frequency response will be better. However, if the setting value is over high, it may affect the motor operation. The default setting of P1-26 and P1-28 are both 0, and it indicates that the low-frequency vibration suppression function is disabled. Relevant parameters: P1 - 25 VSF1 Low-frequency Vibration Suppression (1) Address: 0132H, 0133H Related Section: Section 6.2.9

Default: 100.0 Applicable Control Mode: PT/PR Unit: Hz Range: 1.0 ~ 100.0 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the first group of the low-frequency of mechanical system. It can be used to suppress the low-frequency vibration of mechanical system. If P1-26 is set to 0, this parameter is disabled.

6-20

Revision January 2011

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

P1 - 26

VSG1

Low-frequency Vibration Suppression Gain (1)

Address: 0134H, 0135H Related Section: Section 6.2.9

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PT/PR Unit: Range: 0 ~ 9 (0: Disable the function of P1-25) Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the vibration suppression gain for P1-25. When the setting value is higher, the position response is quicker. However, if the setting value is over high, it may addect the normal operation of servo motor. It is recommended to set P1-26 as 1.

P1 - 27

VSF2

Low-frequency Vibration Suppression (2)

Address: 0136H, 0137H Related Section: Section 6.2.9

Default: 100.0 Applicable Control Mode: PT/PR Unit: Hz Range: 1.0 ~ 100.0 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the second group of the low-frequency of mechanical system. It can be used to suppress the low-frequency vibration of mechanical system. If P1-28 is set to 0, this parameter is disabled. Low-frequency Vibration Suppression Gain (2)

P1 - 28

VSG2

Address: 0138H, 0139H Related Section: Section 6.2.9

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PT/PR Unit: Range: 0 ~ 9 (0: Disable the function of P1-27) Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the vibration suppression gain for P1-27. When the setting value is higher, the position response is quicker. However, if the setting value is over high, it may addect the normal operation of servo motor. It is recommended to set P1-28 as 1.

Revision January 2011

6-21

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

Please note: 1. After the low-frequency vibration is suppressed, the changes of the response may become excessive. Therefore, please ensure that the machine is able to stop any time and ensure the safety of personnel working with the machine when execute lowfrequency vibration suppression function. 2. The low-frequency vibration suppression function can be enabled only in position control mode (PT, PR or PR-PT mode). 3. When the users use resonance suppression function, the resonance condition can be improved immediately after the correct resonance frequency is found. However, when the users use low-frequency vibration suppression function, the vibration of the mechanical system will not be eliminated immediately. The vibration condition is improved gradually after the correct frequency is found. This is because the lowfrequency vibration suppression function is not effective for the vibration caused by external force and the vibration occurred before using suppression function. 4. After the low-frequency vibration suppression function is enabled, it will certainly affect the original response performance. When the value of the low-frequency is lower, the effect upon the response performance is greater. At this time, the users can adjust the setting value of P1-26 to increase the position response. But, please do not set P1-26 to a higher value. If the setting value of P1-26 is too high, it will affect the motor operation. 5. In order to avoid that the vibration frequency may not easily to be found when the commanding time is too fast in Auto mode, we recommend the users can set a longer command delay time. The command can be given after the vibration frequency is found.

6-22

Revision January 2011

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

6.3 Speed Control Mode


The speed control mode (S or Sz) is usually used on the applications of precision speed control, such as CNC machine, etc. ASDA-A2 series servo drives support two kinds of command sources in speed control mode. One is external analog signal and the other is internal parameter. The external analog signal is from external voltage input and it can control the speed of servo motor. There are two usage of internal parameter, one is set different speed command in three speed control parameters before operation and then using SPD0 and SPD1 of CN1 DI signal perform switching. The other usage is using serial communication to change the setting value of parameter. Beside, in order to make the speed command switch more smoothly, ASDA-A2 series servo drives also provide complete S-curve profile for speed control mode. For the closed-loop speed control, ASDA-A2 series servo drives provide gain adjustment function and an integrated PI or PDFF controller. Besides, two modes of tuning technology (Manual/Auto) are also provided for the users to select (parameter P2-32).

There are two turning modes for gain adjustment: Manual and Auto modes. Manual Mode: User-defined loop gain adjustment. When using this mode, all auto and auxiliary function will be disabled. Auto Mode: Continuous adjustment of loop gains according to measured inertia, with ten levels of system bandwidth. The parameter set by user is default value.

6.3.1 Command Source of Speed Control Mode


Speed command Sources: 1) External analog signal: External analog voltage input, -10V to +10V 2) Internal parameter: P1-09 to P1-11 Speed Command CN1 DI signal SPD1 SPD0 Command Source External analog signal N/A Content Range

S S1 0 0 Mode Sz S2 S3 S4 0 1 1 1 0 1

Voltage between V-REF- -10 V ~ +10V GND Speed command is 0 P1-09 P1-10 P1-11 0 -60000 ~ +60000 r/min

Internal parameter

Revision January 2011

6-23

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

State of SPD0~1: 0: indicates OFF (Normally Open); 1: indicates ON (Normally Closed)

When SPD0 and SPD1 are both = 0 (OFF), if the control mode of operation is Sz, then the speed command is 0. Therefore, if the users do not use analog voltage as speed command, the users can choose Sz mode and avoid the zero point drift problem of analog voltage signal. If the speed control mode is S mode, then the command is the analog voltage between V-REF and GND. The setting range of the input voltage is from -10V to +10V and the corresponding motor speed is adjustable (Please see parameter P1-40).

When at least one of SPD0 and SPD1 is not 0 (OFF), the speed command is internal parameter (P1-09 to P1-11). The command is valid (enabled) after either SPD0 or SPD1 is changed.

The range of internal parameters is within -60000 ~ +60000 r/min. Setting value = Range x Unit (0.1 r/min). For example, if P1-09 is set to +30000, the setting value = +30000 x 0.1 r/min = +3000 r/min.

The speed command that is described in this section not only can be taken as speed command in speed control mode (S or Sz mode) but also can be the speed limit input command in torque control mode (T or Tz mode).

6.3.2 Structure of Speed Control Mode


Basic Structure:

In the figure above, the speed command processing is used to select the command source of speed control according to chapter 6.3.1, including proportional gain (P1-40) and S-curve filter smoothing strategy of speed control. The speed control block diagram is used to manage the gain parameters of the servo drive and calculate the current input provided to motor instantaneously. The resonance suppression block diagram is used to suppress the resonance of mechanical system.

6-24

Revision January 2011

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

The function and structure of speed command processing is shown as the figure below:

The command source is selected according to the state of SPD0, SPD1 and parameter P101 (S or Sz). Whenever the command signal needs to be more smoothly, we recommend the users to use S-curve and low-pass filter.

6.3.3 Smoothing Strategy of Speed Control Mode


S-curve Filter The S-curve filter is a speed smoothing command which provides 3 steps accel / decel Scurve to smooth the speed command change of the motor during acceleration and deceleration. Using S-curve filter can let the servo motor run more smoothly in response to a sudden speed command change. Since the speed and acceleration curve are both continuous, in order to avoid the mechanical resonance and noise may occur due to a sudden speed command (differentiation of acceleration), using S-curve filter not only can improve the performance when servo motor accelerate or decelerate but also can make the motor run more smoothly. S-curve filter parameters include P1-34 Acceleration Time (TACC), P1-35 Deceleration Time (TDEC) and Accel /Decel S-curve (TSL), and the users can use these three parameters to improve the motor performance during acceleration, deceleration and operation. ASDA-A2 series servo drives also support the time calculation of completing speed command. T (ms) is the operation (running) time. S (r/min) is absolute speed command, i.e. the absolute value (the result) after starting speed subtracts the final speed.

Revision January 2011

6-25

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

Relevant parameters: P1 - 34 TACC Acceleration Time Address: 0144H, 0145H Related Section: Section

Default: 200 6.3.3, Applicable Control Mode: S Unit: msec Range: 1 ~ 65500 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to determine the acceleration time to accelerate from 0 to its rated motor speed. The functions of parameters P1-34, P1-35 and P1-36 are each individual. When P1-36 is set to 0 (Disabled), the settings of P1-34, P1-35 are still effective. It indicates that the parameters P1-34 and P1-35 will not become disabled even when P1-36 is disabled. Please note: 1. When the source of speed command is analog command, the maximum setting value of P1-36 is set to 0, the acceleration and deceleration function will be disabled. 2. When the source of speed command is analog command, the maximum setting value of P1-34 is limited to 20000 automatically.

6-26

Revision January 2011

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

P1 - 35

TDEC

Deceleration Time

Address: 0146H, 0147H Related Section: Section 6.3.3

Default: 200 Applicable Control Mode: S Unit: msec Range: 1 ~ 65500 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to determine the acceleration time to accelerate from 0 to its rated motor speed. The functions of parameters P1-34, P1-35 and P1-36 are each individual. When P1-36 is set to 0 (Disabled), the settings of P1-34, P1-35 are still effective. It indicates that the parameters P1-34 and P1-35 will not become disabled even when P1-36 is disabled. Please note: 1. When the source of speed command is analog command, the maximum setting value of P1-36 is set to 0, the acceleration and deceleration function will be disabled. 2. When the source of speed command is analog command, the maximum setting value of P1-35 is limited to 20000 automatically.

P1 - 36

TSL

Accel /Decel S-curve

Address: 0148H, 0149H Related Section: Section 6.3.3

Default: 0 Unit: msec Applicable Control Mode: S, PR Unit: msec Range: 0 ~ 65500 (0: Disabled) Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to make the motor run more smoothly when startup and windup. Using this parameter can improve the motor running stability.

TACC: P1-34, Acceleration time TDEC: P1-35, Deceleration time

Revision January 2011

6-27

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

TSL: P1-36, Accel /Decel S-curve Total acceleration time = TACC + TSL Total deceleration time = TDEC + TSL The functions of parameters P1-34, P1-35 and P1-36 are each individual. When P136 is set to 0 (Disabled), the settings of P1-34, P1-35 are still effective. It indicates that the parameters P1-34 and P1-35 will not become disabled even when P1-36 is disabled. Please note: 1. When the source of speed command is analog command, the maximum setting value of P1-36 is set to 0, the acceleration and deceleration function will be disabled. 2. When the source of speed command is analog command, the maximum setting value of P1-36 is limited to 10000 automatically. 3. If the control of the servo motor is achieved via internal parameters, the command curve should be defined by the users. Analog Speed Command S-curve Filter ASDA-A2 series servo drives also provide Analog Speed Command S-curve Filter for the smoothing in response to a sudden analog input signal.
Speed (rpm) 3000 Analog speed command Motor Torque

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9

Time (sec)

-3000

The analog speed command S-curve filter is for the smoothing of analog input signal and its function is the same as the S-curve filter. The speed and acceleration curve of analog speed command S-curve filter are both continuous. The above figure shows the curve of analog speed command S-curve filter and the users can see the ramp of speed command is different during acceleration and deceleration. Also, the users can see the difference of input command tracking and can adjust time setting by using parameter P1-34, P1-35, P136 to improve the actual motor performance according to actual condition.

Analog Speed Command Low-pass Filter Analog Speed Command Low-pass Filter is used to eliminate high frequency response and electrical interference from an analog speed command and it is also with smoothing function.
6-28

Revision January 2011

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

Relevant parameters: P1 - 06 SFLT Accel / Decel Smooth Constant of Analog Speed Command (Low-pass Filter) Address: 010CH, 010DH Related Section: Section 6.3.3

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: S Unit: msec Range: 0 ~ 1000 (0: Disabled) Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal
Target Speed

SFLT

6.3.4 Analog Speed Input Scaling


The analog voltage between V_REF and GND determines the motor speed command. Using with parameter P1-40 (Max. Analog Speed Command) can adjust the speed control ramp and its range.
5000rpm 3000rpm The speed control ramp is determined by parameter P1-40

-10

-5 5 10 Analog Input Voltage (V)

-3000rpm

-5000rpm

Revision January 2011

6-29

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

Relevant parameters: P1 - 40 VCM Max. Analog Speed Command or Limit Address: 0150H, 0151H Related Section: Section 6.3.4

Default: rated speed Applicable Control Mode: S, T Unit: r/min Range: 0 ~ 10000 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

In Speed mode, this parameter is used to set the maximum analog speed command based on the maximum input voltage (10V). In Torque mode, this parameter is used to set the maximum analog speed limit based on the maximum input voltage (10V). For example, in speed mode, if P1-40 is set to 3000 and the input voltage is 10V, it indicates that the speed command is 3000 r/min. If P1-40 is set to 3000, but the input voltage is changed to 5V, then the speed command is changed to 1500 r/min. Speed Command / Limit = Input Voltage Value x Setting value of P1-40 / 10

6.3.5 Timing Chart of Speed Control Mode


S4 (P1-11) Internal speed command S3 (P1-10) S2 (P1-09) External analog voltage or zero (0) S1 SPD0 External I/O signal SPD1 SON OFF OFF ON ON OFF ON ON

NOTE
1) OFF indicates normally open and ON indicates normally closed. 2) When speed control mode is Sz, the speed command S1=0; when speed control mode is S, the speed command S1 is external analog voltage input (Please refer to P1-01). 3) After Servo ON, the users can select command according to the state of SPD0~1.

6-30

Revision January 2011

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

6.3.6 Speed Loop Gain Adjustment


The function and structure of speed control mode is shown as the figure below:

There are two turning modes of gain adjustment: Manual and Auto modes. The gain of ASDA-A2 series servo drives can be adjusted by using any one of two tuning modes. Manual Mode: User-defined loop gain adjustment. When using this mode, all auto and auxiliary function will be disabled. Auto Mode: Continuous adjustment of loop gains according to measured inertia, with ten levels of system bandwidth. The parameter set by user is default value. The mode of gain adjustment can be selected by parameter P2-32: Relevant Parameter: P2 - 32 AUT2 Tuning Mode Selection Address: 0240H, 0241H Related Section: Section 5.6, Section 6.3.6

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 2 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings: 0: Manual mode 1: Auto Mode [Continuous adjustment] 2: Semi-Auto Mode [Non-continuous adjustment]
Revision January 2011

6-31

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

Explanation of manual mode: 1. When P2-32 is set to mode#0, the setting value of P2-00, P2-02, P2-04, P2-06, P2-07, P2-25 and P2-26 can be user-defined. When switching mode #1 or #2 to #0, the setting value of P2-00, P2-02, P2-04, P2-06, P2-07, P2-25 and P2-26 will change to the value that measured in #1 auto-tuning mode or #2 semi-auto tuning mode. Explanation of auto-tuning mode: The servo drive will continuously estimate the system inertia, save the measured load inertia value automatically and memorized in P1-37 every 30 minutes by referring to the frequency response settings of P2-31. 1. When switching mode #1 or #2 to #0, the servo drive will continuously estimate the system inertia, save the measured load inertia value automatically and memorized in P1-37. Then, set the corresponding parameters according to this measured load inertia value. 2. When switching mode#0 or #1 to #2, enter the appropriate load inertia value in P1-37. 3. When switching mode#1 to #0, the setting value of P2-00, P2-04 and P2-06 will change to the value that measured in #1 auto-tuning mode. Explanation of semi-auto tuning mode: 1. When switching mode #2 to #0, the setting value of P2-00, P2-04, P2-06, P2-25 and P2-26 will change to the value that measured in #1 auto-tuning mode. 2. After the system inertia becomes stable (The displau of P2-33 will show 1), it will stop estimating the system inertia, save the measured load inertia value automatically, and memorized in P1-37. However, when P2-32 is set to mode#1 or #2, the servo drive will continuously perform the adjustment for a period of time. 3. When the value of the system inertia becomes over high, the display of P2-33 will show 0 and the servo drive will start to adjust the load inertia value continuously. Manual Mode When Tuning Mode Settings of P2-32 is set to 0, the users can define the proportional speed loop gain (P2-04), speed integral gain (P2-06) feed forward gain (P2-07) and ratio of load inertia to servo motor Inertia (1-37). Please refer to the following description: Proportional gain: Adjust this gain can increase the position loop responsiveness. Integral gain: Adjust this gain can enhance the low-frequency stiffness of speed loop and eliminate the steady error. Also, reduce the value of phase margin. Over high integral gain will result in the unstable servo system. Feed forward gain: Adjust this gain can decrease the phase delay error

6-32

Revision January 2011

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

Relevant parameters: P2 - 04 KVP Proportional Speed Loop Gain Address: 0208H, 0209H Related Section: Section 6.3.6

Default: 500 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: rad/s Range: 0 ~ 8191 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the speed loop gain. When the value of proportional speed loop gain is increased, it can expedite speed loop response. However, if the setting value is over high, it may generate vibration or noise.

P2 - 06

KVI

Speed Integral Compensation

Address: 020CH, 020DH Related Section: Section 6.3.6

Default: 100 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: rad/s Range: 0 ~ 1023 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the integral time of speed loop. When the value of speed integral compensation is increased, it can improve the speed response ability and decrease the speed control deviation. However, if the setting value is over high, it may generate vibration or noise.

P2 - 07

KVF

Speed Feed Forward Gain

Address: 020EH, 020FH Related Section: Section 6.3.6

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: % Range: 0 ~ 100 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the feed forward gain when executing speed control command.

Revision January 2011

6-33

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

When using speed smooth command, increase gain can improve speed track deviation. When not using speed smooth command, decrease gain can improve the resonance condition of mechanical system. In theory, stepping response can be used to explain proportional gain (KVP), integral gain (KVI) and feed forward gain (KVF). Now we use frequency area and time area respectively to explain the logic. Frequency Domain

6-34

Revision January 2011

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

Time Domain

Revision January 2011

6-35

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

In general, the equipment, such as spectrum analyzer is needed and used to analyze when using frequency domain method and the users also should have this kind of analysis technology. However, when using time domain method, the users only need to prepare an oscilloscope. Therefore, the general users usually use time domain method with the analog DI/DO terminal provided by the servo drive to adjust what is called as PI (Proportional and Integral) type controller. As for the performance of torque shaft load, input command tracking and torque shaft load have the same responsiveness when using frequency domain method and time domain method. The users can reduce the responsiveness of input command tracking by using input command low-pass filter.

Auto Mode (Continuous adjustment)) This Auto Mode provides continuous adjustment of loop gains according to measured inertia automatically. It is suitable when the load inertia is fixed or the load inertia change is small and is not suitable for wide range of load inertia change. The period of adjustment time is different depending on the acceleration and deceleration of servo motor. To change the stiffness and responsiveness, please use parameter P2-31.
Motor Speed

Inertia Measurement

6-36

Revision January 2011

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

6.3.7 Resonance Suppression


The resonance of mechanical system may occur due to excessive system stiffness or frequency response. However, this kind of resonance condition can be improved, suppressed, even can be eliminated by using low-pass filter (parameter P2-25) and notch filter (parameter P2-23, P2-24) without changing control parameter. Relevant parameters: P2 - 23 NCF1 Notch Filter 1 (Resonance Suppression) Address: 022EH, 022FH Related Section: Section 6.3.7

Default: 1000 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: Hz Range: 50 ~ 1000 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set first resonance frequency of mechanical system. It can be used to suppress the resonance of mechanical system and reduce the vibration of mechanical system. If P2-24 is set to 0, this parameter is disabled. The parameters P2-23 and P2-24 are the first group of notch filter parameters and the parameters P2-43 and P2-44 are the second group of notch filter parameters. Notch Filter Attenuation Rate 1 (Resonance Suppression)

P2 - 24

DPH1

Address: 0230H, 0231H Related Section: Section 6.3.7

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: dB Range: 0 ~ 32 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set magnitude of the resonance suppression that is set by parameter P2-23. If P2-24 is set to 0, the parameters P2-23 and P2-24 are both disabled. The parameters P2-23 and P2-24 are the first group of notch filter parameters and the parameters P2-43 and P2-44 are the second group of notch filter parameters.

Revision January 2011

6-37

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

P2 - 43

NCF2

Notch Filter 2 (Resonance Suppression)

Address: 0256H, 0257H Related Section: Section 6.3.7

Default: 1000 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: Hz Range: 50 ~ 2000 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set second resonance frequency of mechanical system. It can be used to suppress the resonance of mechanical system and reduce the vibration of mechanical system. If P2-43 is set to 0, this parameter is disabled. The parameters P2-23 and P2-24 are the first group of notch filter parameters and the parameters P2-43 and P2-44 are the second group of notch filter parameters. Notch Filter Attenuation Rate 2 (Resonance Suppression)

P2 - 44

DPH2

Address: 0258H, 0259H Related Section: Section 6.3.7

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: dB Range: 0 ~ 32 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set magnitude of the resonance suppression that is set by parameter P2-43. If P2-44 is set to 0, the parameters P2-43 and P2-44 are both disabled.

6-38

Revision January 2011

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

P2 - 45

NCF3

Notch Filter 3 (Resonance Suppression)

Address: 025AH, 025BH Related Section: Section 6.3.7

Default: 1000 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: Hz Range: 50 ~ 2000 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set third resonance frequency of mechanical system. It can be used to suppress the resonance of mechanical system and reduce the vibration of mechanical system. If P2-45 is set to 0, this parameter is disabled. Notch Filter Attenuation Rate 3 (Resonance Suppression)

P2 - 46

DPH3

Address: 025CH, 025DH Related Section: Section 6.3.7

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: dB Range: 0 ~ 32 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set magnitude of the resonance suppression that is set by parameter P2-45. If P2-46 is set to 0, the parameters P2-45 and P2-46 are both disabled. Low-pass Filter Time Constant (Resonance Suppression)

P2 - 25

NLP

Address: 0232H, 0233H Related Section: Section 6.3.7

Default: 2 (1kW and below models) or 5 (other models) Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: 0.1 msec Range: 0 ~ 1000 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set low-pass filter time constant of resonance suppression. If P2-25 is set to 0, this parameter is disabled.
Revision January 2011

6-39

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

There are two groups of notch filters provided by ASDA-A2 series. The first group of notch filter is P2-43 and P2-44, and the second group of notch filter is P2-45 and P2-46. When there is resonance, please set P2-47 to 1 or 2 (Auto mode), and then the servo drive will find resonance frequency and suppress the resonance automatically. After suppressing the resonance point, the system will memorize the notch filter frequency into P2-43 and P-45, and memorize the notch filter attenuation rate into P2-44 and P2-46. When P2-47 is set to 1, the resonance suppression will be enabled automatically. After the mechanical system becomes stable (approximate 20 minutes), the setting value of P2-47 will return to 0 (Disable auto resonance suppression function). When P2-47 is set to 2, the system will find the resonance point continuously even after the mechanical system becomes stable. When P2-47 is set to 1 or 2, if the resonance conditions can not be eliminated, we recommend the users to check the settings of P2-44 and P2-46. If either of the setting value of P2-44 and P2-46 is set to 32, please decrease the speed frequency response and estimate the resonance point again. If the resonance conditions can not be eliminated when the setting values of P244 and P2-46 are both less than 32, please set P2-47 to 0 first, and increase the setting value of P2-44 and P2-46 manually. If the resonance exists still after increasing the setting value of P2-44 and P2-46, please decrease the value of speed frequency response again and then use the resonance suppression function again. When increasing the setting value of P2-44 and P2-46 manually, ensure to pay close attention on the setting value of P2-44 and P2-46. If the value of P2-44 and P2-46 is greater than 0, it indicates that the corresponding resonance frequency of P2-43 and P2-45 is found through auto resonance suppression function. If the value of P2-44 and P2-46 is equal to 0, it indicates that the value of P2-43 and P2-45 will be the default value 1000 and this is not the frequency found by auto resonance suppression function. At this time, if the users increase the value of notch filter attenuation rate which does not exist, the performance of the current mechanical system may deteriorate.

6-40

Revision January 2011

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

Settings of P2-47 Current Value 0 0 1 1 1 2 2 2 Desired Value 1 2 0 1 2 0 1 2 Function Clear the setting value of P2-43 ~ P2-46 and enable auto resonance suppression function. Clear the setting value of P2-43 ~ P2-46 and enable auto resonance suppression function. Save the setting value of P2-43 ~ P2-46 and disable auto resonance suppression function. Clear the setting value of P2-43 ~ P2-46 and enable auto resonance suppression function. Do not clear the setting value of P2-43 ~ P2-46 and enable auto resonance suppression function continuously. Save the setting value of P2-43 ~ P2-46 and disable auto resonance suppression function. Clear the setting value of P2-43 ~ P2-46 and enable auto resonance suppression function. Do not clear the setting value of P2-43 ~ P2-46 and enable auto resonance suppression function continuously.

Revision January 2011

6-41

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

6-42

Revision January 2011

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

Low-pass filter Please use parameter P2-25. The figure below shows the resonant open-loop gain.
Gain

Frequency

When the low-pass filter (parameter P2-25) is adjusted from 0 to high value, the value of Low-pass frequency (BW) will become smaller (see the figure below). The resonant condition is improved and the frequency response and phase margin will also decrease.
Gain

0dB

BW

Frequency

Notch Filter Usually, if the users know the resonance frequency, we recommend the users can eliminate the resonance conditions directly by using notch filter (parameter P2-23, P2-24). However, the range of frequency setting is from 50 to 1000Hz only and the range of resonant attenuation is 0~32 dB only. Therefore, if the resonant frequency is out of this range, we recommend the users to use low-pass filter (parameter P2-25) to improve resonant condition. Please refer to the following figures and explanation to know how to use notch filter and low-pass filter to improve resonant condition.

Revision January 2011

6-43

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

Use Notch Filter to suppress resonance


Resonance conditions is suppressed Low-pass Frequency Frequency

Gain

Resonance Point Low-pass Frequency Resonance Frequency . Frequency

Gain 0db Attenuation Rate P2-24

Notch Filter

Gain

Resonance Frequency P2-23

Frequency

Resonance Frequency .

Use Low-pass Filter to suppress resonance


. Gain Resonance Point Low-pass Frequency Resonance Frequency Frequency Gain 0db Attenuation Rate -3db Low-pass Filter Cut-off Frequency of Low-pass Filter = 10000 / P2-25 Hz Gain Resonance conditions is suppressed Low-pass Frequency Frequency

Frequency

Resonance Frequency .

When the low-pass filter (parameter P2-25) is adjusted from 0 to high value, the value of Low-pass frequency will become smaller (see the figure on page 6-26). The resonant condition is improved but the frequency response and phase margin will also decrease and the system may become unstable. Therefore, if the users know the resonance frequency, the users can eliminate the resonance conditions directly by using notch filter (parameter P2-23, P2-24). Usually, if the resonant frequency can be recognized, we recommend the users can directly use notch filter (parameter P2-23, P2-24) to eliminate the resonance. However, if the resonant frequency will drift or drift out of the notch filter range, we recommend the users not to use notch filter and use low-pass filter to improve resonant conditions.

6-44

Revision January 2011

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

6.4 Torque Control Mode


The torque control mode (T or Tz) is usually used on the applications of torque control, such as printing machine, spinning machine, twister, etc. Delta ASDA-A2 series servo drives support two kinds of command sources in torque control mode. One is external analog signal and the other is internal parameter. The external analog signal is from external voltage input and it can control the torque of servo motor. The internal parameters are from P1-12 to P1-14 which are used to be the torque command in torque control mode.

6.4.1 Command Source of Torque Control Mode


Torque command Sources: 1) External analog signal: External analog voltage input, -10V to +10V 2) Internal parameter: P1-12 to P1-14 The command source selection is determined by the DI signal of CN1 connector. Torque Command DI signal of CN1 TCM1 TCM0 T T1 T2 T3 T4 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 Internal parameter Mode Tz External analog signal None Voltage between -10V ~ +10V T-REF-GND Torque command is 0 P1-12 P1-13 P1-14 0 -300% ~ 300% Command Source Content Range

State of TCM0~1: 0: indicates OFF (Normally Open); 1: indicates ON (Normally Closed)

When TCM0 and TCM1 are both 0 (OFF), if the control mode of operation is Tz, then the command is 0. Therefore, if the users do not use analog voltage as torque command, the users can choose Tz mode to operation torque control to avoid the zero point drift problem of analog voltage. If the control mode of operation is T, then the command is the analog voltage between T-REF and GND. The setting range of the input voltage is from -10V to +10V and the corresponding torque is adjustable (see parameter P1-41).

When at least one of TCM0 and TCM1 is not 0 (OFF), the torque command is internal parameter. The command is valid (enabled) after either TCM0 or TCM1 is changed.

The torque command that is described in this section not only can be taken as torque command in torque control mode (T or Tz mode) but also can be the torque limit input command in position mode (P mode) and speed control mode (S or Sz mode).

Revision January 2011

6-45

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

6.4.2 Structure of Torque Control Mode


Basic Structure:

The toque command processing is used to select the command source of torque control according to chapter 6.4.1, including max. analog torque command (parameter P1-41) and smoothing strategy of torque control mode. The current control block diagram is used to manage the gain parameters of the servo drive and calculate the current input provided to motor instantaneously. As the current control block diagram is too complicated, setting the parameters of current control block diagram is not allowed. The function and structure of torque command processing is shown as the figure below:

The command source is selected according to the state of TCM0, TCM1 and parameter P1-01 (T or Tz). Whenever the command signal needs to be more smoothly, we recommend the users to use proportional gain (scalar) and low-pass filter to adjust torque.

6-46

Revision January 2011

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

6.4.3 Smoothing Strategy of Torque Control Mode


Relevant parameters: P1 - 07 TFLT Smooth Constant of Analog Torque Command (Low-pass Filter) Address: 010EH, 010FH Related Section: Section 6.4.3

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: T Unit: msec Range: 0 ~ 1000 (0: Disabled) Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

NOTE
1) If the setting value of parameter P1-07 is set to 0, it indicates the function of this parameter is disabled and the command is just By-Pass.
Target Speed

TFLT

6.4.4 Analog Torque Input Scaling


The analog voltage between T_REF and GND controls the motor torque command. Using with parameter P1-41 can adjust the torque control ramp and its range.
300% 100% The torque control ramp is determined by parameter P1-41

Torque command

-10

-5 5 10 Analog Input Voltage (V)

-100%

-300%

Revision January 2011

6-47

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

Relevant parameters: P1 - 41 TCM Max. Analog Torque Command or Limit Address: 0152H, 0153H Related Section: Section 6.4.4

Default: 100 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: % Range: 0 ~ 1000 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

In Torque mode, this parameter is used to set the maximum analog torque command based on the maximum input voltage (10V). In Position (PT, PR) and Speed mode, this parameter is used to set the maximum analog torque limit based on the maximum input voltage (10V). For example, in torque mode, if P1-41 is set to 100 and the input voltage is 10V, it indicates that the torque command is 100% rated torque. If P1-41 is set to 100, but the input voltage is changed to 5V, then the torque command is changed to 50% rated torque. Torque Command / Limit = Input Voltage Value x Setting value of P1-41 / 10

6.4.5 Timing Chart of Torque Control Mode


T4 (P1-14) Internal speed command T3 (P1-13) T2 (P1-12) T1

External analog voltage or zero (0)

TCM0 External I/O signal TCM1 SON

OFF OFF ON

ON

OFF ON

ON

NOTE
1) OFF indicates normally open and ON indicates normally closed. 2) When torque control mode is Tz, the torque command T1=0; when torque control mode is T, the speed command T1 is external analog voltage input (Please refer to P1-01). 3) After Servo ON, the users can select command according to the state of TCM0~1.

6-48

Revision January 2011

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

6.5 Control Modes Selection


Except signal control mode operation, ASDA-A2 series servo drives also provide many dual and multiple modes for the users to select. 1 Speed / Position mode selection: PT-S, PR-S, PT-PR 2 Speed / Torque mode selection: S-T 3 Torque / Position mode selection: PT-T, PR-T 4 Position / Speed multiple mode selection: PT-PR-S 5 Position / Torque multiple mode selection: PT-PR-T

Mode

Name PT-S PT-T PR-S

Code 06 07 08 09 0A 0D 0E 0F

Description Either PT or S control mode can be selected via the Digital Inputs (DI) Either PT or T control mode can be selected via the Digital Inputs (DI) Either PR or S control mode can be selected via the Digital Inputs (DI) Either PR or T control mode can be selected via the Digital Inputs (DI) Either S or T control mode can be selected via the Digital Inputs (DI) Either PT or PR control mode can be selected via the Digital Inputs (DI). Either PT or PR or S control mode can be selected via the Digital Inputs (DI). Either PT or PR or T control mode can be selected via the Digital Inputs (DI).

Dual Mode PR-T S-T PT-PR PT-PR-S Multiple Mode PT-PR-T

Sz and Tz mode selection is not provided. In order to avoid using too much DI inputs, we recommend that the users can use external analog signal as input command in speed and torque mode to reduce the use of DI inputs (SPD0~1 or TCM0~1). In position mode, we recommend that the users can use PT mode to input pulse to reduce the use of DI inputs (POS0~5). Please refer to table 3.B and table 3.C in section 3.3.2 to see the default pin number of DI/DO signal.

Revision January 2011

6-49

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

6.5.1 Speed / Position Control Mode Selection


PT-S Mode / PR-S Mode: The command source of PT-S mode is from external input pulse. The command source of PR-S mode is from internal parameters (P6-00 to P7-27). The speed command can be the external analog voltage or internal parameters (P1-09 to P1-11). The speed and position mode switching is controlled by the S-P signal. The selection will be more complicated when the position of PR-S mode and speed command are both selected through DI signal. The timing chart of speed / position control mode selection is shown as the figure below:
CTRG

S-P POS0-2 NOT CARE SPD0-1 VALID Speed control mode POS0-2 VALID POS0-2 NOT CARE SPD0-1 VALID Speed control mode

SPD0~1 NOT CARE Position control mode

Figure 1. : Speed / Position Control Mode Selection

In speed mode (when S-P is ON), speed command is selected by SPD0~1 and CTRG is disabled at this time. When switching to the position mode (when S-P is OFF), the position command is not determined (it needs to wait that CTRG is on the rising edge), so the motor stop running. Once CTRG is on the rising edge, position command will be selected according to POS0~5 and the motor will immediately move to the determined position. After S-P is ON, it will immediately return to speed mode. For the relationship between DI signal and selected command in each mode, please refer to the introduction of single mode.

6-50

Revision January 2011

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

6.5.2 Speed / Torque Control Mode Selection


S-T Mode: The speed command can be the external analog voltage or internal parameters (P1-09 to P1-11) and SPD0~1 is used to select speed command. The same as speed command, the torque command can be the external analog voltage or internal parameters (P1-12 to P114) and TCM0~1 is used to select torque command. The speed and torque mode switching is controlled by the S-T signal. The timing chart of speed / torque control mode selection is shown as the figure below:
S-T NOT CARE TCM0-1 VALID Torque control mode NOT CARE TCM0-1 VALID Torque control mode

SPD0-1 VALID NOT CARE Speed control mode

Figure 2. : Speed / Torque Control Mode Selection

In torque mode (when S-T is ON), torque command is selected by TCM0~1. When switching to the speed mode (when S-T is OFF), the speed command is selected by SPD0~1, and then the motor will immediately rotate following the command. After S-T is ON again, it will immediately return to torque mode.

Revision January 2011

6-51

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

6.5.3 Torque / Position Control Mode Selection


PT-T Mode / PR-T Mode: The command source of PT-T mode is from external input pulse. The command source of PR-T mode is from internal parameters (P6-00 to P7-27). The torque command can be the external input pulse or internal parameters (P1-12 to P1-14). The torque and position mode switching is controlled by T-P signal. The selection will be more complicated when the position of PR-T mode and torque command are both selected through DI signal. The timing chart of speed / position control mode selection is shown as the figure below:

In torque mode (when T-P is ON), torque command is selected by TCM0~1 and CTRG is disabled at this time. When switching to the position mode (when T-P is OFF), the position command is not determined (it needs to wait that CTRG is on the rising edge), so the motor stop running. Once CTRG is on the rising edge, position command will be selected according to POS0~5 and the motor will immediately move to the determined position. After T-P is ON, it will immediately return to torque mode. For the relationship between DI signal and selected command in each mode, please refer to the introduction of single mode.

6-52

Revision January 2011

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

6.6 Others 6.6.1 Speed Limit


The max. servo motor speed can be limited by using parameter P1-55 no matter in position, speed or torque control mode. The command source of speed limit command is the same as speed command. It can be the external analog voltage but also can be internal parameters (P1-09 to P1-11). For more information of speed command source, please refer to chapter 6.3.1. The speed limit only can be used in torque mode (T mode) to limit the servo motor speed. When the torque command is the external analog voltage, there should be surplus DI signal that can be treated as SPD0~1 and be used to select speed limit command (internal parameter). If there is not enough DI signal, the external voltage input can be used as speed limit command. When the Disable / Enable Speed Limit Function Settings in parameter P1-02 is set to 1, the speed limit function is activated. The timing chart of speed limit is shown as the figure below:
Disable / Enable Speed Limit Function Settings in parameter P1-02 is set to 0 SPD0~1 INVALID Disable / Enable Speed Limit Function Settings in parameter P1-02 is set to 1

SPD0~1 VALID

Command Source Selection of Speed Limit

6.6.2 Torque Limit


The command source of torque limit command is the same as torque command. It can be the external analog voltage but also can be internal parameters (P1-12 to P1-14). For more information of torque command source, please refer to chapter 6.4.1. The torque limit only can be used in position mode (PT and PR mode) and speed mode (S mode) to limit the output torque of servo motor. When the position command is the external pulse and speed command is the external analog voltage, there should be surplus DI signal that can be treated as TCM0~1 used to select torque limit command (internal parameter). If there is not enough DI signal, the external voltage input can be used as torque limit command. When the Disable / Enable Torque Limit Function Settings in parameter P1-02 is set to 1, the torque limit function is activated. The timing chart of torque limit is shown as the figure below:
Disable / Enable Torque Limit Function Settings in parameter P1-02 is set to 0 TCM0~1 INVALID Disable / Enable Torque Limit Function Settings in parameter P1-02 is set to 1

TCM0~1 VALID

Command Source Selection of Torque Limit

Revision January 2011

6-53

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

6.6.3 Analog Monitor


Users can use analog monitor to observe the required analog voltage signals. ASDA-A2 series servo drives provide two analog channels, they are PIN No. 15 and 16 of CN1 connector. The parameters relative to analog monitor are shown below. Relevant parameters: P0 - 03 MON Analog Monitor Output Address: 0006H, 0007H Related Section: Section 4.3.5

Default: 01 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 00 ~ 77 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings:

This parameter determines the functions of the analog monitor outputs.

XY: (X: CH1; Y: CH2) 0: Motor speed (+/-8V / maximum motor speed) 1: Motor torque (+/-8V / maximum torque) 2: Pulse command frequency (+8Volts / 4.5Mpps) 3: Speed command (+/-8Volts / maximum speed command) 4: Torque command (+/-8Volts / maximum torque command) 5: V_BUS voltage (+/-8Volts / 450V) 6: Reserved 7: Reserved Please note: For the setting of analog output voltage proportion, refer to the P1-04 and P1-05. Example: P0-03 = 01(CH1 is speed analog output) Motor speed = (Max. motor speed V1/8) P1-04/100, when the output voltage value of CH1 is V1.

6-54

Revision January 2011

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

P1 - 03

AOUT

Pulse Output Polarity Setting

Address: 0106H, 0107H Related Section: Section 3.3.3

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 13 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings:

A B not used

This parameter is used to determine the polarity of analog monitor outputs and position pulse outputs. The analog monitor outputs can be configured with different polarity individually, but the position pulse outputs have to be each with the same polarity. A: Analog monitor outputs polarity 0: MON1(+), MON2(+) 1: MON1(+), MON2(-) 2: MON1(-), MON2(+) 3: MON1(-), MON2(-) B: Position pulse outputs polarity 0: Forward output 1: Reverse output

P1 - 04

MON1

Analog Monitor Output Proportion 1 (CH1)

Address: 0108H, 0109H Related Section: Section 6.4.4

Default: 100 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: % (full scale) Range: 0 ~ 100 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

Revision January 2011

6-55

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

P1 - 05

MON2

Analog Monitor Output Proportion 2 (CH2)

Address: 010AH, 010BH Related Section: Section 6.4.4

Default: 100 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: % (full scale) Range: 0 ~ 100 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

P4 - 20

DOF1

Analog Monitor Output Drift Adjustment (CH1)

Address: 0428H, 0429H Related Section: Section 6.4.4

Default: Factory setting Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: mV Range: -800 ~ 800 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

Please note that when P2-08 is set to 10, the users cannot reset this parameter. Analog Monitor Output Drift Adjustment (CH2)

P4 - 21

DOF2

Address: 042AH, 042BH Related Section: Section 6.4.4

Default: Factory setting Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: mV Range: -800 ~ 800 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

Please note that when P2-08 is set to 10, the users cannot reset this parameter.

For example, when the users want to observe the analog voltage signal of channel 1, if the monitor output setting range is 8V per 325Kpps, then it is needed to change the setting value of parameter P1-04 (Analog Monitor Output Proportion 1) to 50 (=325Kpps/Max. input frequency). Other related parameters setting include parameter P003 (A=3) and P1-03 (A=0~3, output polarity setting). In general, when output voltage value of Ch1 is V1, the pulse command frequency is equal to (Max. input frequency V1/8) P1-04/100.

6-56

Revision January 2011

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

Because there is an offset value of analog monitor output voltage, the zero voltage level of analog monitor output does not match to the zero point of setting value. We recommend the users can use Analog Monitor Output Drift Adjustment, DOF1 (parameter P4-20) and DOF2 (parameter P4-21) to improve this condition. The maximum output voltage range of analog monitor output is 8V. If the output voltage exceed its limit, it is still limited within the range of 8V. The revolution provided by ASDA-A2 series servo drives is 10bit, approximated to 13mv/LSB.
8V DOF

-8V

6.6.4 Electromagnetic Brake


When the servo drive is operating, if the digital output BRKR is set to Off, it indicates the electromagnetic brake is disabled and motor is stop running and locked. If the digital output BRKR is set to ON, it indicates electromagnetic brake is enabled and motor can run freely. There are two parameters that affect the electromagnetic brake. One is parameter P1-42 (MBT1) and the other is parameter P1-43 (MBT2). The users can use these two parameters to set the On and Off delay time of electromagnetic brake. The electromagnetic brake is usually used in perpendicular axis (Z-axis) direction to reduce the large energy generated from servo motor. Using electromagnetic brake can avoid the load may slip since there is no motor holding torque when power is off. Without using electromagnetic brake may reduce the life of servo motor. To avoid malfunction, the electromagnetic brake should be activated after servo system is off (Servo Off). If the users desire to control electromagnetic brake via external controller, not by the servo drive, the users must execute the function of electromagnetic brake during the period of time when servo motor is braking. The braking strength of motor and electromagnetic brake must be in the same direction when servo motor is braking. Then, the servo drive will operate normally. However, the servo drive may generate larger current during acceleration or at constant speed and it may the cause of overload (servo fault).

Revision January 2011

6-57

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

Timing chart for using servo motor with electromagnetic brake:


ON SON (DI Input) BRKR (DO Output) OFF ON OFF OFF OFF

MBT1(P1-42)

MBT2(P1-43) ZSPD(P1-38)

Motor Speed

BRKR output timing explanation: 1. When Servo Off (when DI SON is not activated), the BRKR output goes Off (electromagnetic brake is locked) after the delay time set by P1-43 is reached and the motor speed is still higher than the setting value of P1-38. 2. When Servo Off (when DI SON is not activated), the BRKR output goes Off (electromagnetic brake is locked) if the delay time set by P1-43 is not reached and the motor speed is still lower than the setting value of P1-38. Electromagnetic Brake Wiring Diagram

NOTE
1) 2) Please refer to Chapter 3 Connections and Wiring for more wiring information. The BRKR signal is used to control the brake operation. The VDD DC24V power supply of the servo drive can be used to power the relay coil (Relay). When BRKR signal is ON, the motor brake will be activated. 3) 4) Please note that the coil of brake has no polarity. The power supply for brake is DC24V. Never use it for VDD, the +24V source voltage.

6-58

Revision January 2011

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

The timing charts of control circuit power and main circuit power:
L1, L2 Control Circuit Power 5V Control Circuit Power > 0msec R, S, T Main Circuit Power BUS Voltage READY 2 sec SERVO READY SERVO ON (DI Input) SERVO ON (DO Output) Position \ Speed \ Torque Command Input Input available

1 sec

800ms

1 msec (min)+ Response Filter Time of Digital Input ( P2-09)

Revision January 2011

6-59

Chapter 6 Control Modes of Operation

This page intentionally left blank.

6-60

Revision January 2011

Chapter 7 Motion Control Functions

7.1 Motion Control Functions


ASDA-A2 series provides the following motion control functions: 1) Innovative PR mode 2) Capture (Position Latch) / Compare (Position Detection) functions 3) Electronic Cam (E-Cam) function (ASDA-A2 series L type models does not provide this function.)

7.2 System Information


The system information of the servo drive includes: 1. System Parameters; 2. Monitor Parameters; 3. Data Array Please refer to the following table below. System Parameters Applied to function settings or commands, for example, position/speed/torque control modes, position/speed loop gain and other settings. LED Display: display PX-XX on the display for example P1-01. Press the SET key to display the setting value of parameters. For the operation of the digital keypad, please refer to Chapter 4. There are 16-bit and 32-bit parameters which can be read/written via several ways. 16-bit or 32-bit (depends on the settings of parameters) Monitor Parameters For monitoring status of servo operating, for example, speed, position, torque and other settings. Set P0-02 directly to enter into monitor mode and specify the monitor status. The monitor status depends on the setting value of P0-02. Press MODE key on the keypad is to enter into monitor mode directly. For the operation of the digital keypad, please refer to Chapter 4. Read only 32-bit integer
Monitoring is accomplished through

Usage

Display Method

Access Method Data Length

USB (upon PC software) Communication Support MODBUS/CANopen/USB Read & Write, each parameter occupies two MODBUS addresses.
Do not support MODBUS/CANopen

Read & Write directly unless users use mapping function to monitor the specified monitor parameters via the corresponding system parameters. P0-09 ~ P0-13, total 5 parameters (Determined by P0-17 ~ P0-21)

Mapping Parameters

P0-25 ~ P0-32, total 8 parameters (Determined by P0-35 ~ P0-42)

Revision January 2011

7-1

Chapter 7 Motion Control Functions

System Parameters

Monitor Parameters In monitor mode, users can press UP or DOWN arrow key to change the monitoring variables (monitor item settings) in common use (code 0 ~ 26). Please note that not all monitoring variables can be displayed (total 150 kinds of monitor parameters).

Remark

7.2.1 Monitoring Variables


Please refer to the following table for the explanation of monitoring variables: Item Code Format Explanation Each monitoring variable has one corresponding code. Using the parameter P0-02 is able to set this code and perform status monitoring. Each monitoring variable is saved in 32-bit (long integer) in the servo drive. There are two types of monitoring variables, basic monitoring variables and extension monitoring variables: 1. Basic monitoring variables: Enter into the monitor mode by pressing MODE key on the digital keypad. In monitor mode, press UP/DOWN arrow keys to find the available basic monitoring variables (P0-02=0~26). 2. Extension monitoring variables: Other monitoring variables are called extension monitoring variables except basic monitoring variables (P002=27~127). There are two methods for status monitoring. One is through LED display of the digital keypad and the other is via the mapping parameters: 1. LED display of digital keypad: Status monitoring through the LED display of the digital keypad directly. 2. Mapping parameters: The settings of the monitoring variables will be reflected on the setting value of the mapping parameters. Users can know the settings of the monitoring variables through the corresponding parameters. 1. Display Press MODE key to switch the monitor mode and then press UP/DOWN arrow keys to select the desired monitoring variables. 2. Set P0-02 directly and then display the settings of the desired monitoring variables. Press SHIFT key to switch high/low byte display; Press SET key to switch decimal/hexadecimal display. 1. The parameters which support mapping function includes: P0-09 ~ P0-13. (Please refer to section 8.3 Detailed Parameter Listings of Chapter 8. 2. Using mapping parameters and read & write monitor parameters through communication. 3. The setting values of P0-09 ~ P0-13 (Status Monitor 1 ~ 5) are the content of basic monitoring variables (17h,18h,19h,1Ah). When users want to monitor P0-09, set P0-17 first to read the status value (see P0-02). When reading the drive status through Modbus communication, the system will read the monitor status which specified by P0-17. When reading the drive status through the keypad, if P0-02 is set to 23, VAR-1 will quickly show for about two seconds and then the value of P0-09 will display on the display.

Type

Monitor Method

Mapping Function

7-2

Revision January 2011

Chapter 7 Motion Control Functions

Attribute of monitoring variables: Attribute B Dn Dec Hex Explanation Basic monitoring variable. Pressing UP/DOWN keys can change the status shown on LED display. Decimal place display. D1 indicates one decimal place, D2 indicates two decimal places. Decimal display only. When pressing SET key on the keypad, the system can not switch to hexadecimal display. Hexadecimal display only. When pressing SET key on the keypad, the system can not switch to decimal display.

Explanation of monitoring variables: Code 000 (00h) Monitoring Variables / Attribute Feedback position (PUU) B Explanation Motor feedback current position. Unit is user unit, PUU. Position command current position. Unit is user unit, PUU. PT mode: it indicates the pulse command received by the servo drive. PR mode: it indicates the absolute position command. It is equal to the pulse number sent by the host (external) controller. Position error counts between position command pulse and feedback pulse. Unit is user unit, PUU. Motor feedback current position. Unit is encoder unit, pulse. Position command current position. Unit is encoder unit, pulse. It is also the position command after electronic gear ratio is set. Position error counts between position command pulse and feedback pulse. Unit is encoder unit, pulse. Input frequency of pulse command received by the servo drive. Unit is Kpps. Applicable for PT and PR mode. Actual motor speed. Unit is 0.1r/min. The low-pass filter function is used so the value is more stable. Analog speed input command. Unit is 0.01Volt. Integrated speed input command. Unit is 1r/min. The command source may be from analog command / internal parameter / position loop.

001 (01h)

Position command (PUU) B

002 (02h) 003 (03h) 004 (04h) 005 (05h) 006 (06h) 007 (07h) 008 (08h) 009 (09h)

Position error (PUU) B Feedback position (pulse) B Position command (pulse) B Position error (pulse) B Input frequency of pulse command B Feedback speed B D1 Dec Speed input command (Analog) B D2 Dec Speed command (Integrated) B

Revision January 2011

7-3

Chapter 7 Motion Control Functions

Code 010 (0Ah) 011 (0Bh) 012 (0Ch) 013 (0Dh) 014 (0Eh) 015 (0Fh) 016 (10h)

Monitoring Variables / Attribute Torque command (Analog) B D2 Dec Torque command (Integrated) B Average load B Peak load B DC Bus voltage B Ratio of load inertia to motor inertia B D1 Dec IGBT temperature B

Explanation

Analog torque input command. Unit is 0.01Volt. Integrated torque input command. Unit is Percent (%). The command source may be from analog command / internal parameter / position loop. Average load output by the servo drive. Unit is Percent (%). Peak load output by the servo drive. Unit is Percent (%) Main circuit voltage after rectification. Unit is Volt.

Ratio of load inertia to motor inertia. Unit is 0.1times.

IGBT temperature. Unit is C. Resonance frequency of the mechanical system. There are two groups of resonance frequency: F1 and F2 When reading the drive status through the keypad, pressing SHIFT key can switch the display of F1 and F2. F2: no decimal point; F1: display one decimal point When reading the drive status through the communication, Low 16-bit (Low Byte) will display frequency F2 High 16-bit (High Byte) will display frequency F1 Absolute pulse number relative to encoder (use Z phase as home). The value of Z phase home point is 0, and it can be the value from -5000 to +5000 pulses. When the value is higher, the deviation pulse number is higher too. Display the content of parameter P0-25 (mapping target is specified by parameter P0-35). Display the content of parameter P0-26 (mapping target is specified by parameter P0-36). Display the content of parameter P0-27 (mapping target is specified by parameter P0-37). Display the content of parameter P0-28 (mapping target is specified by parameter P0-38). Display the content of parameter P0-09 (the monitor status is specified by parameter P0-17). Display the content of parameter P0-10 (the monitor status is specified by parameter P0-18). Display the content of parameter P0-11 (the monitor status is specified by parameter P0-19).

017 (11h)

Resonance frequency B Dec

018 (12h) 019 (13h) 020 (14h) 021 (15h) 022 (16h) 023 (17h) 024 (18h) 025 (19h)

Absolute pulse number relative to encoder (use Z phase as home) B Dec Mapping parameter #1 B Mapping parameter #2 B Mapping parameter #3 B Mapping parameter #4 B Status monitor #1 B Status monitor #2 B Status monitor #3 B

7-4

Revision January 2011

Chapter 7 Motion Control Functions

Code 026 (1Ah)

Monitoring Variables / Attribute Status monitor #4 B

Explanation Display the content of parameter P0-12 (the monitor status is specified by parameter P0-20). Integrated DI status. Each bit corresponds to one channel of digital input. The command source may be from DI signal or communication control (upon software). P3-06 can determine how digital inputs accept commands. Actual DO output status. Each bit corresponds to one channel of digital output. The drive status will display via P0-46. Please refer to P046 for explanation. The latest captured data by using Capture function. Note: Using Capture function is able to capture many positions. Pulse counts input by auxiliary encoder (CN5). Pulse counts input by pulse command (CN1). Integrated speed input command. Unit is 0.1r/min. The command source may be from analog command / internal parameter / position loop. Actual motor speed. Unit is 0.1r/min.

039 (27h)

DI status (Integrated) Hex DO status (Hardware) Hex Drive Status

040 (28h) 041 (29h) 043 (2Bh) 048 (30h) 049 (31h) 050 (32h) 051 (33h) 052 (34h) 053 (35h) 054 (36h) 055 (37h) 056 (38h) 059 (3Bh)

Capture data

Auxiliary encoder CNT Pulse command CNT Speed command (Integrated) D1 Dec Feedback speed (Instant) D1 Dec Feedback speed (Filter) D1 Dec Torque command (Integrated) D1 Dec Feedback Torque D1 Dec Feedback current D2 Dec DC Bus voltage D1 Dec Pulse number of E-Cam master axis (Accumulated) Pulse number of E-Cam master axis (Incremental)

Actual motor speed. Unit is 0.1r/min. (The low-pass filter function is used.) Integrated torque command. Unit is 0.1Percent (%). The command source may be from analog command / internal parameter / speed loop. Actual motor torque. Unit is 0.1Percent (%). Actual motor current. Unit is 0.01ampere (Amp). Main circuit voltage after rectification. Unit is 0.1Volt. The accumulated pulse numbers of master axis of electronic cam. Please refer to P5-86. (ASDA-A2 series L type models does not provide this function.) The incremental pulse numbers of master axis of electronic cam every 1msec. (ASDA-A2 series L type models does not provide this function.)

060 (3Ch)

Revision January 2011

7-5

Chapter 7 Motion Control Functions

Code

Monitoring Variables / Attribute

Explanation Lead pulse number of E-Cam master axis which is used to decide the engage condition. 1. Before the electronic gear engaged: Lead pulse number is determined by P5-87 or P5-92. The electronic cam engaged when the setting value is 0. 2. After the electronic gear engaged: Lead pulse number is determined by P5-89. The electronic cam disengaged when the setting value is 0. (ASDA-A2 series L type models does not provide this function.) The position of E-Cam axis. The input of E-Cam curve. Unit: It is the same as the pulse number of master axis. After receiving the pulse number P of master axis, E-Cam axis will operate M cycles. It indicates that there are M cycles of the E-Cam curve (P5-83=M, P5-84=P). (ASDA-A2 series L type models does not provide this function.) The position of slave axis of E-Cam. The output of E-Cam curve. Unit: It is the data unit of E-Cam curve. (ASDA-A2 series L type models does not provide this function.) In PR mode, it is the end of the position command (Cmd_E). In PR mode, it is the accumulated outputs of position command. It is target speed of PR path command. Unit is PPS (Pulse Per Second). Input data of S-curve filter which is used to create the effect of S-curve filter. In PR mode, it is valid for both ECam and internal speed command. (ASDA-A2 series L type models does not provide this function.) Output data of S-curve filter which is used to create the effect of S-curve filter. In PR mode, it is valid for both ECam and internal speed command. (ASDA-A2 series L type models does not provide this function.) In PR mode, it is the terraced speed curve drawn up according to target speed / accel & decel time / position move (before using S-curve filter). Unit is PPS (Pulse Per Second). When Synchronous Capture Axis is enabled, it is the received pulses between two capture operation and it can be used to measure the actual mark distance.

061 (3Dh)

Pulse number of E-Cam master axis (Lead Pulse Number)

062 (3Eh)

Position of E-Cam axis

063 (3Fh)

Position of E-Cam slave axis

064 (40h) 065 (41h) 067 (43h)

End register of PR command. Output register of PR command. Target speed of PR command.

068 (44h)

S-curve filter (Input)

069 (45h)

S-curve filter (Output)

076 (4Ch) 081 (51h)

Speed command of PR mode Synchronous Capture Axis Pulse input increment

7-6

Revision January 2011

Chapter 7 Motion Control Functions

Code 084 (54h)

Monitoring Variables / Attribute Synchronous Capture Axis Synchronous error pulse number

Explanation When Synchronous Capture Axis is enabled, it is the accumulated errors between actual output pulse and target pulse. After the synchronization operation is completed, this value will be near to zero (0). Includes 2 versions: DSP and CPLD When reading the firmware version through the keypad, pressing SHIFT key can switch the version display of DSP and CPLD. DSP: no decimal place; CPLD: it will display one decimal place. When reading the firmware version through the communication (using mapping parameters): Low 16-bit (Low Word) will display DSP firmware version. High 16-bit (High Word) will display CPLD firmware version. It is regarded as the refresh time of digital inputs and outputs. Unit is 0.5msec. Display the capacity of data array. Unit is DWORD (32bit). Display servo fault code. But it only displays the servo drive fault code. The fault code for motion control will not be displayed. Display the time when the servo drive receives synchronous signal (TimeStamp). Unit is usec. Display the time when the servo drive receives synchronous signal and low-pass filter is used. Unit is usec. When CANopen communication is enabled, display the timing correction value which is synchronized with the host (external) controller. Unit is usec. When reading the monitor value through the keypad, it is used to read the monitor value displayed on the keypad.

096 (60h)

Firmware version of servo drive Dec

098 (62h) 109 (6Dh) 111 (6Fh) 112 (70h)

PLC scan time

Data array capacity Servo fault code CANopen synchronous time (Low-pass filter is not used) CANopen synchronous time (Low-pass filter is used) CANopen synchronous timing correction

113 (71h)

114 (72h)

123 (7Bh)

Keypad monitor value

Revision January 2011

7-7

Chapter 7 Motion Control Functions

7.2.2 Data Array


ASDA-A2 series provides many motion control functions, such as E-Cam (ASDA-A2 series L type models does not provide this function.), Capture function, and Compare function. The data array can keep data for E-Cam, Capture function, and Compare function with maximum to 800 records (all together to max. 800 records). Please refer to the following table for the introduction of data array. Data Array Save Capture data. Save Compare data. Save E-Cam curve. Note: 1. The data array is user-defined and the system will not partition off the data array for Capture, Compare and E-Cam function respectively. Therefore, the memory blocks of the data array may be overlapped. Please pay close attention when defining the data array. 2. ASDA-A2 series L type models does not provide this function.

Usage

Array Size

32-bit integer x 800 records (the data address when reading and writing data array is determined by P5-10). Each data should have a corresponding address. This address should be specified when reading and writing data array. The address is within the range of 0 ~ 799. Set P2-08 to 30 first and set to 35 next. Then, the content of the data array will be saved in EEPROM when power is off. Please save data when Servo Off. After re-power the servo drive, the content of the data array will be written automatically. Perform read and write operation through P5-10 ~ P5-13.

Backup Data Into EEPROM

Read/Write Window

The content of the data array can not be read and written via external commands. It only can be read and written through the settings of P5-10 ~ P5-13. Please refer to the following table for explanation: Relevant Parameters for Data Array Parameter P5-10 P5-11 Name Data Amount (N x 32 bits) Read / Write Address Explanation This parameter is used to set the data amount of data array (N x 32 bits). N is the capacity of the data array (Read only). This parameter is used to set the data address when reading and writing data array.

7-8

Revision January 2011

Chapter 7 Motion Control Functions

Relevant Parameters for Data Array Parameter Name Explanation Panel Read: P5-11 unchanged Panel Write: P5-11=P5-11+1 When reading data through the panel (keypad): Read the content specified by P5-11. After read operation is completed, the address of P5-11 will not change. When writing data through the panel (keypad): Write the content specified by P5-11. After write operation is completed, the address of P5-11 will increase 1 automatically. Communication Read: P5-11=P5-11+1 Communication Write: P5-11=P5-11+1 When reading data through the communication: Read the content specified by P5-11. After read operation is completed, the address of P5-11 will increase 1 automatically. When writing data through the communication: Write the content specified by P5-11. After write operation is completed, the address of P5-11 will increase 1 automatically. Panel Read: P5-11=P5-11+1 Panel Write: Inhibition When reading data through the panel (keypad): Read the content specified by P5-11. After read operation is completed, the address of P5-11 will increase 1 automatically. When writing data through the panel (keypad): This parameter can not be written through the keypad. P5-13 Read / Write Window #2 Communication Read: P5-11=P5-11+1 Communication Write: P5-11=P5-11+1 When reading data through the communication: Read the content specified by P5-11. After read operation is completed, the address of P5-11 will increase 1 automatically. When writing data through the communication: Write the content specified by P5-11. After write operation is completed, the address of P5-11 will increase 1 automatically.

P5-12

Read / Write Window #1

Access to Data Array There is one index working along with two read/write windows for accessing data array. For some hosts resending data several times while communication, it had better to put the index P5-11 every time before read/write. In brief, users need to set the desired read & write address by using P5-11 and then read and write the data through P5-12 or P5-13. For example, suppose that users want to write three consecutive numbers of data (100th, 200th, 300th), and save them into the address 11, 12, 13 of data array, the operation steps are described as follows:

Revision January 2011

7-9

Chapter 7 Motion Control Functions

1. When writing data through the keypad: Use P5-12 because P5-13 does not provide this function. 1) Set first address: Set P5-11=11 (the first address) 2) Write data: Set P5-12=100. (This is the first written data, 100th data and it will be saved in address 11, i.e. P5-11. After write operation is completed, the address of P5-11 will increase 1 automatically, i.e. address 12.) Set P5-12=200 (This is the secondary written data, 200th data and it will be saved in address 12, i.e. P5-11. After write operation is completed, the address of P5-11 will increase 1 automatically, i.e. address 13.) Set P5-12=300 (This is the third written data, 300th data and it will be saved in address 13, i.e. P5-11. After write operation is completed, the address of P5-11 will increase 1 automatically, i.e. address 14.) Then, users can read the address 11, 12, and 13 and check the written values. 2. When reading data through the keypad: Use P5-13 to read consecutive data. 1) Set first address: Set P5-11=11 (the first address) 2) Read data: When display shows P5-13: Press SET key at the first time, the display will show the 100th data saved in address 11. Pressing MODE key can exit P5-13. Press SET key at the second time, the display will show the 200th data saved in address 12. Pressing MODE key can exit P5-13. Press SET key at the first time, the display will show the 300th data saved in address 13. Pressing MODE key can exit P5-13. Please note that when use P5-13 to read data every time, the address of P5-11 will increase 1 automatically so using P5-13 can read the consecutive data. However, if users use P5-12 to read the data, the address of P5-11 will remain the same, so using P5-12 can not read the consecutive data.

7-10

Revision January 2011

Chapter 7 Motion Control Functions

The operation steps for reading or writing data through the communication are similar to the steps when using keypad. The functions of P5-12 and P5-13 are also the same. For example, suppose that users want to write 6 consecutive data (100th, 200th, 300th, 400th, 500th, 600th data) through Modbus communication continuously, set the communication command by referring to the table below. Communication command: write data intro data array No. Command Starting Data Address P5-11 P5-11 P5-11 Data Amount 6 (Word) 6 (Word) 6 (Word) P5-11 Low Word 11 13 15 High Word 0 0 0 P5-12 Low Word 100 300 500 High Word 0 0 0 P5-13 Low Word 200 400 600 High Word 0 0 0

1 2 3

0x10 0x10 0x10

First Address Third Address Fifth Address

First Data Third Data Fifth Data

Second Data Fourth Data Sixth Data

Please check if the above written data is correct when reading the data of data array. Users can use Modbus communication command 0x06(write one data) to set P5-11 and write the desired read data. For the settings of the communication command, please refer to the table below. Communication command: read data from data array No. 4 Command 0x06 Starting Data Address P5-11 Written Data 11

Then, read the data of the specified address by using communication command 0x03. Please refer to the table below to set communication command. Communication command: Read data array No. Command Starting Data Address P5-11 Data Amount P5-11 Low Word 11 5 0x03 6 (Word) High Word 0 Response Data P5-12 Low Word 100 High Word 0 P5-13 Low Word 200 High Word 0

Read Address 13 0

Data of address 11 300 0 Data of address 13 500 0 Data of address 15

Data of address 12 400 0 Data of address 14 600 0 Data of address 16

0x03

P5-11

6 (Word)

Read Address 15 0

0x03

P5-11

6 (Word)

Read Address

Revision January 2011

7-11

Chapter 7 Motion Control Functions

7.3 Motion Axes


Motion axis is a counter within the servo drive which is used to count the data of absolute position (32-bit integer). The available motion axes are introduced in the following table. Axis Name 1. Motor Encoder Axis (P5-16) 2. Auxiliary Encoder Axis (P5-17) 3. Pulse Command Axis (P5-18) Description It indicates the motor absolute feedback position and the user unit is PUU. It is the pulse counts of the auxiliary encoder (linear scale) input by CN5. The pulse type is AB phase pulse only. It is the pulse counts of the host (external) controller input from CN1. The pulse type can be defined by P1-00. It is the motion axis which is used to enable Capture function. The command source could be from motor encoder axis, auxiliary encoder axis and pulse command axis. Position offset exists between output axis and physical axis. After the first point is captured, the axis position can be defined again. It is the motion axis which is used to enable Compare function. The command source could be from motor encoder axis, auxiliary encoder axis, pulse command axis and Capture axis. Position offset exists between output axis and physical axis. It is the master axis of electronic cam. The command source could be from auxiliary encoder axis, pulse command axis, Capture axis and PR command axis. Position offset exists between output axis and physical axis. (ASDA-A2 series L type models does not provide this function.) Command position defined by PR. Internal timer. The value will increase 1 every 1msec. The function is similar to Capture axis (P5-37). But, it will correct the offset value of this synchronous axis (P5-78) when capture operation is activated every two times. (This function is available only in firmware version V1.009 and later models). Read (R) / Write (W) R R/W Attribute Physical Axis Physical Axis Physical Axis

R/W

4. Capture Axis (P5-37)

R/W

Output Axis

5. Compare Axis (P5-57)

R/W

Output Axis

6. E-Cam Master Axis (P5-86)

R/W

Output Axis

7. PR Command Axis 8. Internal Time Axis 9. Synchronous Capture Axis (P5-77) Please note:

R R

Virtual Axis Virtual Axis

R/W

Virtual Axis

1. Physical axis: Position value is obtained from the actual terminal signal counts. 2. Output axis: It is the axis output by the physical axis. The value will not be the same as the source of physical axis, but the increasing value will be the same as the increasing value of physical axis.

7-12

Revision January 2011

Chapter 7 Motion Control Functions

3. Virtual axis: It is the axis generated by the servo firmware, e.g. PR command axis. It is unable to command in real time so it could not be regarded as the command axis for Capture and Compare function. But it could be regarded as the command source of the master axis of electronic cam.

7.4 PR Mode
PR mode could be composed of one position command or multiple position commands, and triggered by DI signal, CTRG. DI signals, POS0 ~ POS5 are used to specify the desired trigger position. In PR mode, electronic cam (E-Cam) is provided. Users can enable electronic cam function by PRs (Position Registers). After the electronic cam is disengaged, the system can command the motor to return to the specified position as well. The PR cannot be interpreted as Point to Point control. It does beyond that. The servo is capable to change its working profile under PR mode instantaneously. There are 64 PRs available.

7.5 Comparison
Old PR mode Position settings Command Type 8 position settings Position command PR Mode of ASDA-A2 64 position registers (64PRs) Homing mode, constant speed mode, position control mode, jump mode, write parameter mode are available.

Parameters for Position Commands

Either Absolute command or Incremental command Accel / Decel time x 1 Motion speed x8 Delay time x8

Absolute command / Incremental command can be set individually. Accel / Decel time x 16 Motion speed x 16 Delay time x 16

Command Trigger Timing

It is enabled when DO signal, ZSPD is On.

It can be enabled at any time. Users can specify the command connection method (sequential command / insertion command / overlap command).

Trigger Method

DI signals: CTRG + POSn (n: number)

DI signals: CTRG + POSn (n: number) Event trigger function: DI signals EV1 ~ 4 + CAP_OK P5-07 (Trigger Position Command)

Position Command Profile Format

Accel / Decel S-curve (When S-curve function (P1-36) is disabled, the acceleration and deceleration function are also disable.)

Accel / Decel S-curve (When S-curve function (P1-36) is disabled, the acceleration and deceleration function can be enabled still.)

Rotation or Pulse

32-bit data (user unit)

Revision January 2011

7-13

Chapter 7 Motion Control Functions

Old PR mode

PR Mode of ASDA-A2


Homing Function Execute homing function automatically when power is applied to the servo drive (Servo On at the first time) DI signal, SHOM

Software Limit Function

Execute homing function automatically when power is applied to the servo drive (Servo On at the first time) DI signal, SHOM When PR path is set to 0, it is homing mode. Users also can use DI signal, CTRG to trigger PR path 0. After homing operation is completed, it can execute the specified PR path.

This function is not provided.

This function is provided.

7.6 Pulse of User Unit


The position command unit of PR mode is presented by PUU (Pulse of User Unit). It also indicates the ratio of position command unit of host (external) controller to internal position command unit of servo drive, i.e. electronic gear ratio of servo drive. The PUU is a unit which is scaled by the electronic gear. This will bring out an advantage, and that is YOU SEE WHAT YOU COMMAND. For example, if you send 10000 PUU for command and you can read from the feedback 10000 PUU and ignore the electronic gear ratio. 1 Position command unit of servo drive (pulse): encoder unit, 1280000pulses per revolution (pulse/rev). 2 User unit (PUU): unit of host (external) controller. If the pulse number per revolution is P pulses (PUU/rev), then the electronic gear ratio should be set to: GEAR_NUM(P1-44) / GEAR_DEN(P1-45) = 1280000 / P

7.7 Position Registers


1 The unit of position register of PR mode: They are indicates as user unit, PUU. 2 Cmd_E (Monitoring Variable 064): The target position of command. 3 Cmd_O (Monitoring Variable 001): The intermediate command 4 Fb_PUU (Monitoring Variable 000): The current (feedback) position of motor. 5 Err_PUU (Monitoring Variable 002): The position error = (Cmd_O Fb_PUU). 6 In PR mode, at any time (no matter during operation or at stop): Err_PUU = Cmd_O - Fb_PUU.

7-14

Revision January 2011

Chapter 7 Motion Control Functions

Position Commands and Position Registers: Five different types of position commands: Absolute, Incremental, Stop, Homing and Speed commands. Type After position command accepted Cmd_E = command data (absolute) Cmd_O: unchanged DO signal: CMD_OK is OFF Cmd_E+= command data (incremental) Cmd_O: unchanged DO signal: CMD_OK is OFF Cmd_E: unchanged Cmd_O continuously output DO: CMD_OK output unchanged Cmd_E: unchanged Homing command Cmd_O: unchanged DO signal: CMD_OK is OFF DO signal: HOME is OFF Cmd_E continuously output Speed command Cmd_O continuously output. After speed command is completed, it indicates that the speed reaches the setting value and the motor will not stop. DO signal: CMD_OK is OFF Enter PR at the first time ( Servo Off-> Servo On or other mode for entering PR mode) Cmd_O = Cmd_E = current motor feedback position When position command being executed Cmd_E: unchanged Cmd_O continuously output ... Cmd_E: unchanged Cmd_O continuously output ... When position command is completed Cmd_E: unchanged Cmd_O = Cmd_E DO signal: CMD_OK is ON Cmd_E: unchanged Cmd_O = Cmd_E DO signal: CMD_OK is ON Cmd_E: unchanged Cmd_O = position at stop DO signal: CMD_OK is ON Cmd_E = Z pulse (absolute position) Cmd_O = position at stop DO signal: CMD_OK is ON DO signal: HOME is ON

Absolute position command

Incremental position command

Stop command DI signal, STP

Cmd_E: unchanged Cmd_O stop in accordance with deceleration curve

Cmd_E continuously output Cmd_O continuously output ... ...

Note: The incremental position command performs accumulation according to the end of the position command (Cmd_E). It is irrelevant to current motor position and command timing as well.

Revision January 2011

7-15

Chapter 7 Motion Control Functions

7.8 Homing Function


The homing function determines the homing characteristics of servo motors. The purpose of homing function is used to connect the position of Z pulse of motor encoder to the internal coordinate of the servo drive. The coordinate value corresponds to Z pulse can be specified. After homing operation is completed, the stop position will not locate at the position of Z pulse. This is because the motor must accelerate to stop when Z pulse is found. Generally, the motor stop position will be a little ahead of the position of Z pulse. At this time, Z pulse is set correctly so it will not affect the position precision. For example: If the coordinate corresponds to Z pulse is set to 100, after homing operation is completed, Cmd=300. It indicates that the acceleration distance is equal to 300-100=200(PUU). Since Cmd_E=100 (absolute position of Z pulse), if users want to command the motor to return to the position of Z pulse, just set absolute position command to 100 or incremental position command to 0. In PR mode of ASDA-A2 series, after homing operation, it can execute the specified path and command the motor to return to the position of Z pulse automatically. When homing function is executed, the software limit function is disabled.

7-16

Revision January 2011

Chapter 7 Motion Control Functions

7.9 Triggering PRs


There are several methods to call a PR. 1. Standard CTRG: Trigger the PR selected by DIs (POS0 ~ POS5). 2. Special STP: Terminate the running PR. SHOM: Start to run homing procedure (PR0). 3. Event EV1 ~ 4 (rising edge): Event can be used to call a PR. EV1 ~ 4 (falling edge): Event can be used to call a PR. 4. Software P5-07: Use PR identification to call a PR. 5. Others PR#50 is called when Capture function finished, and a specific PR can be assigned after ECam disengaging.

DI signals: CTRG, SHOM, STP, POS0 ~ POS5, ORG, PL(CCWL), NL(CWL), EV1~4 DO signals: CMD_OK, MC_OK, TPOS, ALRM, CAP_OK, CAM_AREA Timing chart:

Revision January 2011

7-17

Chapter 7 Motion Control Functions

The Ways to Call a PR There are 64 position settings in PR mode. PR 0 is homing mode and the others (PR 1 ~ 63) can be user-defined. For the ways to call a PR, please refer to the table below: Command Source DI signals: CTRG + POS0 ~ 5 Explanation Use DI signals, POS0 ~ 5 to specify the desired trigger procedure number (PR), and then use the rising-edge of DI signal, CTRG to trigger a PR. Suitable application: PC or PLC commands the servo drive by using DI signals DI signal: Set STP from OFF to be ON, and the command will stop. DI signal: Set SHOM from OFF to be ON, and the servo drive will start to perform homing operation. There are 4 events with rising and falling edges can be set to trigger a specific PR. DI signals: Trigger the command by changing the status of EV1 ~ 4 P5-98: Event Rising-edge Trigger Command (OFF ON) P5-99: Event Falling-edge Trigger Command (ON OFF) Suitable application: sensor, preset trigger procedure Set P5-07 to the desired trigger procedure number (PR) and it will trigger the dedicated position command immediately. P5-07 can be set through the keypad / communication (RS-232/485 and CANopen. Suitable application: PC or PLC commands the servo drive by using the communication. The number from 0 to 63 can be put into P5-07 to call a PR respectively. PR#0 is defined as homing procedure. The P5-07 will reply appropriate message about the result of executing PR. After Capture operation is completed, it will trigger PR 50. This function is enabled by the Bit3 setting of P5-39. After the electronic cam is disengaged, it will return to PR mode and trigger the specified PR designated by BA setting of P5-88. (ASDA-A2 series L type models does not provide this function.)

Standard

Special

DI signals: STP, SHM

Event

DI signals: EV1 ~ 4

Software

P5-07

Others

Trigger the command after Capture operation. Trigger the command after ECam is disengaged.

7-18

Revision January 2011

Chapter 7 Motion Control Functions

7.10 Parameter Settings


1) Target speed: P5-60 ~ P5-75 (Moving Speed Setting of Position 0 ~ 15), total 16 groups Bit W0 15 ~ 0 TARGET_SPEED0.1 ~ 6000.0(r/min)

2) Accel / Decel time: P5-20 ~ P5-35 (Accel / Decel Time 0 ~ 15), total 16 parameters Bit W0 15 ~ 0 T_ACC / T_DEC1 ~ 65500(msec)

Note: The acceleration time is used for DO signals, STP/EMS/NL(CWL)/PL(CCWL) when users want to stop the motor. The function of P5-07 will refer to this setting when perform stop positioning as well. 3) Delay time: P5-40 ~ P5-55 (Delay Time 0 ~ 15), total 16 groups. Bit W0 15 ~ 0 IDLE0 ~ 32767(msec)

4) PR parameters: P5-00 ~ P5-09, P6-00 ~ P6-01, total 12 DWORD. 32 BIT P5-00 P5-01 P5-02 P5-03 P5-04 P5-05 P5-06 P5-07 P5-08 P5-09 P6-00 P6-01 Reserved Reserved (for internal testing, do not use it) Reserved (for internal testing, do not use it) Deceleration Time of Protection Function Homing Mode 1st Speed Setting of High Speed Homing 2nd Speed Setting of Low Speed Homing Trigger Position Command (PR mode only) Forward Software Limit Reverse Software Limit Homing Definition Homing Definition Value (Z pulse position)

5) PR Definition: P6-02 ~ P7-27, (64 BIT), total 63 groups (2N) Bit DW0 DW1 31 ~ 28 27 ~ 24 23 ~ 20 19 ~ 16 15 ~ 12 11 ~ 8 7~4 3~0 TYPE

DATA (32 bit)

Each PR occupies two parameters. TYPE determines the PR type or function. DATA indicates PR data and the others are auxiliary information.

Revision January 2011

7-19

Chapter 7 Motion Control Functions

6) Constant Speed Control: TYPE = 1 Bit DW0 DW1 31 ~ 28 27 ~ 24 23 ~ 20 DLY 19 ~ 16 15 ~ 12 DEC 11 ~ 8 ACC 7~4 OPT 3~0 1

DATA (32 bit): Target speed. Unit: Defined by OPT.UNIT

When executing this command, the motor will accelerate or decelerate from current speed (the value does not necessarily have to be 0.). Once the motor reach the target speed, it indicates that this command is completed and the motor will continue running in this target speed and will not stop. OPT: OPT Bit 7 Bit 6 UNIT Bit 5 AUTO Bit 4 INS

When the TYPE is set to 1 ~ 3, it can accept DO signals, STP (Motor Stop), SNL(SCWL, Reverse Software Limit), SPL(SCCWL, Forward Software Limit). INS: Insertion command on PR AUTO: When current positioning is completed, the motor moves to the next dedicated PR automatically. UNIT: 0 ~ 1. 0: Unit is 0.1r/min 1: Unit is PPS(Pulse Per Second) ACC / DEC: 0 ~ F. Accel / Decel time number (4 bits) ACC / DEC (4) SPD: 0 ~ F. Target speed (4 bits) SPD (4) Index P5-60 ~ P5-75 Index P5-20 ~ P5-35

DLY: 0 ~ F. Delay time number (4 bits). The digital output of this PR activates after the delay time. External INS is not valid. The delay time number settings correspond with the parameter P5-40 ~ P5-55. DLY (4) Index P5-40 ~ P5-55

7) Position Control: (TYPE = 2, Single positioning control. Motor stops when positioning is completed. TYPE = 3: Auto positioning control. Motor goes to next dedicated PR when positioning is completed.) Bit DW0 DW1 31 ~ 28 27 ~ 24 23 ~ 20 DLY 19 ~ 16 SPD 15 ~ 12 DEC 11 ~ 8 ACC 7~4 OPT 3~0 2 or 3

DATA (32 bit): Target position, Unit: Pulse of User Unit

7-20

Revision January 2011

Chapter 7 Motion Control Functions

OPT: OPT Bit 7 0 1 0 1 Bit 6 0 0 1 1 Bit 5 OVLP Bit 4 INS CMD Explanation Absolute position command: Cmd_E = DATA (Note 1) Incremental position command: Cmd_E = Cmd_E + DATA (Note 2) Relative position command: Cmd_E = Current feedback position + DATA (Note 3) Capture position command: Cmd_E = Capture position + DATA (Note 4)

When the TYPE is set to 1 ~ 3, it can accept DO signals, STP (Motor Stop), SNL(SCWL, Reverse Software Limit), SPL(SCCWL, Forward Software Limit). INS: Insertion command on PR. OVLP: Overlap the next PR. This function is not available in speed mode. In position mode, DLY becomes disabled. CMD: The calculation method for Cmd_E (End of position command) is described in the notes below: Note 1: The end of position command is an absolute position command which is equal to DATA directly. Note 2: The end of the position command is an incremental position command which is equal to the end of the position command (Cmd_E, monitor variable 40h) plus a designated DATA. Note 3: The end of the position command is a relative position command which is equal to current feedback position (monitor variable 00h) plus a designated DATA. Note 4: The end of the position command is a capture position command which is equal to capture position (monitor variable 2Bh) plus a designated DATA. 8) Special Function: TYPE = 7. Jump to the dedicated PR. Bit DW0 DW1 OPT: OPT Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 INS 31 ~ 28 27 ~ 24 23 ~ 20 19 ~ 16 DLY 15 ~ 12 FUNC_CODE 11 ~ 8 OPT 7~4 7 3~0 -

PR Number ( 0 ~ 63 )

PR Number: Dedicated jump PR

Revision January 2011

7-21

Chapter 7 Motion Control Functions

FUN_CODE: Reserved DLY: Delay time after jump 9) Special Function: TYPE = 8Write the specified parameter to the dedicated PR. Bit DW0 DW1 P_Grp, P_Idx: Parameter group and number DLY: Delay time after writing the parameters 31 ~ 28 27 ~ 24 23 ~ 20 DLY 19 ~ 16 P_Grp 15 ~ 12 P_Idx 11 ~ 8 OPT 7~4 8 3~0 -

Para_Data

OPT OPT Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 AUTO Bit 4 INS

Para_Data: Write data Please note: 1. For the firmware version V1.013 and earlier models: If the values of the parameters can be retained when power is off, the new setting values will be written into EEPROM. Please note that do not frequently write data into EEPROM as doing this may damage EEPROM. 2. For the firmware version V1.013 and later models: Even if the values of the parameters can be retained when power is off, the new setting values will not be written into EEPROM. Do not worry that EEPROM may be damaged. Note: Writing the specified parameter to the dedicated PR is used for the applications which need On/Off operation or tuning function. For example, it can be used when using P2-00 for different position commands). Usually, On/Off operation or tuning function will not be executed for one time only. They are usually executed for many times repeatedly during the operation of the mechanical system. If users write all the data into EEPROM too frequently, it may damage EEPROM. When setting P2-30 to 5, the data will not retained when power is off. But this is not convenient for users to use. In order to solve this problem, ASDA-A2 series adds this function. 3. If the operation of writing parameter to the dedicated PR is failed, the fault AL213 ~ AL219 will occur (see Chapter 11 Troubleshooting). If any fault occurs, the motor will not move to the next dedicated PR automatically when current positioning is completed.

7-22

Revision January 2011

Chapter 7 Motion Control Functions

10) Homing Definition: P6-00 ~ P6-01, (64 bits), total 1 group. Bit DW0 DW1 PR: 0 ~ 3F. PR style (4 bits) 0: Stop mode. Motor stops after homing is completed. 1~63 (01 ~ 3F): Auto mode. Motor goes the dedicated PR 1 ~ 63 after homing is completed. ACC: Acceleration time DEC1 / DEC2: 1st deceleration time / 2nd deceleration time.. DLY: Delay time BOOT: Boot mode. Disable or enable homing function when the servo drive is applied to power (power on). 0: Disable homing function 1: Enable homing function (when the servo drive is applied to power, first time Servo On) ORG_DEF: Homing definition value which is determined by the parameter P6-01. The homing definition value does not necessarily have to be 0. 1) ASDA-A2 series does not provide the functions that find Z pulse and regard Z pulse as Home. Therefore, it needs to decide if the motor return to Z pulse position when homing operation is completed. After home sensor or Z pulse is found, the motor must accelerate to stop. Generally, the motor stop position will be a little ahead of the position of Z pulse. 31 ~ 28 BOOT 27 ~ 24 23 ~ 20 DLY 19 ~ 16 DEC2 15 ~ 12 DEC1 11 ~ 8 ACC 7~4 PR 3~0 BOOT

ORG_DEF (32 bit)

Do not return to Z pulse: Set PR=0 Return to Z pulse: Set PR=a non-zero value and set absolute position command= ORG_DEF. CMD_OCommand Output Position CMD_ECommand End Position

Revision January 2011

7-23

Chapter 7 Motion Control Functions

2) Position offset values are not defined when performing homing operation. After homing operation, the position offset values can be set as a dedicated PR. For example, if users want the motor to move a distance S (relative to home senor or Z pulse), and defined the position coordinate as P, set PR as a non-zero value and set ORG_DEF=P - S. (P is the absolute position command and S is the incremental position command)

7.10.1 Motion Commands


1) Each motion command can be inserted (INS) or overlapped (OVLP). INS P_Command 1 OVLP INS P_Command 2 OVLP

2) The priority of INS is higher than OVLP. P_Command 1 P_Command 2 OVLP=0 INS=0 Sequence Sequential Command Overlap Command Insertion Command Output Note

P_Command 1 and P_Command 2 DLY 1 can be speed or position command. When P_Command 2 is a speed NO DLY command, OVLP function is disabled. N/A P_Command 1 and P_Command 2 can be speed or position command.

OVLP=1 OVLP=0 OVLP=1

INS=0

INS=1

7-24

Revision January 2011

Chapter 7 Motion Control Functions

7.10.2 Sequence
1) Sequential Command on PR A command will be executed only when the previous command completed.

P_Command 1: DLY is set P_Command 2: INS is not set (DLY: Delay time is calculated from the time when the position command is completed)

V_Command 1: Speed command. DLY is set P_Command 2: Position command. (DLY: Delay time is calculated from the time when the position command is completed)

2) Overlap Command The second command will be executed after delay time or during deceleration period. A long delay time at the first command will affect the timing of second command. Zero delay is recommended for overlap application.

Revision January 2011

7-25

Chapter 7 Motion Control Functions

P_Command 1: OVLP is set, DLY can not be set. P_Command 2: INS is not set

3) Internal Insertion Command The second command will insert the first command to be a new command. The final result depends on the types of commands. The delay time gets function.

V_Command 1: Speed Command. DLY is set P_Command 2: Position Command. INS is set (DLY is valid for internal insertion command) This procedure can be used to create complicated position profile.

7-26

Revision January 2011

Chapter 7 Motion Control Functions

4) External Insertion Command The external insertion will change the command being executed at the moment it inserted. The delay time is not a matter for external insertion.
INS OVLP DLY INS OVLP DLY

SPEED

The final destination : Absolute : Cmd_E = command Relative : Cmd_E = Fb_PUU + command Incremental : Cmd_E = last Cmd_E + command Cap. Relative : Data captured + command
TIME

P_Command 1 DLY P_Command 2

SPEED

AUTO INS OVLP DLY V_Command 1

INS OVLP DLY

The final destination : Absolute : Cmd_E = command Relative : Cmd_E = Fb_PUU + command Incremental : Cmd_E = last Cmd_E + command Cap. Relative : Data captured + command
TIME

DLY

P_Command 2

V_Command 1: Speed Command. The delay time is not a matter for external insertion. P_Command 2: Position Command. INS is set (DLY is not valid for external insertion command) This procedure can be used to change position profile freely.

Revision January 2011

7-27

Chapter 7 Motion Control Functions

7.11 Electronic Cam (E-Cam) (ASDA-A2 series L type models does not provide this function)
From Machine Cam to Electronic Cam The concept of electronic cam (E-Cam) is to use the software settings to determine the position relationship between master axis (Master) and slave axis (Slave), almost like a virtual electronic cam exists between both of them. Please refer to the figure below.

In PT mode, the external input pulse number (from master axis) is the reference of the position command (from slave axis). It indicates the slave axis follows the master axis. The relationship between master axis and slave axis is a linear relationship (The ratio is electronic gear ratio). When the electronic cam function is enabled, the relationship between master axis and slave axis is no longer a linear relationship only. It will become a cyclic curve relationship, just like the profile of the electronic cam. In the traditional mechanical system, a machine cam (physical cam) can convert the simple constant speed motion to variable speed motion, reciprocating motion and intermittent motion, etc. a wide range of motion control operation. The electronic cam can provide the same function and make the system to be used for a variety of motion control applications as well.

7-28

Revision January 2011

Chapter 7 Motion Control Functions

Please refer to the table below to know the differences between a machine cam (physical cam) and an electronic cam (virtual cam). Machine Cam (Physical Cam) Structure Smooth Performance Position Accuracy Long Distance Motion If master axis can be eliminated Replacement Maintenance Other Return to the original position after one rotation. Determined by actual process precision The position accuracy is very precise (under the condition of no vibration) When the motion distance is longer, the system needs bigger machine cam. Making a big machine cam is not easy. Master axis can not be eliminated Need of replacement or repair. It will cost money. Machine will wear. Maintenance is necessary. Mater axis will occupy the space and consume the power. Electronic Cam After E-Cam rotates 360 degrees (one revolution), it can return to the original position and also can display by spiral form like mosquito coil incense. Three curves can be interpolated between two positions upon software. The position accuracy is very precise, but the actual motor position will be a little deviated due to the delay time. Only need to change the values of ECam curve. It is applicable for the application of long motion distance. Master axis can be eliminated for constant speed motion application. Users can use the signals that generated by the servo drive. No need of replacement or repair. Users only need to reset the parameter settings. Maintenance is not necessary. Space and energy saving. Good for environmental protection.

Revision January 2011

7-29

Chapter 7 Motion Control Functions

Characteristics of E-Cam: Characteristics of E-Cam Control Mode E-Cam function is available only in PR mode. X=0: Disable E-Cam function (Default). If E-Cam has been engaged already, setting X=0 will force E-Cam to be disengaged. X=1Enable E-Cam function. There are three statuses: Stop / Lead Pulse / Engaged

Enable E-Cam Function (P5-88 X Settings) States of E-Cam

Physical axes: P5-88 Y=1. Linear Encoder (CN5) P5-88 Y=2. Pulse Command (CN1) Output axis: P5-88 Y=0. Capture source setting. (Defined by Capture function, P5-39 B settings) Virtual axes: P5-88 Y=3. PR command (Internal signal) P5-88 Y=4. 1ms clock (Internal signal) P5-88 Y=5. Synchronous Capture Axis (P5-39 B, Mark tracking) The command will be sent only when E-Cam is engaged.

Sources of Master Axis (P5-88 Y Settings)

Servo drive command = E-Cam command + PR command No matter E-Cam is engaged or not, PR command is valid. Only when E-Cam is engaged, the source of master axis is PR command and PR command is set to 0. When E-Cam operates, users can adjust E-Cam position through PR command still (usually using incremental position command).

Servo Drive Command

Data Storage Location E-Cam Curve Division Data Format Data Content

Data array. The E-Cam curve is stored in the data array. P5-81 notes its start point where P5-82 +1 (720+1, maximum items of one E-Cam curve) is for its length. P5-85 is the initial point where the E-Cam engaged. It is set by P5-82. Range: 5 ~ 720 32-bit data with polarity Save the position of slave axis (user unit: PUU) Pulses of E-Cam master axis output incrementally E-Cam Axis Pulses of E-Cam slave axis output incrementally Position Command After E-Cam rotates one revolution, the slave axis may not return to the original position definitely. The position of the slave axis is determined by the content of E-Cam curve. Three curves can be interpolated between two positions upon software. The adjacent curves at the ends continue quadratic differential equation and make the torque of the ends to be smooth. DO signalCAM_AREA. When CAM_AREA is activated, it indicates that the servo drive has detected the E-Cam master position is within the setting area.

Calculation Method of E-Cam Position

DO signal: CAM_AREA (DO=0x18)

7-30

Revision January 2011

Chapter 7 Motion Control Functions

The function block diagram of E-Cam is shown as the figure below:

Master Axis Master Axis: Sources of main axis P5-88 Y Settings

Clutch Clutch: Control the timing that slave starts to follow master. P5-88 U&Z Settings, P5-87, P5-89

Gear Box #1

Master E-Gear: The scaling of command pulse P5-83, P5-84

E-Cam Axis

Data Array .. POS 0 POS 1 ~ POS N

Slave Axis E-Cam (PUU)

Gear Box #2

Pulse Command (Pulse)

Position Controller E-Cam is activated P5-88 X Settings

Slave E-Gear: The scaling of E-Cam E-Cam Curve: The E-Cam function curve to output P1-44, P1-45, P5-19 defines the relationship of master and slave. P5-81, P5-82, P5-85

Function of Master Axis Function of Master Axis Descriptions The movement of the master axis is the signal which enables ECam operation of the servo drive. The command source of the master axis is determined by P5-88 Y settings.

Physical axes: P5-88 Y=1. Linear Encoder (CN5) P5-88 Y=2. Pulse Command (CN1) Output axis: P5-88 Y=0. Capture source setting. (Defined by Capture function, P5-39 B settings) Virtual axes: P5-88 Y=3. PR command (Internal signal) P5-88 Y=4. 1ms clock (Internal signal) P5-88 Y=5. Synchronous Capture Axis (P5-39 B, Mark tracking)

Source of Master Axis (P5-88 Y Settings)

Position of Master Axis (P5-86)

Using P5-86 can monitor the position of the master axis. Before ECam is engaged, P5-86 can be set and changed still. Doing this will not affect the position of the slave axis because the movement of the master axis does not change as well. When the E-Cam is activated (P5-88 X=1), the pulse will be counted in P5-86. The P5-86 should be an increasing number. If not, reverse the pulse direction (not motor direction).

Revision January 2011

7-31

Chapter 7 Motion Control Functions

Function of Clutch Function of Clutch This function is used to determine the engaging and disengaging state of the master axis and gear box # 1. After E-Cam is engaged, then the movement of the master axis is able to rotate E-Cam of the servo drive. X=0: Disable E-Cam function (Default). If E-Cam has been engaged already, setting X=0 will force E-Cam to be disengaged. X=1: Enable E-Cam function. There are three statuses: Stop / Lead Pulse / Engaged

Descriptions

Enable E-Cam Function (P5-88 X Settings)

5
P5-88 X=0 P5-88 U=1, 2, 6 S1 Engaged S0 Stop

P5-88 U=4 The lead pulse The lead pulse number number is set set in P5-87 or P5-92 in P5-92 reached Can be read from monitoring variable 061

2
P5-88 X=0 The condition set in P5-88 Z setting is satisfied The lead pulse number is set in P5-87

S2 Lead Pulse

States of E-Cam

States of E-Cam There are 3 states to indicate the status of the E-Cam system. Stop This is the default status of E-Cam. E-Cam will not operate in accordance with the pulses of the master axis. When E-Cam function is disabled (P5-88 X=0), E-Cam will return to this state. Lead Pulse When the engaging conditions are satisfied (Path 1), the status of E-Cam will change to Lead Pulse. At this time, E-Cam will not operate in accordance with the pulses of the master axis. Engaged When the lead pulse number set in P5-87 or P5-92 reached (Path 3), E-Cam will enter into Engaged state and start to operate in accordance with the pulses of the master axis. Path Explanation Path 1 When the engaging conditions are satisfied (P5-88 Z setting), the status of E-Cam will change from Stop to Lead Pulse. The lead pulse number is set in P5-87.

7-32

Revision January 2011

Chapter 7 Motion Control Functions

Function of Clutch

States of E-Cam

Path 2 When E-Cam function is disabled (P5-88 X=0), the status of ECam will return to Stop. Path 3 When the lead pulse number set in P5-87 or P5-92 reached, , the status of E-Cam will change from Lead Pulse to Engaged. Path 4 When disengaging conditions are satisfied (P5-88 U=4), the status of E-Cam will change from Engaged to Lead Pulse. When the electronic gear is disengaged, the status of E-Cam will not change to Stop. It will change to Lead Pulse and the lead pulse number at this time is set in P5-92 (this function is only available for the firmware version V1.006sub04 and later models). Path 5 When disengaging conditions are satisfied (P5-88 U=1, 2, 6), or when E-Cam function is disabled (P5-88 X=0), the status of E-Cam will change from Engaged to Stop.

Engaging Conditions (P5-88 Z Settings)

When E-Cam is in the status of Stop, this function is used to determine the engaging timing (Path 1). Three conditions to engage the clutch: Z=0: Engage immediately when E-Cam function is enabled (When P5-88 X=1) Z=1: Engage when DI signal, CAM (DI=0x36) is ON. Z=2: Any action of Capture function. E-Cam engaged after the next position is captured. The Capture function is designed to activate E-Cam because of its high speed input. When the Capture function fetches the position, it will bring the E-Cam function enforcement simultaneously. Because the Capture operation is controlled by external control command (hardware), and no delay occurs, this setting is suitable for the application requires real time such as the master axis is already operating before E-Cam is engaged.

Lead Pulse Number (Monitoring Variable 061)

When E-Cam is in the status of Lead Pulse, the master axis needs to move for a certain distance and then E-Cam is able to be engaged (Path 3). This movement is called as Lead Pulse Number and it can be monitored by the monitoring variable 061. The value of lead pulse number will descend according to the input pulses of the master axis. When the value of lead pulse number becomes 0, the status of E-Cam will change to Engaged. When the status of E-Cam changes to Lead Pulse by Path 1, the lead pulse number is set in P5-87. When the status of E-Cam changes to Lead Pulse by Path 4, the lead pulse number is set in P5-92.

If the setting value of P5-87 and P-92 is 0, it indicates that there is no lead pulse number and the status of E-Cam will change to Engaged immediately. + / - signs indicates the direction of lead pulse. Please note that if the polarity of the direction of lead pulse is set incorrectly, E-Cam will not be engaged.
7-33

Revision January 2011

Chapter 7 Motion Control Functions

Function of Clutch Lead Pulse Number (Monitoring Variable 061) When the direction of lead pulse is not set correctly, it will cause that the value of the monitoring variable 061 becomes higher and higher and finally lead to overflow. At this time, E-Cam function will be disabled (P5-88 X=0) and the status of E-Cam will be forced to be changed to Stop. This option is used to determine the disengaging timing when the status of E-Cam is Engaged. Please note that the condition 2, 4, and 6 are mutually exclusive; that is, only one of them can be selected. U 0 Disengaging Conditions Do not disengage. When P5-88 X=0, E-Cam disengaged. Disengage when DI signal, CAM (DI=0x36) is OFF. Fixed number of master pulses (P589) to disengage. (The polarity sign indicates the direction) (This setting is only available in firmware V1.009 and later models) Fixed number of master pulses (P589) to disengage for smooth speed. The function is the same as the setting of U=2. The difference is that the speed will not change when disengaging and the engaging length will exceed the setting value of P5-89 a little. This setting is suitable for the application which needs to use PR command immediately when disengaging. (This setting is only available in firmware V1.009 and later models) Fixed number of master pulses (P589) to disengage with cycle function. (The polarity sign indicates the direction) Shut down E-Cam when disengaging. States of E-Cam when disengaging (Path 5) Change to the status of Stop (Path 5) Change to the status of Stop (Path 5) Change to the status of Stop

Disengaging Timing (P5-88 U Settings)

(Path 5) Change to the status of Stop

(Path 4) Return to the status of Lead Pulse (before engaging) (The lead pulse number is set in P592). P5-88 X=0

8 Auxiliary Function (P5-88 BA Settings)

Call PR defined in P5-88 BA settings when disengaging (only when P5-88 U=2, 4, or 6 is selected). When E-Cam returns to the status of Stop, the designated PR defined in P5-88 BA settings will be executed immediately.

7-34

Revision January 2011

Chapter 7 Motion Control Functions

Function of Gear Box #1 (Master E-Gear) Function of Gear Box #1 (Master E-Gear)

Function

This function defines the relationship of the master axis and E-Cam axis. When the master axis rotates one revolution, it does not mean that E-Cam must rotate one revolution as well. The master E-Gear can be set. The master E-Gear (electronic gear) will change the resolution of master pulse command. E-Cam axis is a virtual axis. When E-Cam axis rotates 360 degrees, it indicates that E-Cam rotates one revolution also and the slave axis operates one cycle as well. The moving unit of the master axis is pulse number. The resolution is determined by the command source. P5-83 and P5-84 is used to set the scaling of command pulse. After receiving the pulse number P of master axis, the axis of E-Cam will rotate M cycles. P5-83=M, P5-84=P P5-83 can be adjusted while engaging.


Explanation

Setting Method P5-83 : M P5-84 : P

Function of E-Cam Curve Function of E-Cam Curve

Function

The E-Cam function defines the relationship of master and slave axes. The related settings are saved in E-Cam curve. When E-Cam rotates one revolution, the slave axis operates one cycle. Data array. The E-Cam curve is stored in the data array. P5-81 notes its start point where P5-82 +1 (720+1, maximum items of one E-Cam curve) is for its length. P5-85 is the initial point where the E-Cam engaged. 32-bit data with polarity (user unit is PUU) It is used to magnify or minify E-Cam curve without changing the setting value of the E-Cam curve. Each data in E-Cam curve can be multiplied by this parameter. Range of P5-19 is:-2147.000000 ~ 2147.000000 with minimum scale of 0.000001. The change or P5-19 will be put into enforcement when the E-Cam re-engaged. E-Cam curve can be a negative scaling. If P5-19 is set to negative, the result will have a upside down curve compared to P5-19 is a positive value. When it is set to 0, E-Cam command will not output (always be 0). E-Cam curve can be divided into certain equal N parts (set by P5-82, N>=5). For example, if N=5, there will be 6 points recorded in the data array. Each division has 360/N degrees. 720 divisions are maximum number for one curve.

Data Storage Location Data Format

E-Cam Curve Scaling P5-19 (-2147.000000 ~ 2147.000000)

E-Cam Curve Division N

Revision January 2011

7-35

Chapter 7 Motion Control Functions

Function of E-Cam Curve

E-Cam curve saves the position data of slave axis (user unit is PUU). If E-Cam is divided into N parts, it means that total N+1 points are recorded in the data array. This is because the position of the first point (0) and the position of the last point (360) are not the same. 1. When the positions of 0 and 360 are the same:

2.

When the positions of 0 and 360 are not the same:

E-Cam Curve Content

Suppose that: 1. When the positions of 0 and 360 are the same: It indicates that the position of slave axis will return to home after E-Cam rotates 360 (one revolution). After E-Cam rotates 360 degrees

Slave Axis

E-Cam Axis 2. When the positions of 0 and 360 are not the same: It indicates that the position of slave axis will not return to home after E-Cam rotates 360 (one revolution). After E-Cam rotates 360 degrees

Slave Axis

E-Cam Axis

7-36

Revision January 2011

Chapter 7 Motion Control Functions

Function of E-Cam Curve

Slave axis is a virtual axis (user unit is PUU). P5-85 is the first point where the E-Cam engaged. When ECam engaged, the position of E-Cam axis will move to the point set by P5-85. The position of slave axis will move to the position which corresponds to P5-85. After E-Cam engaged, if E-Cam axis does not move, the slave axis will not move either. After E-Cam engaged, if E-Cam moves, the position changes of E-Cam axis represent the output pulses of the slave axis. When E-Cam rotates 360 degrees (one revolution), the slave axis operates one cycle. E-Cam axis can rotate in either forward or reverse direction. If the position of E-Cam axis is between two points of E-Cam curve, the position of the slave axis can be interpolated by cubic curves and the adjacent curves at the ends will continue quadratic differential equation and make the torque of the ends to be smooth. The point number of E-Cam curve will not affect the smooth operation of E-Cam either.

Operation

Function of Gear Box #2 (Slave E-Gear) Function of Gear Box #2 (Slave E-Gear)

Function

This function defines the relationship of slave axes and pulse command. When the slave axis rotates one revolution, it does not mean that pulse command must rotate one revolution as well. The slave E-Gear can be set. Slave axis is a virtual axis (user unit is PUU). The unit of pulse command is encoder unit, pulse (1280000 pulse/rev) When E-Cam axis rotates one revolution, the slave axis operates one cycle as well. When the pulse command of slave axis is L and motor runs R rotation, the electronic gear ratio will be equal to P1-44/P1-45 = 1280000 x R/L The function is the same as the electronic gear ratio in PT and PR mode.

Explanation

Setting Method P1-44: Numerator of Electronic Gear Ratio P1-45: Denominator of Electronic Gear Ratio

Digital Outputs for E-Cam Function Digital Outputs for E-Cam Function Digital Outputs Function When E-Cam engaged When E-Cam disengaged

DO signal: CAM_AREA (DO=0x18) When DO signal, CAM_AREA is ON, it indicates that the position of E-Cam axis is within the specified angle range. Degree when P5-90 and P5-91 is set to ON See Table 1 & 2 below. DO signal: CAM_AREA are OFF

Revision January 2011

7-37

Chapter 7 Motion Control Functions

Table 1 P5-90 <= P5-91: E-Cam Degree DO:CAM_AREA Table 2 P5-90 > P5-91: E-Cam Angle DO:CAM_AREA 0 ON ~ ON P5-91 OFF ~ OFF P5-90 OFF ~ ON 360 ON 0 OFF ~ OFF P5-90 ON ~ ON P5-91 ON ~ OFF 360 OFF

7.11.1 Capture Function


The Capture function can be applied to latch a reference position which could be the signal of main encoder, linear encoder, or pulse train. It is possible to record 800 items with max. length of data array. The DI7 is the only one high speed digital input in ASDA-A2. The Capture function needs DI7 to admit the signal changed in real time. The signal to DI7 for Capture function is a physical signal and cannot be simulated from software. It can complete precise Capture function for high-speed motion axis. The characteristics of Capture function is described as follows: Characteristics of Capture function Three sources of Capture function:

Sources

Pulse command: Pulse train The selected source axis will be displayed by P5-37. Before executing Capture function, please set P5-37 first. Please note: The capture source setting can not be changed when the compare source is the capture axis.

Main encoder: Motor encoder Auxiliary encoder: Linear scale

Trigger Signal

It is triggered by DI7 and the response time is 1 usec. Please note: DI7 signal is a physical signal used to control Capture function directly. No matter what the setting value of P2-16 is, when DI7 is triggered, Capture function will be enabled always. After Capture function is enabled, in order to avoid the malfunction of the other DI signals, the system will force the other DI signals to be disabled, i.e. set P2-16=0x0100 automatically. Please note that the setting value of P2-16 will not be written into EEPROM when power is off. After re-power the servo drive, the setting value of P2-16 will be restored to its default setting automatically.
By edge triggered. A or B contact can be selectable. It is able to capture multiple positions continuously. The interval time can be set also. (It can determine how long it will take when accepting the next trigger command)

Trigger Method

7-38

Revision January 2011

Chapter 7 Motion Control Functions

Characteristics of Capture function Data Storage Location Amount Data Format

Data array. The starting point is set in P5-36. The amount is determined by P5-38. But, the total amount can not exceed the limit of data array. 32-bit pulse number (with polarity) If Bit 1 of P5-39 X setting is set, P5-37=P5-76 after the first point is captured. If Bit 2 of P5-39 X setting is set, the servo system will initiate Compare function automatically after the first point is captured. If Bit 3 of P5-39 X setting is set, the servo system will call PR#50 automatically when all data in P5-38 captured completely. The default setting is OFF. It will be ON when the last position is captured. When Bit0 of P5-39 is set to 1 (P5-39 X0=1), it will be OFF after the capture function is enabled. If P5-38=0 and Bit0 of P5-39 is set to 1 (P5-39 X0=1), Capture function will be disabled. At this time, Bit0 of P5-39 will be reset to 0 (P5-39 X0=0) and the DO signal, CAP_OK will be inactivated (OFF) as well. The data format of Capture axis is 32-bit data. Do not calculate the capture data repeatedly; otherwise the overflow may occur and result in error or invalid result.

Auxiliary Function

DO Signal: CAP_OK

Remark

The data captured by Capture function are all stored in data array. The first captured point is stored in data array (P5-36), the capture amount is determined by P5-38 and the last captured point is stored in data array (P5-36+P5-38-1). When Bit0=1 (P5-39 X setting value), the Capture function is enabled. Once DI7 is triggered every time, one position data will be captured and stored into data array. At this time, the setting value of P5-38 will decrease 1 automatically until the capture amount is reached, i.e. the setting value of P5-38 becomes 0. When capture function has finished, the value of Bit0 (P5-39 X setting value) will be reset to 0 automatically, and DO signal, CAP_OK will be activated. When the first point is captured, users can choose to reset the position of Capture axis. Then, the value of the first capture point must be the value of P5-76 and the captured value after the second captured point will be the movement relative to the first captured point. This kind of Capture is called Relative Capture. However, if users choose not to reset the fist captured point, the capture method is called Absolute Capture. When capturing the first point, users can select to enable Compare function as well

Revision January 2011

7-39

Chapter 7 Motion Control Functions

Capture Operation:
First point captured P5-76 Data Array .. POS 1 POS 2 POS 3 ~ POS N

Enable Compare function The first point is saved in P5-36 The second point is saved in P5-36+1 The third point is saved in P5-36+2

Capture axis (P5-37)

Capture signal (DI7) DO signal: CAP_OK

P5-38 Amount (Data Length)

P5-39 X0=0 after Capture operation is Call PR#50 when all in P5-38 captured completed. P5-39 X0=1DO signal is reset when Capture

completed.

function is enabled next time.

7.11.2 Compare Function


The Compare function is a reverse process of the Capture function. The items stored in data array will be compared to the signal of a physical axis (main encoder, linear encoder, or pulse train). The Compare function uses the instant position of motion axis to compare with the value which store in data array. When the compare conditions are satisfied, DO4 signal will output immediately for motion control. The signal to DO4 for Compare function is a physical signal and cannot be simulated from software. It can complete precise Compare function for high-speed motion axis. The characteristics of Compare function is described as follows: Characteristics of Compare function Three sources of Compare function:

Sources

Capture axis (When the source is the capture axis, the capture source setting can not be changed.) The selected source axis will be displayed by P5-57. Before executing Capture function, please set P5-57 first.

Main encoder: Motor encoder Auxiliary encoder: Linear scale Pulse command: Pulse train

7-40

Revision January 2011

Chapter 7 Motion Control Functions

Characteristics of Compare function It is output by DO4 and the response time is 1 usec. Please note: DO4 signal is a physical signal used to control Compare function directly. No matter what the setting value of P2-21 is, when DO4 is triggered, Compare function will be enabled always. After Compare function is enabled, in order to avoid the malfunction of the other DO signals, the system will force the other DO signals to be disabled, i.e. set P2-21=0x0100 automatically. Please note that the setting value of P2-21 will not be written into EEPROM when power is off. After re-power the servo drive, the setting value of P2-21 will be restored to its default setting automatically.

Trigger Signal

Output Method Data Storage Location Amount Data Format Compare Condition

Pulse output. A or B contact can be selectable. It is able to compare multiple positions continuously. The output pulse width can be set also. Data array. The starting point is set in P5-56. The amount is determined by P5-58. But, the total amount can not exceed the limit of data array. 32-bit pulse number (with polarity) It is triggered when the position of source axis pass through the compare value. Continuous Mode: When the last point is compared, the servo system will return to the fist point and start Compare operation again. After the last point is compared, the servo system will enable Capture function automatically. If P5-58=0 and Bit0 of P5-59 is set to 1 (P5-59 X0=1), Compare function will be disabled. At this time, Bit0 of P5-59 will be reset to 0 (P5-59 X0=0). The data format of Compare axis is 32-bit data. Do not calculate the compare data repeatedly; otherwise the overflow may occur and result in error or invalid result.

Auxiliary Function

Remark

The data compared by Compare function are all stored in data array. The first compared point is stored in data array (P5-56), the compare amount is determined by P5-58 and the last compared point is stored in data array (P5-56+P5-58-1). When Bit0=1 (P5-59 X setting value), the Compare function is enabled and start to compare the data of the first point. Every time when one position is compared, the pulse signal will output one time. At this time, the setting value of P5-58 will decrease 1 automatically until the compare amount is reached, i.e. the setting value of P5-58 becomes 0. When compare function has finished, the value of Bit0 (P5-59 X setting value) will be reset to 0 automatically. When the last point is compared, users can choose to compare from the first point again and again, and it is called Continuous Mode. Or users can choose to enable Capture function automatically after the last point is compared.

Revision January 2011

7-41

Chapter 7 Motion Control Functions

Compare Operation:
Data Array .. POS 1 The first point is saved in P5-56 POS 2 The second point is saved in P5-56+1 POS 3 ~ The third point is saved in P5-56+2 POS N Compare axis (P5-57)

Compare signal (DO4)

2 3 N P5-58 Amount (Data Length) Output pulse width can be set in P5-59.CBA

Enable Capture function

(It is invalid if Capture function is enabled already.) After the last pulse outputs completely: Non-continuous mode: P5-59 X0=0 after Compare operation is completed. Continuous mode: The servo system keeps repeating the Compare function, P5-59 X0=1

7-42

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

8.1 Definition
There are following eight groups for drive parameters: Group 0: Monitor parameters Group 1: Basic parameters Group 2: Extension parameters (example: P0-xx) (example: P1-xx) (example: P2-xx)

Group 3: Communication parameters (example: P3-xx) Group 4: Diagnosis parameters (example: P4-xx)

Group 5: Motion control parameters (example: P5-xx) Group 6: PR path definition parameters Group 7: PR path definition parameters (example: P6-xx) (example: P7-xx)

Abbreviation of control modes: PT PR S T : : : : Position control mode (command from external signal) Position control mode (command from internal signal) Speed control mode Torque control mode

Explanation of symbols (marked after parameter) ( ) () () ( ) Read-only register, such as P0-00, P0-01, P4-00. Parameter cannot be set when Servo On (when the servo drive is enabled), such as P100, P1-46 and P2-33. Parameter is effective only after the servo drive is restarted (after switching power off and on), such as P1-01 and P3-00. Parameter setting values are not retained when power is off, such as P2-31 and P3-06.

Revision January 2011

8-1

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

8.2 Parameters Summary 8.2.1 Parameters List by Group


Group 0: P0-xx

Monitor Parameters
Parameter Name Function Default Factory setting N/A 00 01 Unit Control Mode PT PR S T P0-00 P0-01 P0-02 P0-03 P0-04 ~ P0-07 P0-08 P0-09 P0-10 P0-11 P0-12 P0-13 P0-14 ~ P0-16 P0-17 P0-18 P0-19 P0-20 P0-21 P0-22 ~ P0-24 P0-25 P0-26 P0-27 P0-28 P0-29 P0-30 P0-31 P0-32 P0-33 ~ P0-34 8-2 VER
2

Firmware Version Drive Fault Code Drive Status (Front Panel Display) Analog Monitor Output

N/A N/A N/A N/A

ALE STS MON

Reserved (Do Not Use) TSON CM1 CM2 CM3 CM4 CM5 Servo Startup Time Status Monitor 1 Status Monitor 2 Status Monitor 3 Status Monitor 4 Status Monitor 5 0 N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A Hour N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A

Reserved (Do Not Use) CM1A CM2A CM3A CM4A CM5A Status Monitor Selection 1 Status Monitor Selection 2 Status Monitor Selection 3 Status Monitor Selection 4 Status Monitor Selection 5 0 0 0 0 0 N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A

Reserved (Do Not Use) MAP0 MAP1 MAP2 MAP3 MAP4 MAP5 MAP6 MAP7 Mapping Parameter 1 Mapping Parameter 2 Mapping Parameter 3 Mapping Parameter 4 Mapping Parameter 5 Mapping Parameter 6 Mapping Parameter 7 Mapping Parameter 8 N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A

Reserved (Do Not Use)

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Monitor Parameters
Parameter Name Function Block Data Read / Write Register 1 (for P0-25) Block Data Read / Write Register 2 (for P0-26) Block Data Read / Write Register 3 (for P0-27) Block Data Read / Write Register 4 (for P0-28) Block Data Read / Write Register 5 (for P0-29) Block Data Read / Write Register 6 (for P0-30) Block Data Read / Write Register 7 (for P0-31) Block Data Read / Write Register 8 (for P0-32) Status Monitor Register (PC Software Setting) Status Monitor Register Selection (PC Software Setting) Servo Output Status Display Default Unit Control Mode PT PR S T P0-35 P0-36 P0-37 P0-38 P0-39 P0-40 P0-41 P0-42 P0-43 P0-44 P0-45 P0-46 MAP1A MAP2A MAP3A MAP4A MAP5A MAP6A MAP7A MAP8A 0x0 0x0 0x0 0x0 0x0 0x0 0x0 0x0 N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A

Reserved (Do Not Use) PCMN PCMNA SVSTS 0x0 0x0 0 N/A N/A N/A

Explanation of symbols (marked after parameter) () () () () Read-only register. Parameter cannot be set when Servo On (when the servo drive is enabled). Parameter is effective only after the servo drive is restarted (after switching power off and on). Parameter setting values are not retained when power is off.

Revision January 2011

8-3

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Group 1: P1-xx

Basic Parameters
Parameter P1-00 P1-01 P1-02 P1-03 P1-04 P1-05 P1-06 P1-07 P1-08 P1-09 ~ P1-11 P1-12 ~ P1-14 P1-15 ~ P1-24 P1-25 P1-26 P1-27 P1-28 P1-29 P1-30 P1-31 P1-32 P1-33 P1-34 8-4 Name PTT CTL PSTL AOUT MON1 MON2 SFLT TFLT PFLT SP1~ 3 TQ1 ~ 3 Function External Pulse Input Type Control Mode and Output Direction Speed and Torque Limit Pulse Output Polarity Setting Analog Monitor Output Proportion 1 (CH1) Analog Monitor Output Proportion 2 (CH2) Accel / Decel Smooth Constant of Analog Speed Command (Low-pass Filter) Smooth Constant of Analog Torque Command (Low-pass Filter) Smooth Constant of Position Command (Low-pass Filter) 1st ~ 3rd Speed Command 1st ~ 3rd Speed Limit 1st ~ 3rd Torque Command 1st ~ 3rd Torque Limit Default 0x2 0 0 0 100 100 0 0 0 -60000 ~ +60000 -300 ~ +300 Unit N/A Control Mode PT PR S T

pulse r/min N-m N/A N/A

% (full scale) % (full scale) Msec Msec msec r/min %

Reserved (Do Not Use) VSF1 VSG1 VSF2 VSG2 AVSM VCL Low-frequency Vibration Suppression (1) Low-frequency Vibration Suppression Gain (1) Low-frequency Vibration Suppression (2) Low-frequency Vibration Suppression Gain (2) Auto Low-frequency Vibration Suppression Mode Selection Low-frequency Vibration Detection Level Motor Stop Mode Selection Acceleration Time 100.0 0 100.0 0 0 500 Hz N/A Hz N/A N/A

pulse

Reserved (Do Not Use) LSTP TACC 0 200 N/A msec Reserved (Do Not Use)

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Basic Parameters
Parameter P1-35 P1-36 P1-37 P1-38 P1-39 P1-40 P1-41 P1-42 P1-43 P1-44 P1-45 P1-46 P1-47 P1-48 P1-49 ~ P1-51 P1-52 P1-53 P1-54 P1-55 P1-56 P1-57 P1-58 P1-59 P1-60 ~ P1-61 P1-62 P1-63 Name TDEC TSL GDR ZSPD SSPD VCM TCM MBT1 MBT2 GR1 GR2 GR3 SPOK MCOK Function Deceleration Time Accel /Decel S-curve Ratio of Load Inertia to Servo Motor Inertia Zero Speed Range Setting Target Motor Speed Max. Analog Speed Command or Limit Max. Analog Torque Command or Limit On Delay Time of Electromagnetic Brake OFF Delay Time of Electromagnetic Brake Electronic Gear Ratio (1st Numerator) (N1) Electronic Gear Ratio (Denominator) (M) Encoder Output Pulse Number Speed Reached Output Range Motion Control Completed Output Selection Default 200 0 10 100 3000 rated speed 100 0 -1000 ~ 1000 128 10 2500 10 0x0000 Unit msec msec Control Mode PT PR S T

0.1 times 0.1 r/min r/min r/min %

msec msec pulse pulse pulse N/A N/A

Reserved (Do Not Use) RES1 RES2 PER MSPD OVW CRSHA CRSHT MFLT Regenerative Resistor Value Regenerative Resistor Capacity Positioning Completed Width Maximum Speed Limit Output Overload Warning Time Motor Protection Percentage Motor Protection Time Analog Speed Linear Filter (Moving Filter) 12800 rated speed 120 0 1 0 Ohm Watt pulse r/min % % 0.1 msec

msec

Reserved (Do Not Use) FRCL FRCT Friction Compensation Percentage Friction Compensation Smooth Constant 0 0 %

msec

Revision January 2011

8-5

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Basic Parameters
Parameter P1-64 ~ P1-65 P1-66 P1-67 P1-68 P1-69 ~ P1-71 P1-72 P1-73 P1-74 P1-75 P1-76 Name Function Default Unit Control Mode PT PR S Reserved (Do Not Use) Max. Rotation Number of Analog Position Command (will be available soon) Position Command Moving Filter 0.1 30
rotatio n

PCM

Reserved (Do Not Use) PFLT2 4 msec

Reserved (Do Not Use) FRES FERR FCON FELP AMSPD Full-closed Loop Resolution Full-closed Loop Excessive Position Error Range Full-closed Loop Control Function Selection Full-closed Loop Low-pass Filter Time Constant Max. Rotation Speed of Encoder Output 5000 30000 000h 100 5500 pulse/ rev pulse N/A

msec r/min

Explanation of symbols (marked after parameter) () () () () Read-only register. Parameter cannot be set when Servo On (when the servo drive is enabled). Parameter is effective only after the servo drive is restarted (after switching power off and on). Parameter setting values are not retained when power is off.

8-6

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Group 2: P2-xx

Extension Parameters
Parameter P2-00 P2-01 P2-02 P2-03 P2-04 P2-05 P2-06 P2-07 P2-08 P2-09 P2-10 P2-11 P2-12 P2-13 P2-14 P2-15 P2-16 P2-17 P2-18 P2-19 P2-20 P2-21 P2-22 P2-23 P2-24 P2-25 P2-26 P2-27 P2-28 Name KPP PPR PFG PFF KVP SPR KVI KVF PCTL DRT DI1 DI2 DI3 DI4 DI5 DI6 DI7 DI8 DO1 DO2 DO3 DO4 DO5 NCF DPH NLP DST GCC GUT Function Proportional Position Loop Gain Position Loop Gain Switching Rate Position Feed Forward Gain Smooth Constant of Position Feed Forward Gain Proportional Speed Loop Gain Speed Loop Gain Switching Rate Speed Integral Compensation Speed Feed Forward Gain Special Factory Setting Bounce Filter Digital Input Terminal 1 (DI1) Digital Input Terminal 2 (DI2) Digital Input Terminal 3 (DI3) Digital Input Terminal 4 (DI4) Digital Input Terminal 5 (DI5) Digital Input Terminal 6 (DI6) Digital Input Terminal 7 (DI7) Digital Input Terminal 8 (DI8) Digital Output Terminal 1 (DO1) Digital Output Terminal 2 (DO2) Digital Output Terminal 3 (DO3) Digital Output Terminal 4 (DO4) Digital Output Terminal 5 (DO5) Notch Filter 1 (Resonance Suppression) Notch Filter Attenuation Rate 1 (Resonance Suppression) Low-pass Filter Time Constant (Resonance Suppression) External Anti-Interference Gain Gain Switching Control Selection Gain Switching Time Constant Default 35 100 50 5 500 100 100 0 0 2 101 104 116 117 102 22 23 21 101 103 109 105 7 1000 0 2 or 5 0 0 10 Unit Control Mode PT PR S rad/s % % T

msec rad/s % % N/A 2ms N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A Hz dB rad/s

0.1ms 0.001 N/A


10mse c

Revision January 2011

8-7

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Extension Parameters
Parameter Name Function Default Unit Control Mode PT PR S P2-29 P2-30 P2-31 P2-32 P2-33 P2-34 P2-35 P2-36 P2-37 P2-38 P2-39 P2-40 P2-41 P2-42 P2-43 P2-44 P2-45 P2-46 P2-47 P2-48 P2-49 P2-50 P2-51 ~ P2-52 8-8 GPE INH AUT1 AUT2 INF SDEV PDEV EDI9 EDI10 EDI11 EDI12 EDI13 EDI14 Gain Switching Condition Auxiliary Function Speed Frequency Response Level in Auto and Semi-Auto Mode Tuning Mode Selection Semi-Auto Mode Inertia Adjustment Selection Overspeed Warning Condition Excessive Error Warning Condition External Digital Input Terminal 9 (EDI9) External Digital Input Terminal 10 (EDI10) External Digital Input Terminal 11 (EDI11) External Digital Input Terminal 12 (EDI12) External Digital Input Terminal 13 (EDI13) External Digital Input Terminal 14 (EDI14) Notch Filter 2 (Resonance Suppression) Notch Filter Attenuation Rate 2 (Resonance Suppression) Notch Filter 3 (Resonance Suppression) Notch Filter Attenuation Rate 3 (Resonance Suppression) Auto Resonance Suppression Mode Selection Auto Resonance Suppression Detection Level Speed Detection Filter and Jitter Suppression Pulse Deviation Clear Mode 1280000 0 80 0 0 5000 3840000 0 0 0 0 0 0 T

pulse Kpps r/min N/A Hz N/A N/A r/min pulse N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A

Reserved (Do Not Use) NCF2 DPH2 DOD FSN PED BLAS SJIT DCLR 1000 0 1000 0 1 100 0 0 Hz dB Hz dB N/A N/A sec N/A

Reserved (Do Not Use)

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Extension Parameters
Parameter P2-53 P2-54 ~ P2-59 P2-60 P2-61 P2-62 P2-63 ~ P2-64 P2-65 P2-66 P2-67 Name KPI Function Position Integral Compensation Default 0 Unit Control Mode PT PR S T

rad/s

Reserved (Do Not Use) GR4 GR5 GR6 Electronic Gear Ratio (2nd Numerator) (N2) Electronic Gear Ratio (3rd Numerator) (N3) Electronic Gear Ratio (4th Numerator) (N4) 128 128 128 pulse pulse pulse

Reserved (Do Not Use) GBIT GBIT2 JSL Special Function 1 Special Function 2 Stable Inertia Estimating Time 0 0 1.5 N/A N/A

0.1 times

Explanation of symbols (marked after parameter) () () () () Read-only register. Parameter cannot be set when Servo On (when the servo drive is enabled). Parameter is effective only after the servo drive is restarted (after switching power off and on). Parameter setting values are not retained when power is off.

Revision January 2011

8-9

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Group 3: P3-xx

Communication Parameters
Parameter P3-00 P3-01 P3-02 P3-03 P3-04 P3-05 P3-06 P3-07 P3-08 P3-09 P3-10 ~ P3-11 Name ADR BRT PTL FLT CWD CMM SDI CDT MNS SYC Function Communication Address Setting Transmission Speed Communication Protocol Transmission Fault Treatment Communication Time Out Detection Communication Selection Digital Input Communication Function Communication Response Delay Time Monitor Mode CANopen Synchronization Setting Default 0x7F 0x0203 6 0 0 0 0 0 0000 0x57A1 Unit N/A bps N/A N/A sec N/A N/A 1 ms N/A N/A Control Mode PT PR S T CANopen mode

Reserved (Do Not Use)

Explanation of symbols (marked after parameter) () () () () Read-only register. Parameter cannot be set when Servo On (when the servo drive is enabled). Parameter is effective only after the servo drive is restarted (after switching power off and on). Parameter setting values are not retained when power is off.

8-10

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Group 4: P4-xx

Diagnosis Parameters
Parameter P4-00 P4-01 P4-02 P4-03 P4-04 P4-05 P4-06 P4-07 P4-08 P4-09 P4-10 P4-11 P4-12 P4-13 P4-14 P4-15 P4-16 P4-17 P4-18 P4-19 P4-20 P4-21 P4-22 P4-23 P4-24 Name ASH1 ASH2 ASH3 ASH4 ASH5 JOG FOT ITST PKEY MOT CEN SOF1 SOF2 TOF1 TOF2 COF1 COF2 COF3 COF4 TIGB DOF1 DOF2 SAO TAO LVL Function Fault Record (N) Fault Record (N-1) Fault Record (N-2) Fault Record (N-3) Fault Record (N-4) JOG Operation Force Output Contact Control Input Status Digital Keypad Input of Servo Drive Output Status Adjustment Function Analog Speed Input Drift Adjustment 1 Analog Speed Input Drift Adjustment 2 Analog Torque Drift Adjustment 1 Analog Torque Drift Adjustment 2 Current Detector Drift Adjustment (V1 phase) Current Detector Drift Adjustment (V2 phase) Current Detector Drift Adjustment (W1 phase) Current Detector Drift Adjustment (W2 phase) IGBT NTC Calibration Analog Monitor Output Drift Adjustment (CH1) Analog Monitor Output Drift Adjustment (CH2) Analog Speed Input Offset Analog Torque Input Offset Undervoltage Error Level Default 0 0 0 0 0 20 0 0 N/A N/A 0 Factory setting Factory setting Factory setting Factory setting Factory setting Factory setting Factory setting Factory setting Factory setting 0 0 0 0 160 Unit N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A mV mV mV mV Control Mode PT PR S T

r/min

V(rms)

Revision January 2011

8-11

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Group 5: P5-xx

Motion Control Parameters


Parameter P5-00 ~ P5-02 P5-03 P5-04 P5-05 P5-06 P5-07 P5-08 P5-09 P5-10 P5-11 P5-12 P5-13 P5-14 P5-15 P5-16 P5-17 P5-18 P5-19 P5-20 ~ P5-33 P5-34 P5-35 P5-36 P5-37 P5-38 P5-39 8-12 Name Function Default Unit Control Mode PT PR S Reserved (Do Not Use) PDEC HMOV HSPD1 HSPD2 PRCM SWLP SWLN AYSZ AYID AYD0 AYD1 Deceleration Time of Protectin Function Homing Mode 1st Speed Setting of High Speed Homing 2nd Speed Setting of Low Speed Homing Trigger Position Command (PR mode only) Forward Software Limit Reverse Software Limit Data Array: Data Amount (N x 32 bits) Data Array: Read / Write Address Data Array: Read / Write Data Block 1 Data Array: Read / Write Data Block 2 PATH 1 ~ PATH 2 Data Not Retained Setting Axis Position: Motor Encoder Axis Position: Auxiliary Encoder (Pulse Command Feedback) Axis Position: Pulse Command E-Cam Curve Scaling Accel / Decel Time 0 ~ 13 Accel / Decel Time 14 Accel / Decel Time 15 CAPTURE: Start Address of Data Array CAPTURE: Axis Position CNT CAPTURE: Capture Amount CAPTURE: Capture Source Setting 0XE0EFEEFF 0 100.0 20.0 0 2147483647 -2147483648 N/A 0 0 0 N/A N/A T

0.1 r/min 0.1 r/min N/A PUU PUU N/A N/A N/A N/A

Reserved (Do Not Use) PMEM AXEN AXAU AXPC TBS AC0 ~ AC13 AC14 AC15 CAST CAAX CANO CACT 0x0 0 N/A N/A 1.000000 200 ~ 8000 50 30 0 0 1 0x2010 N/A PUU

pulse pulse
1/(10^ 6)

msec msec msec N/A N/A N/A N/A

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Motion Control Parameters


Parameter P5-40 ~ P5-55 P5-56 P5-57 P5-58 P5-59 P5-60 ~ P5-75 P5-76 P5-77 P5-78 P5-79 P5-80 P5-81 P5-82 P5-83 P5-84 P5-85 P5-86 P5-87 P5-88 P5-89 P5-90 P5-91 P5-92 P5-93 P5-94 Name DLY0 ~ DLY15 CMST CMAX CMNO CMCT POV0 ~ POV15 CPRS CSAX CSDS CSDS CSDS ECHD ECMN ECMM ECMP ECME ECAX PLED ECON ECRD CMAP CMAN PLED CSDS CSDS Function Default Unit Control Mode PT PR S Delay Time 0 ~ 15 COMPARE: Start Address of Data Array COMPARE: Axis Position COMPARE: Compare Amount COMPARE: Compare Source Setting Moving Speed Setting of Position 0 ~ 15 Capture 1st Position Reset Data Position of CAPTURE SYNC AXIS Interval Pulse Number of CAPTURE SYNC AXIS Error Pulse Number of CAPTURE SYNC AXIS Max. Correction Rate of CAPTURE SYNC AXIS E-Cam: Start Address of Data Array E-Cam: E-Cam Area Number N (at least >=5) E-Cam: E-Cam Cycle Number (M) E-Cam: Pulse Number of Master Axis (P) E-Cam: Engage Area Number E-Cam: Position of Master Axis E-Cam: Lead Command Length E-Cam: E-Cam Setting E-Cam: Disengage Timing Data E-Cam: Area Number + (Polarity is Positive) E-Cam: Area Number - (Polarity is Negative) E-Cam: Cyclic Lead Command Length Motion Control: Macro Parameter 4 Motion Control: Macro Parameter 3 0 ~ 5500 0 0 1 00640010h 20.0 ~ 3000.0 0 0 100 0 10 100 5 1 3600 0 0 0 00000000h 0 0 0 0 0 0 msec N/A N/A N/A N/A 0.1 r/min N/A N/A T

pulse pulse % N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A

Revision January 2011

8-13

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Motion Control Parameters


Parameter Name Function Motion Control: Macro Parameter 2 Motion Control: Macro Parameter 1 Motion Control: Macro Command Event Rising-edge Trigger Command (OFF ON) Event Falling-edge Trigger Command (ON OFF) Default Unit Control Mode PT PR S P5-95 P5-96 P5-97 P5-98 CSDS CSDS CSDS EVON 0 0 100 0 N/A N/A T

pulse N/A

P5-99

EVOF

N/A

Explanation of symbols (marked after parameter) () () () () Read-only register. Parameter cannot be set when Servo On (when the servo drive is enabled). Parameter is effective only after the servo drive is restarted (after switching power off and on). Parameter setting values are not retained when power is off.

8-14

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Group 6: P6-xx

PR Path Definition Parameters


Parameter P6-00 P6-01 P6-02 ~ P6-98 P6-03 ~ P6-99 Name PDEC ODAT Function Homing Definition Homing Definition Value Default 0x00000000 0 0x00000000 0 Unit N/A N/A N/A N/A Control Mode PT PR S T

PDEF1 ~ Definition of Path 1 ~ 49 PDEF49 PDAT1 ~ Data of Path 1 ~ 49 PDEF49

Explanation of symbols (marked after parameter) () () () () Read-only register. Parameter cannot be set when Servo On (when the servo drive is enabled). Parameter is effective only after the servo drive is restarted (after switching power off and on). Parameter setting values are not retained when power is off.

Revision January 2011

8-15

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Group 7: P7-xx

PR Path Definition Parameters


Parameter Name PDEF50 ~ PDEF63 Function Default Unit Control Mode PT PR S P7-00 ~ P7-26 P7-01 ~ P7-27 Definition of Path 50 ~ 63 0x00000000 N/A T

PDAT50 ~ Data of Path 50 ~ 49 PDEF63

N/A

Explanation of symbols (marked after parameter) () () () () Read-only register. Parameter cannot be set when Servo On (when the servo drive is enabled). Parameter is effective only after the servo drive is restarted (after switching power off and on). Parameter setting values are not retained when power is off.

8-16

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

8.2.2 Parameters List by Function


Monitor and General Use
Parameter P0-00 P0-01 P0-02 P0-03 P0-08 P0-09 P0-10 P0-11 P0-12 P0-13 P0-17 P0-18 P0-19 P0-20 P0-21 P0-25 P0-26 P0-27 P0-28 P0-29 P0-30 P0-31 P0-32 P0-35 P0-36 P0-37 P0-38 Name VER
2

Function Firmware Version Drive Fault Code Drive Status (Front Panel Display) Analog Monitor Output Servo Startup Time Status Monitor 1 Status Monitor 2 Status Monitor 3 Status Monitor 4 Status Monitor 5 Status Monitor Selection 1 Status Monitor Selection 2 Status Monitor Selection 3 Status Monitor Selection 4 Status Monitor Selection 5 Mapping Parameter 1 Mapping Parameter 2 Mapping Parameter 3 Mapping Parameter 4 Mapping Parameter 5 Mapping Parameter 6 Mapping Parameter 7 Mapping Parameter 8 Block Data Read / Write Register 1 (for P0-25) Block Data Read / Write Register 2 (for P0-26) Block Data Read / Write Register 3 (for P0-27) Block Data Read / Write Register 4 (for P0-28)

Default Factory Setting N/A 00 01 0 N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A 0 0 0 0 0 N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A 0x0 0x0 0x0 0x0

Unit N/A N/A N/A N/A Hour N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A

Control Mode PT PR O O O O O O O O S O O O O T O O O O

Related Section 11.1 11.2 11.3 7.2 4.3.5 -

ALE STS MON TSON CM1 CM2 CM3 CM4 CM5 CM1A CM2A CM3A CM4A CM5A MAP1 MAP2 MAP3 MAP4 MAP5 MAP6 MAP7 MAP8 MAP1A MAP2A MAP3A MAP4A

O O O O O

O O O O O

O O O O O

O O O O O

4.3.5 4.3.5 4.3.5 4.3.5 4.3.5 -

O O O O O O O O O O O O

O O O O O O O O O O O O

O O O O O O O O O O O O

O O O O O O O O O O O O

4.3.5 4.3.5 4.3.5 4.3.5 4.3.5 4.3.5 4.3.5 4.3.5 4.3.5 4.3.5 4.3.5 4.3.5

Revision January 2011

8-17

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Monitor and General Use


Parameter P0-39 P0-40 P0-41 P0-42 P0-46 P1-04 P1-05 Name MAP5A MAP6A MAP7A MAP8A SVSTS MON1 MON2 Function Block Data Read / Write Register 5 (for P0-29) Block Data Read / Write Register 6 (for P0-30) Block Data Read / Write Register 7 (for P0-31) Block Data Read / Write Register 8 (for P0-32) Servo Output Status Display Analog Monitor Output Proportion 1 (CH1) Analog Monitor Output Proportion 2 (CH2) Default 0x0 0x0 0x0 0x0 0 100 100 Unit N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A % (full scale) % (full scale) Control Mode PT PR O O O O O O O O O O O O O O S O O O O O O O T O O O O O O O Related Section 4.3.5 4.3.5 4.3.5 4.3.5 6.4.4 6.4.4

Explanation of symbols (marked after parameter) () () () () Read-only register. Parameter cannot be set when Servo On (when the servo drive is enabled). Parameter is effective only after the servo drive is restarted (after switching power off and on). Parameter setting values are not retained when power is off.

8-18

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Smooth Filter and Resonance Suppression


Parameter Name Function Accel / Decel Smooth Constant of Analog Speed Command (Low-pass Filter) Smooth Constant of Analog Torque Command (Low-pass Filter) Smooth Constant of Position Command (Low-pass Filter) Low-frequency Vibration Suppression (1) Low-frequency Vibration Suppression Gain (1) Low-frequency Vibration Suppression (2) Low-frequency Vibration Suppression Gain (2) Auto Low-frequency Vibration Suppression Mode Selection Low-frequency Vibration Detection Level Acceleration Time Deceleration Time Accel /Decel S-curve Analog Speed Linear Filter (Moving Filter) Friction Compensation Percentage Friction Compensation Smooth Constant Position Command Moving Filter Full-closed Loop Low-pass Filter Time Constant Notch Filter 1 (Resonance Suppression) Notch Filter Attenuation Rate 1 (Resonance Suppression) Notch Filter 2 (Resonance Suppression) Notch Filter Attenuation Rate 2 (Resonance Suppression) Default Unit Control Mode PT PR S O T Related Section 6.3.3

P1-06

SFLT

msec

P1-07 P1-08 P1-25 P1-26 P1-27 P1-28 P1-29 P1-30 P1-34 P1-35 P1-36 P1-59 P1-62 P1-63 P1-68 P1-75 P2-23 P2-24 P2-43 P2-44

TFLT PFLT VSF1 VSG1 VSF2 VSG2 AVSM VCL TACC TDEC TSL MFLT FRCL FRCT PFLT2 FELP NCF1 DPH1 NCF2 DPH2

0 0 100.0 0 100.0 0 0 500 200 200 0 0 0 0 0 100 1000 0 1000 0

msec 10 msec 0.1Hz N/A 0.1Hz N/A N/A pulse msec msec msec 0.1ms % ms ms msec Hz dB Hz dB O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O

6.4.3 6.2.6 6.2.9 6.2.9 6.2.9 6.2.9 6.2.9 6.2.9 6.3.3 6.3.3 6.3.3 -

O O

O O O O

6.3.7 6.3.7 6.3.7 6.3.7

Revision January 2011

8-19

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Smooth Filter and Resonance Suppression


Parameter P2-45 P2-46 P2-47 P2-48 P2-25 P2-33 P2-49 Name NCF3 DPH3 ANCF ANCL NLP INF SJIT Function Notch Filter 3 (Resonance Suppression) Notch Filter Attenuation Rate 3 (Resonance Suppression) Auto Resonance Suppression Mode Selection Auto Resonance Suppression Detection Level Low-pass Filter Time Constant (Resonance Suppression) Semi-Auto Mode Inertia Adjustment Selection Speed Detection Filter and Jitter Suppression Default 1000 0 1 100 2 or 5 0 0 Unit Hz dB N/A N/A msec N/A sec Control Mode PT PR O O O O O O O O O O O O O O S O O O O O O O T O O O O O O O Related Section 6.3.7 6.3.7 6.3.7 6.3.6 -

Explanation of symbols (marked after parameter) () () () () Read-only register. Parameter cannot be set when Servo On (when the servo drive is enabled). Parameter is effective only after the servo drive is restarted (after switching power off and on). Parameter setting values are not retained when power is off.

8-20

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Gain and Switch


Parameter P2-00 P2-01 P2-02 P2-03 P2-04 P2-05 P2-06 P2-07 P2-26 P2-27 P2-28 P2-29 Name KPP PPR PFG PFF KVP SPR KVI KVF DST GCC GUT GPE Function Proportional Position Loop Gain Position Loop Gain Switching Rate Position Feed Forward Gain Smooth Constant of Position Feed Forward Gain Proportional Speed Loop Gain Speed Loop Gain Switching Rate Speed Integral Compensation Speed Feed Forward Gain External Anti-Interference Gain Gain Switching Control Selection Gain Switching Time Constant Gain Switching Condition Speed Frequency Response Level in Auto and Semi-Auto Mode Speed Frequency Response Level in Auto and Semi-Auto Mode Default 35 100 50 5 500 100 100 0 0 0 10
1280000

Unit rad/s % % msec rad/s % rad/s % 0.001 N/A 10 msec pulse Kpps r/min Hz

Control Mode PT PR O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O S T

Related Section 6.2.8 6.2.8 6.2.8 6.3.6 6.3.6 6.3.6 5.6 6.3.6 5.6 6.3.6

P2-31

AUT1

80

P2-32

AUT2

N/A

Explanation of symbols (marked after parameter) () () () () Read-only register. Parameter cannot be set when Servo On (when the servo drive is enabled). Parameter is effective only after the servo drive is restarted (after switching power off and on). Parameter setting values are not retained when power is off.

Revision January 2011

8-21

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Position Control
Parameter Name Function Control Mode and Output Direction Speed and Torque Limit 1st ~ 3rd Torque Limit Encoder Output Pulse Number Maximum Speed Limit Full-closed Loop Resolution Full-closed Loop Excessive Position Error Range Full-closed Loop Control Function Selection Pulse Deviation Clear Mode Default Unit pulse r/min N-M N/A % pulse r/min Control Mode PT PR O O O O O O O O O O O O O O S O O O O O T O O O O O Related Section 6.1 6.6 6.4.1 -

P1-01 P1-02 P1-12 ~ P1-14 P1-46 P1-55 P1-72 P1-73 P1-74 P2-50

CTL PSTL TQ1 ~ 3 GR3 MSPD FRES FERR FCON DCLR

0 0 100 2500 rated 5000 30000 000h 0

Pulse/ O rev pulse N/A O O O

External Pulse Control Command (PT mode) P1-00 P1-44 P1-45 P2-60 P2-61 P2-62 PTT GR1 GR2 GR4 GR5 GR6 External Pulse Input Type Electronic Gear Ratio (1st Numerator) (N1) Electronic Gear Ratio (Denominator) (M) Electronic Gear Ratio (2nd Numerator) (N2) Electronic Gear Ratio (3rd Numerator) (N3) Electronic Gear Ratio (4th Numerator) (N4) 0x2 1 1 1 1 1 N/A pulse pulse pulse pulse pulse O O O O O O O O O O O 6.2.1 6.2.5 6.3.6 -

Internal Pulse Control Command (PR mode) P6-02 ~ P7-27 P5-60 ~ P5-75 P5-03 P5-04 P5-05 P5-06 P5-07 PO1 ~ PO63 POV1 ~ POV15 PDEC HMOV HSPD1 HSPD2 PRCM Definition of Path 1 ~ 63 Data of Path 1 ~ 63 Moving Speed Setting of Position 0 ~ 15 Deceleration Time of Protectin Function Homing Mode 1st Speed Setting of High Speed Homing 2nd Speed Setting of Low Speed Homing Trigger Position Command (PR mode only) 0 20 ~ 3000 0XF00F FFFF 0 100 20 0 N/A 0.1 r/min N/A N/A 0.1 r/min 0.1 r/min N/A O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O 7.10 7.10 -

8-22

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Position Control
Parameter P5-20 ~ P5-35 P5-40 ~ P5-55 P5-98 Name AC0 ~ AC15 DLY0 ~ DLY15 EVON Function Accel / Decel Time 0 ~ 13 Delay Time 0 ~ 15 Event Rising-edge Trigger Command (OFF ON) P5-99 EVOF Event Falling-edge Trigger Command (ON OFF) P5-15 P5-16 P5-17 P5-18 P5-08 P5-09 PMEM AXEN AXAU AXPC SWLP SWLN PATH 1 ~ PATH 2 Data Not Retained Setting Axis Position: Motor Encoder Axis Position: Auxiliary Encoder (Pulse Command Feedback) Axis Position: Pulse Command Forward Software Limit Reverse Software Limit 0x0 N/A N/A N/A +231 -231 N/A N/A N/A N/A PUU PUU O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O 7.3 7.3 7.3 0 N/A O Default Unit 200 ~ 30 0~ 5500 0 ms ms Control Mode PT PR O O S T Related Section 7.10 7.10

N/A

Explanation of symbols (marked after parameter) () () () () Read-only register. Parameter cannot be set when Servo On (when the servo drive is enabled). Parameter is effective only after the servo drive is restarted (after switching power off and on). Parameter setting values are not retained when power is off.

Revision January 2011

8-23

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Speed Control
Parameter Name Function Control Mode and Output Direction Speed and Torque Limit Encoder Output Pulse Number Maximum Speed Limit Default Unit pulse r/min N-M N/A pulse r/min 0.1 r/min % r/min % r/min O O O O O O Control Mode PT PR O O O O O O O O S O O O O O O O O O T O O O O O O O O O Related Section 6.1 6.6 6.3.1 6.6.2 6.3.4 -

P1-01 P1-02 P1-46 P1-55 P1-09 ~ P1-11 P1-12 ~ P1-14 P1-40 P1-41 P1-76

CTL PSTL GR3 MSPD

0 0 1 rated 1000 ~ 3000 100 rated 100 5500

SP1 ~ 3 1st ~ 3rd Speed Command TQ1 ~ 3 1st ~ 3rd Torque Limit VCM TCM AMSPD Max. Analog Speed Command or Limit Max. Analog Torque Command or Limit Max. Rotation Speed of Encoder Output

Explanation of symbols (marked after parameter) () () () () Read-only register. Parameter cannot be set when Servo On (when the servo drive is enabled). Parameter is effective only after the servo drive is restarted (after switching power off and on). Parameter setting values are not retained when power is off.

8-24

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Torque Control
Parameter Name Function Control Mode and Output Direction Speed and Torque Limit Encoder Output Pulse Number Maximum Speed Limit 1st ~ 3rd Speed Limit Default Unit pulse r/min N-M N/A pulse r/min r/min Control Mode PT PR O O O O O O O O S O O O O O T O O O O O Related Section 6.1 6.6 6.6.1

P1-01 P1-02 P1-46 P1-55 P1-09 ~ P1-11 P1-12 ~ P1-14 P1-40 P1-41

CTL PSTL GR3 MSPD SP1~3

0 0 1 rated 100 ~ 300 100 rated 100

TQ1~3 VCM TCM

1st ~ 3rd Torque Command Max. Analog Speed Command or Limit Max. Analog Torque Command or Limit

% r/min %

O O

O O O

6.4.1 6.4.4

Explanation of symbols (marked after parameter) () () () () Read-only register. Parameter cannot be set when Servo On (when the servo drive is enabled). Parameter is effective only after the servo drive is restarted (after switching power off and on). Parameter setting values are not retained when power is off.

Revision January 2011

8-25

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Digital I/O and Relative Input Output Setting


Parameter P2-09 P2-10 P2-11 P2-12 P2-13 P2-14 P2-15 P2-16 P2-17 P2-36 P2-37 P2-38 P2-39 P2-40 P2-41 P2-18 P2-19 P2-20 P2-21 P2-22 P1-38 P1-39 P1-42 Name DRT DI1 DI2 DI3 DI4 DI5 DI6 DI7 DI8 EDI9 EDI10 EDI11 EDI12 EDI13 EDI14 DO1 DO2 DO3 DO4 DO5 ZSPD SSPD MBT1 Function Bounce Filter Digital Input Terminal 1 (DI1) Digital Input Terminal 2 (DI2) Digital Input Terminal 3 (DI3) Digital Input Terminal 4 (DI4) Digital Input Terminal 5 (DI5) Digital Input Terminal 6 (DI6) Digital Input Terminal 7 (DI7) Digital Input Terminal 8 (DI8) External Digital Input Terminal 9 (EDI9) External Digital Input Terminal 10 (EDI10) External Digital Input Terminal 11 (EDI11) External Digital Input Terminal 12 (EDI12) External Digital Input Terminal 13 (EDI13) External Digital Input Terminal 14 (EDI14) Digital Output Terminal 1 (DO1) Digital Output Terminal 2 (DO2) Digital Output Terminal 3 (DO3) Digital Output Terminal 4 (DO4) Digital Output Terminal 5 (DO5) Zero Speed Range Setting Target Motor Speed On Delay Time of Electromagnetic Brake Default 2 101 104 116 117 102 22 23 21 0 0 0 0 0 0 101 103 109 105 7 100 3000 0 Unit Control Mode PT PR O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O S O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O T O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O Related Section Table 8.A Table 8.A Table 8.A Table 8.A Table 8.A Table 8.A Table 8.A Table 8.A Table 8.A Table 8.A Table 8.A Table 8.A Table 8.A Table 8.A Table 8.B Table 8.B Table 8.B Table 8.B Table 8.B Table 8.B Table 8.B 6.5.5

2msec O N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A 0.1 r/min r/min ms O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O

8-26

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Digital I/O and Relative Input Output Setting


Parameter P1-43 P1-47 P1-54 P1-56 Name MBT2 SCPD PER OVW Function OFF Delay Time of Electromagnetic Brake Speed Reached Output Range Positioning Completed Width Output Overload Warning Time Default 0 10 12800 120 Unit ms r/min pulse % O O O O O O Control Mode PT PR O O S O O T O Related Section 6.5.5 Table 8.B Table 8.B Table 8.B

Communication
Parameter P3-00 P3-01 P3-02 P3-03 P3-04 P3-05 P3-06 P3-07 P3-08 P3-09 Name ADR BRT PTL FLT CWD CMM SDI CDT MNS SYC Function Communication Address Setting Transmission Speed Communication Protocol Transmission Fault Treatment Communication Time Out Detection Communication Selection Digital Input Communication Function Communication Response Delay Time Monitor Mode CANopen Setting Synchronization Default Unit 0x7F 0x0203 6 0 0 0 0 0 0000 0x57A1 N/A bps N/A N/A sec N/A N/A 1ms N/A N/A Control Mode PT PR O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O S O O O O O O O O O O T O O O O O O O O O O Related Section 9.2 9.2 9.2 9.2 9.2 9.2 9.2 9.2 9.2 9.2

Explanation of symbols (marked after parameter) () () () () Read-only register. Parameter cannot be set when Servo On (when the servo drive is enabled). Parameter is effective only after the servo drive is restarted (after switching power off and on). Parameter setting values are not retained when power is off.

Revision January 2011

8-27

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Diagnosis
Parameter P4-00 P4-01 P4-02 P4-03 P4-04 P4-05 P4-06 P4-07 P4-08 P4-09 P4-10 P4-11 P4-12 P4-13 P4-14 P4-15 P4-16 P4-17 P4-18 P4-19 P4-20 P4-21 P4-22 P4-23 P4-24 Name ASH1 ASH2 ASH3 ASH4 ASH5 JOG FOT ITST PKEY MOT CEN SOF1 SOF2 TOF1 TOF2 COF1 COF2 COF3 COF4 TIGB DOF1 DOF2 SAO TAO LVL Function Fault Record (N) Fault Record (N-1) Fault Record (N-2) Fault Record (N-3) Fault Record (N-4) JOG Operation Force Output Contact Control Input Status Digital Keypad Input of Servo Drive Output Status Adjustment Function Analog Speed Input Drift Adjustment 1 Analog Speed Input Drift Adjustment 2 Analog Torque Drift Adjustment 1 Analog Torque Drift Adjustment 2 Current Detector Drift Adjustment (V1 phase) Current Detector Drift Adjustment (V2 phase) Current Detector Drift Adjustment (W1 phase) Current Detector Drift Adjustment (W2 phase) IGBT NTC Calibration Analog Monitor Output Drift Adjustment (CH1) Analog Monitor Output Drift Adjustment (CH2) Analog Speed Input Offset Analog Torque Input Offset Undervoltage Error Level Default 0 0 0 0 0 20 0 0 N/A N/A 0 Factory Setting Factory Setting Factory Setting Factory Setting Factory Setting Factory Setting Factory Setting Factory Setting Factory Setting 0 0 0 0 160 Unit N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A r/min N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A mV mV mV mV V(rms) O O O Control Mode PT PR O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O S O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O T O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O Related Section 4.4.1 4.4.1 4.4.1 4.4.1 4.4.1 4.4.2 4.4.4 4.4.5 9.2 4.4.6 6.4.4 6.4.4 -

8-28

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

E-Cam Function
Parameter P5-81 P5-82 P5-83 P5-84 P5-85 P5-86 P5-87 P5-88 P5-89 P5-90 P5-91 P5-92 Name ECHD ECMN ECMM ECMP ECME ECAX PLED ECON ECRD CMAP CMAN PLED Function E-Cam: Start Address of Data Array E-Cam: E-Cam Area Number N (at least >=5) E-Cam: E-Cam Cycle Number (M) E-Cam: Pulse Number of Master Axis (P) E-Cam: Engage Area Number E-Cam: Position of Master Axis E-Cam: Lead Command Length E-Cam: E-Cam Setting E-Cam: Disengage Timing Data E-Cam: Area Number + (Polarity is Positive) E-Cam: Area Number - (Polarity is Negative) E-Cam: Cyclic Lead Command Length Default 100 5 1 3600 0 0 0 000000 00h 0 0 0 0 Unit N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A Control Mode PT PR O O O O O O O O O O O O O S O T O Related Section 7.10 7.10 7.10 7.10 7.10 7.10 7.10 7.10 7.10 7.10 7.10 7.10

Explanation of symbols (marked after parameter) () () () () Read-only register. Parameter cannot be set when Servo On (when the servo drive is enabled). Parameter is effective only after the servo drive is restarted (after switching power off and on). Parameter setting values are not retained when power is off.

Revision January 2011

8-29

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

8.3 Detailed Parameter Listings


Group 0: P0-xx Monitor Parameters P0 - 00 VER Firmware Version Address: 0000H, 0001H Related Section: N/A

Default: Factory setting Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: N/A Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

P0 - 01 ALE

Drive Fault Code

Address: 0002H, 0003H Related Section: Chapter 11

Default: N/A Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 001 ~ 380 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: BCD Settings:

This parameter shows the current servo drive fault if the servo drive is currently faulted. The fault code is hexadecimal data but displayed in BCD format (Binary coded decimal). Servo Drive Fault Codes: 001: Overcurrent 002: Overvoltage 003: Undervoltage (This fault code shows when main circuit voltage is below its minimum specified value while Servo On, and it will not show while Servo Off. This fault code cant be cleared automatically after the voltage has returned within its specification. Please refer to parameter P2-66.) 004: Motor error (The drive and motor are not correctly matched for size (power rating). 005: Regeneration error 006: Overload 007: Overspeed 008: Abnormal pulse control command 009: Excessive deviation 010: Reserved 011: Encoder error (The wiring of the encoder is in error and this causes the communication error between the servo drive and the encoder.) 012: Adjustment error 8-30
Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

013: Emergency stop activated 014: Reverse limit switch error 015: Forward limit switch error 016: IGBT temperature error 017: Memory error 018: Encoder output error 019: Serial communication error 020: Serial communication time out 021: Reserved 022: Input power phase loss 023: Pre-overload warning 024: Encoder initial magnetic field error 025: Encoder internal error 026: Encoder data error 030: Motor protection error 031: U, V, W wiring error 040: Full-closed loop excessive deviation 099: DSP firmware upgrade CANopen Communication Fault Codes 185: CANbus error 111: CANopen SDO receive buffer overrun 112: CANopen PDO receive buffer overrun 121: Index error occurs when accessing CANopen PDO object. 122: Sub-index error occurs when accessing CANopen PDO object. 123: Data type (size) error occurs when accessing CANopen PDO object. 124: Data range error occurs when accessing CANopen PDO object. 125: CANopen PDO object is read-only and write-protected. 126: CANopen PDO object does not support PDO. 127: CANopen PDO object is write-protected when Servo On. 128: Error occurs when reading CANopen PDO object from EE-PROM. 129: Error occurs when writing CANopen PDO object into EE-PROM. 130: EE-PROM invalid address range 131: EE-PROM checksum error 132: Password error Motion Control Fault Codes: 201: CANopen data initial error 213: Write parameter error: exceeds the limit of normal range 215: Write parameter error: read only
Revision January 2011

8-31

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

217: Write parameter error: parameter lock 219: Write parameter error: parameter lock 235: PR command overflow 245: PR positioning time out 249: Invalid PR path number 261: Index error occurs when accessing CANopen object. 263: Sub-index error occurs when accessing CANopen object. 265: Data type (size) error occurs when accessing CANopen object. 267: Data range error occurs when accessing CANopen object. 269: CANopen object is read-only and write-protected. 26b: CANopen object does not support PDO. 26d: CANopen object is write-protected when Servo On. 26F: Error occurs when reading CANopen object from EE-PROM. 271: Error occurs when writing CANopen object into EE-PROM. 273: EE-PROM invalid address range 275: EE-PROM checksum error 277: Password error 283: Forward software limit 285: Reverse software limit 289: Position counter overflow 291: Servo Off error 301: CANopen SYNC failed 302: CANopen SYNC signal error 303: CANopen SYNC time out 304: CANopen IP command failed 305: SYNC period error 380: Position deviation alarm for digital output, MC_OK (Please refer to P1-48.) P0 - 02 STS Drive Status (Front Panel Display) Address: 0004H, 0005H Related Section: Section 4.3.5, Section 7.2

Default: 00 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 00 ~ 127 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: This parameter shows the servo drive status.

00: Motor feedback pulse number (after electronic gear ratio is set) [user unit] 8-32
Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

01: Input pulse number of pulse command (after electronic gear ratio is set) [user unit] 02: Position error counts between control command pulse and feedback pulse [user unit] 03: Motor feedback pulse number (encoder unit, 1280000 pulse/rev) [pulse] 04: Input pulse number of pulse command (before electronic gear ratio is set) [pulse] 05: Position error counts [pulse] 06: Input frequency of pulse command [Kpps] 07: Motor rotation speed [r/min] 08: Speed input command [Volt] 09: Speed input command [r/min] 10: Torque input command [Volt] 11: Torque input command [%] 12: Average load [%] 13: Peak load [%] 14: Main circuit voltage [Volt] 15: Ratio of load inertia to Motor inertia [0.1times] 16: IGBT temperature 17: Resonance frequency [Hz] 18: Absolute pulse number relative to encoder (use Z phase as home). The value of Z phase home point is 0, and it can be the value from -5000 to +5000 pulses.

19: Mapping Parameter 1: Display the content of parameter P0-25 (mapping target is specified by parameter P0-35) 20: Mapping Parameter 2: Display the content of parameter P0-26 (mapping target is specified by parameter P0-36) 21: Mapping Parameter 3: Display the content of parameter P0-27 (mapping target is specified by parameter P0-37) 22: Mapping Parameter 4: Display the content of parameter P0-28 (mapping target is specified by parameter P0-38) 23: Status Monitor 1: Display the content of parameter P0-09 (the monitor status is specified by parameter P0-17) 24: Status Monitor 2: Display the content of parameter P0-10 (the monitor status is specified by parameter P0-18) 25: Status Monitor 3: Display the content of parameter P0-11 (the monitor status is specified by parameter P0-19) 26: Status Monitor 4: Display the content of parameter P0-12 (the monitor status is specified by parameter P0-20)

Revision January 2011

8-33

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P0 - 03

MON

Analog Monitor Output

Address: 0006H, 0007H Related Section: Section 4.3.5

Default: 01 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 00 ~ 77 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings:

This parameter determines the functions of the analog monitor outputs.

XY: (X: CH1; Y: CH2) 0: Motor speed (+/-8V / maximum motor speed) 1: Motor torque (+/-8V / maximum torque) 2: Pulse command frequency (+8Volts / 4.5Mpps) 3: Speed command (+/-8Volts / maximum speed command) 4: Torque command (+/-8Volts / maximum torque command) 5: V_BUS voltage (+/-8Volts / 450V) 6: Reserved 7: Reserved Please note: For the setting of analog output voltage proportion, refer to the P1-04 and P1-05. Example: P0-03 = 01(CH1 is speed analog output) Motor speed = (Max. motor speed V1/8) P1-04/100, when the output voltage value of CH1 is V1.

P0 - 04 Reserved (Do Not Use) P0 - 05 Reserved (Do Not Use) P0 - 06 Reserved (Do Not Use) P0 - 07 Reserved (Do Not Use)

8-34

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P0 - 08 TSON

Servo Startup Time

Address: 0010H, 0011H Related Section: N/A

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: Hour Range: 0 ~ 65535 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

P0 - 09 CM1

Status Monitor 1

Address: 0012H, 0013H Related Section: Section 4.3.5

Default: N/A Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: N/A Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to provide the value of one of the status monitoring functions found in P0-02. The value of P0-09 is determined by P0-17 (desired drive status) through communication setting or the keypad. The drive status can be read from the communication address of this parameter via communication port. For example: Set P0-17 to 3, then all consequent reads of P0-09 will return the motor feedback pulse number in pulse. When reading the drive status through Modbus communication, the system should read two 16-bit data stored in the addresses of 0012H and 0013H to form a 32-bit data. (0013H : 0012H) = (High Word : Low Word) When reading the drive ststus through the keypad, if P0-02 is set to 23, VAR-1 will quickly show for about two seconds and then the value of P0-09 will display on the display.

P0 - 10 CM2

Status Monitor 2

Address: 0014H, 0015H Related Section: Section 4.3.5

Default: N/A Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: N/A Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal

Revision January 2011

8-35

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Settings: This parameter is used to provide the value of one of the status monitoring functions found in P0-02. The value of P0-10 is determined by P0-18 (desired drive status) through communication setting or the keypad. The drive status can be read from the communication address of this parameter via communication port. When reading the drive status through the keypad, if P0-02 is set to 24, VAR-2 will quickly show for about two seconds and then the value of P0-10 will display on the display.

P0 - 11 CM3

Status Monitor 3

Address: 0016H, 0017H Related Section: Section 4.3.5

Default: N/A Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: N/A Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to provide the value of one of the status monitoring functions found in P0-02. The value of P0-11 is determined by P0-19 (desired drive status) through communication setting or the keypad. The drive status can be read from the communication address of this parameter via communication port. When reading the drive status through the keypad, if P0-02 is set to 25, VAR-3 will quickly show for about two seconds and then the value of P0-11 will display on the display.

P0 - 12 CM4

Status Monitor 4

Address: 0018H, 0019H Related Section: Section 4.3.5

Default: N/A Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: N/A Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to provide the value of one of the status monitoring functions found in P0-02. The value of P0-12 is determined by P0-20 (desired drive status) through communication setting or the keypad. The drive status can be read from the communication address of this parameter via communication port. When reading the drive status through the keypad, if P0-02 is set to 26, VAR-4 will quickly show for about two seconds and then the value of P0-12 will display on the display. 8-36
Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P0 - 13 CM5

Status Monitor 5

Address: 001AH, 001BH Related Section: Section 4.3.5

Default: N/A Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: N/A Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to provide the value of one of the status monitoring functions found in P0-02. The value of P0-12 is determined by P0-20 (desired drive status) through communication setting or the keypad. The drive status can be read from the communication address of this parameter via communication port.

P0 - 14 P0 - 15 P0 - 16

Reserved (Do Not Use) Reserved (Do Not Use) Reserved (Do Not Use)

P0 - 17

CM1A

Status Monitor Selection 1

Address: 0022H, 0023H Related Section: N/A

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 127 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to determine the drive status found in P0-02. The selected drive status will be displayed by P0-09. For example: Set P0-17 to 7, then all consequent reads of P0-09 will return the motor rotation speed in r/min.

Revision January 2011

8-37

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P0 - 18

CM2A

Status Monitor Selection 2

Address: 0024H, 0025H Related Section: N/A

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 127 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to determine the drive status found in P0-02. The selected drive status will be displayed by P0-10. Refer to P0-17 for explanation.

P0 - 19

CM3A

Status Monitor Selection 3

Address: 0026H, 0027H Related Section: N/A

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 127 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to determine the drive status found in P0-02. The selected drive status will be displayed by P0-11. Refer to P0-17 for explanation.

P0 - 20

CM4A

Status Monitor Selection 4

Address: 0028H, 0029H Related Section: N/A

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 127 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to determine the drive status found in P0-02. The selected drive status will be displayed by P0-12. Refer to P0-17 for explanation.

8-38

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P0 - 21

CM5A

Status Monitor Selection 5

Address: 002AH, 002BH Related Section: N/A

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 127 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to determine the drive status found in P0-02. The selected drive status will be displayed by P0-13. Refer to P0-17 for explanation.

P0 - 22 P0 - 23 P0 - 24

Reserved (Do Not Use) Reserved (Do Not Use) Reserved (Do Not Use)

P0 - 25

MAP1

Mapping Parameter 1

Address: 0032H, 0033H Related Section: Section 4.3.5

Default: N/A Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: determined by the parameter specified by P0-35 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings:

The parameters from P0-25 to P0-32 are used to read and write the values of the parameters those communication addresses are not consecutive. The users can set P035 ~ P0-42 as the desired read and write mapping parameter numbers through communication setting or the keypad. When reading or writing P0-25 ~ P0-32, the read or write values are equivalent to the values of the parameters specified by P0-35 ~ P042, and vise versa. Refer to P0-35 for explanation.

Revision January 2011

8-39

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P0 - 26

MAP2

Mapping Parameter 2

Address: 0034H, 0035H Related Section: Section 4.3.5

Default: N/A Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: determined by the parameter specified by P0-36 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings: Refer to P0-25 and P0-36 for explanation.

P0 - 27

MAP3

Mapping Parameter 3

Address: 0036H, 0037H Related Section: Section 4.3.5

Default: N/A Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: determined by the parameter specified by P0-37 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings: Refer to to P0-25 and P0-37 for explanation.

P0 - 28

MAP4

Mapping Parameter 4

Address: 0038H, 0039H Related Section: Section 4.3.5

Default: N/A Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: determined by the parameter specified by P0-38 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings: Refer to P0-25 and P0-38 for explanation.

8-40

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P0 - 29

MAP5

Mapping Parameter 5

Address: 003AH, 003BH Related Section: Section 4.3.5

Default: N/A Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: determined by the parameter specified by P0-39 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings: Refer to P0-25 and P0-39 for explanation.

P0 - 30

MAP6

Mapping Parameter 6

Address: 003CH, 003DH Related Section: Section 4.3.5

Default: N/A Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: determined by the parameter specified by P0-40 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings: Refer to P0-25 and P0-40 for explanation.

P0 - 31

MAP7

Mapping Parameter 7

Address: 003EH, 003FH Related Section: Section 4.3.5

Default: N/A Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: determined by the parameter specified by P0-41 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings: Refer to P0-25 and P0-41 for explanation.

Revision January 2011

8-41

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P0 - 32

MAP8

Mapping Parameter 8

Address: 0040H, 0041H Related Section: Section 4.3.5

Default: N/A Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: determined by the parameter specified by P0-42 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings: Refer to P0-25 and P0-42 for explanation.

P0 - 33 P0 - 34

Reserved (Do Not Use) Reserved (Do Not Use)

P0 - 35

MAP1A Block Data Read / Write Register 1 (for P0-25) Default: 0x0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A

Address: 0046H, 0047H Related Section: Section 4.3.5

Range: determined by the communication address of the designated parameter Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings: The parameters from P0-35 to P0-42 are used to designate the desired read and write parameter numbers for P0-25 to P0-32, and read and write the values of the parameters those communication addresses are not consecutive through communication setting or the keypad more efficiently. The read / write parameter could be one 32-bit parameter or two 16-bit parameters. The operation of parameter P0-35 is described as follows:

When PH PL, it indicates that P0-25 includes two 16-bit parameters. VH = *(PH) VL = *(PL)

When PH = PL = P, it indicates that the content of P0-25 is one 32-bit parameter. V32 = *(P). If P = 060Ah (parameter P6-10), the value of V32 is the value of P6-10. 8-42
Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

A: Parameter group code in hexadecimal format B: Parameter number in hexadecimal format For example: If the desired read and write parameter number is P2-06, please set P0-35 to 0206. If the desired read and write parameter number is P5-42, please set P0-35 to 052A, and vise versa. When the users want to read and write the value of the parameter P1-44 (32-bit parameter) via P0-25, please set P0-35 to 0x012C012C through communication setting or the keypad. The the value of the parameter P1-44 will be displayed by P0-25. When the users want to read and write the values of the parameters P2-02 (Position Feed Forward Gain, 16-bit parameter) and P2-04 (Proportional Speed Loop Gain, 16-bit parameter) via P0-25, please set P0-35 to 0x02040202 through communication setting or the keypad. The the values of the parameters P2-02 and P2-04 will be displayed by P0-25.

P0 - 36

MAP2A Block Data Read / Write Register 2 (for P0-26) Default: 0x0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A

Address: 0048H, 0049H Related Section: Section 4.3.5

Range: determined by the communication address of the designated parameter Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings:

Refer to P0-35 for explanation.

Revision January 2011

8-43

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P0 - 37

MAP3A Block Data Read / Write Register 3 (for P0-27) Default: 0x0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A

Address: 004AH, 004BH Related Section: Section 4.3.5

Range: determined by the communication address of the designated parameter Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings:

Refer to P0-35 for explanation.

P0 - 38

MAP4A Block Data Read / Write Register 4 (for P0-28) Default: 0x0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A

Address: 004CH, 004DH Related Section: Section 4.3.5

Range: determined by the communication address of the designated parameter Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings:

Refer to P0-35 for explanation.

P0 - 39

MAP5A Block Data Read / Write Register 5 (for P0-29) Default: 0x0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A

Address: 004EH, 004FH Related Section: Section 4.3.5

Range: determined by the communication address of the designated parameter Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings:

Refer to P0-35 for explanation. 8-44


Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P0 - 40

MAP6A Block Data Read / Write Register 6 (for P0-30) Default: 0x0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A

Address: 0050H, 0051H Related Section: Section 4.3.5

Range: determined by the communication address of the designated parameter Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings:

Refer to P0-35 for explanation.

P0 - 41

MAP7A Block Data Read / Write Register 7 (for P0-31) Default: 0x0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A

Address: 0052H, 0053H Related Section: Section 4.3.5

Range: determined by the communication address of the designated parameter Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings:

Refer to P0-35 for explanation.

P0 - 42

MAP8A Block Data Read / Write Register 8 (for P0-32) Default: 0x0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A

Address: 0054H, 0055H Related Section: Section 4.3.5

Range: determined by the communication address of the designated parameter Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings:

Refer to P0-35 for explanation.


Revision January 2011

8-45

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P0 - 43

Reserved (Do Not Use)

P0 - 44

PCMN

Status Monitor Register (PC Software Setting)

Address: 0058H, 0059H Related Section: Section 4.3.5

Default: 0x0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A

Range: determined by the communication address of the designated parameter Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: The function of this parameter is the same as P0-09 (Please refer to P0-09). Please note that this pamameter can be set through communication setting only. Status Monitor Register Selection (PC Software Setting)

P0 - 45 PCMNA

Address: 005AH, 005BH Related Section: Section 4.3.5

Default: 0x0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 127 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

The function of this parameter is the same as P0-17 (Please refer to P0-17). Please note that this pamameter can be set through communication setting only.

P0 - 46 SVSTS

Servo Output Status Display

Address: 005CH, 005DH Related Section: -

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0x00 ~ 0xFF Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings:

This parameter is used to display the digital output signal of the servo drive. The servo output status display will show in hexadecimal format. Bit0: SRDY (Servo ready) Bit1: SON (Servo On) Bit2: ZSPD (At Zero speed) 8-46
Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Bit3: TSPD (At Speed reached) Bit4: TPOS (At Positioning completed) Bit5: TQL (At Torque limit) Bit6: ALRM (Servo alarm activated) Bit7: BRKR (Electromagnetic brake control) Bit8: HOME (Homing completed) Bit9: OLW (Output overload warning) Bit10: WARN (Servo warning activated. WARN is activated when the drive has detected reverse limit error; forward limit error, emergency stop, serial communication error, and undervoltage these fault conditions.) Bit11: Reserved Bit12: Reserved Bit13: Reserved Bit14: Reserved Bit15: Reserved The servo output status display can be monitored through communication also.

Revision January 2011

8-47

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Group 1: P1-xx Basic Parameters


P1 - 00 PTT External Pulse Input Type Address: 0100H, 0101H Related Section: Section 6.2.1

Default: 0x2 Applicable Control Mode: PT Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 1132 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings: A: Input pulse type

0: AB phase pulse (4x) (Quadrature Input)


A B C D not used

1: Clockwise (CW) + Counterclockwise(CCW) pulse 2: Pulse + Direction 3: Other settings:

B: Input pulse filter This setting is used to suppress or reduce the chatter caused by the noise, etc. However, if the instant input pulse filter frequency is over high, the frequency that exceeds the setting value will be regarded as noise and filtered. B 0 1 2 3 4 Low Filter 1.66Mpps 416Kpps 208Kpps 104Kpps No Filter Function Setting Value 0 1 2 3 4 High Filter 6.66Mpps 1.66Mpps 833Kpps 416Kpps No Filter Function

8-48

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

C: Input polarity Logic Pulse Type AB phase pulse 0 Positive Logic CW + CCW pulse Pulse + Direction AB phase pulse 1 Negative Logic CW + CCW pulse Pulse + Direction Forward Reverse

Pulse specification High-speed pulse Low-speed pulse Line receiver Line driver Open collector

Max. input pulse frequency 4Mpps 500Kpps 200Kpps

Min. time width T1 62.5ns 0.5s 1.25s T2 125ns 1s 2.5s T3 250ns 2s 5s T4 200ns 2s 5s T5 125ns 1s 2.5s T6 125ns 1s 2.5s

Pulse specification High-speed pulse Low-speed pulse Line receiver Line driver Open collector

Max. input pulse frequency 4Mpps 500Kpps 200Kpps

Voltage specification 5V 2.8V ~ 3.7V 24V (Max.)

Forward specification < 25mA < 25mA < 25mA

D: Source of pulse command Setting value 0 1 Input pulse interface Open collector for low-speed pulse Line driver for high-speed pulse Remark CN1 Terminal Identification: PULSE, SIGN CN1 Terminal Identification: PULSE_D, SIGN_D

Revision January 2011

8-49

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P1 - 01 CTL

Control Mode and Output Direction

Address: 0102H, 0103H Related Section: Section 6.1, Table 8.A

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: pulse (P mode), r/min (S mode), N-m (T mode) Range: 00 ~ 110F Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings:

A: Control mode settings PT 00 01 02 03 04 05 Multiple Mode 0E 0F PR S T Sz Tz PT 06 07 08 09 0A 0B 0C 0D PR S T Sz Tz

Single Mode

Dual Mode

CANopen Mode Reserved

PT: Position control mode. The command is from external pulse or analog voltage (external analog voltage will be available soon). PR: Position control mode. The command is from internal signal. Execution of 64 positions is via DI signals (POS0 ~ POS5). A variety of homing control is also provided. S: Speed control mode. The command is from external signal or internal signal. Execution of the command selection is via DI signals, SPD0 and SPD1. T: Torque control mode. The command is from external signal or internal signal. Execution of the command selection is via DI signals, TCM0 and TCM1. Sz: Zero speed / internal speed command Tz: Zero torque / internal torque command

8-50

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Dual Mode: Control of the mode selection is via DI signals. For example, either PT or S control mode can be selected via DI signal, S-P (see Table 8.A). Multiple Mode: Control of the mode selection is via DI signals. For example, either PT or PR or S control mode can be selected via DI signals, S-P and PT-PR (see Table 8.A). B: Torque output direction settings Direction Forward 0 1

Reverse

C: Discrete I/O Setting 1: When switching to different mode, digital inputs/outputs (P2-10 ~ P2-22) can be reset to be the default value of the mode you switch to. 0: When switching to different mode, the setting value of digital inputs/outputs (P210 ~ P2-22) will remain the same and will not be changed.

P1 - 02 PSTL

Speed and Torque Limit

Address: 0104H, 0105H Related Section: Section 6.6, Table 8.A

Default: 00 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 00 ~ 11 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings:

A B not used

A: Disable or Enable speed limit function 0: Disable speed limit function 1: Enable speed limit function (It is available in torque mode)

Revision January 2011

8-51

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

B: Disable or Enable torque limit function 0: Disable torque limit function 1: Enable torque limit function (It is available in position and speed mode)

This parameter is used to determine that the speed and torque limit functions are enabled or disabled. If P1-02 is set to 11, it indicates that the speed and torque limit functions are enabled always. The users can also use DI signals, SPDLM and TRQLM to enable the speed and torque limit functions. Please note that DI signals, SPD0, SPD1, TCM0, and TCM1 are used to select the command source of the speed and torque limit.

P1 - 03

AOUT

Pulse Output Polarity Setting

Address: 0106H, 0107H Related Section: Section 3.3.3

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 13 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings:

A B not used
This parameter is used to determine the polarity of analog monitor outputs and position pulse outputs. The analog monitor outputs can be configured with different polarity individually, but the position pulse outputs have to be each with the same polarity. A: Analog monitor outputs polarity 0: MON1(+), MON2(+) 1: MON1(+), MON2(-) 2: MON1(-), MON2(+) 3: MON1(-), MON2(-) B: Position pulse outputs polarity 0: Forward output 1: Reverse output

8-52

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P1 - 04

MON1

Analog Monitor Output Proportion 1 (CH1)

Address: 0108H, 0109H Related Section: Section 6.4.4

Default: 100 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: % (full scale) Range: 0 ~ 100 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

P1 - 05

MON2

Analog Monitor Output Proportion 2 (CH2)

Address: 010AH, 010BH Related Section: Section 6.4.4

Default: 100 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: % (full scale) Range: 0 ~ 100 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Accel / Decel Smooth Constant of Analog Speed Command (Low-pass Filter)

P1 - 06

SFLT

Address: 010CH, 010DH Related Section: Section 6.3.3

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: S Unit: msec Range: 0 ~ 1000 (0: Disabled) Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

P1 - 07

TFLT

Smooth Constant of Analog Torque Command (Low-pass Filter)

Address: 010EH, 010FH Related Section: Section 6.4.3

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: T Unit: msec Range: 0 ~ 1000 (0: Disabled) Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

Revision January 2011

8-53

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P1 - 08

PFLT

Smooth Constant of Position Command (Lowpass Filter)

Address: 0110H, 0111H Related Section: Section 6.2.6

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PT/PR Unit: 10msec Range: 0 ~ 1000 (0: Disabled) Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

P1 - 09

SP1

1st Speed Command or Limit

Address: 0112H, 0113H Related Section: Section 6.3.1

Default: 1000 Applicable Control Mode: S, T Unit: 0.1 r/min Range: -60000 ~ +60000 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: 1st Speed Command

In Speed mode, this parameter is used to set speed 1 of internal speed command. 1st Speed Limit In Torque mode, this parameter is used to set speed limit 1 of internal speed command.

P1 - 10

SP2

2nd Speed Command or Limit

Address: 0114H, 0115H Related Section: Section 6.3.1

Default: 2000 Applicable Control Mode: S, T Unit: 0.1 r/min Range: -60000 ~ +60000 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: 2nd Speed Command

In Speed mode, this parameter is used to set speed 2 of internal speed command. 2nd Speed Limit In Torque mode, this parameter is used to set speed limit 2 of internal speed command.

8-54

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P1 - 11

SP3

3rd Speed Command or Limit

Address: 0116H, 0117H Related Section: Section 6.3.1

Default: 3000 Applicable Control Mode: S, T Unit: 0.1 r/min Range: -60000 ~ +60000 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: 3rd Speed Command

In Speed mode, this parameter is used to set speed 3 of internal speed command. 3rd Speed Limit In Torque mode, this parameter is used to set speed limit 3 of internal speed command.

P1 - 12

TQ1

1st Torque Command or Limit

Address: 0118H, 0119H Related Section: Section 6.4.1

Default: 100 Applicable Control Mode: T, P&S Unit: % Range: -300 ~ +300 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: 1st Torque Command

In Torque mode, this parameter is used to set torque 1 of internal torque command. 1st Torque Limit In Position and Speed mode, this parameter is used to set torque limit 1 of internal torque command. Digital output signal TQL is activated when the drive has detected that the motor has reached the torques limits set by either the parameters P1-12 ~ P1-14 of via an external analog voltage.

Revision January 2011

8-55

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P1 - 13

TQ2

2nd Torque Command or Limit

Address: 011AH, 011BH Related Section: Section 6.4.1

Default: 100 Applicable Control Mode: T, P&S Unit: % Range: -300 ~ +300 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: 2nd Torque Command

In Torque mode, this parameter is used to set torque 2 of internal torque command. 2nd Torque Limit In Position and Speed mode, this parameter is used to set torque limit 2 of internal torque command. Digital output signal TQL is activated when the drive has detected that the motor has reached the torques limits set by either the parameters P1-12 ~ P1-14 of via an external analog voltage.

P1 - 14

TQ3

3rd Torque Command or Limit

Address: 011CH, 011DH Related Section: Section 6.4.1

Default: 100 Applicable Control Mode: T, P&S Unit: % Range: -300 ~ +300 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: 3rd Speed Command

In Torque mode, this parameter is used to set torque 3 of internal torque command. 3rd Speed Limit In Position and Speed mode, this parameter is used to set torque limit 3 of internal torque command. Digital output signal TQL is activated when the drive has detected that the motor has reached the torques limits set by either the parameters P1-12 ~ P1-14 of via an external analog voltage.

P1 - 15 P1 - 16 P1 - 17 8-56

Reserved (Do Not Use) Reserved (Do Not Use) Reserved (Do Not Use)

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P1 - 18 P1 - 19 P1 - 20 P1 - 21 P1 - 22 P1 - 23 P1 - 24

Reserved (Do Not Use) Reserved (Do Not Use) Reserved (Do Not Use) Reserved (Do Not Use) Reserved (Do Not Use) Reserved (Do Not Use) Reserved (Do Not Use)

P1 - 25

VSF1

Low-frequency Vibration Suppression (1)

Address: 0132H, 0133H Related Section: Section 6.2.9

Default: 100.0 Applicable Control Mode: PT/PR Unit: Hz Range: 1.0 ~ 100.0 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the first group of the low-frequency of mechanical system. It can be used to suppress the low-frequency vibration of mechanical system. If P1-26 is set to 0, this parameter is disabled. Low-frequency Vibration Suppression Gain (1)

P1 - 26

VSG1

Address: 0134H, 0135H Related Section: Section 6.2.9

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PT/PR Unit: Range: 0 ~ 9 (0: Disable the function of P1-25) Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the vibration suppression gain for P1-25. When the setting value is higher, the position response is quicker. However, if the setting value is over high, it may addect the normal operation of servo motor. It is recommended to set P1-26 as 1.

Revision January 2011

8-57

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P1 - 27

VSF2

Low-frequency Vibration Suppression (2)

Address: 0136H, 0137H Related Section: Section 6.2.9

Default: 100.0 Applicable Control Mode: PT/PR Unit: Hz Range: 1.0 ~ 100.0 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the second group of the low-frequency of mechanical system. It can be used to suppress the low-frequency vibration of mechanical system. If P1-28 is set to 0, this parameter is disabled. Low-frequency Vibration Suppression Gain (2)

P1 - 28

VSG2

Address: 0138H, 0139H Related Section: Section 6.2.9

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PT/PR Unit: Range: 0 ~ 9 (0: Disable the function of P1-27) Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the vibration suppression gain for P1-27. When the setting value is higher, the position response is quicker. However, if the setting value is over high, it may addect the normal operation of servo motor. It is recommended to set P1-28 as 1. Auto Low-frequency Vibration Suppression Mode Selection

P1 - 29

AVSM

Address: 013AH, 013BH Related Section: Section 6.2.9

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PT/PR Unit: Range: 0 ~ 1 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

0: Normal mode (Disable Auto Low-frequency Vibration Suppression Mode). 1: Auto mode (Enable Auto Low-frequency Vibration Suppression Mode).

8-58

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Explanation: If P1-29 is set to 0, the setting of low-frequency vibration suppression is fixed and will not change automatically. If P1-29 is set to 1, when there is no low-frequency vibration or the low-frequency vibration becomes less and stable, the system will set P1-29 to 0, save the measured low-frequency value automatically and memorize it in P1-25.

P1 - 30

VCL

Low-frequency Vibration Detection Level

Address: 013CH, 013DH Related Section: Section 6.2.9

Default: 500 Applicable Control Mode: PT/PR Unit: pulse Range: 1 ~ 8000 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

When P1-29 is set to 1, the system will find this detection level automatically. If the setting value of P1-30 is too low, the dectection of frequency will become sensitive and result in erroneous measurement. If the setting value of P1-30 is too high, although the probability of erroneous measurement will decrease, the frequency will become difficult to be found especially when the vibration of mechanical system is less.

P1 - 31

Reserved (Do Not Use)

P1 - 32

LSTP

Motor Stop Mode Selection

Address: 0140H, 0141H Related Section: N/A

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 20 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings:

This parameter is used to select servo motor stop mode when Servo Off or a fault (servo alarm, includes EMGS (Emergency stop)) occurs.

Revision January 2011

8-59

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Fault Stop Mode 0: Use dynamic brake 1: Allow servo motor to coast to stop 2: Use dynamic brake first, after the motor speed is below than P1-38, allow servo motor to coast to stop When the fault NL(CWL) or PL(CCWL) occurs, please refer to the settings of parameter P5-03 to determine the deceleration time. If the deceleration time is set to 1msec, the motor will stop instantly.

P1 - 33

Reserved (Do Not Use)

P1 - 34

TACC

Acceleration Time

Address: 0144H, 0145H Related Section: Section 6.3.3,

Default: 200 Applicable Control Mode: S Unit: msec Range: 1 ~ 65500 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to determine the acceleration time to accelerate from 0 to its rated motor speed. The functions of parameters P1-34, P1-35 and P1-36 are each individual. When P1-36 is set to 0 (Disabled), the settings of P1-34, P1-35 are still effective. It indicates that the parameters P1-34 and P1-35 will not become disabled even when P1-36 is disabled. Please note: 1. When the source of speed command is analog command, the maximum setting value of P1-36 is set to 0, the acceleration and deceleration function will be disabled. 2. When the source of speed command is analog command, the maximum setting value of P1-34 is limited to 20000 automatically.

P1 - 35

TDEC

Deceleration Time

Address: 0146H, 0147H Related Section: Section 6.3.3,

Default: 200 Applicable Control Mode: S Unit: msec Range: 1 ~ 65500 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

8-60

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Settings: This parameter is used to determine the acceleration time to accelerate from 0 to its rated motor speed. The functions of parameters P1-34, P1-35 and P1-36 are each individual. When P1-36 is set to 0 (Disabled), the settings of P1-34, P1-35 are still effective. It indicates that the parameters P1-34 and P1-35 will not become disabled even when P1-36 is disabled. Please note: 1. When the source of speed command is analog command, the maximum setting value of P1-36 is set to 0, the acceleration and deceleration function will be disabled. 2. When the source of speed command is analog command, the maximum setting value of P1-35 is limited to 20000 automatically.

P1 - 36

TSL

Accel /Decel S-curve

Address: 0148H, 0149H Related Section: Section 6.3.3,

Default: 0 Unit: msec Applicable Control Mode: S, PR Unit: msec Range: 0 ~ 65500 (0: Disabled) Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to make the motor run more smoothly when startup and windup. Using this parameter can improve the motor running stability.

TACC: P1-34, Acceleration time TDEC: P1-35, Deceleration time TSL: P1-36, Accel /Decel S-curve Total acceleration time = TACC + TSL Total deceleration time = TDEC + TSL The functions of parameters P1-34, P1-35 and P1-36 are each individual. When P1-36 is set to 0 (Disabled), the settings of P1-34, P1-35 are still effective. It indicates that the parameters P1-34 and P1-35 will not become disabled even when P1-36 is disabled. Please note: 1. When the source of speed command is analog command, the maximum setting value of P1-36 is set to 0, the acceleration and deceleration function will be disabled. 8-61

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

2. When the source of speed command is analog command, the maximum setting value of P1-36 is limited to 10000 automatically.

P1 - 37

GDR

Ratio of Load Inertia to Servo Motor Inertia

Address: 014AH, 014BH Related Section: N/A

Default: 10 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: 0.1 times Range: 0 ~ 2000 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

Settings: Ratio of load inertia to servo motor inertia (for Rotation Motor): (J_load /J_motor) J_load: Total equivalent moment of inertia of external mechanical load J_motor: Moment of inertia of servo motor Ratio of load weight to servo motor weight (for Linear Motor): (M_load /M_motor)(not available now but will be available soon) M_load: Total equivalent weight of external mechanical load M_motor: Weight of servo motor

P1 - 38

ZSPD

Zero Speed Range Setting

Address: 014CH, 014DH Related Section: Table 8.A

Default: 100 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: 0.1 r/min Range: 0 ~ 2000 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set output range of zero speed signal (ZSPD) and determine whrn zero speed signal (ZSPD) becomes activated. ZSPD is activated when the drive senses the motor is equal to or below the Zero Speed Range setting as defined in parameter P1-38. For Example, at default ZSPD will be activated when the drive detects the motor rotating at speed at or below 100 r/min. ZSPD will remain activated until the motor speed increases above 100 r/min.

8-62

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P1 - 39

SSPD

Target Motor Speed

Address: 014EH, 014FH Related Section: Table 8.A

Default: 3000 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: r/min Range: 0 ~ 5000 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

When target motor speed reaches its preset value, digital output (TSPD) is enabled. When the forward and reverse speed of servo motor is equal and higher than the setting value, the motor will reach the target motor speed, and then TSPD signal will output. TSPD is activated once the drive has detected the motor has reached the Target Motor Speed setting as defined in parameter P1-39. TSPD will remain activated until the motor speed drops below the Target Motor Speed.

P1 - 40 VCM

Max. Analog Speed Command or Limit

Address: 0150H, 0151H Related Section: Section 6.3.4

Default: rated speed Applicable Control Mode: S, T Unit: r/min Range: 0 ~ 10000 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

In Speed mode, this parameter is used to set the maximum analog speed command based on the maximum input voltage (10V). In Torque mode, this parameter is used to set the maximum analog speed limit based on the maximum input voltage (10V). For example, in speed mode, if P1-40 is set to 3000 and the input voltage is 10V, it indicates that the speed command is 3000 r/min. If P1-40 is set to 3000, but the input voltage is changed to 5V, then the speed command is changed to 1500 r/min. Speed Command / Limit = Input Voltage Value x Setting value of P1-40 / 10

Revision January 2011

8-63

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P1 - 41 TCM

Max. Analog Torque Command or Limit

Address: 0152H, 0153H Related Section: Section 6.4.4

Default: 100 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: % Range: 0 ~ 1000 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

In Torque mode, this parameter is used to set the maximum analog torque command based on the maximum input voltage (10V). In Position (PT, PR) and Speed mode, this parameter is used to set the maximum analog torque limit based on the maximum input voltage (10V). For example, in torque mode, if P1-41 is set to 100 and the input voltage is 10V, it indicates that the torque command is 100% rated torque. If P1-41 is set to 100, but the input voltage is changed to 5V, then the torque command is changed to 50% rated torque. Torque Command / Limit = Input Voltage Value x Setting value of P1-41 / 10

P1 - 42

MBT1

On Delay Time of Electromagnetic Brake

Address: 0154H, 0155H Related Section: Section 6.5.5, Table 8.B

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: msec Range: 0 ~ 1000 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

Used to set the period of time between when the servo drive is On (Servo On) and when electromagnetic brake output signal (BRKR) is activated.

P1 - 43

MBT2

OFF Delay Time of Electromagnetic Brake

Address: 0156H, 0157H Related Section: Section 6.5.5, Table 8.B

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: msec Range: -1000 ~ +1000 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

8-64

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Settings: Used to set the period of time between when the servo drive is Off (Servo Off) and when electromagnetic brake output signal (BRKR) is inactivated.

Please note: 1. When servo is commanded off and the off delay time set by P1-43 has not elapsed, if the motor speed is lower than the setting value of P1-38, the electromagnetic brake will be engaged regardless of the off delay time set by P1-43. 2. When servo is commanded off and the off delay time set by P1-43 has elapsed, if the motor speed is higher than the setting value of P1-38, electromagnetic brake will be engaged regardless of the current motor speed. 3. When the servo drive is disabled (Servo Off) due to a fault (except AL022) or by EMGS (Emergency stop)) being activated, if the off delay time set by P1-43 is a negative value, it will not affect the operation of the motor. A negative value of the off delay time is equivalent to one with a zero value.

P1 - 44 GR1

Electronic Gear Ratio (1st Numerator) (N1)

Address: 0158H, 0159H Related Section: Section 6.2.5

Default: 128 Applicable Control Mode: PT, PR Unit: pulse Range: 1 ~ (229-1) Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the numerator of the electronic gear ratio. The denominator of the electronic gear ratio is set by P1-45. P2-60 ~ P2-62 are used to set the additional numberators. Please note: 1. In PT mode, the setting value of P1-44 can be changed only when the servo drive is enabled (Servo On). 2. In PR mode, the setting value of P1-44 can be changed only when the servo drive is disabled (Servo Off).

Revision January 2011

8-65

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P1 - 45 GR2

Electronic Gear Ratio (Denominator) (M)

Address: 015AH, 015BH Related Section: Section 6.3.6

Default: 10 Applicable Control Mode: PT, PR Unit: pulse Range: 1 ~ (231-1) Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the denominator of the electronic gear ratio. The numerator of the electronic gear ratio is set by P1-44. P2-60 ~ P2-62 are used to set the additional numberators. As the wrong setting may cause motor to run chaotically (out of control) and it may lead to personnel injury, therefore, ensure to observe the following rule when setting P1-44, P1-45. The electronic gear ratio setting (Please also see P1-44, P2-60 ~ P2-62):

Pulse input f1

N M

Position command N f2 = f1 x M

f1: Pulse input P2-62

f2: Position command

N: Numerator, the setting value of P1-44 or P2-60 ~ M: Denominator, the setting value of P1-45

The electronic gear ratio setting range must be within: 1/50<N/M<25600. Please note: 1. In PT and PR mode, the setting value of P1-45 can not be changed when the servo drive is enabled (Servo On).

P1 - 46 GR3

Encoder Output Pulse Number

Address: 015CH, 015DH Related Section: N/A

Default: 2500 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: pulse Range: 20 ~ 320000 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the pulse numbers of encoder outputs per motor revolution. Please note: When the following conditions occur, the output frequency for pulse output may exceed the specification and cause that the servo drive fault AL018 (Encoder Output Error) is activated.

8-66

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Condition 1: Encoder error. Condition 2: Motor speed is above the value set by parameter P1-76. Condition 3: Motor Speed P1 46 4 19.8 10 6 60

P1 - 47

SPOK

Speed Reached Output Range

Address: 015EH, 015FH Related Section: N/A

Default: 10 Applicable Control Mode: S, Sz Unit: r/min Range: 0 ~ 300 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the speed reached output range. The DO signal, SP_OK will be activated when the speed error is equal and below the setting value of P1-47.

1. Speed Command: It is the speed command input by the users (no Accel/Decel), not the frond-end command of speed control loop. The source of this command includes analog voltage and registers. 2. Feedback Speed: It is the actual motor speed which is filtered. 3. Get Absolute Value 4. Judge if the speed error is equal and below the setting value of P1-47: When P1-47 is set to 0, this digital output will be always off. 5. ON or OFF: When the speed error is equal and below the setting value of P1-47, SP_OK will be ON; otherwise, SP_OK will be OFF.

Revision January 2011

8-67

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P1 - 48

MCOK

Motion Control Completed Output Selection

Address: 0160H, 0161H Related Section: N/A

Default: 0x0000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x0000 ~ 0x0011 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal

Settings: (for firmware version V1.003 sub08 and later models only) This parameter is used to determine the operation after digital output signal, MC_OK (DO code is 0x17) is activated. Display Range 0 0 Y 0~1 X 0~1

X=0: MC_OK will not be always ON after it is activated. X=1: MC_OK will be always ON after it is activated. Y=0: Servo fault AL380 will not be activated. Y=1: Servo fault AL380 will be activated.

1. PR command is triggerred: It indicates that the new PR command becomes effective. When the signal 3 starts to output the command, the signals 2, 4 and 5 will be clear simetaneously. 2. CMD_OK: CMD_OK is used to detect if the internal position command, signal 3 has been completed. DLY delay time can also be set. 3. Output Command: Output the internal position command according to desired acceleration and deceleration. 4. TPOS: It is activated when the position error is equal and below the setting value of P1-54.

8-68

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

5. MC_OK (P1-48 X=0): It is activated when the position command has output and the positioning is completed also, i.e. CMD_OK and TPOS are both ON. However, once TPOS becomes OFF, it will become OFF as well. 6 MC_OK (P1-48 X=1): It is activated when the position command has output and the positioning is completed also, i.e. CMD_OK and TPOS are both ON. However, when TPOS becomes OFF, it will not become OFF. It will be always ON 7. The signal 5 and signal 6 cannot be selected simetaneously. This function is determined by X setting of P1-48. 8. Position deviation alarm (AL380): After signal 7 occurs, if signal 4 or 5 becomes off, it indicates a position deviation alarm is detected and AL380 can be activated to provide a alarm signal. This function is determined by Y setting of P1-48.

P1 - 49 P1 - 50 P1 - 51

Reserved (Do Not Use) Reserved (Do Not Use) Reserved (Do Not Use)

P1 - 52

RES1 Default: -

Regenerative Resistor Value

Address: 0168H, 0169H Related Section: Section 6.6.3

Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: Ohm Range: 10 ~ 750 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the resistance of the applicable regenerative resistor. Model For 1.5kW models and below Default 40 20 15

For 2kW to 4.5kW models For 5.5kW

P1 - 53

RES2 Default: -

Regenerative Resistor Capacity

Address: 016AH, 016BH Related Section: Section 6.6.3

Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: Watt Range: 30 ~ 3000 Data Size: 16-bit

Revision January 2011

8-69

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Display Format: Decimal Settings: This parameter is used to set the capacity of the applicable regenerative resistor. Model For 1.5kW models and below Default 60W 100W 0W

For 2kW to 4.5kW models 5.5kW

P1 - 54

PER

Positioning Completed Width

Address: 016CH, 016DH Related Section: Table 8.A

Default: 12800 Applicable Control Mode: PT , PR Unit: pulse Range: 0 ~ 1280000 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

In PT mode, when the error pulse numbers is less than the setting value of parameter P1-54, TPOS (At positioning completed signal) will be activated. In PR mode, when the difference in pulse number between the target position and the actual position is less than the setting value of parameter P1-54, TPOS (At positioning completed signal) will be activated.

P1 - 55

MSPD

Maximum Speed Limit

Address: 016EH, 016FH Related Section: N/A

Default: rated speed Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: r/min Range: 0 ~ Max. speed Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set maximum motor speed. The default setting is rated speed.

8-70

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P1 - 56

OVW

Output Overload Warning Time

Address: 0170H, 0171H Related Section: N/A

Default: 120 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: % Range: 0 ~ 120 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set output overload time. If the setting value of parameter P156 is set to 0 ~ 100, the function of parameter P1-56 is enabled. When the motor has reached the output overload time set by parameter P1-56, the motor will send a warning to the drive. After the drive has detected the warning, the DO signal OLW will be activated. If the setting value of parameter P1-56 exceeds 100, the function of parameter P1-56 is disabled. tOL = Permissible Time for Overload x the setting value of parameter P1-56 When overload accumulated time (continuously overload time) exceeds the value of tOL, the overload warning signal will output, i.e. DO signal, OLW will be ON. However, if the accumulated overload time (continuous overload time) exceeds the permissible time for overload, the overload alarm (AL006) will occur. For example: If the setting value of parameter P1-56 (Output Overload Warning Time) is 60%, when the permissible time for overload exceeds 8 seconds at 200% rated output, the overload fault (AL006) will be detected and shown on the LED display. At this time, tOL = 8 x 60% = 4.8 seconds Result: When the drive output is at 200% rated output and the drive is continuously overloaded for 4.8 seconds, the overload warning signal will be ON, i.e. DO signal OLW will be activated. If the drive is continuously overloaded for 8 seconds, the overload alarm will be detected and shown on the LED display (AL006). Then, Servo Fault signal will be ON (DO signal ALRM will be activated).

P1 - 57

CRSHA

Motor Protection Percentage

Address: 0172H, 0173H Related Section: -

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: % Range: 0 ~ 300 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

Revision January 2011

8-71

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Settings: This parameter is used to protect the motor in case the motor touchs the mechanical equipment. If P1-57 is set to 0, the function of P1-57 is disabled. The function of P1-57 is enabled when the setting value of P1-57 is set to 1 or more. The fault AL030 will be activated when the setting value of P1-57 is reached after a period of time set by P1-58.

P1 - 58

CRSHT

Motor Protection Time

Address: 0174H, 0175H Related Section: P1-57

Default: 1 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: msec Range: 0 ~ 1000 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to protect the motor in case the motor touchs the mechanical equipment. The fault AL030 will be activated when the setting value of P1-57 is reached after a period of time set by P1-58. Please note that this function is applicable for non-contact applications, such as electric discharge machines only (P1-37 must be set correctly).

P1 - 59

MFLT

Analog Speed Linear Filter (Moving Filter)

Address: 0176H, 0177H Related Section: N/A

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: S Unit: 0.1msec Range: 0 ~ 40 (0: Disabled) Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to eliminate the noise generated during the operation when the host (external) controller sends the step analog voltage speed command. The parameter P1-06 is Low-pass Filter and parameter P1-59 is Moving Filter. The differences are that Low-pass Filter is usually used to smooth the end of the command but Moving Filter can be used to smooth the start and the end of step analog voltage speed command. Using Moving Filter can facilitate the smooth operation of the motor very effectively. Therefore, it is recommended to use P1-06 Low-pass Filter when the speed command from the external controller is applied for position control loop. If the command is for speed control only, using Moving Filter P1-59 can achieve better (smooth) performance.

8-72

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P1 - 60 P1 - 61

Reserved (Do Not Use) Reserved (Do Not Use)

P1 - 62

FRCL

Friction Compensation Percentage

Address: 017CH, 017DH Related Section: N/A

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PT, PR, S Unit: % Range: 0 ~ 100 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the torque percentage for friction compensation. If P1-62 is set to 0, the function of P1-62 is disabled. The function of P1-62 is enabled when the setting value of P1-62 is set to 1 or more.

P1 - 63

FRCT

Friction Compensation Smooth Constant

Address: 017EH, 017FH Related Section: N/A

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: msec Range: 0 ~ 1000 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the smooth constant of friction compensation.

P1 - 64 P1 - 65

Reserved (Do Not Use) Reserved (Do Not Use)

Revision January 2011

8-73

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P1 - 66

PCM

Max. Rotation Number of Analog Position Command (will be available soon)

Address: 0184H, 0185H Related Section: N/A

Default: 30 Applicable Control Mode: PT Unit: 0.1 rotation Range: 0 ~ 10000 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the maximum rotation number of analog position command based on the maximum input voltage (10V). For example, if P1-66 is set to 30 and the input voltage is 10V, it indicates that the position command is +3 rotations. If P1-66 is set to 30, but the input voltage is changed to 5V, then the position command is +1.5 rotations. Position Command = Input Voltage Value x Setting value of P1-66 / 10

P1 - 67

Reserved (Do Not Use)

P1 - 68

PFLT2

Position Command Moving Filter

Address: 0188H, 0189H Related Section: N/A

Default: 4 Applicable Control Mode: PT, PR Unit: msec Range: 0 ~ 100 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

P1 - 69 P1 - 70 P1 - 71

Reserved (Do Not Use) Reserved (Do Not Use) Reserved (Do Not Use)

P1 - 72

FRES

Full-closed Loop Resolution

Address: 0190H, 0191H Related Section: N/A

Default: 5000 Applicable Control Mode: PT, PR Unit: pulse (PT mode), rev (PR mode) Range: 200 ~ 80000 Data Size: 32-bit

8-74

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Display Format: Decimal Settings: This parameter is used to set the corresponding AB (Quadrature) phase pulses (4x) for full-closed loop per motor revolution. Full-closed Loop Excessive Position Error Range

P1 - 73

FERR

Address: 0192H, 0193H Related Section: P2-34

Default: 30000 Applicable Control Mode: PT, PR Unit: pulse (based on full-closed loop) Range: 1 ~ (231-1) Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

When the position of A/B counter feedbacked by full-closed loop is too far from the position feedbacked by the encoder of the servo motor, it indicates that the encoder connector may loose or there is some problem occurred on connected mechanical system.

P1 - 74 FCON

Full-closed Loop Control Function Selection

Address: 0194H, 0195H Related Section: P1-46

Default: 0000h Applicable Control Mode: PT, PR Unit: N/A Range: 0000h ~ 0121h Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings:

This parameter is used to determine the function of full-closed loop control.

A: Full-closed loop function selection 0: Disable full-closed loop function. 1: Enable full-closed loop function. B: Source of OA/OB/OZ outputs 0: The source of OA/OB/OZ outputs is the encoder of the motor. 1: The source of OA/OB/OZ outputs is the encoder of the linear scale full-closed loop.
Revision January 2011

8-75

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

2: The source of OA/OB/OZ outputs is the pulse command of CN1 (only provided by the firmware DSP V1.016 + CPLD 0.07 and later models.). C: Polarity setting of linear scale C=0 Forward Reverse Forward C=1 Reverse

P1 - 75

FELP

Full-closed Loop Low-pass Filter Time Constant

Address: 0196H, 0197H Related Section: N/A

Default: 100 Applicable Control Mode: PT, PR Unit: msec Range: 0 ~ 1000 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

When the stiffness of the mechanical system between full-closed loop and half-closed loop is insufficient, the users can use this parameter to enhance the stability of the mechanical system. When P1-75 is set to 0, the low-pass filter function is disabled. The stiffness of the mechanical system , the setting value of P1-75 . The stiffness of the mechanical system , the setting value of P1-75 .

P1 - 76

AMSPD Max. Rotation Speed of Encoder Output Default: 5500 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: r/min Range: 0 ~ 6000 (0: Disabled) Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

Address: 0198H, 0199H Related Section: P1-46

This parameter is used to optimize the encoder outputs (OA, OB). When the users set the actual reached maximum motor speed, the servo drive will equalize the encoder outputs automatically. When P1-76 is set to 0, it indicates that equalizing function is not available.

8-76

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Group 2: P2-xx Extension Parameters


P2 - 00 KPP Proportional Position Loop Gain Address: 0200H, 0201H Related Section: Section 6.2.8

Default: 35 Applicable Control Mode: PT, PR Unit: rad/s Range: 0 ~ 2047 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the position loop gain. It can increase stiffness, expedite position loop response and reduce position error. However, if the setting value is over high, it may generate vibration or noise.

P2 - 01

PPR

Position Loop Gain Switching Rate

Address: 0202H, 0203H Related Section: Section 6.2.8

Default: 100 Applicable Control Mode: PT, PR Unit: % Range: 10 ~ 500 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the position gain switching rate when the gain switching condition is satisfied. Please refer to P2-27 for gain switching control selection settings and refer to P2-29 for gain switching condition settings.

P2 - 02

PFG

Position Feed Forward Gain

Address: 0204H, 0205H Related Section: Section 6.2.8

Default: 50 Applicable Control Mode: PT, PR Unit: % Range: 0 ~ 100 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the feed forward gain when executing position control command. When using position smooth command, increase gain can improve position track deviation. When not using position smooth command, decrease gain can improve the resonance condition of mechanical system.
Revision January 2011

8-77

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P2 - 03

PFF

Smooth Constant of Position Feed Forward Gain

Address: 0206H, 0207H Related Section: N/A

Default: 5 Applicable Control Mode: PT, PR Unit: msec Range: 2 ~ 100 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

When using position smooth command, increase gain can improve position track deviation. When not using position smooth command, decrease gain can improve the resonance condition of mechanical system.

P2 - 04

KVP

Proportional Speed Loop Gain

Address: 0208H, 0209H Related Section: Section 6.3.6

Default: 500 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: rad/s Range: 0 ~ 8191 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the speed loop gain. When the value of proportional speed loop gain is increased, it can expedite speed loop response. However, if the setting value is over high, it may generate vibration or noise.

P2 - 05

SPR

Speed Loop Gain Switching Rate

Address: 020AH, 020BH Related Section: N/A

Default: 100 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: % Range: 10 ~ 500 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the speed gain switching rate when the gain switching condition is satisfied. Please refer to P2-27 for gain switching control selection settings and refer to P2-29 for gain switching condition settings.

8-78

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P2 - 06

KVI

Speed Integral Compensation

Address: 020CH, 020DH Related Section: Section 6.3.6

Default: 100 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: rad/s Range: 0 ~ 1023 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the integral time of speed loop. When the value of speed integral compensation is increased, it can improve the speed response ability and decrease the speed control deviation. However, if the setting value is over high, it may generate vibration or noise.

P2 - 07

KVF

Speed Feed Forward Gain

Address: 020EH, 020FH Related Section: Section 6.3.6

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: % Range: 0 ~ 100 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the feed forward gain when executing speed control command. When using speed smooth command, increase gain can improve speed track deviation. When not using speed smooth command, decrease gain can improve the resonance condition of mechanical system.

P2 - 08 PCTL

Special Factory Setting

Address: 0210H, 0211H Related Section: N/A

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 65535 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter can be used to reset all parameters to their original factory settings and enable some parameters functions. Reset parameters settings: 10: Users can reset all parameter values to factory defaults. All parameter values
Revision January 2011

8-79

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

will be reset after re-power the servo drive. (Before perform this settings, ensure that the status of the servo drive is Servo Off.) Enable parameters functions: 20: If P2-08 is set to 20, then the parameter P4-10 is enabled. 22: If P2-08 is set to 22, then the parameters P4-11~P4-19 are enabled. 30, 35: If P2-08 is set to 30 first, and then set to 35, the value of E-Cam (Electronic Cam) can be recorded. 406: If P2-08 is set to 406, then the Digital Output (DO) signal can be forced to be activated and the drive will enter into Force Output Control operation mode. 400: If P2-08 is set to 400, it can switch the Force Output Control operation mode to normal Digital Output (DO) Control operation mode. Please note: ASDA-A2 series L type models does not provide Electronic Cam (E-Cam) function.

P2 - 09

DRT

Bounce Filter

Address: 0212H, 0213H Related Section: Section 6.3.6

Default: 2 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: 2msec Range: 0 ~ 20 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

For example, if P2-09 is set to 5, the bounce filter time is 5 x 2msec = 10msec. When there are too much vibration or noises around environment, increasing this setting value (bounce filter time) can improve reliability. However, if the time is too long, it may affect the response time.

P2 - 10

DI1

Digital Input Terminal 1 (DI1)

Address: 0214H, 0215H Related Section: Table 8.A

Default: 101 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 015Fh Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings:

The parameters from P2-10 to P2-17 are used to determine the functions and statuses of DI1 ~ DI8.

8-80

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

A: DI (Digital Input) Function Settings: For the setting value of P2- 10 ~ P2-17, please refer to Table 8.A. B: DI (Digital Input) Enabled Status Settings: 0: Normally closed (contact b) 1: Normally open (contact a) For example, when P2-10 is set to 101, it indicates that the function of DI1 is SON (Servo On, setting value is 0x01) and it requires a normally open contact to be connected to it. Please re-start the servo drive after parameters have been changed. Please note: The parameter P3-06 is used to set how the Digital Inputs (DI) accept commands and signals through the external terminals or via the communication which is determined by parameter P4-07.

P2 - 11

DI2

Digital Input Terminal 2 (DI2)

Address: 0216H, 0217H Related Section: Table 8.A

Default: 104 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 015Fh Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings: Refer to P2-10 for explanation.

P2 - 12

DI3

Digital Input Terminal 3 (DI3)

Address: 0218H, 0219H Related Section: Table 8.A

Default: 116 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 015Fh Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings: Refer to P2-10 for explanation.

Revision January 2011

8-81

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P2 - 13

DI4

Digital Input Terminal 4 (DI4)

Address: 021AH, 021BH Related Section: Table 8.A

Default: 117 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 015Fh Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings: Refer to P2-10 for explanation.

P2 - 14

DI5

Digital Input Terminal 5 (DI5)

Address: 021CH, 021DH Related Section: Table 8.A

Default: 102 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 015Fh Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings: Refer to P2-10 for explanation.

P2 - 15

DI6

Digital Input Terminal 6 (DI6)

Address: 021EH, 021FH Related Section: Table 8.A

Default: 22 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 015Fh Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings: Refer to P2-10 for explanation.

P2 - 16

DI7

Digital Input Terminal 7 (DI7)

Address: 0220H, 0221H Related Section: Table 8.A

Default: 23 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 015Fh Data Size: 16-bit

8-82

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings: Refer to P2-10 for explanation.

P2 - 17

DI8

Digital Input Terminal 8 (DI8)

Address: 0222H, 0223H Related Section: Table 8.A

Default: 21 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 015Fh Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings: Refer to P2-10 for explanation.

P2 - 18

DO1

Digital Output Terminal 1 (DO1)

Address: 0224H, 0225H Related Section: Table 8.B

Default: 101 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 013Fh Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings:

The parameters from P2-18 to P2-22 are used to determine the functions and statuses of DO1 ~ DO5.

A: DO Function Settings: For the setting value of P2- 18 ~ P2-22, please refer to Table 8.A. B: DO Enabled Status Settings: 0: Normally closed (contact b) 1: Normally open (contact a) For example, when P2-18 is set to 101, it indicates that the function of DO1 is SRDY (Servo ready, setting value is 0x01) and it requires a normally open contact to be connected to it. Please re-start the servo drive after parameters have been changed. 8-83

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P2 - 19

DO2

Digital Output Terminal 2 (DO2)

Address: 0226H, 0227H Related Section: Table 8.B

Default: 103 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 013Fh Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings: Refer to P2-18 for explanation.

P2 - 20

DO3

Digital Output Terminal 3 (DO3)

Address: 0228H, 0229H Related Section: Table 8.B

Default: 109 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 013Fh Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings: Refer to P2-18 for explanation.

P2 - 21

DO4

Digital Output Terminal 4 (DO4)

Address: 022AH, 022BH Related Section: Table 8.B

Default: 105 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 013Fh Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings: Refer to P2-18 for explanation.

8-84

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P2 - 22

DO5

Digital Output Terminal 5 (DO5)

Address: 022CH, 022DH Related Section: Table 8.B

Default: 7 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 013Fh Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings: Refer to P2-18 for explanation.

P2 - 23

NCF1

Notch Filter 1 (Resonance Suppression)

Address: 022EH, 022FH Related Section: Section 6.3.7

Default: 1000 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: Hz Range: 50 ~ 1000 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set first resonance frequency of mechanical system. It can be used to suppress the resonance of mechanical system and reduce the vibration of mechanical system. If P2-24 is set to 0, this parameter is disabled. The parameters P2-23 and P2-24 are the first group of notch filter parameters and the parameters P2-43 and P2-44 are the second group of notch filter parameters. Notch Filter Attenuation Rate 1 (Resonance Suppression)

P2 - 24

DPH1

Address: 0230H, 0231H Related Section: Section 6.3.7

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: dB Range: 0 ~ 32 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set magnitude of the resonance suppression that is set by parameter P2-23. If P2-24 is set to 0, the parameters P2-23 and P2-24 are both disabled. The parameters P2-23 and P2-24 are the first group of notch filter parameters and the parameters P2-43 and P2-44 are the second group of notch filter parameters.
Revision January 2011

8-85

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P2 - 25

NLP

Low-pass Filter Time Constant (Resonance Suppression)

Address: 0232H, 0233H Related Section: Section 6.3.7

Default: 2 (1kW and below models) or 5 (other models) Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: 0.1 msec Range: 0 ~ 1000 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set low-pass filter time constant of resonance suppression. If P2-25 is set to 0, this parameter is disabled.

P2 - 26

DST

External Anti-Interference Gain

Address: 0234H, 0235H Related Section: N/A

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: 0.001 Range: 0 ~ 1023 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: If P2-26 is set to 0, this parameter is disabled.

P2 - 27

GCC

Gain Switching Control Selection

Address: 0236H, 0237H Related Section: N/A

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 4 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings: Gain Switching Condition Settings:

8-86

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

A: Gain Switching Condition Settings: 0: Disabled 1: Gain switching DI (Digital Input) signal (GAINUP) is On. (see Table 8.A) 2: In position mode, position deviation is higher than the setting value of P2-29. 3: Position command frequency is higher than the setting value of P2-29. 4: Servo motor speed is higher than the setting value of P2-29. 5: Gain switching DI (Digital Input) signal (GAINUP) is Off. (see Table 8.A) 6: In position mode, position deviation is lower than the setting value of P2-29. 7: Position command frequency is lower than the setting value of P2-29. 8: Servo motor speed is lower than the setting value of P2-29. B: Gain Switching Control Settings: 0: Gain multiple switching 1: P PI switching Setting P mode P2-00 x 100% P2-04 x 100% P2-00 x P2-01 P2-04 x P2-05 S mode P2-04 x 100% P2-04 x P2-05 Status Before switching After switching Before switching After switching

P2-06 x 0% P2-26 x 0% P2-06 x 100% P2-26 x 100%

P2 - 28

GUT

Gain Switching Time Constant

Address: 0238H, 0239H Related Section: N/A

Default: 10 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: 10msec Range: 0 ~ 1000 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the time constant when switching the smooth gain. If P2-28 is set to 0, this parameter is disabled.

Revision January 2011

8-87

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P2 - 29

GPE

Gain Switching Condition

Address: 023AH, 023BH Related Section: N/A

Default: 1280000 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: pulse, Kpps, r/min Range: 0 ~ 3840000 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the value of gain switching condition (pulse error, Kpps, r/min) selected in P2-27. The setting value will be different depending on the different gain switching condition.

P2 - 30 INH

Auxiliary Function

Address: 023CH, 023DH Related Section: N/A

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: -8 ~ +8 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: 0: Disabled all functions described below. 1: Force the servo drive to be Servo On (upon software) 2: Reserved 3: Reserved 4: Reserved

5: After setting P2-30 to 5, the setting values of all parameters will lost (not remain in EEPROM) at power-down. When the parameters data are no more needed, using this mode can allows users not to save parameters data into memory without damaging the EEPROM. P2-30 should be set to 5 when using communication control function. 6: After setting P2-30 to 6, the servo drive will enter into Simulation mode. At this time, DO signal SRDY (Servo ready) will be activated. The servo drive can accept commands in each mode and monitor the commands via Data Scope function provided by ASDA-A2Soft software program. But, the servo motor will not run when the servo drvie in Simulation mode. This setting is only used to check and ensure the command is correct. It indicates the external Servo On signal is disabled in this mode, and therefore the motor fault messages such as overcurrent, overload, or overspeed, etc. will not display. The paraemeter P0-01 displays external fault messages such as reverse inhibit limit, forward inhibit limit, or emergency stop, etc. only.

8-88

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

7: (available in firmware version V1.013 and later models) After setting P2-30 to 7, high-speed oscilloscope and time out function will be disabled (PC software setting). 8: (available in firmware version V1.013 and later models) After setting P2-30 to 8, the system will backup all parameters (current value) and save them to EEPROM. The current value of the backup parameters will not lost after re-start the servo drive. When backup function is executed, to.rom is displayed (backup function can be executed when Servo On). -1, -5, -6, -7: (available in firmware version V1.013 and later models) Disable the function of setting value 1, 5, 6 and 7. -2, -3, -4, -8: Reserved Please note: 1. Please set P2-30 to 0 during normal operation. 2. When the communication control function is used, ensure that P2-30 is set to 5. 3. The setting value of P2-30 will return to 0 automatically after re-power the servo drive. Speed Frequency Response Level in Auto and Semi-Auto Mode

P2 - 31

AUT1

Address: 023EH, 023FH Related Section: Section 5.6, Section 6.3.6

Default: 80 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: Hz Range: 1 ~ 1000 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings:

This parameter allows the users to set the speed frequency response level of autotuning and semi-auto tuning mode. The speed frequency response settings are as follows: 1 ~ 50Hz : Low stiffness and low frequency response 51 ~ 250Hz : Medium stiffness and medium frequency response 251 ~ 850Hz : High stiffness and high frequency response 851 ~ 1000Hz : Extremely high stiffness and extremely high frequency response Please note: 1. The servo drive will set the position frequency response according to the setting value of P2-31. 2. This parameter is activated by P2-32. Please refer to Section 5.6 for the tuning procedure and the related settings.

Revision January 2011

8-89

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P2 - 32 AUT2

Tuning Mode Selection

Address: 0240H, 0241H Related Section: Section 5.6, Section 6.3.6

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 2 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings: 0: Manual mode 1: Auto Mode [Continuous adjustment] 2: Semi-Auto Mode [Non-continuous adjustment] Explanation of manual mode:

1. When P2-32 is set to mode#0, the setting value of P2-00, P2-02, P2-04, P2-06, P2-07, P2-25 and P2-26 can be user-defined. When switching mode #1 or #2 to #0, the setting value of P2-00, P2-02, P2-04, P2-06, P2-07, P2-25 and P2-26 will change to the value that measured in #1 auto-tuning mode or #2 semi-auto tuning mode. Explanation of auto-tuning mode: The servo drive will continuously estimate the system inertia, save the measured load inertia value automatically and memorized in P1-37 every 30 minutes by referring to the frequency response settings of P2-31. 1. When switching mode #1 or #2 to #0, the servo drive will continuously estimate the system inertia, save the measured load inertia value automatically and memorized in P1-37. Then, set the corresponding parameters according to this measured load inertia value. 2. When switching mode#0 or #1 to #2, enter the appropriate load inertia value in P137. 3. When switching mode#1 to #0, the setting value of P2-00, P2-04 and P2-06 will change to the value that measured in #1 auto-tuning mode. Explanation of semi-auto tuning mode: 1. When switching mode #2 to #0, the setting value of P2-00, P2-04, P2-06, P2-25 and P2-26 will change to the value that measured in #1 auto-tuning mode. 2. After the system inertia becomes stable (The displau of P2-33 will show 1), it will stop estimating the system inertia, save the measured load inertia value automatically, and memorized in P1-37. However, when P2-32 is set to mode#1 or #2, the servo drive will continuously perform the adjustment for a period of time. 3. When the value of the system inertia becomes over high, the display of P2-33 will show 0 and the servo drive will start to adjust the load inertia value continuously.

8-90

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P2 - 33 AUT3

Semi-Auto Mode Inertia Adjustment Selection

Address: 0242H, 0243H Related Section: N/A

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 1 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

When the setting value of A is set to 0 or display is 0, it indicates that the load inertia estimation of semi-auto tuning mode has been executed but not been completed yet. When the setting value of A is set to 1, it indicates that the load inertia estimation of semi-auto tuning mode has been completed. The measured load inertia is memorized in P1-37. If P2-33 is reset to 0, the servo drive will perform continuous adjustment for estimating the load inertia (P1-37) again. B: Reserved.

P2 - 34

SDEV

Overspeed Warning Condition

Address: 0244H, 0245H Related Section: N/A

Default: 5000 Applicable Control Mode: S Unit: r/min Range: 1 ~ 5000 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the over speed threshold that is used to determine the over speed fault condition. When the difference in speed between the desired speed and actual motor speed is over than the setting value of parameter P2-34, the servo fault, Overspeed (AL007) will be activated.

Revision January 2011

8-91

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P2 - 35

PDEV

Excessive Error Warning Condition

Address: 0246H, 0247H Related Section: N/A

Default: 3840000 Applicable Control Mode: PT, PR Unit: pulse Range: 1 ~ 128000000 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the position deviation excessive error threshold that is used to determine the escessive deviation fault condition. When the difference in pulse number between the desired position and actual motor position is over than the setting value of parameter P2-35, the servo fault, Excessive Deviation (AL009) will be activated.

P2 - 36

EDI9

External Digital Input Terminal 9 (EDI9)

Address: 0248H, 0249H Related Section: Table 8.A

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 015Fh Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings:

The parameters from P2-36 to P2-41 are used to determine the functions and statuses of external DI9 ~ DI14.

A: DI (Digital Input) Function Settings: For the setting value of P2- 36 ~ P2-41, please refer to Table 8.A. B: External DI (Digital Input) Enabled Status Settings: 0: Normally closed (contact b) 1: Normally open (contact a) For example, when P2-36 is set to 101, it indicates that the function of EDI9 is SON (Servo On, setting value is 0x01) and it requires a normally open contact to be connected to it. Please re-start the servo drive after parameters have been changed.

8-92

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P2 - 37

EDI10

External Digital Input Terminal 10 (EDI10)

Address: 024AH, 024BH Related Section: Table 8.A

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 015Fh Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings: Refer to P2-36 for explanation.

P2 - 38

EDI11

External Digital Input Terminal 11 (EDI11)

Address: 024CH, 024DH Related Section: Table 8.A

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 015Fh Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings: Refer to P2-36 for explanation.

P2 - 39

EDI12

External Digital Input Terminal 12 (EDI12)

Address: 024EH, 024FH Related Section: Table 8.A

Default: N/A Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 015Fh Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings: Refer to P2-36 for explanation.

Revision January 2011

8-93

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P2 - 40

EDI13

External Digital Input Terminal 13 (EDI13)

Address: 0250H, 0251H Related Section: Table 8.A

Default: N/A Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 015Fh Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings: Refer to P2-36 for explanation.

P2 - 41

EDI14

External Digital Input Terminal 14 (EDI14)

Address: 0252H, 0253H Related Section: Table 8.A

Default: N/A Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 015Fh Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings: Refer to P2-36 for explanation.

P2 - 42

Reserved (Do Not Use)

P2 - 43

NCF2

Notch Filter 2 (Resonance Suppression)

Address: 0256H, 0257H Related Section: Section 6.3.7

Default: 1000 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: Hz Range: 50 ~ 2000 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set second resonance frequency of mechanical system. It can be used to suppress the resonance of mechanical system and reduce the vibration of mechanical system. If P2-43 is set to 0, this parameter is disabled. The parameters P2-23 and P2-24 are the first group of notch filter parameters and the parameters P2-43 and P2-44 are the second group of notch filter parameters.

8-94

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P2 - 44

DPH2

Notch Filter Attenuation Rate 2 (Resonance Suppression)

Address: 0258H, 0259H Related Section: Section 6.3.7

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: dB Range: 0 ~ 32 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set magnitude of the resonance suppression that is set by parameter P2-43. If P2-44 is set to 0, the parameters P2-43 and P2-44 are both disabled.

P2 - 45

NCF3

Notch Filter 3 (Resonance Suppression)

Address: 025AH, 025BH Related Section: Section 6.3.7

Default: 1000 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: Hz Range: 50 ~ 2000 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set third resonance frequency of mechanical system. It can be used to suppress the resonance of mechanical system and reduce the vibration of mechanical system. If P2-45 is set to 0, this parameter is disabled. Notch Filter Attenuation Rate 3 (Resonance Suppression)

P2 - 46

DPH3

Address: 025CH, 025DH Related Section: Section 6.3.7

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: dB Range: 0 ~ 32 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set magnitude of the resonance suppression that is set by parameter P2-45. If P2-46 is set to 0, the parameters P2-45 and P2-46 are both disabled.

Revision January 2011

8-95

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P2 - 47

ANCF

Auto Resonance Suppression Mode Selection

Address: 025EH, 025FH Related Section: N/A

Default: 1 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 2 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: 0: Disable Auto Resonance Suppression Mode.

The setting value of P2-23~P2-24 and P2-43~P2-46 will be fixed and will not be changed. 1: Auto Resonance Suppression Mode 1 [Non-continuous adjustment] After the resonance is suppressed, the setting value of P2-23, P2-24, P2-43, P2-44, P2-45 and P2-46 will be fixed and will not be changed. 2: Auto Resonance Suppression Mode 2 [Continuous adjustment] The servo drive will perform the resonance suppression continuously (will not stop). The setting value of P2-23, P2-24, P2-43, P2-44, P2-45 and P2-46 will not be fixed. When P2-47 is set to 1, the resonance suppression will be enabled automatically. After the mechanical system becomes stable, the setting value of P2-47 will return to 0. When the mechanical system is stable, the resonance suppression point will be memorized. When the mechanical system is not stable, if the servo drive is restarted or P2-47 is set to 1, the servo drive will estimate the resonance suppression point again. When P2-47 is set to 2, the servo drive will perform the resonance suppression continuously. When the mechanical system becomes stable, the resonance suppression point will be memorized. When the mechanical system is not stable, if the servo drive is restarted, the servo drive will estimate the resonance suppression point again. When switching the mode#1 or #2 to #0, the setting values of P2-43, P2-44, P2-45 and P2-46 will be saved automatically.

P2 - 48

ANCF

Auto Resonance Suppression Detection Level

Address: 0260H, 0261H Related Section: N/A

Default: 100 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 1 ~ 300% Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

When the setting value is smaller, the system will become more sensitive to detect and find the resonance. 8-96
Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

When the value of The setting value of P2-48 , the sensitivity of detecting resonance . The setting value of P2-48 , the sensitivity of detecting resonance .

P2 - 49

SJIT

Speed Detection Filter and Jitter Suppression

Address: 0262H, 0263H Related Section: N/A

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: sec Range: 0 ~ 1F Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Setting Value of P2-49 00 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 0A 0B 0C 0D 0E 0F 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18

Cutoff Frequency of Speed Loop Feedback (Hz) 2500 2250 2100 2000 1800 1600 1500 1400 1300 1200 1100 1000 950 900 850 800 750 700 650 600 550 500 450 400 350 8-97

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Setting Value of P2-49 19 1A 1B 1C 1D 1E 1F

Cutoff Frequency of Speed Loop Feedback (Hz) 300 250 200 175 150 125 100

P2 - 50

DCLR

Pulse Deviation Clear Mode

Address: 0264H, 0265H Related Section: N/A

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PT, PR Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 2 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings:

For digital input function (DI function), please refer to Table 8.A. This pulse deviation clear function is enabled when a digital input is set to pulse clear function (CCLR mode, DI (Digital Input) setting value is 0x04). When this input is triggered, the position accumulated pulse number will be clear to 0. (available in PT and PR mode only) 0: CCLR is triggered by rising-edge 1: CCLR is triggered bu level

P2 - 51 P2 - 52

Reserved (Do Not Use) Reserved (Do Not Use)

P2 - 53

KPI

Position Integral Compensation

Address: 026AH, 026BH Related Section: Section 6.3.6

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: rad/s Range: 0 ~ 1023 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

8-98

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Settings: This parameter is used to set the integral time of position loop. When the value of position integral compensation is increased, it can decrease the position control deviation. However, if the setting value is over high, it may generate position overshoot or noise.

P2 - 54 P2 - 55 P2 - 56 P2 - 57 P2 - 58 P2 - 59

Reserved (Do Not Use) Reserved (Do Not Use) Reserved (Do Not Use) Reserved (Do Not Use) Reserved (Do Not Use) Reserved (Do Not Use)

P2 - 60

GR4

Electronic Gear Ratio (2nd Numerator) (N2)

Address: 0278H, 0279H Related Section: N/A

Default: 128 Applicable Control Mode: PT Unit: pulse Range: 1 ~ (229-1) Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

The electronic gear numerator value can be set via GNUM0, GNUM1 (refer to Table 8.A). When the GNUM0, GNUM1 are not defined, the default of gear numerator value is set by P1-44. When the users wish to set the gear numerator value by using GNUM0, GNUM1, please set P2-60 ~ P2-62 after the servo motor has been stopped to prevent the mechanical system vibration.

Revision January 2011

8-99

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P2 - 61

GR5

Electronic Gear Ratio (3rd Numerator) (N3)

Address: 027AH, 027BH Related Section: N/A

Default: 128 Applicable Control Mode: PT Unit: pulse Range: 1 ~ (229-1) Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P2-60 for explanation.

P2 - 62

GR6

Electronic Gear Ratio (4th Numerator) (N4)

Address: 027CH, 027DH Related Section: N/A

Default: 128 Applicable Control Mode: PT Unit: pulse Range: 1 ~ (229-1) Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P2-60 for explanation.

P2 - 63 P2 - 64

Reserved (Do Not Use) Reserved (Do Not Use)

8-100

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P2 - 65

GBIT

Special Function 1

Address: 0282H, 0283H Related Section: N/A

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR, PT, S Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 0xFF Data Size: N/A Display Format: N/A Settings:

Bit15 Bit14 Bit13 Bit12 Bit11 Bit10 Bit9 Bit8 Bit7 Bit6 Bit5 Bit4 Bit3 Bit2 Bit1 Bit0

Bit1

Bit0

Bit0: DI SPD0/SPD1 speed command trigger mode Bit0=0: by level Bit0=1: by rising edge Bit1: DI TCM0/TCM1 torque command trigger mode Bit1=0: by level Bit1=1: by rising edge When the servo drive is rising-edge triggered, the internal commands work as follows: A: Execute internal command 1 B: Execute internal command 2 C: Execute internal command 3 D: Execute internal command 3 Bit5 Bit4 Bit3 Bit2

Bit2 ~ Bit5: Reserved. Must be set to 0. Bit6 Bit6: Abnormal pulse command detection (In PT mode) Bit6=0: enable abnormal pulse command detection Bit6=1: disable abnormal pulse command detection Bit7 Bit7: Reserved. Must be set to 0. Bit8 Bit8: U, V, W wiring error detection Bit8=1: enable U, V, W wiring error detection

Revision January 2011

8-101

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Bit9 Bit9: U, V, W wiring cut-off detection Bit9=1: enable U, V, W wiring cut-off detection Bit10 Bit10: DI ZCLAMP function selection When the following conditions are all met, ZCLAMP function will be activated. Condition1: Speed mode Condition2: DI ZCLAMP is activated. Condition3: External analog speed command or internal register speed command is less than parameter P1-38. Bit10=0: When the command source is an analog speed command, the users can use ZCLAMP DI signal to stop the motor at the desire position and do not care the acceleration and deceleration speed curve of the analog speed command. The motor will be locked at the position when ZCLAMP conditions are satisfied.

Bit10=0: When the command source is an internal speed command, the users can use ZCLAMP DI signal to stop the motor at the desire position and keep the the acceleration and deceleration speed curve of the internal speed command. The motor will be locked at the position when ZCLAMP conditions are satisfied.

Bit10=1: When the command source is an analog speed command, the users can use ZCLAMP DI signal to stop the motor at the desire position and do not care the acceleration and deceleration speed curve of the internal speed command. When ZCLAMP conditions are satisfied, the speed command is decreased to 0 r/min. When ZCLAMP conditions are not satisfied, the speed command will follow the analog speed command through Accel/Decel S-curve.

8-102

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Bit10=1: When the command source is an internal speed command, the users can use ZCLAMP DI signal to stop the motor at the desire position and keep the acceleration and deceleration speed curve of the analog speed command. When ZCLAMP conditions are satisfied, the speed command is forced to 0 r/min directly.

B11 Bit11: NL(CWL)/PL(CCWL) pulse input inhibit function Bit11=0: Disable NL(CWL)/PL(CCWL) pulse input inhibit function. In PT mode, no matter NL or PL exists or not, external position pulse command will be input into the servo drive. Bit11=1: Enable NL(CWL)/PL(CCWL) pulse input inhibit function. In PT mode, if NL exists, the external NL pulse input into the servo drive will be inhibited and PL pulse input will be accepted. On the one hand, in PT mode, if PL exists, the external PL pulse input into the servo drive will be inhibited and PL pulse input will be accepted. Please note: If NL and PL both exist, NL and PL pulse input into the servo drive will be both inhibited.

Revision January 2011

8-103

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Bit12 Bit12: Input power phase loss detection function Bit12=0: Enable Input power phase loss (AL022) detection function Bit12=1: Disable Input power phase loss (AL022) detection function Bit13 Bit13: Encoder output error detection function Bit13=0: Enable encoder output error (AL018) detection function Bit13=1: Disable encoder output error (AL018) detection function Bit14 Bit14: Reserved. Must be set to 0.

Bit15 Bit15: Friction Compensation Selection Bit15=0: When external analog speed command or internal register speed command is less than parameter P1-38, the friction compensation value will not change. Bit15=1: When external analog speed command or internal register speed command is less than parameter P1-38, the friction compensation value will change to 0(zero).

P2 - 66

GBIT2

Special Function 2

Address: 0284H, 0285H Related Section: N/A

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR, PT, S Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 0x000F Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings: Bit7 Bit6 Bit5 Bit4 Bit3 Bit2 Bit1 Bit0 Bit1 Bit0

Bit0 ~ Bit1: Reserved. Must be set to 0. Bit2 Bit2: Undervoltage (Servo Drive Fault) clear mode selection Bit2=0: The fault, Undervoltage will not be cleared automatically. Bit2=1: The fault, Undervoltage will be cleared automatically.

8-104

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Bit3 Bit3: Reserved. Must be set to 0. Bit4 Bit4: ALE44 disable selection Bit4=0: The fault, ALE44 is not disabled. Bit4=1: The fault, ALE44 is disabled. Bit5 Bit5: ALE41 disable selection (only available when full-close control function is enabled) Bit5=0: The fault, ALE41 is disabled. Bit5=1: The fault, ALE41 is not disabled. Bit7 Bit6

Bit6 ~ Bit7: Reserved. Must be set to 0.

P2 - 67

JSL

Stable Inertia Estimating Time

Address: 0286H, 0287H Related Section: N/A

Default: 1.5 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: 0.1times Range: 0 ~ 200.0 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

In semi-auto tuning mode, after the servo drive continuously perform the adjustment for a period of time which is determined by P2-67, the system will consider that the system inertia has become stable and finish the operation of system inertia estimation.

Revision January 2011

8-105

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Group 3: P3-xx Communication Parameters


P3 - 00 ADR Communication Address Setting Address: 0300H, 0301H Related Section: Section 9.2

Default: 0x7F Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0x01 ~ 0x7F Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the communication slave address in hexadecimal format. This address is an absolute address which represents the servo drive on a RS-232/485 or CANbus network. Display Range 0 0 Y 0~7 X 0~F

X: Axis number, the value must be within the range from 0 through F. Y: Group number, the value must be within the range from 0 to through 7 If the AC servo drive is controlled by RS-232/485 communication, each drive (or device) must be uniquely identified. One servo drive only can set one address. If the address is duplicated, there will be a communication fault. Please note: 1. This parameter does not provide broadcast function and does not respond insecurity. 2. When the address of host (external) controller is set to 0xFF, it is with auto-respond function. Then, the servo drive will receive from and respond to host (external) controller both no matter the address is matching or not. However, the parameter P3-00 cannot be set to 0xFF.

P3 - 01

BRT

Transmission Speed

Address: 0302H, 0303H Related Section: Section 9.2

Default: 0x0203 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: bps Range: 0x0000 ~ 0x0405 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the baud rate and data transmission speed of the communications.

8-106

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Display COM Port Range

0 0

Z CAN 0~4

Y 0

X RS-232/485 0~5

X: Baud rate setting 0: Baud rate 4800 1: Baud rate 9600 2: Baud rate 19200 3: Baud rate 38400 4: Baud rate 57600 5: Baud rate 115200 Y: Reserved. Must be set to 0. Z: Data transmission speed setting. 0: 125K bits / second 1: 250K bits / second 2: 500K bits / second 3: 750K bits / second 4: 1.0M bits / second Please note: 1. When setting this parameter via CANopen communication, only the setting of Z (data transmission speed setting) can be configured and other settings. 2. The communication transmission speed for USB can be set to 1.0M bits / second only and cannot be changed.

P3 - 02

PTL

Communication Protocol

Address: 0304H, 0305H Related Section: Section 9.2

Default: 6 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 8 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the communication protocol. The alphanumeric characters represent the following: 7 or 8 is the number of data bits; N, E or O refers to the parity bit, Non, Even or Odd; the 1 or 2 is the numbers of stop bits. 0: Modbus ASCII mode, <7,N,2> 1: Modbus ASCII mode, <7,E,1 > 2: Modbus ASCII mode, <7,O,1> 3: Modbus ASCII mode, <8,N,2 >
Revision January 2011

8-107

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

4: Modbus ASCII mode, <8,E,1> 5: Modbus ASCII mode, <8,O,1> 6: Modbus RTU mode, <8,N,2> 7: Modbus RTU mode, <8,E,1> 8: Modbus RTU mode, <8,O,1>

P3 - 03

FLT

Transmission Fault Treatment

Address: 0306H, 0307H Related Section: Section 9.2

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 1 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings:

This parameter is used to determine the operating sequence once a communication fault has been detected. If '1' is selected, the drive will stop operating upon detection the communication fault. The mode of stopping is set by parameter P1-32. 0: Display fault and continue operating 1: Display fault and decelerate to stop operating (deceleration time is determined by parameter P5-03)

P3 - 04

CWD

Communication Time Out Detection

Address: 0308H, 0309H Related Section: Section 9.2

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: sec Range: 0 ~ 20 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the maximum permissible time before detecting a fault due to communication time out. When P3-04 is set to a value over than 0, it indicates this parameter is enabled. However, if not communicating with the servo in this period of time, the servo drive will assume the communication has failed and show the communication error fault message. When P3-04 is set to 0, this parameter is disabled.

8-108

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P3 - 05

CMM

Communication Selection

Address: 030AH, 030BH Related Section: Section 9.2

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0x00 ~ 0x01 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings: Communication interface selection 0: RS-232 1: RS-485

Multiple communication modes RS232 and RS-485 cannot be used within one communication ring. Point-to-point connection or multidrop connection can be selected.

P3 - 06 SDI

Digital Input Communication Function

Address: 030CH, 030DH Related Section: Section 9.2

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0x0000 ~ 0x3FFF Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal

The setting of this parameter determines how the Digital Inputs (DI) accept commands and signals. Bit0 ~ Bit 7 corresponds with DI1 ~ DI8. The least significant bit (Bit0) shows DI1 status and the most significant bit (Bit7) shows DI8 status. Bit8 ~ Bit14 corresponds with EDI9 ~ EDI14. Bit settings: 0: Digital input is controlled by external command (via CN1) 1: Digital input is controlled by parameter P4-07 For the settings of DI1 ~ DI8, please refer to P2-10 ~ P2-17. For the settings of EDI9 ~ EDI14, please refer to P2-36 ~ P2-41. This parameter P3-06 also works in conjunction with the parameter P4-07 which has several functions. Please see section 9.2 for details.

Revision January 2011

8-109

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P3 - 07

CDT

Communication Response Delay Time

Address: 030EH, 030FH Related Section: Section 9.2

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: 1msec Range: 0 ~ 1000 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to delay the communication time that servo drive responds to host controller (external controller).

P3 - 08 MNS

Monitor Mode

Address: 0310H, 0311H Related Section: Section 9.2

Default: 0000 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: refer to the description of Settings Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings:

This parameter is used to monitor the data of the servo drive via communication. The monitor data can be displayed on PC upon the data scope function provided by ASDAA2-Soft software. Word Function Range 0 0 Low High

Monitor time Monitor mode at low speed 0~F 0~3

H: Monitor mode, the value must be within the range from 0 through 3. 0: Disabled, i.e. disable monitor function. 1: Low-speed monitor mode. The sampling time is determined by the setting value of L and 4 channels can be monitored. 2: High-speed monitor mode. The sampling time is 8000 times per second and 4 channels can be monitored. 3: High-speed monitor mode. The sampling time is 16000 times per second and 2 channels can be monitored. L: Sampling time in low-speed monitor mode (units: millisecond) When the setting value of L is set (more than 0), the system will send a monitor message via USB device every L milliseconds to host controller so as to monitor the status of the servo drive. Each monitor message includes the data of 4 channels (16 bits x 4). 8-110
Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

If the setting value of L is set to 0, it indicates that low-speed monitor function is disabled. Low-speed monitor function is enabled only when the setting value of H is set to 1.

P3 - 09

SYC

CANopen Synchronization Setting

Address: 0312H, 0313H Related Section: Section 9.2

Default: 0x57A1 Applicable Control Mode: CANopen Unit: N/A Range: refer to the description of Settings Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the CANopen slave to be synchronized with the CANopen master through synchronization signal. Although this parameter allows the users to execute manual adjustment, if not necessary, we do not recommend users to change the default setting manually. Display Function Range E T D M Clock correction setting 1~F

SYNC error Dead zone Target value range range 1~9 0~9 0~F

M: Clock correction setting, the value must be within the range from 1 through F, and the unit is usec. When setting the CANopen slave to be synchronized with the CANopen master, the clock of the servo drive must be corrected. This function is used to set the maximum correction everytime. D: Dead zone range, the value must be within the range from 0 through F, and the unit is usec. When the difference between actual value and target value of SYNC signal reach time does not exceed the dead zone range, the clock correction does not need to be changed. T: Target value of SYNC signal reach time, the value must be within the range from 0 through 9, and the standard value of SYNC signal reach time is 500 usec. Target reach time of synchronization signal = 400 + 10 x setting value of T. For example: When T is set to 5, the target reach time of synchronization signal = 400 + 10 x 5 = 450 There should be a buffer between the target value and the standard value. The target value should be less than the standard value. If the target value is above than the standard value, an error may occur.

Revision January 2011

8-111

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

E: SYNC error range, the value must be within the range from 1 through 9, and the unit is 10 usec. When the difference between actual value and target value of SYNC signal reach time is below this range, it indicates that the CANopen slave synchronize with the CANopen master through synchronization signal.

P3 - 10 P3 - 11

Reserved (Do Not Use) Reserved (Do Not Use)

8-112

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Group 4: P4-xx Diagnosis Parameters


P4 - 00 ASH1 Fault Record (N) Address: 0400H, 0401H Related Section: Section 4.4.2

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: N/A Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings: This parameter is used to set the most recent fault record.

Display of Low Word: LXXXX: It indicates the fault code, i.e. alarm code Display of High Word: hYYYY: It indicates the corresponding CANopen error code.

P4 - 01 ASH2

Fault Record (N-1)

Address: 0402H, 0403H Related Section: Section 4.4.2

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: N/A Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the second most recent fault record.

P4 - 02 ASH3

Fault Record (N-2)

Address: 0404H, 0405H Related Section: Section 4.4.2

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: N/A Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the third most recent fault record.

Revision January 2011

8-113

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P4 - 03 ASH4

Fault Record (N-3)

Address: 0406H, 0407H Related Section: Section 4.4.2

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: N/A Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the fourth most recent fault record.

P4 - 04 ASH5

Fault Record (N-4)

Address: 0408H, 0409H Related Section: Section 4.4.2

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: N/A Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the fifth most recent fault record.

P4 - 05

JOG

JOG Operation

Address: 040AH, 040BH Related Section: Section 4.4.2

Default: 20 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: r/min Range: 0 ~ 5000 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: JOG operation command: 1. Operation Test

(1) Press the SET key to display the JOG speed. (The default value is 20 r/min). (2) Press the UP or DOWN arrow keys to increase or decrease the desired JOG speed. (This also can be undertaken by using the SHIFT key to move the cursor to the desired unit column (the effected number will flash) then changed using the UP and DOWN arrow keys). (3) Press the SET when the desired JOG speed is displayed. The Servo Drive will display "JOG".

8-114

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

(4) Press the UP or DOWN arrow keys to jog the motor either P(CCW) or N(CW) direction. The motor will only rotation while the arrow key is activated. (5) To change JOG speed again, press the MODE key. The servo Drive will display "P4 - 05". Press the SET key and the JOG speed will displayed again. Refer back to #(2) and #(3) to change speed. (6) In JOG operation mode, if any fault occurs, the motor will stop running. The maximum JOG speed is the rated speed of the servo motor. 2. DI Signal Control Set the value of DI signal as JOGU and JOGD (refer to Table 8.A). Users can perform JOG run forward and run reverse control. 3. Communication Control To perform a JOG Operation via communication command, use communication addresses 040AH and 040BH. (1) Enter 1 ~ 5000 for the desired JOG speed (2) Enter 4998 to JOG in the P(CCW) direction (3) Enter 4999 to JOG in the N(CW) direction (4) Enter 0 to stop the JOG operation Please note that when using communication control, please set P2-30 to 5 to avoid that there are excessive writes to the system flash memory. P4 - 06

FOT

Force Output Contact Control

Address: 040CH, 040DH Related Section: Section 4.4.3

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 0xFF Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings:

The function of Digital Outout (DO) is determined by the DO setting value. The user can set DO setting value (0x30 ~ 0x3F) via communication and then write the values into P4-06 to complete the settings. Bit00 corresponds with DO setting value 0x30 Bit01 corresponds with DO setting value 0x31 Bit02 corresponds with DO setting value 0x32 Bit03 corresponds with DO setting value 0x33 Bit04 corresponds with DO setting value 0x34 Bit05 corresponds with DO setting value 0x35 Bit06 corresponds with DO setting value 0x36 Bit07 corresponds with DO setting value 0x37
Revision January 2011

8-115

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Bit08 corresponds with DO setting value 0x38 Bit09 corresponds with DO setting value 0x39 Bit10 corresponds with DO setting value 0x3A Bit11 corresponds with DO setting value 0x3B Bit12 corresponds with DO setting value 0x3C Bit13 corresponds with DO setting value 0x3D Bit14 corresponds with DO setting value 0x3E Bit15 corresponds with DO setting value 0x3F For example: When P2-18 is set to 0x0130, it indicates that the state of DO1 is the Bit00 state of P406. This parameter can also be used to force the state of DO signal. Please refer to P2-18 ~ P2-22 to assign the functions of digital outouts (DO signals) and section 4.4.3 for the Force Outputs Operation.

P4 - 07 ITST

Input Status

Address: 040EH, 040FH Related Section: Section 4.4.4, Section 9.2

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 3FFF Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings:

The control of digital inputs can be determined by the external terminals (DI1 ~ DI8, EDI9 ~ EDI14) or by the internal software digital inputs SDI1 ~ SDI14 (corresponds to Bit0 ~ Bit13 of P1-47) via communication (upon software). Please refer to P3-06 and section 9.2 for the setting method. P3-06 External DIs Internal DIs Read or Write Final DI Status

Read P4-07: Display the final status of DI input signal. Write P1-47: Write the status of software digital inputs SDI1 ~ SDI14 (No matter the servo drive is controller through digital keypad or communication control, the function of this parameter is the same.)

8-116

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

For example: External Control: Display the final status of DI input signal When the read value of P4-07 is 0x0011, it indicates that DI1 and DI5 are ON. Communication Control (Internal DIs): Read the status of input signal (upon software). For example: When the write value of P4-07 is 0x0011, it indicates that software digital inputs SDI1 and SDI5 are ON. Bit0 ~ Bit7 corresponds with DI1 ~ DI8. Bit8 ~ Bit14 corresponds with EDI9 ~ EDI14. For the settings of DI1 ~ DI8, please refer to P2-10 ~ P2-17. For the settings of EDI9 ~ EDI14, please refer to P2-36 ~ P2-41.

P4 - 08 PKEY

Digital Keypad Input of Servo Drive

Address: 0410H, 0411H Related Section: N/A

Default: N/A Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: Read only Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings:

This parameter is used to check if MODE, UP, DOWN, SHIFT, and SET keys on the drive keypad being pressed or not. It is used to examine if these five keys work normally via communication during production.

P4 - 09 MOT

Output Status

Address: 0412H, 0413H Related Section: Section 4.4.5

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 0x1F Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings:

There is no difference when reading DO output signal via the drive keypad or the communication. For the status of DO output signal, please refer to P2-18 ~ P2-22.

Revision January 2011

8-117

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P4 - 10 CEN

Adjustment Function

Address: 0414H, 0415H Related Section: N/A

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 6 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: 0: Reserved 1: Execute analog speed input drift adjustment 2: Execute analog torque input drift adjustment 3: Execute current detector (V phase) drift adjustment 4: Execute current detector (W phase) drift adjustment 5: Execute drift adjustment of the above 1~4 6: Execute IGBT NTC calibration Please note:

1. This adjustment function is enabled after parameter P2-08 is set to 20. 2. When executing any adjustment, the external wiring connected to analog speed or torque must be removed and the servo system should be off (Servo off).

P4 - 11

SOF1

Analog Speed Input Drift Adjustment 1

Address: 0416H, 0417H Related Section: N/A

Default: Factory setting Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 32767 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

The adjustment functions from P4-11 through P4-19 are enabled after parameter P2-08 is set to 22. Although these parameters allow the users to execute manual adjustment, we still do not recommend the users to change the default setting value of these parameters (P4-11 ~ P4-19) manually. Please note that when P2-08 is set to 10, the users cannot reset this parameter.

8-118

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P4 - 12

SOF2

Analog Speed Input Drift Adjustment 2

Address: 0418H, 0419H Related Section: N/A

Default: Factory setting Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 32767 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P4-11 for explanation.

Please note that when P2-08 is set to 10, the users cannot reset this parameter.

P4 - 13

TOF1

Analog Torque Drift Adjustment 1

Address: 041AH, 041BH Related Section: N/A

Default: Factory setting Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 32767 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P4-11 for explanation.

Please note that when P2-08 is set to 10, the users cannot reset this parameter.

P4 - 14

TOF2

Analog Torque Drift Adjustment 2

Address: 041CH, 041DH Related Section: N/A

Default: Factory setting Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 32767 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P4-11 for explanation.

Please note that when P2-08 is set to 10, the users cannot reset this parameter.

Revision January 2011

8-119

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P4 - 15

COF1

Current Detector Drift Adjustment (V1 phase)

Address: 041EH, 041FH Related Section: N/A

Default: Factory setting Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 32767 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P4-11 for explanation.

Please note that when P2-08 is set to 10, the users cannot reset this parameter.

P4 - 16

COF2

Current Detector Drift Adjustment (V2 phase)

Address: 0420H, 0421H Related Section: N/A

Default: Factory setting Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 32767 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P4-11 for explanation.

Please note that when P2-08 is set to 10, the users cannot reset this parameter. Current phase) Detector Drift Adjustment (W1

P4 - 17

COF3

Address: 0422H, 0423H Related Section: N/A

Default: Factory setting Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 32767 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P4-11 for explanation.

Please note that when P2-08 is set to 10, the users cannot reset this parameter.

8-120

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P4 - 18

COF4

Current phase)

Detector

Drift

Adjustment

(W2

Address: 0424H, 0425H Related Section: N/A

Default: Factory setting Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 32767 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P4-11 for explanation.

Please note that when P2-08 is set to 10, the users cannot reset this parameter.

P4 - 19

TIGB

IGBT NTC Calibration

Address: 0426H, 0427H Related Section: N/A

Default: Factory setting Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 1 ~ 4 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P4-11 for explanation.

When executing this auto adjustment, please ensure to cool the servo drive to 25 C. Please note that when P2-08 is set to 10, the users cannot reset this parameter. Analog Monitor Output Drift Adjustment (CH1)

P4 - 20

DOF1

Address: 0428H, 0429H Related Section: Section 6.4.4

Default: Factory setting Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: mV Range: -800 ~ 800 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

Please note that when P2-08 is set to 10, the users cannot reset this parameter.

Revision January 2011

8-121

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P4 - 21

DOF2

Analog Monitor Output Drift Adjustment (CH2)

Address: 042AH, 042BH Related Section: Section 6.4.4

Default: Factory setting Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: mV Range: -800 ~ 800 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

Please note that when P2-08 is set to 10, the users cannot reset this parameter.

P4 - 22

SAO

Analog Speed Input Offset

Address: 042CH, 042DH Related Section: N/A

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: S Unit: mV Range: -5000 ~ 5000 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

In speed mode, the users can use this parameter to add an offset value to analog speed input.

P4 - 23

TAO

Analog Torque Input Offset

Address: 042EH, 042FH Related Section: N/A

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: T Unit: mV Range: -5000 ~ 5000 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

In speed mode, the users can use this parameter to add an offset value to analog speed input.

8-122

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P4 - 24

LVL

Undervoltage Error Level

Address: 0430H, 0431H Related Section: N/A

Default: 160 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: V (rms) Range: 140 ~ 190 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

When DC Bus voltage is lower than the value of P4-24 x 2 , the fault, Undervoltage will occur.

Revision January 2011

8-123

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Group 5: P5-xx Motion Control Parameters


P5 - 00 P5 - 01 P5 - 02 Reserved (Do Not Use) Reserved (Do Not Use) Reserved (Do Not Use)

P5 - 03

PDEC

Deceleration Time of Protectin Function

Address: 0506H, 0507H Related Section: N/A

Default: 0XE0EFEEFF Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xF0FFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings: Display Function Range High Word D STP 0~F C Reserve d B CTO 0~F A OVF 0~F W SNL 0~F

Low Word Z SPL 0~F Y NL 0~F X PL 0~F

This parameter is used to set motor deceleration when protection functions, such as STOP (Motor stop), OVF (Position command overflow), SNL (Reverse software limit), SPL (Forward software limit), NL (Reverse inhibit limit) or PL (Forward inhibit limit), etc. are activated. 1. Deceleration time of protection functions include: OVF, CTO(AL020), SPL, SNL, PL, NL 2. Deceleration time of motor stop command: STP When entering P5-03, Lower Word display will show first. After pressing SHIFT key on the drive keypad, the High Word display will show next. The values from 0 through F correspond with the setting values from P5-20 through P535. For example, when the setting value X is set to A, it indicates that the motor PL deceleration time is determined by parameter P5-30.

P5 - 04

HMOV

Homing Mode

Address: 0508H, 0509H Related Section: N/A

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PT, PR Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 0x128

8-124

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings: This parameter is used to determine the homing characteristics of the servo motor. Display W Z Limit setting 0~1 Y Z pulse setting 0~2 Y=0: Stop and return to Z pulse. Y=1: Go forward to Z pulse. Y=2: Ingore Z pulse X Homing direction setting 0~8 X=0: Move forward to PL(CCWL) used as home. X=1: Move reverse to NL(CWL) used as home. When there is a limit: Z=0: After reaching the limit, activate the limit signal. Z=1: After reaching the limit, the motor will run in the reverse direction. X=2: Move forward to dedicated home sensor (ORGP: OFF ON) X=3: Move reverse to dedicated home sensor (ORGP: OFF ON) X=4: Move forward and regard Z pulse as home sensor. X=5: Move reverse and regard Z pulse as home sensor. Y=0: Stop and return to Z pulse. Y=1: Go forward to Z pulse. Y=2: Ingore Z pulse X=6: Move forward to dedicated home sensor (ORGP: ON OFF) X=7: Move reverse to dedicated home sensor (ORGP: ON OFF) X=8: Regard current position as home sensor

Function Reserved Range Settings -

Revision January 2011

8-125

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P5 - 05

HSPD1

1st Speed Setting of High Speed Homing

Address: 050AH, 050BH Related Section: N/A

Default: 100.0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: 0.1 r/min Range: 1 ~ 2000.0 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

Settings: This parameter is used to set the initial (high speed) homing speed. The homing operation of the servo motor involves two homing speed settings. When homeing is triggered, the servo motor will proceed at a high speed speed until a home sensor is detected. The servo motor will then move reverse at a low speed speed until off of the home sensor, and finally will stop at the next Z pulse.

P5 - 06

HSPD2

2nd Speed Setting of Low Speed Homing

Address: 050CH, 050DH Related Section: N/A

Default: 20.0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: 0.1 r/min Range: 1 ~ 500.0 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the secondary (low speed) homing speed. Refer to P5-06 for explanation.

P5 - 07 PRCM

Trigger Position Command (PR mode only)

Address: 050EH, 050FH Related Section: N/A

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 1000 8-126

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: There are 64 stored positions can be programmed via a combination of the POS0 ~ POS5 commands. This parameter is used to trigger the dedicated position command in PR mode and command the motor to move to the dedicated position instead of using DI (Digital Input) CTRG and POS0 ~ POS5. 0: Start homing function. When entering P5-07, the default setting value 0 will display. Pressing SET key on the drive keypad, the servo motor will start homing operation. 1 ~ 63: Trigger Position Command (This function is equivalent to the function of DI CTRG signal + POSn signal). When P5-07 is set to 1 ~ 63, the dedicated position command can be triggered and the servo drive will command the motor move to the the dedicated position. For example, when P5-07 is set to 1, the position command P1 is triggered and the servo drive will command the motor to move to the position which correspond the position command P1. 64 ~ 9999: Write inhibit (Invaild setting value) 1000: Stop positioning. When P5-07 is set to 1000, the motor stop command will be activated. This function is equivalent to the function of DI STOP signal. The display value of P5-07: 1. When the motor does not receive the drive command (the motor is not running), if the users read P5-07 at this time, the display value of P5-07 will be the setting value of P5-07 2. When the position command is triggered and the motor start runningbut does not reach the dedicated position (during positioning, the motor is running), if the users read P5-07 at this time, the display value of P5-07 will be setting value of P5-07 plus 10000. 3. When the position command is triggered and the motor reachs the dedicated position (the positioning is completed and the motor stop running), if the users read P5-07 at this time, the display value of P5-07 will be setting value of P5-07 plus 20000. For example, when P5-07 is set to 3, it indicates that the position command P3 will be triggered. 1. If the display value of P5-07 is 3, it indicates that the motor does not receive the drive command and the motor is not running. 2. If the display value of P5-07 is 100003, it indicates that the position command is triggered but the positioning is not completed. 3. If the display value of P5-07 is 200003, it indicates that the position command is triggered and the positioning is completed.

Revision January 2011

8-127

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P5 - 08

SWLP

Forward Software Limit

Address: 0510H, 0511H Related Section: N/A

Default: 2147483647 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: PUU Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal

P5 - 09

SWLN

Reverse Software Limit

Address: 0512H, 0513H Related Section: N/A

Default: -2147483648 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: PUU Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal

P5 - 10 AYSZ

Data Array: Data Amount (N x 32 bits)

Address: 0514H, 0515H Related Section: Section 7.2

Default: N/A Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: read only Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the data amount of data arrady (N x 32 bits). N is the capacity of the data array.

P5 - 11 AYID

Data Array: Read / Write Address

Address: 0516H, 0517H Related Section: Section 7.2

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ (P5-10-1) Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the data address when reading and writing data array.

8-128

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P5 - 12 AYD0

Data Array: Read / Write Data Block 1

Address: 0518H, 0519H Related Section: Section 7.2

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to read the data block 0 of data arrady (Array[P5-11++]). For example, when P5-11 is set to 100, the first read data displayed by P5-12 is the 100th data, the secondary read data is 101+1=102th data, the third read data is 102+1 = 103th data and vise versa. By the same logic, when P5-11 is set to 100, the first written data displayed by P5-12 is the 100th data, the secondary written data is 101+1=102th data, the third written data is 102+1 = 103th data and vise versa. However, if P5-12 is read via the drive keypad, only the 101th data will be read.

P5 - 13

AYD1

Data Array: Read / Write Data Block 2

Address: 051AH, 051BH Related Section: Section 7.2

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to read the data block 2 of data arrady (Array[P5-11++]). The usage of this parameter is the same as the parameter P5-12. Only one function is different. When P5-12 is read via the drive keypad, the first read data displayed by P512 is the 100th data, the secondary read data is 101+1=102th data, the third read data is 102+1 = 103th data and vise versa. It indicates that using P5-13 can read more than one data via the drive keypad. Please note that using P5-13 can not write data via the drive keypad.

P5 - 14

Reserved (Do Not Use)

Revision January 2011

8-129

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P5 - 15 PMEM

PATH 1 ~ PATH 2 Data Not Retained Setting

Address: 051EH, 051FH Related Section: N/A

Default: 0x0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0x0 ~ 0x0011 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings:

This parameter is designed for the users who need to change the positioning point frequently via communication. Display Range 0 0 Y 0~1 X 0~1

X=0: The data of PATH 1 (P6-02 ~P6-03) will be retained (memorized) when the power goes off. X=1: The data of PATH 1 (P6-02 ~P6-03) will not be retained (memorized) when the power goes off. Y=0: The data of PATH 2 (P6-04 ~P6-05) will be retained (memorized) when the power goes off. Y=1: The data of PATH 2 (P6-04 ~P6-05) will not be retained (memorized) when the power goes off. Other settings: Reserved

P5 - 16 AXEN

Axis Position: Motor Encoder

Address: 0520H, 0521H Related Section: Section 7.3

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: PUU (user unit) Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

Read function: This parameter is used to read the actual position of the motor encoder, i.e. the monitor variable V000 + deviation value. Write function (available in firmware V1.015 and later models only): The users can write any value and doing this will no change the value of monitor variable V000 and will not affect the position coordinate either.

8-130

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P5 - 17

AXPC

Axis Position: Auxiliary Encoder (Pulse Command Feedback)

Address: 0522H, 0523H Related Section: Section 7.3

Default: N/A Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: pulse Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to send back the pulse counts of the auxiliary encoder (linear scale).

P5 - 18

AXAU

Axis Position: Pulse Command

Address: 0524H, 0525H Related Section: Section 7.3

Default: N/A Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to send back the pulse counts of pulse command.

P5 - 19

TBS

E-Cam Curve Scaling

Address: 0526H, 0527H Related Section: Section 7.3

Default: 1.000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: 0.000001 times, i.e. 1/ (10^6) Range: -2147.000000 ~ +2147.000000 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal

Settings: (available in firmware V1.017 and later models only) This parameter is used to magnify or minify the E-Cam table without changing the setting value of the E-Cam table. For example: When the data of the table is 0,10,20,30,40,20, if the magnification is set to 2.000000, it is equal to the data 0,20,40,60,80,40 which the magnification is set to 1.000000. When using the same pulse frequency of master axis to drive E-Cam operation, increasing the setting value of P5-19 will magnify the route of E-Cam operation and increase the operation speed as well. 8-131

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Please note: 1. This parameter can be set any time. However, it is effective only when the electronic gear is engaged. 2. ASDA-A2 series L type models does not provide Electronic Cam (E-Cam) function.

P5 - 20

ACO

Accel / Decel Time 0

Address: 0528H, 0529H Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 200 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: msec Range: 1 ~ 65500 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

In PR mode, this parameter is used to set the acceleration and deceleration time, i.e. the necessary time when the motor reachs the speed of 3000 r/min from 0.

P5 - 21

AC1

Accel / Decel Time 1

Address: 052AH, 052BH Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 300 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: msec Range: 1 ~ 65500 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P5-20 for explanation.

P5 - 22

AC2

Accel / Decel Time 2

Address: 052CH, 052DH Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 500 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: msec Range: 1 ~ 65500 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P5-20 for explanation.

8-132

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P5 - 23

AC3

Accel / Decel Time 3

Address: 052EH, 052FH Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 600 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: msec Range: 1 ~ 65500 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P5-20 for explanation.

P5 - 24

AC4

Accel / Decel Time 4

Address: 0530H, 0531H Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 800 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: msec Range: 1 ~ 65500 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P5-20 for explanation.

P5 - 25

AC5

Accel / Decel Time 5

Address: 0532H, 0533H Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 900 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: msec Range: 1 ~ 65500 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P5-20 for explanation.

Revision January 2011

8-133

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P5 - 26

AC6

Accel / Decel Time 6

Address: 0534H, 0535H Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 1000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: msec Range: 1 ~ 65500 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P5-20 for explanation.

P5 - 27

AC7

Accel / Decel Time 7

Address: 0536H, 0537H Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 1200 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: msec Range: 1 ~ 65500 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P5-20 for explanation.

P5 - 28

AC8

Accel / Decel Time 8

Address: 0538H, 0539H Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 1500 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: msec Range: 1 ~ 65500 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P5-20 for explanation.

8-134

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P5 - 29

AC9

Accel / Decel Time 9

Address: 053AH, 053BH Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 2000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: msec Range: 1 ~ 65500 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P5-20 for explanation.

P5 - 30

AC10

Accel / Decel Time 10

Address: 053CH, 053DH Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 2500 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: msec Range: 1 ~ 65500 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P5-20 for explanation.

P5 - 31

AC11

Accel / Decel Time 11

Address: 053EH, 053FH Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 3000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: msec Range: 1 ~ 65500 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P5-20 for explanation.

Revision January 2011

8-135

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P5 - 32

AC12

Accel / Decel Time 12

Address: 0540H, 0541H Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 5000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: msec Range: 1 ~ 65500 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P5-20 for explanation.

P5 - 33

AC13

Accel / Decel Time 13

Address: 0542H, 0543H Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 8000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: msec Range: 1 ~ 65500 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P5-20 for explanation.

P5 - 34

AC14

Accel / Decel Time 14

Address: 0544H, 0545H Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 50 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: msec Range: 1 ~ 65500 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

The default setting value of this parameter is smaller and it is for the deceleration setting when protection function is activated.

8-136

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P5 - 35

AC15

Accel / Decel Time 15

Address: 0546H, 0547H Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 30 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: msec Range: 1 ~ 65500 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

The default setting value of this parameter is smaller and it is for the deceleration setting when the motor stops in high speed.

P5 - 36

CAST

CAPTURE: Start Address of Data Array

Address: 0548H, 0549H Related Section: Section 7.11.1

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ (P5-10-1) Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to specify the start address which captures the first point data and save it into data array. Please note: This parameter can be set only when capture operation is stopped (Refer to P5-39).

P5 - 37 CAAX

CAPTURE: Axis Position CNT

Address: 054AH, 054BH Related Section: Section 7.11.1

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter can be set only when capture operation is stopped (Refer to P5-39). Please note: 1. Do not change this parameter when the capture source is the motor encoder. 2. When the capture source is the motor encoder, the value of this parameter is reset to the motor encoder feedback position (monitor variable is 00h).
Revision January 2011

8-137

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P5 - 38 CANO

CAPTURE: Capture Amount

Address: 054CH, 054DH Related Section: Section 7.11.1

Default: 1 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 1 ~ (P5-10 P5-36) Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

When the compare function is not enabled, using this parameter can set the estimated capture amount (able to read and write). Once the capture function is enabled, everytime when one position is captured, the setting value of P5-38 will decrease 1. When the setting value of P5-38 is equal to 0, it indicates that the capture operation has finished. Please note: 1. The total amount of COMPARE, CAPTURE and E-Cam data can not exceed the number of 800. 2. ASDA-A2 series L type models does not provide Electronic Cam (E-Cam) function.

P5 - 39 CACT

CAPTURE: Capture Source Setting

Address: 054EH, 054FH Related Section: Section 7.11.1

Default: 0x2010 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0x0000 ~ 0xF13F Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings:

This parameter is used to determine the capture source and enable the capture function.

A B C D Low Word

A: Capture function settings:

8-138

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Please refer to the following table and descriptions: Bit 3 Execute PR command when capture function has finished. 2 After first position is captured, the system will enable the compare function The compare function is enabled already, and this setting will become ineffective. 1 After first position is captured, the position will be reset. 0 Start capture function

Function

Explanation

After capture function has finished, execute PR 50 command.

When the first point is captured, the position coordinate will be reset.

Setting Bit0 to 1 will enable the capture function. When capture function has finished, the value of Bit0 will be reset to 0 automatically.

Bit0: When the value of P5-38 is higher than 0, setting Bit0 to 1 will enable the capture function and the DO signal, CAP_OK is inactivated. Once the capture function is enabled, everytime when one position is captured, the setting value of P5-38 will decrease 1. When the setting value of P5-38 is equal to 0, it indicates that the capture operation has finished. Then, DO signal, CAP_OK will be activated and the value of Bit0 will be reset to 0 automatically. When the value of P5-38 is equal to 0, setting Bit0 to 1 will not enable the capture function, the DO signal, CAP_OK will be inactivated and then the value of Bit0 will be reset to 0 automatically. If Bit0 is set to 1 already, the new setting value cannot be 1. The users only can set Bit0 to 0 to disable the capture function. Bit1: When Bit1 is set to 1, after first position is captured, the system will set the value of the current position as the value of the parameter P5-76. Bit2: When Bit2 is set to 1, after first position is captured, the system will enable the compare function (Bit0 of P5-59 is set to 1 and the value of P5-58 is set to the last compare amount). If the compare function is enabled already, this setting will become ineffective. Bit3: When Bit3 is set to 1, after capture operation is completed (all positions has been captured), the position command P50 will be triggered immediately. B: Capture source settings 0: Capture function is disabled. 1: Auxiliary encoder (linear scale). 2: Pulse command. 3: Motor encoder C: Activate state settings 0: Normally open (use N.O. contact) 1: Normally closed (use N.C. contact) D: Trigger time settings (unit: msec) 8-139

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P5 - 40

DLY0

Delay Time 0

Address: 0550H, 0551H Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: msec Range: 0 ~ 32767 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

P5 - 41

DLY1

Delay Time 1

Address: 0552H, 0553H Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 100 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: msec Range: 0 ~ 32767 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

P5 - 42

DLY2

Delay Time 2

Address: 0554H, 0555H Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 200 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: msec Range: 0 ~ 32767 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

P5 - 43

DLY3

Delay Time 3

Address: 0556H, 0557H Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 400 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: msec Range: 0 ~ 32767 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

8-140

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P5 - 44

DLY4

Delay Time 4

Address: 0558H, 0559H Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 500 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: msec Range: 0 ~ 32767 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

P5 - 45

DLY5

Delay Time 5

Address: 055AH, 055BH Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 800 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: msec Range: 0 ~ 32767 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

P5 - 46

DLY6

Delay Time 6

Address: 055CH, 055DH Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 1000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: msec Range: 0 ~ 32767 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

P5 - 47

DLY7

Delay Time 7

Address: 055EH, 055FH Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 1500 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: msec Range: 0 ~ 32767 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

Revision January 2011

8-141

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P5 - 48

DLY8

Delay Time 8

Address: 0560H, 0561H Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 2000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: msec Range: 0 ~ 32767 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

P5 - 49

DLY9

Delay Time 9

Address: 0562H, 0563H Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 2500 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: msec Range: 0 ~ 32767 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

P5 - 50

DLY10

Delay Time 10

Address: 0564H, 0565H Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 3000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: msec Range: 0 ~ 32767 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

P5 - 51

DLY11

Delay Time 11

Address: 0566H, 0567H Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 3500 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: msec Range: 0 ~ 32767 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

8-142

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P5 - 52

DLY12

Delay Time 12

Address: 0568H, 0569H Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 4000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: msec Range: 0 ~ 32767 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

P5 - 53

DLY13

Delay Time 13

Address: 056AH, 056BH Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 4500 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: msec Range: 0 ~ 32767 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

P5 - 54

DLY14

Delay Time 14

Address: 056CH, 056DH Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 5000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: msec Range: 0 ~ 32767 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

P5 - 55

DLY15

Delay Time 15

Address: 056EH, 056FH Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 5500 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: msec Range: 0 ~ 32767 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

Revision January 2011

8-143

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P5 - 56

CMST

COMPARE: Start Address of Data Array

Address: 0570H, 0571H Related Section: Section 7.11.2

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ (P5-10-1) Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to specify the start address which compares the first point data and save it into data array. Please note: This parameter can be set only when COMPARE function is disabled (Refer to P5-59).

P5 - 57 CMAX

COMPARE: Axis Position

Address: 0572H, 0573H Related Section: Section 7.11.2

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter can be set only when COMPARE function is disabled (Refer to P5-59). Please note: 1. Do not change this parameter when the compare source is the capture axis and motor encoder. 2. The pulse resolution is determined by the parameter P1-46. 3. When the setting value B of the parameter P5-59 is set to 3, i.e. the compare source is the motor encoder, the value of this parameter is reset to the motor encoder feedback position (monitor variable is 00h). If the motor encoder feedback position is different from this parameter because homing operation is enabled or the capture function setting is changed, the users can set the setting value B of P5-59 to 3 to make this parameter to be equivalent to the motor encoder feedback position.

8-144

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P5 - 58 CMNO

COMPARE: Compare Amount

Address: 0574H, 0575H Related Section: Section 7.11.2

Default: 1 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 1 ~ (P5-10 P5-56) Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

When the compare function is not enabled, using this parameter can set the estimated compare amount (able to read and write). When the compare function is enabled, using this parameter can set the rest compare amount (read-only). When the setting value of P5-58 is equal to 0, it indicates that the compare operation has finished. Please note: The total amount of COMPARE, CAPTURE and E-Cam data can not exceed the number of 800.

P5 - 59 CMCT

COMPARE: Compare Source Setting

Address: 0576H, 0577H Related Section: Section 7.11.2

Default: 00640010h Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: 00010000h ~ 0FFF3137h Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings:

This parameter is used to determine the compare source and enable the compare function.

A B C D Low Word
E Reserved High Word

Revision January 2011

8-145

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

A: Compare function settings: Bit Function 3 2 After the last position is compared, the system will enable the capture function The capture function is enabled already, and this setting will become ineffective. 1 Cycle mode 0 Start compare function

Explanation

The compare operation will not stop.

Setting Bit0 to 1 will enable the compare function. When compare function has finished, the value of Bit0 will be reset to 0 automatically.

Bit0: When the value of P5-58 is higher than 0, setting Bit0 to 1 will enable the compare function. Once the compare function is enabled, everytime when one position is compared, the setting value of P5-58 will decrease 1. When the setting value of P5-58 is equal to 0, it indicates that the compare operation has finished and the value of Bit0 will be reset to 0 automatically. When the value of P5-58 is equal to 0, setting Bit0 to 1 will not enable the compare function, and then the value of Bit0 will be reset to 0 automatically. If Bit0 is set to 1 already, the new setting value cannot be 1. The users only can set Bit0 to 0 to disable the compare function. Bit1: When Bit1 is set to 1, after the last position is compared, the setting value of P5-58 will be reset and start the compare operation from the first position again. The compare operation will not stop and the value of Bit0 will be retained as 1. Bit2: When Bit2 is set to 1, after the last position is compared, the system will enable the capture function (Bit0 of P5-39 is set to 1 and the value of P5-38 is set to the last capture amount). If the capture function is enabled already, this setting will become ineffective. Bit3: Reserved. B: Compare source settings 0: Capture axis. 1: Auxiliary encoder (linear scale). 2: Pulse command. 3: Motor encoder C: Activate state settings 0: Normally open (use N.O. contact) 1: Normally closed (use N.C. contact) E: Length of output pulse (unit: 1 msec)

8-146

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P5 - 60

POV0

Moving Speed Setting of Position 0

Address: 0578H, 0579H Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 20.0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: 0.1 r/min Range: 0.1 ~ 6000.0 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

P5 - 61

POV1

Moving Speed Setting of Position 1

Address: 057AH, 057BH Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 50.0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: 0.1 r/min Range: 0.1 ~ 6000.0 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

P5 - 62

POV2

Moving Speed Setting of Position 2

Address: 057CH, 057DH Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 100.0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: 0.1 r/min Range: 0.1 ~ 6000.0 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

P5 - 63

POV3

Moving Speed Setting of Position 3

Address: 057EH, 057FH Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 200.0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: 0.1 r/min Range: 0.1 ~ 6000.0 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

Revision January 2011

8-147

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P5 - 64

POV4

Moving Speed Setting of Position 4

Address: 0580H, 0581H Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 300.0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: 0.1 r/min Range: 0.1 ~ 6000.0 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

P5 - 65

POV5

Moving Speed Setting of Position 5

Address: 0582H, 0583H Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 500.0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: 0.1 r/min Range: 0.1 ~ 6000.0 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

P5 - 66

POV6

Moving Speed Setting of Position 6

Address: 0584H, 0585H Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 600.0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: 0.1 r/min Range: 0.1 ~ 6000.0 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

P5 - 67

POV7

Moving Speed Setting of Position 7

Address: 0586H, 0587H Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 800.0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: 0.1 r/min Range: 0.1 ~ 6000.0 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

8-148

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P5 - 68

POV8

Moving Speed Setting of Position 8

Address: 0588H, 0589H Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 1000.0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: 0.1 r/min Range: 0.1 ~ 6000.0 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

P5 - 69

POV9

Moving Speed Setting of Position 9

Address: 058AH, 058BH Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 1300.0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: 0.1 r/min Range: 0.1 ~ 6000.0 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

P5 - 70

POV10

Moving Speed Setting of Position 10

Address: 058CH, 058DH Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 1500.0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: 0.1 r/min Range: 0.1 ~ 6000.0 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

P5 - 71

POV11

Moving Speed Setting of Position 11

Address: 058EH, 058FH Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 1800.0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: 0.1 r/min Range: 0.1 ~ 6000.0 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

Revision January 2011

8-149

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P5 - 72

POV12

Moving Speed Setting of Position 12

Address: 0590H, 0591H Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 2000.0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: 0.1 r/min Range: 0.1 ~ 6000.0 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

P5 - 73

POV13

Moving Speed Setting of Position 13

Address: 0592H, 0593H Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 2300.0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: 0.1 r/min Range: 0.1 ~ 6000.0 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

P5 - 74

POV14

Moving Speed Setting of Position 14

Address: 0594H, 0595H Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 2500.0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: 0.1 r/min Range: 0.1 ~ 6000.0 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

P5 - 75

POV15

Moving Speed Setting of Position 15

Address: 0596H, 0597H Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 3000.0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: 0.1 r/min Range: 0.1 ~ 6000.0 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal

8-150

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P5 - 76 CPRS

Capture 1st Position Reset Data

Address: 0598H, 0599H Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: -1073741824 ~ +1073741823 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P5-39 for explanation.

P5 - 77 CSAX

Position of CAPTURE SYNC AXIS

Address: 059AH, 059BH Related Section: N/A

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This position will be synchronized with the capture signal. When capture operation is actived every two times, the offset value of this SYNC axis will be equal to the value of P5-78 (no accumulation errors, for single direction operation only). This parameter can be used as the position source of E-Cam master axis. Please note: ASDA-A2 series L type models does not provide Electronic Cam (E-Cam) function. Interval Pulse Number of CAPTURE SYNC AXIS

P5 - 78

CSDS

Address: 059CH, 059DH Related Section: N/A

Default: 100 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: pulse Range: 10 ~ +100000000 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the offset value of this SYNC axis when capture operation is activated every two times. Please note: This parameter can be set only when capture operation is stopped (Refer to P5-39).
Revision January 2011

8-151

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P5 - 79 CSDS

Error Pulse Number of CAPTURE SYNC AXIS

Address: 059EH, 059FH Related Section: N/A

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: pulse Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to display the error pulse number of CAPTURE SYNC AXIS operation. SYNC error pulse number = output value of SYNC axis ideal value of SYNC axis = P5-77 accumulation amount (P5-78 x capture times) When SYNC axis operates after the data is captured, the system will update this parameter once. This parameter can be set to indicate the offset amount of specified SYNC axis. When the servo system is regarded as the master axis for rotary cutoff application, modifing this parameter is able to shift the cutoff position to left or right every time.

P5 - 80

CSDS

Max. Correction Rate of CAPTURE SYNC AXIS

Address: 05A0H, 05A1H Related Section: N/A

Default: 10 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: % Range: 1 ~ 90 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to limit the correction rate of CAPTURE SYNC AXIS. Correction rate = output pulses of SYNC axis input pulses of SYNC axis (100 P5-80)% < Correction Rate < (100 + P5-80)% When the value of the correction rate is higher, the SYNC error value will go towards 0 quickly, i.e. attain the desired position more easily, but the changes of the speed are very fast. When the value of the correction rate is lower, the SYNC error value will go towards 0 slowly, i.e. attain the desired position more difficultly, but the changes of the speed are very smooth. For rotary cutoff application, after adjusting P5-79, if the setting value of P5-80 is higher, the system can attain the desired rotary cutoff position quickly but the desired speed can not be easily reached.

8-152

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P5 - 81

ECHD

E-Cam: Start Address of Data Array

Address: 05A2H, 05A3H Related Section: Section 7.11

Default: 100 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ (800 P5-82) Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the start address which specifies the first point data of ECam table and save it into data array. Please note: 1. The firmware version V1.015 and earier models: This parameter can not be changed when E-Cam function is enabled (Refer to P5-88). 2. The firmware version V1.015 and later models: This parameter can be set any time. However, it is effective only when the electronic gear is engaged. 3. ASDA-A2 series L type models does not provide Electronic Cam (E-Cam) function.

P5 - 82

ECHN

E-Cam: E-Cam Area Number N (at least >=5)

Address: 05A4H, 05A5H Related Section: Section 7.11

Default: 5 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A

Range: 5 ~ 720, must be <= (P5-10 P5-81) and (P5-82 x P5-84) <= 2147483647 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: The E-Cam graph is divided into N areas. The E-Cam table should include N+1 data. Please note: 1. This parameter can be set only when E-Cam function is stopped (Refer to P5-88). 2. ASDA-A2 series L type models does not provide Electronic Cam (E-Cam) function.

P5 - 83

ECMM

E-Cam: E-Cam Cycle Number (M)

Address: 05A6H, 05A7H Related Section: Section 7.11

Default: 1 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 1 ~ 32767 Data Size: 16-bit
Revision January 2011

8-153

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Display Format: Decimal Settings: After receiving the pulse number P of master axis, the shaft of E-Cam will rotate M cycles. It indicates that there are M cycles of the E-Cam table. Please note: 1. This parameter can be set only when E-Cam function is stopped (Refer to P5-88). 2. ASDA-A2 series L type models does not provide Electronic Cam (E-Cam) function.

P5 - 84

ECMP

E-Cam: Pulse Number of Master Axis (P)

Address: 05A8H, 05A9H Related Section: Section 7.11

Default: 3600 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A

Range: 10 ~ 1073741823, (P5-82 x P5-83) P5-84 and (P5-82 x P5-84) 2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: After receiving the pulse number P of master axis, the shaft of E-Cam will rotate M cycles. It indicates that there are M cycles of the E-Cam table. Please note: 1. This parameter can be set only when E-Cam function is stopped (Refer to P5-88). 2. The firmware version V1.018 and later models: This parameter can be set any time. 3. ASDA-A2 series L type models does not provide Electronic Cam (E-Cam) function.

P5 - 85

ECME

E-Cam: Engage Area Number

Address: 05AAH, 05ABH Related Section: Section 7.11

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ (P5-82 -1) Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the E-Cam area number when the electronic gear is engaged. Please note: ASDA-A2 series L type models does not provide Electronic Cam (E-Cam) function.

8-154

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P5 - 86 ECAX

E-Cam: Position of Master Axis

Address: 05ACH, 05ADH Related Section: Section 7.11

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the position of E-Cam master axis. Please note: 1. This parameter can be set only when E-Cam function is stopped (Refer to P5-88). 2. ASDA-A2 series L type models does not provide Electronic Cam (E-Cam) function.

P5 - 87

PLED

E-Cam: Lead Command Length

Address: 05AEH, 05AFH Related Section: Section 7.11

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -1073741824 ~ +1073741823 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

This parameter is used to set the length of the lead command before the electronic gear is engaged. Once E-Cam engage conditions are satisfied (see the Z settings of P588), the electronic gear will be engaged truly when the pulse number sent by master axis is higher than the setting value of P5-87. In other words, the electronic gear will be engaged only after the lead command specified by P5-87 is ignored. Please note: 1. If this parameter is a positive value, it indicates that the forward pulses are regarded as lead command. If this parameter is a negative value, it indicates that the reverse pulses are regarded as lead command. 2. ASDA-A2 series L type models does not provide Electronic Cam (E-Cam) function.

P5 - 88 ECON

E-Cam: E-Cam Settings

Address: 05B0H, 05B1H Related Section: Section 7.11

Default: 00000000h Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0 ~ 203FF251h Data Size: 32-bit
Revision January 2011

8-155

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Display Format: Hexiadecimal Settings: Display Range High Word S 0~2 0 BA 00 ~ 3F U 0~8 Low Word Z 0~2 Y 0~5 X 0~1

X: Disable or Enable E-Cam Command 0: Disable E-Cam 1: Enable E-Cam Y: Sources of Master Axis 0: Capture Axis 1: Linear encoder 2: Pulse command 3. PR command 4. Time axis (1msec) 5: Capture Sync. Axis (P5-77) Z: Engage timing (only one option can be selected) 0: Immediately 1: DI signal: CAM ON 2. Any point of Capture Axis U: Disengage timing (the setting value can be added up, but the setting value 2, 4 and 6 can not be selected simultaneously.) U 0 1 2 6 Disengage Conditions Do not disengage DI signal: CAM OFF Master axis reaches the setting value of P5-89. (The polarity sign indicates the direction) (available in firmware V1.009 and later models) The function is the same as the function of U=2, but the differences are that the speed will not change when electronic gear is disengaged and the engage length will exceed the setting value of P5-89 a little. This option is suitable for the application which needs to use PR command immediately after the electronic gear is disengaged. (available in firmware V1.009 and later models) Master axis exceeds the setting value of P5-89. (The polarity sign indicates the direction) Disable E-Cam function after the electronic gear is disengaged. Enter into the state of Stop State after the electronic gear is disengaged.

Enter into the state of Stop

Return to the Lead state (befoe the electronic gear is engaged) (The lead command length is set by P5-92). Set X0

8-156

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

When Servo Off, if a servo fault occurs, or there is a forward/reverse limit, or PR command is moving to home, the electronic gear will be disengaged (X=0 of P5-88). BA: Disengage method. The setting value is 00 ~ 3F (00: Disabled). When the disengage conditions are satisfied (U= 2, 4 and 6of P5-88), the system will execute PR path (hexadecimal) automatically S: Engage status display (read-only) 0: Stop state 1: Engaged state 2: Lead state (before the electronic gear is engaged) Please note: ASDA-A2 series L type models does not provide Electronic Cam (E-Cam) function.

P5 - 89

ECRD

E-Cam: Disengage Timing Data

Address: 05B2H, 05B3H Related Section: Section 7.11

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -1073741824 ~ +1073741823 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to the U settings of P5-88 for explanation. Please note:

ASDA-A2 series L type models does not provide Electronic Cam (E-Cam) function.

P5 - 90

CMAP

E-Cam: Area Number + (Polarity is Positive)

Address: 05B4H, 05B5H Related Section: Section 7.11

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR

Unit: degree (it becomes degree in firmware version V1.009 and later models) Range: 0 ~ 360 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Please note: ASDA-A2 series L type models does not provide Electronic Cam (E-Cam) function.

Revision January 2011

8-157

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P5 - 91

CMAN

E-Cam: Area Number - (Polarity is Negative)

Address: 05B6H, 05B7H Related Section: Section 7.11

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR

Unit: degree (it becomes degree in firmware version V1.009 and later models) Range: 0 ~ 360 Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Decimal Please note: ASDA-A2 series L type models does not provide Electronic Cam (E-Cam) function.

P5 - 92

PLED

E-Cam: Cyclic Lead Command Length

Address: 05B8H, 05B9H Related Section: Section 7.11

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -100000000 ~ +100000000 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal

Settings: (available in firmware version V1.006 sub04 and later models only) This parameter works in conjunction with the function of U=4 set in parameter P5-88. When the electronic gear is disengaged, it will not enter into Stop state. It will enter into the lead state (before the electronic gear is engaged) and the lead command length at this time is determined by the setting of P5-92. The electronic gear will be engaged again when the pulse number sent by master axis is higher than the setting value of P5-92. In other words, the electronic gear will be engaged only after the lead command specified by P5-92 is ignored. Please note: 1. If this parameter is a positive value, it indicates that the forward pulses are regarded as lead command. If this parameter is a negative value, it indicates that the reverse pulses are regarded as lead command. 2. ASDA-A2 series L type models does not provide Electronic Cam (E-Cam) function.

P5 - 93

CSDS

Motion Control: Macro Parameter 4

Address: 05BAH, 05BBH Related Section: N/A

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal 8-158

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Settings: The definition of this parmater is determined by macro command P5-97. Please refer to P5-97 for explanation.

P5 - 94

CSDS

Motion Control: Macro Parameter 3

Address: 05BCH, 05BDH Related Section: N/A

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

The definition of this parmater is determined by macro command P5-97. Please refer to P5-97 for explanation.

P5 - 95

CSDS

Motion Control: Macro Parameter 2

Address: 05BEH, 05BFH Related Section: N/A

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

The definition of this parmater is determined by macro command P5-97. Please refer to P5-97 for explanation.

P5 - 96

CSDS

Motion Control: Macro Parameter 1

Address: 05C0H, 05C1H Related Section: N/A

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings:

The definition of this parmater is determined by macro command P5-97. Please refer to P5-97 for explanation.

Revision January 2011

8-159

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P5 - 97 CSDS

Motion Control: Macro Command

Address: 05C2H, 05C3H Related Section: N/A

Default: 100 Applicable Control Mode: ALL Unit: pulse Range: 0 ~ 0999h Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings:

Write function: This parameter can be used to set macro command (0CBAh) Read function: This parameter can be used to display the execution result of macro command (If the command has succeeded, 1CBAh will be sent back). When the macro command code is set to 0001, if the command has succeeded, 1001h will be sent back. If the command has failed, Fxxxh will be sent back. When setting illegal command code, the failure code, Fxxxh will be sent back also. The legal commands are listed in the table below: Command code: 0000h Parameters Disable CAPTURE SYNC AXIS N/A

After this marco command is executed, the position of CAPTURE SYNC AXIS (P5-77) will not perform synchronization correction. The capture and compare function will be disabled at the same time. The capture source settings will not be set to 0. The capture source settings can be changed. Failure code: F002h Command code: 0001h Parameters The compare function cannot be disabled. Enable CAPTURE SYNC AXIS P5-96: Compare the coordinate of the first point. P5-39: Set U, Z, Y settings by referring the user manual. There is no need to set X settings. P5-59: Set CBA, Z setting by referring the user manual. There is no need to set X and Ysettings. P5-78: Set the offset value of SYNC axis when capture operation is activated every two times.

Please set the relevant parameters above in advance and then execute this macro command. After this marco command is executed, the position of CAPTURE SYNC AXIS (P5-77) will start to perform synchronization correction. The capture and compare function will be enabled at the same time. Failure code: F002h Failure code: F003h Failure code: F004h The capture function is enabled. Please disable it. The compare function is enabled. Please disable it. The address of capture and compare data array is the same address.

8-160

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

The firmware version V1.018 and later models provide the following macro command: Command code: 0005h Parameters Set the pulse number when the electronic gear is disengaged after one E-Cam cycle (360 degrees). P5-95: Pulse number of master axis for one E-Cam cycle

Please set P5-84=P5-89<=P5-85 and set P5-83=1 simutaneously. It indicates that the setting value of P5-95 will display the pulse number for one ECam cycle, i.e. the pulse number when the electronic gear is disengaged automatically. (This setting needs to work in conjunction with P5-88 (U=2, 4, 6). Failure code: F005h The setting value of P5-95 has exceeded the specification of P5-84.

The firmware version V1.024 and later models provide the following macro command: Command code: 0006h General Parameters Create E-Cam table: for rotary cutoff application (7 areas) P5-81: Start Address of Data Array for E-Cam table. P5-82: E-Cam Area Number. Set P5-82 to 7 (7 areas, 8 points). P1-44, P1-45: Electronic Gear Ratio (must be set first) P5-94=A (Deceleration Ratio: Numerator) x C (Knife Number) P5-95=B (Deceleration Ratio: Denominator) P5-96= 1000000 x R x V R (Cut Ratio) = L (Cut Length) x C (Knife Number)x (Knife Circumference) The normal cut ratio is the multiple of 0.3 ~ 2.5. V (Speed Compensation) = (Cut Speed) / (Product Speed) When V=1.0, the speed of knife is the same as the product during cutting operation. When V=1.1, the speed of knife will be increased 10% When V=0.9, the speed of knife will be decreased 10% and so on.

Macro Paremeters

Using this macro command is able to calculate the data of E-Cam table and saved the settings in the data array specified by P5-81. The above parameters are all essential for E-Cam table. Please complete the settings of these parameters first correctly before executing this macro command. After this macro command is executed, if the settings of the above parameters are changed, please execute this macro command again so as to create the new E-Cam table again. The data of E-Cam table will be changed after executing this macro command, therefore, do not to execute this macro command when the electronic gear is engaged. When the execution of this macro command is completed, the data of E-Cam table will not be memorized in EEPROM automatically. There are many E-Cam parameters, such as P5-83 and P5-84, etc. which are not used for this macro commands. For more E-Cam parameters and functions, please refer to Chapter 7. Failure code: F061h The electronic gear is engaged when creating E-Cam table. 8-161

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Failure code: F062h Failure code: F063h Failure code: F064h Failure code: F065h Failure code: F066h Failure code: F067h Please note:

The setting value of P5-94 has exceeded the specification (1 ~ 65535) The setting value of P5-95 has exceeded the specification (1 ~ 65535) The setting value of P5-96 has exceeded the specification (300000 ~ 2500000) The address specified by P5-81 is too big. The space of the data array is not sufficient. The setting value of P5-82 should be set to 7; otherwise this macro command can not be executed. Data calculation error. Please decrease the setting value of P1-44 and P1-45.

ASDA-A2 series L type models does not provide Electronic Cam (E-Cam) function. Event Rising-edge Trigger Command (OFF ON)

P5 - 98

EVON

Address: 05C4H, 05C5H Related Section: N/A

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0000 ~ DDDDh Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings:

This parameter is used to trigger the position command when DI signals, EV1 ~ EV4 (Event trigger command 1 ~ 4) are ON (activated). Display Range U 0~D Z 0~D Y 0~D X 0~D

X: EV1 settings 0: When EV1 is ON, no position command is triggered. 1 ~ D: When EV1 is ON, position command P51 ~ P63 is triggered. For example, when the setting value of X is set to 1 while EV1 is ON, the position command P51 is triggered. When the setting value of X is set to 2, the position command P52 is triggered, and so on.

Y: EV2 settings 0: When EV2 is ON, no position command is triggered. 1 ~ D: When EV2 is ON, position command P51 ~ P63 is triggered. Please note: The DI signals, EV3 and EV4 are avaiable for the firmware version V1.009 and later models. 8-162
Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Z: EV3 settings 0: When EV3 is ON, no position command is triggered. 1 ~ D: When EV3 is ON, position command P51 ~ P63 is triggered. U: EV4 settings 0: When EV4 is ON, no position command is triggered. 1 ~ D: When EV4 is ON, position command P51 ~ P63 is triggered. Event Falling-edge Trigger Command (ON OFF)

P5 - 99

EVOF

Address: 05C6H, 05C7H Related Section: N/A

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0000 ~ DDDDh Data Size: 16-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings:

This parameter is used to trigger the position command when DI signal, EV1 ~ EV4 (Event trigger command 1 ~ 4) are OFF (inactivated). Display Range U 0~D Z 0~D Y 0~D X 0~D

X: EV1 settings 0: When EV1 is OFF, no position command is triggered. 1 ~ D: When EV1 is OFF, position command P51 ~ P63 is triggered. For example, when the setting value of X is set to 1 while EV1 is OFF, the position command P51 is triggered. When the setting value of X is set to 2, the position command P52 is triggered, and so on. Y: EV2 settings 0: When EV2 is OFF, no position command is triggered. 1 ~ D: When EV2 is OFF, position command P51 ~ P63 is triggered. Please note: The DI signals, EV3 and EV4 are avaiable for the firmware version V1.009 and later models. Z: EV3 settings 0: When EV3 is OFF, no position command is triggered. 1 ~ D: When EV3 is OFF, position command P51 ~ P63 is triggered. U: EV4 settings 0: When EV4 is OFF, no position command is triggered. 1 ~ D: When EV4 is OFF, position command P51 ~ P63 is triggered.

Revision January 2011

8-163

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Group 6: P6-xx PR Path Definition Parameters


P6 - 00 ODEF Homing Definition Address: 0600H, 0601H Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0x10FFFF3F Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Hexadecimal Settings: Homing definition: Bit Function

31 ~ 28 27 ~ 24 23 ~ 20 19 ~ 16 15 ~ 12 BOOT DLY DEC2 DEC1

11 ~ 8 ACC

7~4

3~0

PATH

PATH: Path style (4 bits) 0: Stop mode. Motor stops after homing is completed. 1~63: Auto mode. Motor goes the dedicated path after homing is completed. ACC: Acceleration time 0 ~ F, corresponds to P5-20 ~ P5-35. DEC1 / DEC2: 1st deceleration time / 2nd deceleration time. Deceleration time 0 ~ F, corresponds to P5-20 ~ P5-35. DLY: Delay time 0 ~ F, corresponds to P5-40 ~ P5-55. BOOT: Boot mode. Disable or enable homing function when the servo drive is applied to power (power on). 0: Disable homing function 1: Enable homing function (when the servo drive is applied to power) Other parameters relevant to homing function: P5-04 (Homing mode) P5-05 (1st Speed Setting of High Speed Homing) P5-06 (2nd Speed Setting of Low Speed Homing) P6-01: ORG_DEF (Homing definition value). P6-01 is used to set the coordinate value of the current home position for the movement of the coordinate system. The coordinate value could be a non-zero value. After detecting Home (home sensor or Z pulse), the motor will decelerate to stop the operation. If the motor does not return to Home, just set path number to 0. If the motor must return to Home, set path number to a non-zero value and set the route PABS = ORG_DEF. When detecting Home (home sensor or Z pulse), if the motor has to go forward for a while (offset value S) and reach the position P, set the path number to a non-zero value and set ORG_DEF = P S (the absolute position command of this route is P). 8-164
Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P6 - 01

ODAT

Homing Definition Value

Address: 0602H, 0603H Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Homing definition value: Bit Function 31 ~ 28 27 ~ 24 23 ~ 20 19 ~ 16 15 ~ 12 ORG_DEF (32-bit)

11 ~ 8

7~4

3~0

ORG_DEF: Homing definition value which is determined by the parameter P6-01. The homing definition value does not necessarily have to be 0.

P6 - 02

PDEF1

Definition of Path 1

Address: 0604H, 0605H Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: N/A Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Bit P6-02 P6-03 TYPE, OPT: OPT Bit7 Bit6 UNIT Bit5 AUTO Bit4 INS 31 ~ 28 27 ~ 24 23 ~ 20 19 ~ 16 15 ~ 12 DLY DATA (32-bit)

11 ~ 8 -

7~4 OPT

3~0 TYPE

TYPE Bit3 ~ Bit0 1: Constant speed control 2: Single positioning control. Motor stops when positioning is completed. 3: Auto positioning control. Motor goes to next dedicated path when positioning is completed. 7: Jump to the dedicated path. 8: Write the specified parameter to the dedicated path.

CMD

OVLP

INS

AUTO

INS INS

When the TYPE is set to 1 ~ 3, it can accept DO signals, STP (Motor Stop), SNL(SCWL, Reverse Software Limit), SPL(SCCWL, Forward Software Limit). INS: Insertion command on PR.
Revision January 2011

8-165

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

OVLP: Overlap the next PR. This function is not available in speed mode. In position mode, DLY becomes disabled. AUTO: When current positioning is completed, the motor moves to the next dedicated PR automatically. CMD: Refer to Section 7.10 in Chapter 7. DLY: 0 ~ F. Delay time number (4 bits). The digital output of this PR activates after the delay time. External INS is not valid. The delay time number settings correspond with the parameter P5-40 ~ P5-55. DLY (4) Index P5-40 ~ P5-55

P6 - 03

PDAT1

Data of Path 1

Address: 0606H, 0607H Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Data of path 1: Bit Function 31 ~ 28 27 ~ 24 23 ~ 20 19 ~ 16 15 ~ 12 DATA (32-bit)

11 ~ 8

7~4

3~0

The parameter P6-02 is used to determine the attributes of definition of Path 1 and parameter P6-03 is used to set the data (target position or jump path number) corresponding to P6-02.

P6 - 04

PDEF2

Definition of Path 2

Address: 0608H, 0609H Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

8-166

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P6 - 05

PDAT2

Data of Path 2

Address: 060AH, 060BH Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

P6 - 06

PDEF3

Definition of Path 3

Address: 060CH, 060DH Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

P6 - 07

PDAT3

Data of Path 3

Address: 060EH, 060FH Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

P6 - 08

PDEF4

Definition of Path 4

Address: 0610H, 0611H Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit

Revision January 2011

8-167

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

P6 - 09

PDAT4

Data of Path 4

Address: 0612H, 0613H Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

P6 - 10

PDEF5

Definition of Path 5

Address: 0614H, 0615H Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

P6 - 11

PDAT5

Data of Path 5

Address: 0616H, 0617H Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

8-168

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P6 - 12

PDEF6

Definition of Path 6

Address: 0618H, 0619H Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

P6 - 13

PDAT6

Data of Path 6

Address: 061AH, 061BH Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

P6 - 14

PDEF7

Definition of Path 7

Address: 061CH, 061DH Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

P6 - 15

PDAT7

Data of Path 7

Address: 061EH, 061FH Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit

Revision January 2011

8-169

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

P6 - 16

PDEF8

Definition of Path 8

Address: 0620H, 0621H Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

P6 - 17

PDAT8

Data of Path 8

Address: 0622H, 0623H Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

P6 - 18

PDEF9

Definition of Path 9

Address: 0624H, 0625H Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

8-170

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P6 - 19

PDAT9

Data of Path 9

Address: 0626H, 0627H Related Section: Section 7.10

Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

P6 - 20

PDEF10 Definition of Path 10 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 0628H, 0629H Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 21

PDAT10 Data of Path 10 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 062AH, 062BH Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 22

PDEF11 Definition of Path 11 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit

Address: 062CH, 062DH Related Section: Section 7.10

Revision January 2011

8-171

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

P6 - 23

PDAT11 Data of Path 11 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 062EH, 062FH Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 24

PDEF12 Definition of Path 12 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 0630H, 0631H Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 25

PDAT12 Data of Path 12 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 0632H, 0633H Related Section: Section 7.10

8-172

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P6 - 26

PDEF13 Definition of Path 13 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 0634H, 0635H Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 27

PDAT13 Data of Path 13 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 0636H, 0637H Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 28

PDEF14 Definition of Path 14 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 0638H, 0639H Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 29

PDAT14 Data of Path 14 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit

Address: 063AH, 063BH Related Section: Section 7.10

Revision January 2011

8-173

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

P6 - 30

PDEF15 Definition of Path 15 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 063CH, 063DH Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 31

PDAT15 Data of Path 15 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 063EH, 063FH Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 32

PDEF16 Definition of Path 16 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 0640H, 0641H Related Section: Section 7.10

8-174

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P6 - 33

PDAT16 Data of Path 16 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 0642H, 0643H Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 34

PDEF17 Definition of Path 17 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 0644H, 0645H Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 35

PDAT17 Data of Path 17 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 0646H, 0647H Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 36

PDEF18 Definition of Path 18 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit

Address: 0648H, 0649H Related Section: Section 7.10

Revision January 2011

8-175

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

P6 - 37

PDAT18 Data of Path 18 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 064AH, 064BH Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 38

PDEF19 Definition of Path 19 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 064CH, 064DH Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 39

PDAT19 Data of Path 19 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 064EH, 064FH Related Section: Section 7.10

8-176

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P6 - 40

PDEF20 Definition of Path 20 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 0650H, 0651H Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 41

PDAT20 Data of Path 20 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 0652H, 0653H Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 42

PDEF21 Definition of Path 21 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 0654H, 0655H Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 43

PDAT21 Data of Path 21 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit

Address: 0656H, 0657H Related Section: Section 7.10

Revision January 2011

8-177

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

P6 - 44

PDEF22 Definition of Path 22 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 0658H, 0659H Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 45

PDAT22 Data of Path 22 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 065AH, 065BH Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 46

PDEF23 Definition of Path 23 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 065CH, 065DH Related Section: Section 7.10

8-178

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P6 - 47

PDAT23 Data of Path 23 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 065EH, 065FH Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 48

PDEF24 Definition of Path 24 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 0660H, 0661H Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 49

PDAT24 Data of Path 24 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 0662H, 0663H Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 50

PDEF25 Definition of Path 25 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit

Address: 0664H, 0665H Related Section: Section 7.10

Revision January 2011

8-179

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

P6 - 51

PDAT25 Data of Path 25 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 0666H, 0667H Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 52

PDEF26 Definition of Path 26 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 0668H, 0669H Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 53

PDAT26 Data of Path 26 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 066AH, 066BH Related Section: Section 7.10

8-180

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P6 - 54

PDEF27 Definition of Path 27 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 066CH, 066DH Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 55

PDAT27 Data of Path 27 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 066EH, 066FH Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 56

PDEF28 Definition of Path 28 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 0670H, 0671H Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 57

PDAT28 Data of Path 28 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit

Address: 0672H, 0673H Related Section: Section 7.10

Revision January 2011

8-181

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

P6 - 58

PDEF29 Definition of Path 29 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 0674H, 0675H Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 59

PDAT29 Data of Path 29 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 0676H, 0677H Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 60

PDEF30 Definition of Path 30 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 0678H, 0679H Related Section: Section 7.10

8-182

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P6 - 61

PDAT30 Data of Path 30 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 067AH, 067BH Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 62

PDEF31 Definition of Path 31 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 067CH, 067DH Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 63

PDAT31 Data of Path 31 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 067EH, 067FH Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 64

PDEF32 Definition of Path 32 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit

Address: 0680H, 0681H Related Section: Section 7.10

Revision January 2011

8-183

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

P6 - 65

PDAT32 Data of Path 32 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 0682H, 0683H Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 66

PDEF33 Definition of Path 33 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 0684H, 0685H Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 67

PDAT33 Data of Path 33 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 0686H, 0687H Related Section: Section 7.10

8-184

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P6 - 68

PDEF34 Definition of Path 34 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 0688H, 0689H Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 69

PDAT34 Data of Path 34 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 068AH, 068BH Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 70

PDEF35 Definition of Path 35 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 068CH, 068DH Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 71

PDAT35 Data of Path 35 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit

Address: 068EH, 068FH Related Section: Section 7.10

Revision January 2011

8-185

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

P6 - 72

PDEF36 Definition of Path 36 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 0690H, 0691H Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 73

PDAT36 Data of Path 36 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 0692H, 0693H Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 74

PDEF37 Definition of Path 37 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 0694H, 0695H Related Section: Section 7.10

8-186

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P6 - 75

PDAT37 Data of Path 37 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 0696H, 0697H Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 76

PDEF38 Definition of Path 38 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 0698H, 0699H Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 77

PDAT38 Data of Path 38 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 069AH, 069BH Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 78

PDEF39 Definition of Path 39 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit

Address: 069CH, 069DH Related Section: Section 7.10

Revision January 2011

8-187

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

P6 - 79

PDAT39 Data of Path 39 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 069EH, 069FH Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 80

PDEF40 Definition of Path 40 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 06A0H, 06A1H Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 81

PDAT40 Data of Path 40 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 06A2H, 06A3H Related Section: Section 7.10

8-188

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P6 - 82

PDEF41 Definition of Path 41 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 06A4H, 06A5H Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 83

PDAT41 Data of Path 41 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 06A6H, 06A7H Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 84

PDEF42 Definition of Path 42 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 06A8H, 06A9H Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 85

PDAT42 Data of Path 42 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit

Address: 06AAH, 06ABH Related Section: Section 7.10

Revision January 2011

8-189

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

P6 - 86

PDEF43 Definition of Path 43 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 06ACH, 06ADH Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 87

PDAT43 Data of Path 43 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 06AEH, 06AFH Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 88

PDEF44 Definition of Path 44 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 06B0H, 06B1H Related Section: Section 7.10

8-190

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P6 - 89

PDAT44 Data of Path 44 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 06B2H, 06B3H Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 90

PDEF45 Definition of Path 45 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 06B4H, 06B5H Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 91

PDAT45 Data of Path 45 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 06B6H, 06B7H Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 92

PDEF46 Definition of Path 46 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit

Address: 06B8H, 06B9H Related Section: Section 7.10

Revision January 2011

8-191

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

P6 - 93

PDAT46 Data of Path 46 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 06BAH, 06BBH Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 94

PDEF47 Definition of Path 47 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 06BCH, 06BDH Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 95

PDAT47 Data of Path 47 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 06BEH, 06BFH Related Section: Section 7.10

8-192

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P6 - 96

PDEF48 Definition of Path 48 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 06C0H, 06C1H Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 97

PDAT48 Data of Path 48 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 06C2H, 06C3H Related Section: Section 7.10

P6 - 98

PDEF49 Definition of Path 49 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 06C4H, 06C5H Related Section: Section 7.10

Revision January 2011

8-193

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P6 - 99

PDAT49 Data of Path 49 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 06C6H, 06C7H Related Section: Section 7.10

8-194

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Group 7: P7-xx PR Path Definition Parameters


P7 - 00 PDEF50 Definition of Path 50 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation. Address: 0700H, 0701H Related Section: Section 7.10

P7 - 01

PDAT50 Data of Path 50 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 0702H, 0703H Related Section: Section 7.10

P7 - 02

PDEF51 Definition of Path 51 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 0704H, 0705H Related Section: Section 7.10

Revision January 2011

8-195

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P7 - 03

PDAT51 Data of Path 51 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 0706H, 0707H Related Section: Section 7.10

P7 - 04

PDEF52 Definition of Path 52 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 0708H, 0709H Related Section: Section 7.10

P7 - 05

PDAT52 Data of Path 52 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 070AH, 070BH Related Section: Section 7.10

8-196

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P7 - 06

PDEF53 Definition of Path 53 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 070CH, 070DH Related Section: Section 7.10

P7 - 07

PDAT53 Data of Path 53 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 070EH, 070FH Related Section: Section 7.10

P7 - 08

PDEF54 Definition of Path 54 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 0710H, 0711H Related Section: Section 7.10

Revision January 2011

8-197

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P7 - 09

PDAT54 Data of Path 54 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 0712H, 0713H Related Section: Section 7.10

P7 - 10

PDEF55 Definition of Path 55 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 0714H, 0715H Related Section: Section 7.10

P7 - 11

PDAT55 Data of Path 55 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 0716H, 0717H Related Section: Section 7.10

8-198

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P7 - 12

PDEF56 Definition of Path 56 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 0718H, 0719H Related Section: Section 7.10

P7 - 13

PDAT56 Data of Path 56 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 071AH, 071BH Related Section: Section 7.10

P7 - 14

PDEF57 Definition of Path 57 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 071CH, 071DH Related Section: Section 7.10

Revision January 2011

8-199

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P7 - 15

PDAT57 Data of Path 57 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 071EH, 071FH Related Section: Section 7.10

P7 - 16

PDEF58 Definition of Path 58 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 0720H, 0721H Related Section: Section 7.10

P7 - 17

PDAT58 Data of Path 58 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 0722H, 0723H Related Section: Section 7.10

8-200

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P7 - 18

PDEF59 Definition of Path 59 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 0724H, 0725H Related Section: Section 7.10

P7 - 19

PDAT59 Data of Path 59 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 0726H, 0727H Related Section: Section 7.10

P7 - 20

PDEF60 Definition of Path 60 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 0728H, 0729H Related Section: Section 7.10

Revision January 2011

8-201

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P7 - 21

PDAT60 Data of Path 60 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 072AH, 072BH Related Section: Section 7.10

P7 - 22

PDEF61 Definition of Path 61 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 072CH, 072DH Related Section: Section 7.10

P7 - 23

PDAT61 Data of Path 61 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 072EH, 072FH Related Section: Section 7.10

8-202

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P7 - 24

PDEF62 Definition of Path 62 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 0730H, 0731H Related Section: Section 7.10

P7 - 25

PDAT62 Data of Path 62 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 0732H, 0733H Related Section: Section 7.10

P7 - 26

PDEF63 Definition of Path 63 Default: 0x00000000 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: 0x00000000 ~ 0xFFFFFFFF Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-02 for explanation.

Address: 0734H, 0735H Related Section: Section 7.10

Revision January 2011

8-203

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

P7 - 27

PDAT63 Data of Path 63 Default: 0 Applicable Control Mode: PR Unit: N/A Range: -2147483648 ~ +2147483647 Data Size: 32-bit Display Format: Decimal Settings: Refer to P6-03 for explanation.

Address: 0736H, 0737H Related Section: Section 7.10

8-204

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Table 8.A Input Function Definition Setting value: 0x01 DI Name SON DI Function Description Servo On. When this DI is activated, it indicates the servo drive is enabled. Trigger Method Level Triggered Control Mode All

Setting value: 0x02 DI Name DI Function Description A number of Faults (Alarms) can be cleared by activating ARST. Please see table 10-3 for applicable faults that can be cleared with the ARST command. However, please investigate Fault or Alarm if it does not clear or the fault description warrants closer inspection of the drive system. Trigger Method Control Mode

ARST

Rising-edge Triggered

All

Setting value: 0x03 DI Name DI Function Description Gain switching in speed and position mode. When GAINUP is activated (P2-27 is set to 1), the gain is switched to the gain multiplied by gain switching rate. Trigger Method Level Triggered Control Mode PT, PR, S

GAINUP

Setting value: 0x04 DI Name DI Function Description When CCLR is activated, the setting parameter P2-50 Pulse Clear Mode is executed. 0: After CCLR is activated (ON), the position accumulated pulse number will be cleared continuously. Trigger Method Rising-edge Triggered, Level Triggered Control Mode

CCLR

PT, PR

Revision January 2011

8-205

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Setting value: 0x05 DI Name DI Function Description When this signal is On and the motor speed value is lower than the setting value of P1-38, it is used to lock the motor in the instant position while ZCLAMP is On.
Speed Command Setting value of P1-38 (Zero speed)

Trigger Method

Control Mode

ZCLAMP
ZCLAMP input signal

Level Triggered
OFF ON

Motor Speed Setting value of P1-38 (Zero speed) Time

Setting value: 0x06 DI Name DI Function Description Command input reverse control. When the drive is in the Position, Speed and Torque mode, and CMDINV is activated, the motor is in reverse rotation. Trigger Method Level Triggered Control Mode S, T

CMDINV

Setting value: 0x07 DI Name Reserved Setting value: 0x08 DI Name DI Function Description Command triggered (available in PR mode only). When the drive is in PR mode and CTRG is activated, the drive will command the motor to move the stored position which correspond the POS 0 ~ POS 5 settings. Activation is triggered on the rising edge of the pulse. Trigger Method Control Mode DI Function Description Trigger Method Control Mode

CTRG

Rising-edge Triggered

PR

8-206

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Setting value: 0x09 DI Name DI Function Description Torque limit enabled. When the drive is in speed and position mode, and TRQLM is activated, it indicates the torque limit command is valid. The torque limit command source is internal parameter or analog voltage. Trigger Method Level Triggered Control Mode

TRQLM

PT, PR, S

Setting value: 0x10 DI Name DI Function Description Speed limit enabled. When the drive is in torque mode and SPDLM is activated, it indicates the speed limit command is valid. The speed limit command source is internal parameter or analog voltage. Trigger Method Level Triggered Control Mode T

SPDLM

Setting value: 0x11, 0x12, 0x13, 0x1A, 0x1B, 0x1C DI Name POS0 POS1 POS2 POS3 POS4 POS5 DI Name DI Function Description Position command selection POS0 ~ POS5 (64 positions) When the PR Control Mode is selected, the 64 stored positions are programmed via a combination of the POS 0 ~ POS 5 commands. Trigger Method Control Mode

Level Triggered

PR

DI Function Description Position POS5 POS4 POS3 POS2 POS1 POS0 CTRG Parameters Command P1 ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON OFF P6-00 P6-01 P6-02 P6-03 ~ OFF OFF OFF OFF ON ON ON ON OFF ON P6-98 P6-99 P7-00 P7-01 ~ OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF P7-26

Trigger Method

Control Mode

POS0 POS1 POS2 POS3 POS4 POS5

P2 ~ P50 P51 ~ P64

Level Triggered

PR

OFF OFF

Revision January 2011

8-207

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Setting value: 0x46 DI Name STOP Motor stop. DI Function Description Trigger Method Rising-edge Triggered Control Mode PR

Setting value: 0x14 ~ 0x15 DI Name DI Function Description Speed command selection 0 ~ 1 (Command S1 ~ S4) Command No. DI signal of CN1 SPD1 SPD0 Command Source Content Range Trigger Method Control Mode

Mode

SPD0 SPD1

S1

OFF

OFF

Voltage External between V+/-10 V S analog Level REF and command Triggere GND d Speed Sz None command 0 is 0 Internal parameter P1-09 P1-10 -60000 ~

S2 S3

OFF ON

ON OFF

Setting value: 0x16 ~ 0x17 DI Name DI Function Description Torque command selection 0 ~ 1 (Command T1 ~ T4) Command No. DI signal of CN1 Command Source TCM1 TCM0 Content Range Trigger Method Control Mode

Mode

TCM0 TCM1

T1

OFF

OFF

Voltage between VAnalog T command REF and GND Tz None Torque command is 0 P1-12 P1-13 P1-14

+/-10 V

Level Triggere d

0 -300 ~ +300 %

T2 T3 T4

OFF ON ON

Internal OFF parameter ON

ON

8-208

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Setting value: 0x18 DI Name S-P DI Function Description Speed / Position mode switching. OFF: Speed mode, ON: Position mode Trigger Method Level Triggered Control Mode P, S

Setting value: 0x19 DI Name S-T DI Function Description Speed / Torque mode switching. OFF: Speed mode, ON: Torque mode Trigger Method Level Triggered Control Mode S, T

Setting value: 0x20 DI Name T-P DI Function Description Torque / Position mode switching. OFF: Torque mode, ON: Position mode Trigger Method Level Triggered Control Mode P, T

Setting value: 0x2B DI Name PT-PR DI Function Description Internal position (PR) and external pulse (PT) mode switching. OFF: PT, ON: PR Trigger Method Level Triggered Control Mode PT, PR

Setting value: 0x21 DI Name EMGS DI Function Description Emergency stop. It should be contact b and normally ON or a fault (AL013) will display. Trigger Method Level Triggered Control Mode All

Setting value: 0x22 DI Name NL(CWL) DI Function Description Reverse inhibit limit. It should be contact b and normally ON or a fault (AL014) will display. Trigger Method Level Triggered Control Mode All

Setting value: 0x23 DI Name PL(CCWL) DI Function Description Forward inhibit limit. It should be contact b and normally ON or a fault (AL015) will display. Trigger Method Level Triggered Control Mode All

Revision January 2011

8-209

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Setting value: 0x24 DI Name ORGP DI Function Description Reference Home sensor. When ORGP is activated, the drive will command the motor to start to search the reference Home sensor. [see P5-04] Trigger Method Rising-edge/ Falling-edge Triggered Control Mode PR

Setting value: 0x27 DI Name SHOM DI Function Description Move to Home. When SHOM is activated, the drive will command the motor to move to Home. [see P5-04] Trigger Method Rising-edge Triggered Control Mode PR

Setting value: 0x36 DI Name DI Function Description Electronic CAM function control [see P5-88] Please note: ASDA-A2 series L type models does not provide Electronic Cam (E-Cam) function. Trigger Method Rising-edge/ Falling-edge Triggered Control Mode

CAM

PR

Setting value: 0x37 DI Name JOGU DI Function Description Forward JOG input. When JOGU is activated, the motor will JOG in forward direction. [see P4-05] Trigger Method Level Triggered Control Mode All

Setting value: 0x38 DI Name JOGD DI Function Description Reverse JOG input. When JOGD is activated, the motor will JOG in reverse direction. [see P4-05] Trigger Method Level Triggered Control Mode All

Setting value: 0x39 DI Name EV1 DI Function Description Event trigger command 1 [see P5-98, P5-99] Trigger Method Rising-edge/ Falling-edge Triggered Control Mode PR

8-210

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Setting value: 0x3A DI Name EV2 DI Function Description Event trigger command 2 [see P5-98, P5-99] Trigger Method Rising-edge/ Falling-edge Triggered Control Mode PR

Setting value: 0x3B DI Name DI Function Description Trigger Method Control Mode PR

EV3

Event trigger command 3 [see P5-98, P5-99] Rising-edge/ (available in firmware version V1.009 and later Falling-edge Triggered models)

Setting value: 0x3C DI Name DI Function Description Trigger Method Control Mode PR

EV4

Event trigger command 4 [see P5-98, P5-99] Rising-edge/ (available in firmware version V1.009 and later Falling-edge Triggered models)

Setting value: 0x43, 0x44 DI Name DI Function Description Electronic gear ratio (Numerator) selection 0 ~ 1 [see P2-60 ~ P2-62] GNUM0 GNUM1 Level Triggered Trigger Method Control Mode

PT

Revision January 2011

8-211

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Setting value: 0x45 DI Name DI Function Description Pulse inhibit input. When the drive is in position mode, if INHP is activated, the external pulse input command is not valid. (Please use DI8 for INHP signal to ensure the real-time operation of INHP function.) Trigger Method Level Triggered Control Mode

INHP

PT

NOTE
1) 11 ~ 17: Single control mode, 18 ~ 20: Dual control mode 2) When P2-10 to P2-17 is set to 0, it indicates input function is disabled.

8-212

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Table 8.B Output Function Definition Setting value: 0x01 DO Name SRDY DO Function Description Servo ready. SRDY is activated when the servo drive is ready to run. All fault and alarm conditions, if present, have been cleared. Trigger Method Level Triggered Control Mode All

Setting value: 0x02 DO Name DO Function Description SON is activated when control power is applied the servo drive. The drive may or may not be ready to run as a fault / alarm condition may exist. Servo ON (SON) is "ON" with control power applied to the servo drive, there may be a fault condition or not. The servo is not ready to run. Servo ready (SRDY) is "ON" where the servo is ready to run, NO fault / alarm exists. Trigger Method Control Mode

SON

Level Triggered

All

Setting value: 0x03 DO Name DO Function Description ZSPD is activated when the drive senses the motor is equal to or below the Zero Speed Range setting as defined in parameter P1-38. For Example, at factory default ZSPD will be activated when the drive detects the motor rotating at speed at or below 10 r/min, ZSPD will remain activated until the motor speed increases above 10 r/min. Trigger Method Control Mode

ZSPD

Level Triggered

All

Setting value: 0x04 DO Name DO Function Description TSPD is activated once the drive has detected the motor has reached the Target Rotation Speed setting as defined in parameter P1-39. TSPD will remain activated until the motor speed drops below the Target Rotation Speed. Trigger Method Level Triggered Control Mode

TSPD

All

Revision January 2011

8-213

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Setting value: 0x05 DO Name DO Function Description 1. When the drive is in PT mode, TPOS will be activated when the position error is equal and below the setting value of P1-54. 2. When the drive is in PR mode, TPOS will be activated when the drive detects that the position of the motor is in a -P1-54 to +P1-54 band of the target position. Trigger Method Control Mode

TPOS

Level Triggered

PT, PR

Setting value: 0x06 DO Name DO Function Description TQL is activated when the drive has detected that the motor has reached the torques limits set by either the parameters P1-12 ~ P1-14 of via an external analog voltage. Trigger Method Level Triggered Control Mode All, except T, Tz

TQL

Setting value: 0x07 DO Name DO Function Description ALRM is activated when the drive has detected a fault condition. (However, when Reverse limit error, Forward limit error, Emergency stop, Serial communication error, and Undervoltage these fault occur, WARN is activated first.) Trigger Method Level Triggered Control Mode

ALRM

All

Setting value: 0x08 DO Name DO Function Description Electromagnetic brake control. BRKR is activated (Actuation of motor brake). (Please refer to parameters P1-42 ~ P1-43) Trigger Method Control Mode

BRKR

Level Triggered

All

8-214

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Setting value: 0x09 DO Name DO Function Description Homing completed. HOME is activated when the servo drive has detected that the "HOME" sensor (ORGP, digital input 0x24) has been detected. When power to the servo drive at the first time, this DO signal is OFF. After homing operation is completed, thi DO signal will be ON and continue being ON when the motor is running. It becomes OFF until the sytem detect that a position overflow occurs. When using PR command to trigger homing command, this DI signal will be OFF immediately. After homeing operation is completed, it becomes ON again. Trigger Method Control Mode

HOME

Level Triggered

PR

Setting value: 0x10 DO Name DO Function Description Output overload warning. OLW is activated when the servo drive has detected that the motor has reached the output overload time set by parameter P1-56. tOL = Permissible Time for Overload x setting value of P1-56 When overload accumulated time (continuously overload time) exceeds the value of tOL, the overload warning signal will output, i.e. DO signal, OLW will be ON. However, if the accumulated overload time (continuous overload time) exceeds the permissible time for overload, the overload alarm (AL006) will occur. For example: If the setting value of parameter P1-56 (Output Overload Warning Time) is 60%, when the permissible time for overload exceeds 8 seconds at 200% rated output, the overload fault (AL006) will be detected and shown on the LED display. At this time, tOL = 8 x 60% = 4.8 seconds Result: When the drive output is at 200% rated output and the drive is continuously overloaded for 4.8 seconds, the overload warning signal will be ON (DO code is 0x10, i.e. DO signal OLW will be activated). If the drive is continuously overloaded for 8 seconds, the overload alarm will be detected and shown on the LED display (AL006). Then, Servo Fault signal will be ON (DO signal ALRM will be activated). Trigger Method Control Mode

OLW

Level Triggered

PR

Revision January 2011

8-215

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Setting value: 0x11 DO Name DO Function Description Servo warning activated. WARN is activated when the drive has detected Reverse limit error. Forward limit error, Emergency stop, Serial communication error, and Undervoltage these fault conditions. Trigger Method Level Triggered Control Mode All

WARN

Setting value: 0x12 DO Name OVF DO Function Description Position command overflow. OVF is activated when the servo drive has detected that a position command overflows. Trigger Method Level Triggered Control Mode All

Setting value: 0x13 DO Name SNL (SCWL) DO Function Description Reverse software limit. SNL is activated when the servo drive has detected that reverse software limit is reached. Trigger Method Level Triggered Control Mode All

Setting value: 0x14 DO Name SPL (SCCWL) DO Function Description Forward software limit. SPL is activated when the servo drive has detected that forward software limit is reached. Trigger Method Level Triggered Control Mode All

Setting value: 0x15 DO Name DO Function Description Internal position command completed output. CMD_OK is activated when the servo drive has detected that the internal position command has been completed. When excuting PR command, this DI signal is OFF. After the execution of PR command is completed, this DI signal is ON. The output is used to indicate the internal position command has been completed and it does not indicate that the motor positioning is completed. For the signal of motor positioning completed, please refer to DO signal, TPOS. Trigger Method Control Mode

CMD_OK

Level Triggered

PR

8-216

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Setting value: 0x16 DO Name CAP_OK DO Function Description Capture operation completed output. CAP_OK is activated when the servo drive has detected that capture operation has been completed. Trigger Method Level Triggered Control Mode PR

Setting value: 0x17 DO Name DO Function Description Motion control completed output. MC_OK is activated when CMD_OK and TPOS are both ON. It indicates MC_OK is activated only when the servo drive has detected that the position command has been given and the positioning has been completed also. If only CMD_OK or TPOS is ON, MC_OK will not be activated. Trigger Method Control Mode

MC_OK

Level Triggered

PR

Setting value: 0x18 DO Name DO Function Description Trigger Method Control Mode

CAM_AREA is activated when the servo drive has detected the master position of E-Cam (electronic CAM) is within the setting area. CAM_AREA Please note: ASDA-A2 series L type models does not provide Electronic Cam (E-Cam) function. Setting value: 0x19 DO Name SP_OK DO Function Description Speed reached output. SP_OK will be activated when the speed error is equal and below the setting value of P1-47.

Level Triggered

PR

Trigger Method Level Triggered

Control Mode S, Sz

Setting value: 0x30 DO Name SDO_0 DO Function Description Output the status of bit00 of P4-06. Trigger Method Level Triggered Control Mode All

Revision January 2011

8-217

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Setting value: 0x31 DO Name SDO_1 DO Function Description Output the status of bit01 of P4-06. Trigger Method Level Triggered Control Mode All

Setting value: 0x32 DO Name SDO_2 DO Function Description Output the status of bit02 of P4-06. Trigger Method Level Triggered Control Mode All

Setting value: 0x33 DO Name SDO_3 DO Function Description Output the status of bit03 of P4-06. Trigger Method Level Triggered Control Mode All

Setting value: 0x34 DO Name SDO_4 DO Function Description Output the status of bit04 of P4-06. Trigger Method Level Triggered Control Mode All

Setting value: 0x35 DO Name SDO_5 DO Function Description Output the status of bit05 of P4-06. Trigger Method Level Triggered Control Mode All

Setting value: 0x36 DO Name SDO_6 DO Function Description Output the status of bit06 of P4-06. Trigger Method Level Triggered Control Mode All

Setting value: 0x37 DO Name SDO_7 DO Function Description Output the status of bit07 of P4-06. Trigger Method Level Triggered Control Mode All

8-218

Revision January 2011

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Setting value: 0x38 DO Name SDO_8 DO Function Description Output the status of bit08 of P4-06. Trigger Method Level Triggered Control Mode All

Setting value: 0x39 DO Name SDO_9 DO Function Description Output the status of bit09 of P4-06. Trigger Method Level Triggered Control Mode All

Setting value: 0x3A DO Name SDO_A DO Function Description Output the status of bit10 of P4-06. Trigger Method Level Triggered Control Mode All

Setting value: 0x3B DO Name SDO_B DO Function Description Output the status of bit11 of P4-06. Trigger Method Level Triggered Control Mode All

Setting value: 0x3C DO Name SDO_C DO Function Description Output the status of bit12 of P4-06. Trigger Method Level Triggered Control Mode All

Setting value: 0x3D DO Name SDO_D DO Function Description Output the status of bit13 of P4-06. Trigger Method Level Triggered Control Mode All

Setting value: 0x3E DO Name SDO_E DO Function Description Output the status of bit14 of P4-06. Trigger Method Level Triggered Control Mode All

Revision January 2011

8-219

Chapter 8 Servo Parameters

Setting value: 0x3F DO Name SDO_F DO Function Description Output the status of bit15 of P4-06. Trigger Method Level Triggered Control Mode All

NOTE
1) When P2-18 to P2-22 is set to 0, it indicates output function is disabled.

8-220

Revision January 2011

Chapter 9 Communications

9.1 RS-485 & RS-232 Communication Hardware Interface


The ASDA-A2 series servo drives support RS-485 and RS-232 serial communication. All aspects of control, operation and monitoring as well as programming of the controller can be achieved via communication. However, only one communication mode can be used at a time. Users can select the desired communication mode via parameter P3-05. Please refer to the following sections for connections and limitations. RS-232

Configuration

NOTE
1) Recommended maximum cable length is 15m (50ft.). Please note, RFI / EME noise should be kept to a minimum, communication cable should kept apart from high voltage wires. If a transmission speed of 38400 bps or greater is required, the maximum length of the communication cable is 3m (9.84ft.) which will ensure the correct and desired baud rate. 2) The number shown in the pervious figure indicates the terminal number of each connector.

Revision January 2011

9-1

Chapter 9 Communications

RS-485

Configuration

CN3 1394 Connector

D-Sub 9-Pin Connector

Servo 1

3 5 4 6 3 5 4 6

485 (+) 485 (-)

485 (+) 485 (-)

Servo 2

NOTE
1) The maximum cable length is 100m (39.37inches) when the servo drive is installed in a location where there are only a few interferences. Please note, RFI / EME noise should be kept to a minimum, communication cable should kept apart from high voltage wires. If a transmission speed of 38400 bps or greater is required, the maximum length of the communication cable is 15m (50ft.) which will ensure the correct and desired baud rate. 2) The number shown in the pervious figure indicates the terminal number of each connector. 3) The power supply should provide a +12V and higher DC voltage. 4) Please use a REPEATER if more than 32 synchronous axes are required. Maximum 254 servo drives can be connected. 5) For the terminal identification of CN3, please refer to Section 3.5. 9-2

Revision January 2011

Chapter 9 Communications

9.2 Communication Parameters


The following four communication parameters, P3-00 (Communication Address Setting), P301 (Transmission Speed), P3-02 (Communication Protocol) and P3-05 (Communication Mode) are essential and must be set for the communication between the master (PC, etc.) and the AC servo drive. The other communication parameters, such as P3-03 (Transmission Fault Treatment), P3-04 (Communication Time Out Detection), P3-06 (Digital Input Communication Function), P3-07 (Communication Response Delay Time) and P3-08 (Monitor Mode) are for advanced communication settings. For the descriptions of all communication parameters, please refer to the Chapter 8. Default: 0x7F Range: 0x01 ~ 0x7F Settings (Hexadecimal): Display Range 0 0 Y 0~7 X 0~F

P3-00 0300H 0301H Communication Address Setting

When using RS-232/485 and CANbus communication, this parameter P3-00 is used set the communication address in hexadecimal format. If the AC servo drive is controlled by RS-232/485 communication, each drive (or device) must be uniquely identified. One servo drive only can set one address. If the address is duplicated, there will be a communication fault. This address is an absolute address which represents the servo drive on a RS232/485 or CANbus network. Default: 0x0203 Range: 0x0000 ~ 0x0405 Settings (Hexadecimal): Display COM Port Range 0 0 Z CAN 0~4 Y 0 X RS-232/485 0~5

P3-01 0302H 0303H Transmission Speed

X: Baud rate setting 0: 4800 1: 9600 2: 19200 3: 38400 4: 57600 5: 115200

Y: Reserved. Must be set to 0. Z: Communication speed setting 0: 125 Kbit/s 1: 250 Kbit/s 2: 500 Kbit/s 3: 750 Kbit/s 4: 1.0 Mbit/s

Please note: 1. When setting this parameter via CANopen communication, only the setting of Z (communication speed setting) can be set. The other settings cannot be set. 2. The communication speed for USB is 1.0Mbit/s and cannot be changed.

Revision January 2011

9-3

Chapter 9 Communications

P3-02 0304H 0305H Communication Protocol

Default: 6 Range: 0~8 Settings: 0: Modbus ASCII mode, <7, N,2> 1: Modbus ASCII mode, <7,E,1 > 2: Modbus ASCII mode, <7,O,1> 3: Modbus ASCII mode, <8,N,2 > 4: Modbus ASCII mode, <8,E,1> 5: Modbus ASCII mode, <8,O,1> 6: Modbus RTU mode, <8,N,2> 7: Modbus RTU mode, <8,E,1> 8: Modbus RTU mode, <8,O,1>

This parameter P3-02 is used to set the communication protocol. The alphanumeric characters represent the following: 7 or 8 is the number of data bits; N, E or O refers to the parity bit, Non, Even or Odd; the 1 or 2 is the numbers of stop bits. Communication selection: Default: 0 Range: 0x00 ~ 0x01 Settings: 0: RS-232 1: RS-485

P3-05 030AH 030BH Communication Mode

Multiple communication modes RS232 and RS-485 cannot be used within one communication ring.

9-4

Revision January 2011

Chapter 9 Communications

9.3 MODBUS Communication Protocol


When using RS-232/485 serial communication interface, each ASDA-A2 series AC servo drive has a pre-assigned communication address specified by parameter P3-00. The computer then controls each AC servo drive according to its communication address. ASDA-A2 series AC servo drives can be set up to communicate on a MODBUS network using on of the following modes: ASCII (American Standard Code for Information Interchange) or RTU (Remote Terminal Unit). Users can select the desired mode along with the serial port communication protocol in parameter P3-02.

Code Description
ASCII Mode: When AC servo drives are set up to communicate on a MODBUS network using ASCII (American Standard Code for Information Interchange) mode, each 8bit data in a message is sent as two ASCII characters between the master and the slave. For example, a 1-byte data: 64 Hex, shown as 64 in ASCII, consists of 6 (36Hex) and 4 (34Hex). ASCII Characters: Character ASCII code Character ASCII code RTU Mode: When AC servo drives are set up to communicate on a MODBUS network using RTU (Remote Terminal Unit) mode, each 8-bit data is the combination of two 4-bit hexadecimal characters. For example, a 1-byte data: 64 Hex. Comparing to ASCII mode, the transmission speed of RTU mode is better. 0 30H 8 38H 1 31H 9 39H 2 32H A 41H 3 33H B 42H 4 34H C 43H 5 35H D 44H 6 36H E 45H 7 37H F 46H

Data Format
10-bit character frame (For 7-bit character) 7N2
Start bit 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 Stop bit Stop bit

7-data bits 10-bits character frame

7E1

Start bit

3 7-data bits

Even parity

Stop bit

10-bits character frame

Revision January 2011

9-5

Chapter 9 Communications

7O1

Start bit

Odd parity

Stop bit

7-data bits 10-bits character frame

11-bit character frame (For 8-bit character) 8N2


Start bit 0 1 2 3 8-data bits 11-bits character frame 4 5 6 7 Stop bit Stop bit

8E1

Start bit

3 8-data bits

Even parity

Stop bit

11-bits character frame

8O1

Start bit

3 8-data bits

Odd parity

Stop bit

11-bits character frame

Communication Protocol
ASCII Mode: Start Slave Address Function Data (n-1) . Data (0) LRC End 1 End 0 Error checking: 1-byte consists of 2 ASCII codes End code 1: (0DH)(CR) End code 0: (0AH)(LF) Contents of data: n word = n x 2-byte consists of n x 4 ASCII codes n10 Start character : (3AH) Communication address: 1-byte consists of 2 ASCII codes Function code: 1-byte consists of 2 ASCII codes

The communication protocol of ASCII mode starts from a start character : (3AH). ADR is 1byte consists of 2 ASCII codes. CR (Carriage Return) and LF (Line Feed) is a special sequence of characters signifying the end. There are communication address, function code, contents of data and LRC (Longitudinal Redundancy Check) between Start and End.

9-6

Revision January 2011

Chapter 9 Communications

RTU Mode: Start Slave Address Function Data (n-1) . Data (0) CRC End 1 Error checking: 1-byte A silent interval of more than 10ms Contents of data: n word = n x 2-byte, n12 A silent interval of more than 10ms Communication address: 1-byte Function code: 1-byte

The communication protocol of RTU mode starts from a signal of silent interval and ends at a signal of silent interval as well. There are communication address, function code, contents of data and CRC (Cyclical Redundancy Check) between Start and End.

Revision January 2011

9-7

Chapter 9 Communications

The format of data characters depends on the function code. The available function codes and examples for AC servo drive are described as follows: Example 1: Function code: 03H, read N words (The maximum value of N is 10) For example, reading continuous 2 words from starting address 0200H of AC servo drive. In the response message (Slave), the content of starting data address 0200H is 00B1H and the content of second data address 0201H is 1F40H. ASCII Mode: Command message (Master): Start Slave Address Function : 0 1 0 3 0 Starting data address 2 0 0 0 Number of data (In Word) 0 0 2 LRC Check End 1 End 0 F 8 (0DH)(CR) (0AH)(LF) LRC Check End 1 End 0 Content of second data address 0201H Content of starting data address 0200H Response message (Slave): Start Slave Address Function Number of data (In Byte) : 0 1 0 3 0 4' 0 0 B 1 1 F 4 0 E 8 (0DH)(CR) (0AH)(LF)

9-8

Revision January 2011

Chapter 9 Communications

RTU Mode: Command message (Master): Slave Address Function Starting data address Number of data (In Word) CRC Check Low CRC Check High 01H 03H 02H (High) 00H (Low) 00H 02H C5H (Low) B3H (High) Response message (Slave): Slave Address Function Number of data (In Byte) Content of starting data address 0200H Content of second data address 0201H CRC Check Low CRC Check High Please note: In RTU mode, a silent interval of more than 10ms is needed before and after transmission. 01H 03H 04H 00H (High) B1H (Low) 1FH (High) 40H (Low) A3H (Low) D4H (High)

Revision January 2011

9-9

Chapter 9 Communications

Example 2: Function code: 06H, write 1 word For example, writing 100 (0064H) to starting data address 0200H. The slave will send the response message to the master after writing operation is completed.

ASCII Mode: Command message (Master): Start Slave Address Function : 0 1 0 6 0 Starting data address 2 0 0 0 Content of data 0 6 4 LRC Check End 1 End 0 9 3 (0DH)(CR) (0AH)(LF) LRC Check End 1 End 0 Content of data Starting data address Response message (Slave): Start Slave Address Function : 0 1 0 6 0 2' 0 0 0 0 6 4 9 3 (0DH)(CR) (0AH)(LF)

RTU Mode: Command message (Master): Address Slave Function Starting data address Content of data CRC Check Low CRC Check High Please note: In RTU mode, a silent interval of more than 10ms is needed before and after transmission.
9-10
Revision January 2011

Response message (Slave): Address Slave Function Starting data address Content of data CRC Check Low CRC Check High 01H 06H 02H (High) 00H (Low) 00H (High) 64H (Low) 89H (Low) 99H (High)

01H 06H 02H (High) 00H (Low) 00H (High) 64H (Low) 89H (Low) 99H (High)

Chapter 9 Communications

Example 3: Function code: 10H, write N words (The maximum value of N is 10) For example, writing continuous 2 words into starting address 0112H of AC servo drive. The content of first data address is 0BB8H and the content of second data address is 0000H. ASCII Mode: Command message (Master): Start Slave Address Function : 0 1 1 0 0 Starting data address 1 1 2 0 Number of data (In Word) 0 0 2 Number of data (In Byte) Content of first data address 0 4 0 B B 8 0 Content of second data address 0 0 0 LRC Check End 1 End 0 1 3 (0DH)(CR) (0AH)(LF) LRC Check End 1 End 0 Number of data Starting data address Response message (Slave): Start Slave Address Function : 0 1 1 0 0 1' 1 2 0 0 0 2 D A (0DH)(CR) (0AH)(LF)

Revision January 2011

9-11

Chapter 9 Communications

RTU Mode: Command message (Master): Slave Address Function Starting data address Number of data (In Word) Number of data (In Byte) Content of first data address Content of second data address CRC Check Low CRC Check High Please note: In RTU mode, a silent interval of more than 10ms is needed before and after transmission. 01H 10H 01H (High) 12H (Low) 00H (High) 02H (Low) 04H 0BH (High) B8H (Low) 00H (High) 00H (Low) FCH (Low) EBH (High) Response message (Slave): Slave Address Function Starting data address Number of data (In Word) CRC Check Low CRC Check High 01H 10H 01H (High) 12H (Low) 00H (High) 02H (Low) E0H (Low) 31H (High)

9-12

Revision January 2011

Chapter 9 Communications

LRC and CRC Error Checking


ASCII mode adopts LRC (Longitudinal Redundancy Check) and RTU mode adopts CRC (Cyclical Redundancy Check) LRC (ASCII Mode): LRC (Longitudinal Redundancy Check) is calculated by summing up, module 256, the values of the bytes from Slave address to last data character then calculating the hexadecimal representation of the 2s-complement negation of the sum. For example, reading 1 word from address 05C4H of the AC servo drive with address 7FH. Start Slave address Function : 7 F 0 3 0 Starting data address 5 C 4 0 Number of data 0 0 1 LRC Check End 1 End 0 B 4 (0DH)(CR) (0AH)(LF)

7FH + 03H + 05H + C4H + 00H + 01H = 14CH, take 4CH only, the 2s complement negation of 4CH is B4H. Hence, we can know that LRC CHK is B,4.

Revision January 2011

9-13

Chapter 9 Communications

CRC (RTU Mode): CRC (Cyclical Redundancy Check) is calculated by the following steps: Step 1: Load a 16-bit register (called CRC register) with FFFFH. Step 2: Exclusive OR the first 8-bit byte of the command message with the low order byte of the 16-bit CRC register, putting the result in the CRC register. Step 3: Extract and examine the LSB. If the LSB of CRC register is 0, shift the CRC register one bit to the right. If the LSB of CRC register is 1, shift the CRC register one bit to the right, then Exclusive OR the CRC register with the polynomial value A001H. Step 4: Repeat step 3 until eight shifts have been performed. When this is done, a complete 8bit byte will have been processed, then perform step 5. Step 5: Repeat step 2 to step 4 for the next 8-bit byte of the command message. Continue doing this until all bytes have been processed. The final contents of the CRC register are the CRC value. For example, reading 2 words from address 0101H of the AC servo drive with address 01H. The final content of the CRC register from ADR to last data character is 3794H, then the command message is shown as follows. What should be noticed is that 94H have to be transmitted before 37H.

Command Message ADR CMD Starting data address Number of data (In Word) CRC Check Low CRC Check High 01H 03H 01H (High) 01H (Low) 00H (High) 02H (Low) 94H (Low) 37H (High)

9-14

Revision January 2011

Chapter 9 Communications

Example The following is an example of CRC generation using C language. The function takes two arguments: unsigned char* data; unsigned char length The function returns the CRC value as a type of unsigned integer. unsigned int crc_chk(unsigned char* data, unsigned char length) { int j; unsigned int reg_crc=0xFFFF; while( length-- ) { reg_crc^= *data++; for (j=0; j<8; j++ ) { if( reg_crc & 0x01 ) { /*LSB(bit 0 ) = 1 */ reg_crc = (reg_crc >> 1)^0xA001; } else { reg_crc = (reg_crc>>1); } } } return reg_crc; } PC communication program example: #include<stdio.h> #include<dos.h> #include<conio.h> #include<process.h> #define PORT 0x03F8 #define THR 0x0000 #define RDR 0x0000 #define BRDL 0x0000 #define IER 0x0001 #define BRDH 0x0001 #define LCR 0x0003 #define MCR 0x0004 #define LSR 0x0005 #define MSR 0x0006 unsigned char rdat[60]; /* read 2 data from address 0200H of ASD with address 1 */ /* the address of COM 1 */

Revision January 2011

9-15

Chapter 9 Communications

unsigned char tdat[60]={:,0,1,0,3,0,2,0,0,0,0,0,2,F,8,\r,\n}; void main() { int I; outportb(PORT+MCR,0x08); outportb(PORT+IER,0x01); /* interrupt enable */ /* interrupt as data in */

outportb(PORT+LCR,( inportb(PORT+LCR) | 0x80 ) ); /* the BRDL/BRDH can be access as LCR.b7 == 1 */ outportb(PORT+BRDL,12); outportb(PORT+BRDH,0x00); outportb(PORT+LCR,0x06); /* set prorocol <7,E,1> = 1AH, <8,N,2> = 07H <8,O,1> = 0BH for( I = 0; I<=16; I++ ) { while( !(inportb(PORT+LSR) & 0x20) ); outportb(PORT+THR,tdat[I]); } I = 0; while( !kbhit() ) { if( inportb(PORT+LSR)&0x01 ) { /* b0==1, read data ready */ rdat[I++] = inportb(PORT+RDR); /* read data from RDR */ } } } /* wait until THR empty */ /* send data to THR */ <7,O,1> = 0AH <8,E,1> = 1BH */

9-16

Revision January 2011

Chapter 9 Communications

9.4 Communication Parameter Write-in and Read-out


There are following 8 groups for parameters: Group 1: Basic parameters Group 2: Extension parameters Group 3: Communication parameters Group 4: Diagnosis parameters Group 5: Motion control parameters Group 6: PR definition parameters Group 7: PR definition parameters (example: P1-xx) (example: P2-xx) (example: P3-xx) (example: P4-xx) (example: P5-xx) (example: P6-xx) (example: P7-xx)

For a complete listing and description of all parameters, refer to Chapter 8. Communication write-in parameters for ASDA-A2 series are including: Group 0: All parameters except P0-00 ~ P0-01, P0-08 ~ P0-13 and P0-46 Group 1: P1-00 ~ P1-76 Group 2: P2-00 ~ P2-67 Group 3: P3-00 ~ P3-11 Group 4: All parameters except P4-00 ~ P4-04 and P4-08 ~ P4-09 Group 5: All parameters except P5-10, P5-16 and P5-76 Group 6: P6-00 ~ P6-99 Group 7: P7-00 ~ P7-27

NOTE
1) P3-01 After the new transmission speed is set, the next data will be written in new transmission speed. 2) P3-02 After the new communication protocol is set, the next data will be written in new communication protocol. 3) P4-05 4) P4-06 JOG control of servo motor. For the description, refer to Chapter 8. Force output contact control. This parameter is for the users to test if DO (Digit output) is normal. User can set 1, 2, 4, 8, 16 to test DO1, DO2, DO3, DO4, DO5, respectively. After the test has been completed, please set this parameter to 0 to inform the drive that the test has been completed. 5) P4-10 Adjustment function selection. If user desires to change the settings of this parameter, user has to set the value of the parameter P2-08 to 20 (hexadecimal: 14H) first and then restart. After restarting, the settings of parameter P4-10 can become modified. 9-17

Revision January 2011

Chapter 9 Communications

6) P4-11 ~ P4-21

These parameters are for offset adjustment. Do not change the factory default setting if not necessary. If the user desires to change the settings of these parameters, the user has to set the value of the parameter P2-08 to 22 (hexadecimal: 16H) first and then restart. After restarting, the settings of parameters P4-11 to P4-21 can become modified.

Communication read-out parameters for ASDA-A2 series are including: Group 0: P0-00 ~ P0-46 Group 1: P1-00 ~ P1-76 Group 2: P2-00 ~ P2-67 Group 3: P3-00 ~ P3-11 Group 4: P4-00 ~ P4-23 Group 5: P5-00 ~ P5-99 Group 6: P6-00 ~ P6-99 Group 7: P7-00 ~ P7-27

9-18

Revision January 2011

Chapter 10 Troubleshooting

If a fault is detected on the servo motor or drive, a corresponding fault code will be shown on the drive's LED display. Fault codes can also be transmitted via communication, see P0-01 and P4-00 ~ P4-04 for display on controller or HMI.

10.1 Fault Messages Table


Servo Drive Fault Messages Fault Messages Display Fault Name Overcurrent Overvoltage Undervoltage Motor error Regeneration error Overload Overspeed Abnormal pulse control command Excessive deviation Reserved Encoder error Adjustment error Emergency stop activated Reverse limit switch error Forward limit switch error Pulse signal is in error. Adjusted value exceeds the limit of its allowable setting value when perform electrical adjustment. Emergency stop switch is activated. Reverse limit switch is activated. Forward limit switch is activated. Fault Description Main circuit current is higher than 1.5 multiple of motors instantaneous maximum current value. Main circuit voltage has exceeded its maximum allowable value. Main circuit voltage is below its minimum specified value. The motor does not match the drive. They are not correctly matched for size (power rating). Regeneration control operation is in error. Servo motor and drive is overload. Motors control speed exceeds the limit of normal speed. Input frequency of pulse command exceeds the limit of its allowable setting value. Position control deviation value exceeds the limit of its allowable setting value.

Revision January 2011

10-1

Chapter 10 Troubleshooting

Fault Messages Display Fault Name IGBT temperature error Memory error Encoder output error Fault Description The temperature of IGBT is over high. EE-PROM write-in and read-out is in error. The encoder output exceeds the rated output frequency.

Serial communication RS-232/485 communication is in error. error Serial communication RS-232/485 communication time out. time out Reserved Input power phase loss One phase of the input power is loss.

To warn that the servo motor and drive is going to overload. This alarm will display before ALM06. When the servo motor reach the setting value of P1-56, the Pre-overload warning motor will send a warning to the drive. After the drive has detected the warning, the DO signal OLW will be activated and this fault message will display. Encoder initial magnetic field error Encoder internal error Encoder data error Motor protection error U,V,W wiring error Full closed-loop excessive deviation The magnetic field of the encoder U, V, W signal is in error. The internal memory of the encoder is in error. An internal counter error is detected. An encoder data error is detected for three times. In order to protect the motor, this alarm will be activated when the setting value of P1-57 is reached after a period of time set by P1-58. The wiring connections of U, V, W (for servo motor output) and GND (for grounding) are in error. The position control deviation value of full closed-loop exceeds the specified limit. EE-PROM is not reset after the firmware version is upgraded. This fault can be cleared after setting P2-08 to 30 first, and then setting P2-08 to 28 next and restarting the servo drive.

DSP firmware upgrade

10-2

Revision January 2011

Chapter 10 Troubleshooting

CANopen Communication Fault Messages Fault Messages Display Fault Name CANbus error CANopen SDO receive buffer overrun CANopen PDO receive buffer overrun Fault Description CANbus off or Error Rx/Tx Counter exceeds 128. SDO Rx buffer overrun is detected (receive two or more SDO packets in 1ms). PDO Rx buffer overrun is detected (receive two or more PDO (same COBID) packets in 1ms).

Index error occurs The specified Index in the message does not exist. when accessing CANopen PDO object. Sub-index error occurs when accessing CANopen PDO object.

The specified Sub-index in the message does not exist.

Data type (size) error The data length in the message does not match the occurs when accessing CANopen specified object. PDO object. Data range error occurs when accessing CANopen PDO object. The data in the message has exceeded the data range of the specified object.

CANopen PDO object The specified object in the message is read-only and is read-only and write-protected (cannot be changed). write-protected. CANopen PDO object The specified object in the message does not support does not support PDO. PDO. CANopen PDO object The specified object in the message is write-protected is write-protected (cannot be changed) when Servo On. when Servo On. Error occurs when reading CANopen PDO object from EEPROM. Error occurs when writing CANopen PDO object into EEPROM. An error occurs when loading the default settings from EE-PROM at start-up. All CANopen objects return to their default settings automatically.

An error occurs when writing the current settings into EE-PROM.

Revision January 2011

10-3

Chapter 10 Troubleshooting

Fault Messages Display Fault Name Fault Description The amount of the data saved in EE-PROM has exceeded the space determined by the firmware. Maybe the firmware version has been upgraded, and it causes that the data of old firmware version saved in EE-PROM cannot be used. The data saved in EE-PROM has been damaged and all CANopen objects return to their default settings automatically. The parameter is password protected when using CANopen communication to access the parameter. The users must enter the valid password to unlock the parameter.

EE-PROM invalid address range

EE-PROM checksum error

Password error

Motion Control Fault Messages Fault Messages Display Fault Name Fault Description

CANopen data initial An error occurs when loading data from EE-PROM. error Write parameter error: exceeds the limit of normal range. Write parameter error: read only. Write parameter error occurs in PR mode: the setting value exceeds the limit of normal range. Write parameter error occurs in PR mode: the parameter is read only.

Write parameter error occurs in PR mode: the parameter Write parameter is write-protected (cannot be changed) when Servo On error: parameter lock or the setting value is invalid. Write parameter error occurs in PR mode: the parameter Write parameter is write-protected (cannot be changed) when Servo On error: parameter lock or the setting value is invalid. PR command overflow PR positioning time out Invalid PR path number Index error occurs when accessing CANopen object. In PR mode, this fault occurs when position command counter register overflowed and at this time an absolute position command is executed. In PR mode, the execution time of positioning command exceeds its time limit. In PR mode, the valid range of PR path number is within 0~63. The path number is not within this range. The specified Index in the message does not exist.

10-4

Revision January 2011

Chapter 10 Troubleshooting

Fault Messages Display Fault Name Sub-index error occurs when accessing CANopen object. Fault Description

The specified Sub-index in the message does not exist.

Data type (size) error The data length in the message does not match the occurs when accessing CANopen specified object. object. Data range error occurs when accessing CANopen object. CANopen object is read-only and writeprotected. The data in the message has exceeded the data range of the specified object.

The specified object in the message is read-only and write-protected (cannot be changed).

CANopen object does The specified object in the message does not support not support PDO. PDO. CANopen object is The specified object in the message is write-protected write-protected when (cannot be changed) when Servo On. Servo On. Error occurs when An error occurs when loading the default settings from reading CANopen EE-PROM at start-up. All CANopen objects return to object from EE-PROM. their default settings automatically. Error occurs when An error occurs when writing the current settings into writing CANopen EE-PROM. object into EE-PROM. The amount of the data saved in EE-PROM has exceeded the space determined by the firmware. Maybe the firmware version has been upgraded, and it causes that the data of old firmware version saved in EE-PROM cannot be used. The data saved in EE-PROM has been damaged and all CANopen objects return to their default settings automatically. The parameter is password protected when using CANopen communication to access the parameter. The users must enter the valid password to unlock the parameter. Position command is equal to or more than forward software limit.

EE-PROM invalid address range

EE-PROM checksum error

Password error

Forward software limit

Revision January 2011

10-5

Chapter 10 Troubleshooting

Fault Messages Display Fault Name Reverse software limit Position counter overflow Servo Off error CANopen SYNC failed CANopen SYNC signal error Fault Description Position command is equal to or less than forward software limit. Position counter overflow occurs. Servo Off occurs during positioning (when the drive and motor are both running). The synchronous communication with the external controller has failed. The CANopen SYNC signal is received too early.

CANopen SYNC time The CANopen SYNC signal is not received within the out specified time. CANopen IP command failed SYNC period error Position deviation alarm for digital output, MC_OK Internal command of CANopen IP mode cannot be sent and received. Object 0x1006 data error. SYNC period 1006h value is invalid. After MC_OK is activated, when the digital output, TPOS is Off, the digital output, MC_OK becomes Off. For more detailed explanation, please refer to parameter P1-48 in Chapter 8.

NOTE
1) If there is any unknown fault code that is not listed on the above table, please inform the distributor or contact with Delta for assistance. 2) For more information about the CANopen objects, please refer to CANopen Instruction Manual.

10-6

Revision January 2011

Chapter 10 Troubleshooting

10.2 Potential Cause and Corrective Actions


Servo Drive Fault Messages : Overcurrent Potential Cause Short-circuit at drive output (U, V, W) Motor wiring error Checking Method Corrective Actions

1. Check the wiring connections between Repair the short-circuited and drive and motor. avoid metal conductor being exposed. 2. Check if the wire is short-circuited. Check if the wiring steps are all correct when connecting motor to drive. Heat sink overheated Follow the wiring steps in the user manual to reconnect wiring. Please contact your distributor for assistance or contact with Delta. Set the setting back to factory default setting and then reset and adjust the parameter setting again. 1. Ensure that input command frequency is stable (too much fluctuation). 2. Activate filter function.

IGBT error

Control parameter setting error

Check if the setting value exceeds the factory default setting.

Control command setting error

Check if the control input command is unstable (too much fluctuation).

: Overvoltage Potential Cause The main circuit voltage has exceeded its maximum allowable value. Input power error (Incorrect power input) Checking Method Corrective Actions

Use voltmeter to check whether the input voltage falls within the rated input Use correct power supply or voltage. stabilizing power or using (For voltage specification, please refer to series transformer. section 12.1 in Chapter12.) Use correct power supply or Use voltmeter to check whether the input stabilizing power or using voltage is within the specified limit. series transformer. If the error does not clear even if the main circuit input voltage falls within the specified limit, please contact your distributor for assistance or contact with Delta.

The hardware of the Use voltmeter to ensure that the main servo drive is circuit input voltage falls within the damaged. specified limit,

Revision January 2011

10-7

Chapter 10 Troubleshooting

: Undervoltage Potential Cause The main circuit voltage is below its minimum specified value. No input voltage at main circuit. Input power error (Incorrect power input) Checking Method Corrective Actions

Check whether the wiring of main circuit Reconfirm voltage wiring. input voltage is normal. Use voltmeter to check whether input voltage at main circuit is normal. Reconfirm power switch.

Use correct power supply or Use voltmeter to check whether the input stabilizing power or using voltage is within the specified limit. series transformer.

: Motor error Potential Cause Encoder is loose. The type of the servo motor is incorrect. Checking Method Examine the encoder connector. Corrective Actions Replace the motor. Install the motor again.

Encoder is damaged. Check the encoder for the damage.

Check if the servo drive and servo motor are not correctly matched for size (power Replace the motor. rating).

: Regeneration error Potential Cause Checking Method Corrective Actions Reconnect regenerative resistor or calculate the value of the regenerative resistor. Set the parameter P1-53 to zero when the regenerative resistor is not in use.

Regenerative resistor is not connected or Check the wiring connection of the value of the regenerative resistor. regenerative resistor is too low. The parameter P1-53 is not set to zero Ensure the parameter P1-53 is set to when the zero. regenerative resistor is not in use. Parameter setting is in error Confirm the parameter settings of P152 and P1-53, and specifications of regenerative resistor.

Correctly reset parameter settings and the specifications of regenerative resistor again.

10-8

Revision January 2011

Chapter 10 Troubleshooting

: Overload Potential Cause The drive has exceeded its rated load during continuous operation. Control system parameter setting is incorrect. The wiring of drive and encoder is in error. The encoder of the motor is damaged. Checking Method Corrective Actions

Check if the drive is overloaded. The users can set parameter P0-02 (Drive Increase motor capacity or Fault Code) to 11 and monitor if the reduce load. value of the average torque [%] exceeds 100% always. 1.Adjust gain value of control circuit. 1.Check if there is mechanical vibration 2.Decrease Accel/Decel time 2.Accel/Decel time setting is too fast. setting. Check the wiring of U, V, W and encoder. Ensure all wiring is correct.

Please contact your distributor for assistance or contact with Delta.

: Overspeed Potential Cause Speed input command is not stable (too much fluctuation). Checking Method Use signal detector to detect if input signal is abnormal. Corrective Actions Ensure that input command frequency is stable (not fluctuate too much) and activate filter function. Correctly set over-speed parameter setting (P2-34).

Over-speed Check if over-speed parameter setting parameter setting is value is too low. defective. : Abnormal pulse control command Potential Cause Pulse command frequency is higher than rated input frequency. Checking Method

Corrective Actions

Use pulse frequency detector to measure Correctly set the input pulse input frequency. frequency.

: Excessive deviation Potential Cause Checking Method Corrective Actions Increases the parameter setting value of P2-35. Correctly adjust gain value. Correctly adjust torque limit value. Reduce external applied load or re-estimate the motor capacity.
10-9

Check the maximum deviation Maximum deviation parameter setting and observe the parameter setting is position error value when the motor is too small. running. Gain value is too small. Torque limit is too low. Check for proper gain value. Check torque limit value.

There is an overload. Check for overload condition.

Revision January 2011

Chapter 10 Troubleshooting

: Reserved : Encoder error (Position detector fault) Potential Cause The wiring of encoder is in error. Encoder is loose Checking Method 1.Check if all wiring is correct. 2.Check if the users conduct the wiring by the wiring information in the user manual. Examine the encoder connector (CN2). Corrective Actions Ensure all wiring is correct. Install the motor again. Conduct the wiring again. Replace the motor.

The wiring of Check if all connections are tight. encoder is defective. Encoder is damage Check the motor for the damage.

: Adjustment error Potential Cause Checking Method Corrective Actions Correctly ground the analog input contact. If the error does not clear after resetting the power supply, please contact your distributor for assistance or contact with Delta.

The analog input Measure if the voltage of the analog contact does not go input contact is the same as the voltage back to zero. of the ground. The detection device Reset the power supply. is damaged.

: Emergency stop activated Potential Cause Emergency stop switch is activated. Checking Method Corrective Actions

Check if emergency stop switch is On or Activate emergency stop Off. switch.

: Reverse (CWL) limit switch error Potential Cause Checking Method Corrective Actions

Reverse limit switch Check if reverse limit switch is On or Off. Activate reverse limit switch. is activated. Servo system is not stable. Check the value of control parameter setting and load inertia. Modify parameter setting and re-estimate motor capacity.

: Forward (CCWL) limit switch error Potential Cause Checking Method Corrective Actions Activate forward limit switch. Modify parameter setting and re-estimate motor capacity.

Forward limit switch Check if forward limit switch is On or is activated. Off. Servo system is not stable. Check the value of control parameter setting and load inertia.

10-10

Revision January 2011

Chapter 10 Troubleshooting

: IGBT temperature error Potential Cause The drive has exceeded its rated load during continuous operation. Checking Method Check if there is overload or the motor current is too high. Corrective Actions Increase motor capacity or reduce load.

Short-circuit at drive Check the drive input wiring. output. : Memory error Potential Cause Checking Method

Ensure all wiring is correct.

Corrective Actions

1.If this fault occurs when power is applied to the Examine the parameter settings. Please drive, it indicates that the do the following steps: setting value of one 1.Press SHIFT key on the drive keypad, parameter has exceeded the and examine the parameter shown on specified range. Correct the LED display. setting value of the Parameter data error 2.If E320A is displayed (in hexadecimal parameter to clear the fault when writing into format), it indicates it is parameter P2and restart the servo drive. EE-PROM. 10. Please examine the parameter 2.If this fault occurs during settings of P2-10. normal operation, it 3.If E3610 is displayed (in hexadecimal indicates that the error format), it indicates it is parameter P6occurs when writing data 16. Please examine the parameter into EE-PROM. Turn ARST (DI settings of P6-16. signal) ON to clear the fault or restart the servo drive. If this fault occurs when resetting the parameter The setting value of Press SHIFT key on the drive keypad and settings, it indicates that the hidden parameter is examine if E100X is displayed on LED servo drive type is not set in error. display. correctly. Correctly set the servo drive type again. If this fault occurs when power is applied to the drive, it indicates that the data in EEPress SHIFT key on the drive keypad and RPM is damaged or there is no examine if E0001 is displayed on LED data in EE-PROM. Please display. contact your distributor for assistance or contact with Delta.

Data in EE-PROM is damaged.

Revision January 2011

10-11

Chapter 10 Troubleshooting

: Encoder output error Potential Cause Checking Method Corrective Actions

Check if the recent fault records (P4-00 ~ Perform the corrective actions Encoder itself or the P4-05) display on the drive keypad in as described in AL011, AL024, wiring of encoder is accordance with the fault codes AL011, AL025 and AL026. in error. AL024, AL025 and AL026. The output frequency for pulse output may exceed the limit of its allowable setting value. Check if the following conditions occur: Condition 1: Motor speed is above the value set by P1-76. Condition 2:
Motor Speed P1 46 4 19.8 10 6 60

Correctly set P1-76 and P1-46. 1.Ensure that the motor speed is below the value set by P176. 2.
Motor Speed P1 46 4 19.8 106 60

: Serial communication error Potential Cause Checking Method Corrective Actions Correctly set parameter setting. Correctly set communication address. Correctly set communication value.

Communication Check the communication parameter parameter setting is setting. defective. Communication Check the communication address. address is incorrect. Communication value is incorrect. Check the communication value.

: Serial communication time out Potential Cause Checking Method Corrective Actions Correctly set P3-07. Tighten the communication cable, make sure the communication cable is not damaged and ensure all wiring is correct.

Setting value in time Check communication time out out parameter is not parameter setting. correct. Not receiving communication Check whether communication cable is command for a long loose or broken. time.

: Reserved : Input power phase loss Potential Cause Checking Method Check the power cable and connections of R, S, T. Check whether the power cable is loose or the possible loss of phase on input power. Corrective Actions If the fault does not clear even when the three-phase power is connected correctly, please contact your distributor for assistance or contact with Delta.

Control power supply is in error.

10-12

Revision January 2011

Chapter 10 Troubleshooting

: Pre-overload warning Potential Cause Checking Method Corrective Actions

1.Check the load condition of the servo 1.Please refer to the correction motor and drive. actions of AL006. The drive is going to 2. Check the setting value of P1-56. 2. Increase the setting value of overload. Check whether the setting value of P1P1-56 or set P1-56 to 100 56 is too small. and above. : Encoder initial magnetic field error Potential Cause Checking Method Corrective Actions If the error does not clear after each checking is done, please contact your distributor for assistance or contact with Delta.

1.Check if the servo motor is properly grounded. 2.Check if the encoder signal cables are The magnetic field placed in separate conduits from the of the encoder U, V, cables connected to R, S, T and U, V, W W signal is in error. terminals to prevent the interference. 3.Check if the shielded cables are used when performing encoder wiring. : Encoder internal error Potential Cause Checking Method

Corrective Actions

1.Please connect the grounding (green color) of U, V, W terminal to the heatsink of the servo drive. 2.Ensure that the encoder 1.Check if the servo motor is properly signal cables are placed in grounded. separate conduits from the The internal memory cables connected to R, S, T 2. Check if the encoder signal cables are of the encoder is in and U, V, W terminals to placed in separate conduits from the error. An encoder cables connected to R, S, T and U, V, W prevent the interference. counter error terminals to prevent the interference. 3.Please use shielded cables occurs. for Encoder wiring. 3.Check if the shielded cables are used when performing encoder wiring. 4.If the error does not clear after all the above actions are done, please contact your distributor for assistance or contact with Delta.

Revision January 2011

10-13

Chapter 10 Troubleshooting

: Encoder data error Potential Cause Checking Method Corrective Actions

An encoder data error occurs for three times.

1.Please connect the grounding (green color) of U, V, W terminal to the heatsink of the servo drive. 2.Ensure that the encoder 1.Check if the servo motor is properly signal cables are placed in grounded. separate conduits from the cables connected to R, S, T 2.Check if the encoder signal cables are and U, V, W terminals to placed in separate conduits from the cables connected to R, S, T and U, V, W prevent the interference. terminals to prevent the interference. 3.Please use shielded cables for Encoder wiring. 3.Check if the shielded cables are used when performing encoder wiring. 4.If the error does not clear after all the above actions are done, please contact your distributor for assistance or contact with Delta.

: Motor protection error Potential Cause Checking Method Corrective Actions 1.Set P1-57 to 0. 2.Correctly set P1-57 and P158. Please note that the over-low setting may results in malfunction, but overhigh setting may let the motor protection function not operate.

The setting value of parameter P1-57 is 1.Check if P1-57 is enabled. reached after a 2.Check if the setting values of P1-57 period of time set by and P1-58 are both too small. parameter P1-58.

: U,V,W wiring error Potential Cause Checking Method Corrective Actions Follow the wiring steps in the user manual to reconnect the wiring and ground the servo drive and motor properly.

The wiring connections of U, V, W (for servo motor Check if wiring connections of U, V, W are not correct. output) and GND (for grounding) are in error.

10-14

Revision January 2011

Chapter 10 Troubleshooting

: Full closed-loop excessive deviation Potential Cause Checking Method Corrective Actions 1.Increases the parameter setting value of P1-73. 2.Ensure all connections are tight and well-connected to the mechanical equipment.

The position control deviation value of 1.Check if the setting value of P1-73 is full-closed loop too small. exceeds the 2. Check if all connections are tight and specified limit. well-connected to the mechanical Maximum deviation equipment. parameter setting is too small. : DSP firmware upgrade Potential Cause Checking Method

Corrective Actions Set P2-08 to 30 first, and then 28 next, and restart the servo drive.

EE-PROM is not reset Check if EE-PROM is reset after the after the firmware firmware version is upgraded. version is upgraded.

CANopen Communication Fault Messages : CANbus error Potential Cause Checking Method Corrective Actions

1.Examine CANbus communication cable. CANbus off or Error NMT Maser send Reset 2.Check if the communication quality is node command to its slave or Rx/Tx Counter good quality state. (It is recommended restart the servo drive. exceeds 128. to use shielded cables and use common grounding.) : CANopen SDO receive buffer overrun Potential Cause Checking Method Corrective Actions NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset)

SDO Rx buffer overrun is detected Check if the servo drive (Master) receives (receive two or more two or more SDO packets in 1ms. SDO packets in 1ms).

Revision January 2011

10-15

Chapter 10 Troubleshooting

: CANopen PDO receive buffer overrun Potential Cause Checking Method Corrective Actions

NMT Maser send Reset PDO Rx buffer node command to its slave or overrun is detected Check if the servo drive (Master) receives reset the fault by sending the (receive two or more two or more PDO (same COB-ID) packets control word (0x6040) through PDO packets in in 1ms. CAN communication (the value 1ms). of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset) : Index error occurs when accessing PDO object Potential Cause Checking Method Corrective Actions NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset)

The specified Index Check if the Entry index value in PDO in the message does mapping is changed when accessing not exist. PDO object.

: Sub-index error occurs when accessing PDO object Potential Cause The specified Subindex in the message does not exist. Checking Method Corrective Actions NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset)

Check if the Entry Sub-index value in PDO mapping is changed when accessing PDO object.

: Data type (size) error occurs when accessing PDO object Potential Cause The data length in the message does not match the specified object. Checking Method Corrective Actions NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset)

Check if the Entry data length in PDO mapping is changed when accessing PDO object.

10-16

Revision January 2011

Chapter 10 Troubleshooting

: Data range error occurs when accessing PDO object Potential Cause The data in the message has exceeded the data range of the specified object. Checking Method Corrective Actions NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset)

Check if the write-in data range in PDO mapping is not correct when accessing PDO object.

: Object is read-only and write-protected Potential Cause Checking Method Corrective Actions NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset)

The specified object Check if the specified object is set to in the message is read-only and write- read-only write-protected (cannot be protected (cannot be changed) when accessing PDO object. changed).

: CANopen PDO object does not support PDO Potential Cause Checking Method Corrective Actions NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset)

The specified object Check if the specified object cannot in the message support PDO when accessing PDO cannot support PDO. object.

: CANopen PDO object is write-protected when Servo On Potential Cause The specified object in the message is write-protected (cannot be changed) when Servo On. Checking Method Corrective Actions

NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or Check if the specified object in the reset the fault by sending the message is write-protected (cannot be control word (0x6040) through changed) while the servo drive is enabled CAN communication (the value (Servo On) when accessing PDO object. of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset)

Revision January 2011

10-17

Chapter 10 Troubleshooting

: Error occurs when reading CANopen PDO object from EE-PROM Potential Cause An error occurs when loading the default settings from EE-PROM at start-up. All CANopen objects return to their default settings automatically. Checking Method Corrective Actions NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset)

Check if it causes an error when the specified object reads EE-PROM when accessing PDO object.

: Error occurs when writing CANopen PDO object into EE-PROM Potential Cause Checking Method Corrective Actions NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset)

An error occurs Check if it causes an error when the when writing the specified object writes EE-PROM when current settings into accessing PDO object. EE-PROM.

: EE-PROM invalid address range Potential Cause Checking Method Corrective Actions

The amount of the data saved in EEPROM has exceeded the space determined by the firmware. Maybe the Check if the specified object lets the firmware version has address range of EE-PROM exceed the been upgraded, and specification when accessing PDO object. it causes that the data of old firmware version saved in EEPROM cannot be used. : EE-PROM checksum error Potential Cause The data saved in EE-PROM has been damaged and all CANopen objects return to their default settings automatically. Checking Method

NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset)

Corrective Actions NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset)

Check if the specified object results in the checksum error of EE-PROM when accessing PDO object.

10-18

Revision January 2011

Chapter 10 Troubleshooting

: Password error Potential Cause Checking Method Corrective Actions NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset)

The parameter is password protected Check if the password for the specified when using CANopen object is invalid when accessing PDO communication to object. access the parameter.

Motion Control Fault Messages : CANopen data initial error Potential Cause Checking Method Corrective Actions

An error occurs when loading data from EE-PROM.

1.Restart the servo drive to check if the error can be cleared. 2.If the error cannot be cleared after restarting the servo drive, it indicates that the data in EE-PROM is damaged and the users must do the following actions: 1. Turn ARST (DI signal) ON to a. If the users want to write default clear the fault. setting values, set P2-08 to 30 first 2. Use CANopen 0x1011 and then 28 next, or use CANopen object to restore default 0x1011 object to restore parameters. parameters from non-volatile memory. b. If the users want to write current setting values, use CANopen 0x1010 object to save parameters in non-volatile memory. : Write parameter error Checking Method Corrective Actions

~ Potential Cause

In PR mode, error occurs when using PR command TYPE=8 (write specified parameter)

: Check if the parameter setting value exceeds the limit of normal 1. Turn ARST (DI signal) ON to clear the fault. range. 2. Set P0-01 to 0. : Check if the parameter is read only. , : Check if the Correct the PR command and parameter is write-protected when Servo parameter setting value. On or the setting value is invalid.

Revision January 2011

10-19

Chapter 10 Troubleshooting

: PR command overflow Potential Cause In PR mode, this fault occurs when position command counter register overflowed and at this time an absolute position command is executed. Checking Method 1.In PR mode, check if the position command is executing continuously toward single direction and make the feedback position command counter overflow. 2.Check if the above situation causes that the correct position cannot be gauged. 3.Check if an absolute position command is executed after the position command counter register overflowed. Corrective Actions

NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset)

: PR positioning time out Potential Cause In PR mode, the execution time of positioning command exceeds its time limit. Checking Method Corrective Actions

NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or If this fault occurs, please contact your reset the fault by sending the distributor for assistance or contact with control word (0x6040) through Delta. CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset)

: Invalid PR path number Potential Cause In PR mode, the valid range of PR path number is within 0~63. The path number is not within this range. Checking Method Corrective Actions

NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or If this fault occurs, please contact your reset the fault by sending the distributor for assistance or contact with control word (0x6040) through Delta. CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset)

: Index error occurs when accessing CANopen object Potential Cause Checking Method Corrective Actions

NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or The specified Index If this fault occurs, please contact your reset the fault by sending the in the message does distributor for assistance or contact with control word (0x6040) through not exist. Delta. CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset)

10-20

Revision January 2011

Chapter 10 Troubleshooting

: Sub-index error occurs when accessing CANopen object Potential Cause The specified Subindex in the message does not exist. Checking Method Corrective Actions

NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or If this fault occurs, please contact your reset the fault by sending the distributor for assistance or contact with control word (0x6040) through Delta. CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset)

: Data type (size) error occurs when accessing CANopen object Potential Cause The data length in the message does not match the specified object. Checking Method Corrective Actions

NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or If this fault occurs, please contact your reset the fault by sending the distributor for assistance or contact with control word (0x6040) through Delta. CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset)

: Data range error occurs when accessing CANopen object Potential Cause The data in the message has exceeded the data range of the specified object. Checking Method Corrective Actions

NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or If this fault occurs, please contact your reset the fault by sending the distributor for assistance or contact with control word (0x6040) through Delta. CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset)

: Object is read-only and write-protected Potential Cause Checking Method Corrective Actions NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset)

The specified object If this fault occurs, please contact your in the message is read-only and write- distributor for assistance or contact with protected (cannot be Delta. changed).

Revision January 2011

10-21

Chapter 10 Troubleshooting

: CANopen object does not support PDO Potential Cause Checking Method Corrective Actions

NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or The specified object If this fault occurs, please contact your reset the fault by sending the in the message does distributor for assistance or contact with control word (0x6040) through not support PDO. Delta. CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset) : Object is write-protected when Servo On Potential Cause Checking Method Corrective Actions NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset)

The specified object If this fault occurs, please contact your in the message is write-protected distributor for assistance or contact with (cannot be changed) Delta. when Servo On.

: Error occurs when reading CANopen object from EE-PROM Potential Cause An error occurs when loading the default settings from EE-PROM at start-up. All CANopen objects return to their default settings automatically. Checking Method Corrective Actions

NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or If this fault occurs, please contact your reset the fault by sending the distributor for assistance or contact with control word (0x6040) through Delta. CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset)

: Error occurs when writing CANopen object into EE-PROM Potential Cause Checking Method Corrective Actions

NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or An error occurs If this fault occurs, please contact your reset the fault by sending the when writing the distributor for assistance or contact with control word (0x6040) through current settings into Delta. CAN communication (the value EE-PROM. of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset)

10-22

Revision January 2011

Chapter 10 Troubleshooting

: EE-PROM invalid address range Potential Cause Checking Method Corrective Actions

The amount of the data saved in EEPROM has exceeded the space determined by the firmware. Maybe the If this fault occurs, please contact your firmware version has distributor for assistance or contact with been upgraded, and Delta. it causes that the data of old firmware version saved in EEPROM cannot be used. : EE-PROM checksum error Potential Cause The data saved in EE-PROM has been damaged and all CANopen objects return to their default settings automatically. Checking Method

NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset)

Corrective Actions

NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or If this fault occurs, please contact your reset the fault by sending the distributor for assistance or contact with control word (0x6040) through Delta. CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset)

: Password error Potential Cause Checking Method Corrective Actions NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset)

The parameter is password protected If this fault occurs, please contact your when using distributor for assistance or contact with CANopen communication to Delta. access the parameter. : Forward software limit Potential Cause Checking Method

Corrective Actions NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset)

This software limit is determined according to position command, not Position command is actual feedback position. It indicates that equal to or more when this fault is activated, the actual position may not exceed the limit. than forward Setting the proper deceleration time is software limit. able to solve this problem. Please refer to parameter P5-03.

Revision January 2011

10-23

Chapter 10 Troubleshooting

: Reverse software limit Potential Cause Checking Method Corrective Actions NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset)

This software limit is determined according to position command, not Position command is actual feedback position. It indicates that equal to or less than when this fault is activated, the actual forward software position may not exceed the limit. limit. Setting the proper deceleration time is able to solve this problem. Please refer to parameter P5-03. : Position counter overflow Potential Cause Checking Method

Corrective Actions

Position counter overflow occurs.

NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or If this fault occurs, please contact your reset the fault by sending the distributor for assistance or contact with control word (0x6040) through Delta. CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset)

: Servo Off error Potential Cause Checking Method Corrective Actions NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset)

1.Examine if the wiring of digital input Servo Off occurs for Servo On is correct. during positioning (when the drive and 2.Check if the host (external) controller motor are both disables the function of Servo On too running). early.

: CANopen SYNC failed Potential Cause Checking Method Corrective Actions NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset)

1.Check if the communication quality is good quality state. CAN IP mode error. The synchronous 2.Check if the host (external) controller communication with has sent SYNC signal. the external 3.Check if the setting value of parameter controller has failed. P3-09 is a proper value (It is recommended to use default setting).

10-24

Revision January 2011

Chapter 10 Troubleshooting

: CANopen SYNC error Potential Cause Checking Method 1.Check if the setting of 0x1006 (communication cycle period) is the same as the setting in host (external) controller. 2.Check if the setting value of parameter P3-09 is a proper value (It is recommended to use default setting). 3.Check if the procedure of host (external) controller is not correct. Corrective Actions NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset)

CAN IP mode error. The SYNC signal is received too early.

: CANopen SYNC time out Potential Cause Checking Method 1.Check if the communication quality is good quality state. 2.Check if the setting of 0x1006 (communication cycle period) is the same as the setting in host (external) controller. 3.Check if the setting value of parameter P3-09 is a proper value (It is recommended to use default setting). 4.Check if the procedure of host (external) controller is not correct. Corrective Actions

CAN IP mode error. The SYNC signal is not received with the specified time.

NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset)

: CANopen IP command failed Potential Cause CAN IP mode error. Internal command cannot be sent and received. Checking Method Corrective Actions NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset)

The calculation time of IP mode is too long. Please disable USB monitor function.

: SYNC period error Potential Cause Checking Method Corrective Actions

NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or Object 0x1006 Data Examine the data of 0x1006. The SYNC reset the fault by sending the Error. SYNC period period 1006h value should not be equal control word (0x6040) through 1006h value is to or less than 0 or this fault will occur. CAN communication (the value invalid. of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset)

Revision January 2011

10-25

Chapter 10 Troubleshooting

: Position deviation alarm for digital output, MC_OK Potential Cause After MC_OK is activated, when the digital output, TPOS is Off, the digital output, MC_OK becomes Off. Checking Method Corrective Actions

Check if the motor position changes by external force after the positioning is completed. 1. Turn ARST (DI signal) ON to This alarm can be disabled by the setting clear the fault. of P1-48. Please refer to the descriptions 2. Set P0-01 to 0. of parameter P1-48 for more detailed explanation.

10-26

Revision January 2011

Chapter 10 Troubleshooting

10.3 Clearing Faults


Servo Drive Fault Messages Display Fault Name Overcurrent Overvoltage Undervoltage Motor error Regeneration error Overload Overspeed Abnormal pulse control command Excessive deviation Reserved Encoder error This fault message can be removed by restarting the servo drive. This fault message can be removed after the wiring of CN1 connector (I/O signal connector) is removed and auto adjustment function is executed. Clearing Method Turn ARST (DI signal) ON to clear the fault. Turn ARST (DI signal) ON to clear the fault. This fault message can be removed automatically after the voltage has returned within its specification. This fault message can be removed by restarting the servo drive. Turn ARST (DI signal) ON to clear the fault. Turn ARST (DI signal) ON to clear the fault. Turn ARST (DI signal) ON to clear the fault. Turn ARST (DI signal) ON to clear the fault. Turn ARST (DI signal) ON to clear the fault.

Adjustment error

This fault message can be removed Emergency stop activated automatically by turning off EMGS (DI signal). 1. Turn ARST (DI signal) ON to clear the fault. 2. This fault message can be removed when the servo drive is Off (Servo Off). Reverse limit switch error 3. When the servo drive does not reach the limit, this fault message can be removed automatically 1. Turn ARST (DI signal) ON to clear the fault. 2. This fault message can be removed when the servo drive is Off (Servo Off). Forward limit switch error 3. When the servo drive does not reach the limit, this fault message can be removed automatically IGBT temperature error Turn ARST (DI signal) ON to clear the fault.

Revision January 2011

10-27

Chapter 10 Troubleshooting

Display

Fault Name

Clearing Method 1. If this fault occurs when power is applied to the drive, correct the setting value of the parameter to clear the fault and restart the servo drive. 2. If this fault occurs during normal operation, turn ARST (DI signal) ON to clear the fault. Turn ARST (DI signal) ON to clear the fault. Turn ARST (DI signal) ON to clear the fault. Turn ARST (DI signal) ON to clear the fault.

Memory error

Encoder output error Serial communication error Serial communication time out Reserved

Input power phase loss

Turn ARST (DI signal) ON to clear the fault. This fault message can be removed automatically after input power phase lost problem is solved. Turn ARST (DI signal) ON to clear the fault. This fault message can be removed by restarting the servo drive. This fault message can be removed by restarting the servo drive. This fault message can be removed by restarting the servo drive. Turn ARST (DI signal) ON to clear the fault. This fault message can be removed by restarting the servo drive.

Pre-overload warning Encoder initial magnetic field error Encoder internal error Encoder data error Motor protection error U,V,W wiring error

Ful closed-loop excessive Turn ARST (DI signal) ON to clear the fault. deviation DSP firmware upgrade This fault message can be removed after setting P2-08 to 30 first, and then 28 next and restarting the servo drive.

10-28

Revision January 2011

Chapter 10 Troubleshooting

CANopen Communication Fault Messages Display Fault Name CANbus error Clearing Method NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or restart the servo drive. NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset). NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset).

CANopen SDO receive buffer overrun

CANopen PDO receive buffer overrun

NMT Maser send Reset node command to Index error occurs when its slave or reset the fault by sending the accessing CANopen PDO control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object object. 0x6040 should be reset). NMT Maser send Reset node command to Sub-index error occurs its slave or reset the fault by sending the when accessing CANopen control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object PDO object. 0x6040 should be reset). Data type (size) error occurs when accessing CANopen PDO object. NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset).

NMT Maser send Reset node command to Data range error occurs its slave or reset the fault by sending the when accessing CANopen control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object PDO object. 0x6040 should be reset). CANopen PDO object is read-only and writeprotected. NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset). NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset). NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset).

CANopen PDO object does not support PDO.

CANopen PDO object is write-protected when Servo On.

Revision January 2011

10-29

Chapter 10 Troubleshooting

Display

Fault Name Error occurs when reading CANopen PDO object from EE-PROM.

Clearing Method NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset).

NMT Maser send Reset node command to Error occurs when writing its slave or reset the fault by sending the CANopen PDO object into control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object EE-PROM. 0x6040 should be reset). EE-PROM invalid address range. NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset).

NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the EE-PROM checksum error. control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset). NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset).

Password error

10-30

Revision January 2011

Chapter 10 Troubleshooting

Motion Control Fault Messages Display Fault Name CANopen Data Initial Error Write parameter error: exceeds the limit of normal range. Write parameter error: read only. Write parameter error: parameter lock Write parameter error: parameter lock Clearing Method 1. Turn ARST (DI signal) ON to clear the fault. 2. Use CANopen 0x1011 object to restore default parameters. 1. Turn ARST (DI signal) ON to clear the fault. 2. Set P0-01 to 0. 1. Turn ARST (DI signal) ON to clear the fault. 2. Set P0-01 to 0. Correct the PR command and parameter setting value. Correct the PR command and parameter setting value. NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset). NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset). NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset). NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset).

PR Command Overflow

PR Positioning Time out

Invalid PR Path Number

Index error occurs when accessing CANopen object.

NMT Maser send Reset node command to Sub-index error occurs its slave or reset the fault by sending the when accessing CANopen control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object object. 0x6040 should be reset). Data type (size) error occurs when accessing CANopen object. NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset).

Revision January 2011

10-31

Chapter 10 Troubleshooting

Display

Fault Name

Clearing Method

NMT Maser send Reset node command to Data range error occurs its slave or reset the fault by sending the when accessing CANopen control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object object. 0x6040 should be reset). Object is read-only and write-protected. NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset).

NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the CANopen object does not control word (0x6040) through CAN support PDO. communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset). NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the CANopen object is writecontrol word (0x6040) through CAN protected when Servo On. communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset). Error occurs when reading CANopen object from EE-PROM. NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset).

NMT Maser send Reset node command to Error occurs when writing its slave or reset the fault by sending the CANopen object into EE- control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object PROM. 0x6040 should be reset). EE-PROM invalid address range NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset).

NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the EE-PROM checksum error control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset). NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset). When the servo drive does not reach the limit, i.e. the position command is less than forward software limit, this fault message can be removed automatically

Password error

Forward software limit

10-32

Revision January 2011

Chapter 10 Troubleshooting

Display

Fault Name Reverse software limit

Clearing Method When the servo drive does not reach the limit, i.e. the position command is more than reverse software limit, this fault message can be removed automatically

NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the Position counter overflow control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset). NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset). NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset). NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset). NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset). NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset). NMT Maser send Reset node command to its slave or reset the fault by sending the control word (0x6040) through CAN communication (the value of CANopen object 0x6040 should be reset). 1. Turn ARST (DI signal) ON to clear the fault. 2. Set P0-01 to 0.

Servo Off error

CANopen SYNC failed

CANopen SYNC signal error

CANopen SYNC time out

CANopen IP command failed

SYNC period error

Position deviation alarm

Revision January 2011

10-33

Chapter 10 Troubleshooting

This page intentionally left blank.

10-34

Revision January 2011

Chapter 11 Specifications
11.1 Specifications of Servo Drives (ASDA-A2 Series) 11.1.1 ASDA-A2 220V Series
100W 200W 400W 750W 1kW 1.5kW 2kW 01 02 04 07 10 15 20 3kW 4.5kW 5.5kW 7.5kW 30 45 55 75

ASDA-A2 Series Phase / Voltage Power supply Permissible Voltage Range Continuous Output Current Cooling System Encoder Resolution / Feedback Resolution Control of Main Circuit Tuning Modes Dynamic Brake Max. Input Pulse Frequency Position Control Mode Pulse Type Command Source Smoothing Strategy Electronic Gear Torque Limit Operation Feed Forward Compensation Voltage Range Analog Input Command Input Resistance Time Constant Speed Control Mode Speed Control Range *1 Command Source Smoothing Strategy Torque Limit Operation Frequency Response Characteristic

Three-phase / Single-phase 220VAC

Three-phase 220VAC

Three-phase / Single-phase Three-phase 200 ~ 230VAC, 200 ~ 230VAC, -15% ~ 10% -15% ~ 10% 0.9 1.55 2.6 5.1 7.3 8.3 13.4 19.4 32.5 40 47.5 Arms Arms Arms Arms Arms Arms Arms Arms Arms Arms Arms Natural Air Fan Cooling Circulation 20-bit (1280000 p/rev) SVPWM (Space Vector Pulse Width Modulation) Control Auto / Manual None Built-in External

Max. 500Kpps / 4Mpps (Line driver), Max. 200Kpps (Open collector) Pulse + Direction, A phase + B phase, CCW pulse + CW pulse External pulse train (PT mode) / Internal parameters (PR mode) Low-pass and P-curve filter Electronic gear N/M multiple N: 1~32767, M: 1:32767 (1/50<N/M<25600) Set by parameters Set by parameters 0 ~ 10 VDC 10K 2.2 us 1:5000 External analog signal / Internal parameters Low-pass and S-curve filter Set by parameters or via analog input Maximum 1kHz 0.01% or less at 0 to 100% load fluctuation 1:3000

Speed Accuracy *2 (at rated rotation speed)

0.01% or less at 10% power fluctuation 0.01% or less at 0 C to 50 C ambient temperature fluctuation
o o

Revision January 2011

11-1

Chapter 11 Specifications

ASDA-A2 Series Voltage Range Analog Input Command Input Resistance Time Constant Command Source Smoothing Strategy Speed Limit Operation Analog Monitor Output

100W 200W 400W 750W 1kW 1.5kW 2kW 01 02 04 07 10 15 20

3kW 4.5kW 5.5kW 7.5kW 30 45 55 75

Torque Control Mode

0 ~ 10 VDC 10K 2.2 us External analog signal / Internal parameters Low-pass filter Set by parameters or via analog input Monitor signal can set by parameters (Output voltage range: 8V) Servo on, Reset, Gain switching, Pulse clear, Zero speed CLAMP, Command input reverse control, Command triggered, Speed/Torque limit enabled, Position command selection, Motor stop, Speed position selection, Position / Speed mode switching, Speed / Torque mode switching, Torque / Position mode switching, PT / PR command switching, Emergency stop, Forward / Reverse inhibit limit, Reference Home sensor, Forward / Reverse operation torque limit, Move to Home, Electronic Cam (E-Cam), Forward / Reverse JOG input, Event trigger PR command, Electronic gear ratio (Numerator) selection and Pulse inhibit input Encoder signal output (A, B, Z Line Driver and Z Open Collector ) Servo ready, Servo on, At Zero speed, At Speed reached, At Positioning completed, At Torques limit, Servo alarm (Servo fault) activated, Electromagnetic brake control, Homing completed, Output overload warning, Servo warning activated, Position command overflow, Forward / Reverse software limit, Internal position command completed, Capture operation completed output., Motion control completed output., Master position of E-Cam (Electronic Cam) Overcurrent, Overvoltage, Undervoltage, Motor overheated, Regeneration error, Overload, Overspeed, Abnormal pulse control command, Excessive deviation, Encoder error, Adjustment error, Emergency stop activated, Reverse/ Forward limit switch error, Position excessive deviation of full-close control loop, Serial communication error, Input power phase loss, Serial communication time out, short circuit protection of U, V, W, and CN1, CN2, CN3 terminals RS-232 / RS-485 / CANopen / USB Indoor location (free from direct sunlight), no corrosive liquid and gas (far away from oil mist, flammable gas, dust) Altitude 1000m or lower above sea level 86kPa to 106kPa 0 C ~ 55 C (If operating temperature is above 45 C, forced cooling will be required) -20 C to 65 C (-4F to 149F) 0 to 90% (non-condensing) 9.80665m/s (1G) less than 20Hz, 5.88m/ s (0.6G) 20 to 50Hz IP20 TN System*3 IEC/EN 61800-5-1, UL 508C, C-tick
2 2 o o o o o

Inputs

Digital Inputs/Outputs

Outputs

Protective Functions

Communication Interface Installation Site Altitude Atmospheric pressure Operating Temperature Environment Storage Temperature Humidity Vibration IP Rating Power System

Approvals

11-2

Revision January 2011

Chapter 11 Specifications Footnote: *1 *2 *3 *4 *5 Rated rotation speed: When full load, speed ratio is defined as the minimum speed (the motor will not pause). When command is rated rotation speed, the speed fluctuation rate is defined as: (Empty load rotation speed Full load rotation speed) / Rated rotation speed TN system: A power distribution system having one point directly earthed, the exposed conductive parts of the installation being connected to that points by protective earth conductor. Please refer to Chart of load and operating time in section 11.4 Overload Characteristics. Please refer to Section 1.2 for details about the model explanation.

Revision January 2011

11-3

Chapter 11 Specifications

11.1.2

ASDA-A2 400V Series


750W 07 1kW 10 1.5kW 15 2kW 20 3kW 30 4.5kW 45 5.5kW 55 7.5kW 75

ASDA-A2 Series Control Power Power supply Main Circuit Power Continuous Output Current Cooling System Encoder Resolution / Feedback Resolution Control of Main Circuit Tuning Modes Dynamic Brake Max. Input Pulse Frequency Position Control Mode Pulse Type Command Source Smoothing Strategy Electronic Gear Torque Limit Operation Feed Forward Compensation Voltage Range Analog Input Command Input Resistance Time Constant Speed Control Mode Speed Control Range *1 Command Source Smoothing Strategy Torque Limit Operation Frequency Response Characteristic

24VDC, 10% Three-phase, 380 ~ 480VAC, 10% 3.07 Arms 3.52 Arms 5.02 Arms 6.66 Arms 11.9 Arms 20 Arms 22.37 Arms 30 Arms

Fan Cooling 20-bit (1280000 p/rev) SVPWM (Space Vector Pulse Width Modulation) Control Auto / Manual Built-in External

Max. 500Kpps / 4Mpps (Line driver), Max. 200Kpps (Open collector) Pulse + Direction, A phase + B phase, CCW pulse + CW pulse External pulse train (PT mode) / Internal parameters (PR mode) Low-pass and P-curve filter Electronic gear N/M multiple N: 1~32767, M: 1:32767 (1/50<N/M<25600) Set by parameters Set by parameters 0 ~ 10 VDC 10K 2.2 us 1:5000 External analog signal / Internal parameters Low-pass and S-curve filter Set by parameters or via analog input Maximum 1kHz 0.01% or less at 0 to 100% load fluctuation 1:3000

Speed Accuracy *2 (at rated rotation speed)

0.01% or less at 10% power fluctuation 0.01% or less at 0 C to 50 C ambient temperature fluctuation
o o

Torque Control Mode

Voltage Range Analog Input Command Input Resistance Time Constant Command Source Smoothing Strategy Speed Limit Operation Analog Monitor Output

0 ~ 10 VDC 10K 2.2 us External analog signal / Internal parameters Low-pass filter Set by parameters or via analog input Monitor signal can set by parameters (Output voltage range: 8V)

11-4

Revision January 2011

Chapter 11 Specifications

ASDA-A2 Series

750W 07

1kW 10

1.5kW 15

2kW 20

3kW 30

4.5kW 45

5.5kW 55

7.5kW 75

Inputs

Digital Inputs/Outputs

Servo on, Reset, Gain switching, Pulse clear, Zero speed CLAMP, Command input reverse control, Command triggered, Speed/Torque limit enabled, Position command selection, Motor stop, Speed position selection, Position / Speed mode switching, Speed / Torque mode switching, Torque / Position mode switching, PT / PR command switching, Emergency stop, Forward / Reverse inhibit limit, Reference Home sensor, Forward / Reverse operation torque limit, Move to Home, Electronic cam, Forward / Reverse JOG input, Event trigger PR command, Electronic gear ratio (Numerator) selection and Pulse inhibit input Encoder signal output (A, B, Z Line Driver and Z Open Collector ) Servo ready, Servo on, At Zero speed, At Speed reached, At Positioning completed, At Torques limit, Servo alarm (Servo fault) activated, Electromagnetic brake control, Homing completed, Output overload warning, Servo warning activated, Position command overflow, Forward / Reverse software limit, Internal position command completed, Capture operation completed output., Motion control completed output., Master position of E-Cam (Electronic Cam) Overcurrent, Overvoltage, Undervoltage, Motor overheated, Regeneration error, Overload, Overspeed, Abnormal pulse control command, Excessive deviation, Encoder error, Adjustment error, Emergency stop activated, Reverse/ Forward limit switch error, Position excessive deviation of full-close control loop, Serial communication error, Input power phase loss, Serial communication time out, short circuit protection of U, V, W, and CN1, CN2, CN3 terminals RS-232 / RS-485 / CANopen / USB Indoor location (free from direct sunlight), no corrosive liquid and gas (far away from oil mist, flammable gas, dust) Altitude 1000m or lower above sea level 86kPa to 106kPa 0 C ~ 55 C (If operating temperature is above 45 C, forced cooling will be required) -20 C to 65 C (-4F to 149F) 0 to 90% (non-condensing) 9.80665m/s (1G) less than 20Hz, 5.88m/ s (0.6G) 20 to 50Hz IP20 TN System*3
2 2 o o o o o

Outputs

Protective Functions

Communication Interface Installation Site Altitude Atmospheric pressure Operating Temperature Environment Storage Temperature Humidity Vibration IP Rating Power System

IEC/EN 61800-5-1, UL 508C, C-tick


Approvals

Footnote: *1 *2 *3 *4 *5 Rated rotation speed: When full load, speed ratio is defined as the minimum speed (the motor will not pause). When command is rated rotation speed, the speed fluctuation rate is defined as: (Empty load rotation speed Full load rotation speed) / Rated rotation speed TN system: A power distribution system having one point directly earthed, the exposed conductive parts of the installation being connected to that points by protective earth conductor. Please refer to Chart of load and operating time in section 11.4 Overload Characteristics. Please refer to Section 1.2 for details about the model explanation.

Revision January 2011

11-5

Chapter 11 Specifications

11.2 Specifications of Servo Motors (ECMA Series) 11.2.1 ECMA 220V Series

Low Inertia Series - 220V series


ECMA Series Rated output power (kW) Rated torque (N-m) *1 Maximum torque (N-m) Rated speed (r/min) Maximum speed (r/min) Rated current (A) Power rating (kW/s) Rotor moment of inertia (Kg.m ) (without brake) Mechanical time constant (ms) Mechanical time constant (ms) Torque constant-KT (N-m/A) Voltage constant-KE (mV/(r/min)) Armature resistance (Ohm) Armature inductance (mH) Armature inductance (mH) Insulation class Insulation resistance Insulation strength Weight (kg) (without brake) Weight (kg) (with brake) Max. radial shaft load (N) Max. thrust shaft load (N) Power rating (kW/s) (with brake) Rotor moment of inertia (Kg.m ) (with brake) Mechanical time constant (ms) (with brake) Brake holding torque [Nt-m (min)]
2 2

C104 01 0.1 0.32 0.96 02 0.2 0.64 1.92

C106 04 0.4 1.27 3.82 04 0.4 1.27 3.82

C108 07 0.75 2.39 7.16 10 1.0 3.18 9.54

C110 20 2.0 6.37 19.1

3000 5000 0.90 2.70 27.7 0.037 0.75 0.36 13.6 9.30 24.0 2.58 1.55 4.65 22.4 0.177 0.80 0.41 16.0 2.79 12.07 4.30 2.60 7.80 57.6 0.277 0.53 0.49 17.4 1.55 6.71 4.30 2.60 7.80 24.0 0.68 0.74 0.49 18.5 0.93 7.39 7.96 5.10 15.3 50.4 1.13 0.63 0.47 17.2 0.42 3.53 8.37 7.30 21.9 38.1 2.65 0.74 0.44 16.8 0.20 1.81 9.30 12.05 36.15 90.6 4.45 0.61 0.53 19.2 0.13 1.50 11.4

Class A (UL), Class B (CE) >100M, DC 500V 1500V AC, 60 seconds 0.5 0.8 78.4 39.2 25.6 0.04 1.2 1.5 196 68 21.3 0.19 1.6 2.0 196 68 53.8 0.30 2.1 2.9 245 98 22.1 0.73 3.0 3.8 245 98 48.4 1.18 4.3 4.7 490 98 30.4 3.33 6.2 7.2 490 98 82.0 4.95

0.81

0.85

0.57

0.78

0.65

0.93

0.66

0.3

1.3

1.3

2.5

2.5

8.0

8.0

11-6

Revision January 2011

Chapter 11 Specifications

ECMA Series Brake power consumption (at 20 C) [W] Brake release time [ms (Max)] Brake pull-in time [ms (Max)] Vibration grade (m) Operating temperature Storage temperature Operating humidity Storage humidity Vibration capacity IP Rating
o

C104 01 7.3 5 25 02 6.5 10 70

C106 04 6.5 10 70 04 8.2 10 70 15

C108 07 8.2 10 70 10 19.4 10 70

C110 20 19.4 10 70

0 C to 40 C (32 F to 104 F) -10 C to 80 C (-14 F to 176 F) 20% to 90% RH (non-condensing) 20% to 90% RH (non-condensing) 2.5G IP65 (when waterproof connectors are used, or when an oil seal is used to be fitted to the rotating shaft (an oil seal model is used))
o o o o

Approvals

Footnote: *1 Rate torque values are continuous permissible values at 0~40 C ambient temperature when attaching with the sizes of heatsinks listed below: ECMA-__04 / 06 / 08 : 250mm x 250mm x 6mm ECMA-__10 : 300mm x 300mm x 12mm ECMA-__13 : 400mm x 400mm x 20mm ECMA-__18 : 550mm x 550mm x 30mm Material type : Aluminum F40, F60, F80, F100, F130, F180
o

NOTE
1) Please refer to Section 1.2 for details about the model explanation.

Revision January 2011

11-7

Chapter 11 Specifications

Medium / High Inertia Series - 220V series


ECMA Series 05 Rated output power (kW) Rated torque (N-m) *1 Maximum torque (N-m) Rated speed (r/min) Maximum speed (r/min) Rated current (A) Maximum current (A) Power rating (kW/s) Rotor moment of inertia (Kg.m ) (without brake) Mechanical time constant (ms) Torque constant-KT (N-m/A) Voltage constant-KE (mV/(r/min)) Armature resistance (Ohm) Armature inductance (mH) Electrical time constant (ms) Insulation class Insulation resistance Insulation strength Weight (kg) (without brake) Weight (kg) (with brake) Max. radial shaft load (N) Max. thrust shaft load (N) Power rating (kW/s) (with brake) Rotor moment of inertia (Kg.m ) (with brake) Mechanical time constant (ms) (with brake) Brake holding torque [Nt-m (min)] Brake power consumption (at 20 C) [W]
o 2 2

E113 10 1.0 4.77 14.3 15 1.5 7.16 21.48 20 2.0 9.55 28.65 20 2.0

E118 30 3.0 14.32 42.97 03 0.3 2.86 8.59

G113 06 0.6 5.73 17.19 1000 2000 09 0.9 8.59 21.48

0.5 2.39 7.16

9.55 28.65

2000 3000 2.9 8.7 7.0 8.17 1.91 0.83 30.9 0.57 7.39 12.96 5.6 16.8 27.1 8.41 1.51 0.85 31.9 0.47 5.99 12.88 8.3 24.9 45.9 11.18 1.10 0.87 31.8 0.26 4.01 15.31 11.01 33.03 62.5 14.59 0.96 0.87 31.8 0.174 2.76 15.86 11.22 33.66 26.3 34.68 1.62 0.85 31.4 0.119 2.84 23.87 16.1 48.3 37.3 54.95 1.06 0.89 32.0 0.052 1.38 26.39 2.5 7.5 10.0 8.17 1.84 1.15 42.5 1.06 14.29 13.55

4.8 14.4 39.0 8.41 1.40 1.19 43.8 0.82 11.12 13.50

7.5 22.5 66.0 11.18 1.06 1.15 41.6 0.43 6.97 16.06

Class A (UL), Class B (CE) >100M, DC 500V 1500V AC, 60 seconds 6.8 8.2 490 98 6.4 7.0 8.4 490 98 24.9 7.5 8.9 490 98 43.1 7.8 9.2 490 98 59.7 13.5 17.5 1176 490 24.1 18.5 22.5 1470 490 35.9 6.8 8.2 490 98 9.2 7.0 8.4 490 98 35.9 7.5 8.9 490 98 62.1

8.94

9.14

11.90

15.88

37.86

57.06

8.94

9.14

11.9

2.07

1.64

1.19

1.05

1.77

1.10

2.0

1.51

1.13

10.0

10.0

10.0

10.0

25.0

25.0

10.0

10.0

10.0

19.0

19.0

19.0

19.0

20.4

20.4

19.0

19.0

19.0

11-8

Revision January 2011

Chapter 11 Specifications

ECMA Series 05 Brake release time [ms (Max)] Brake pull-in time [ms (Max)] Vibration grade (m) Operating temperature Storage temperature Operating humidity Storage humidity Vibration capacity IP Rating 10 70 10 10 70

E113 15 10 70 20 10 70 20 10 70 15

E118 30 10 70 03 10 70

G113 06 10 70 09 10 70

0 C to 40 C (32 F to 104 F) -10 C to 80 C (-14 F to 176 F) 20% to 90% RH (non-condensing) 20% to 90% RH (non-condensing) 2.5G IP65 (when waterproof connectors are used, or when an oil seal is used to be fitted to the rotating shaft (an oil seal model is used))
o o o o

Approvals

Footnote: *1 Rate torque values are continuous permissible values at 0~40 C ambient temperature when attaching with the sizes of heatsinks listed below: ECMA-__04 / 06 / 08 : 250mm x 250mm x 6mm ECMA-__10 : 300mm x 300mm x 12mm ECMA-__13 : 400mm x 400mm x 20mm ECMA-__18 : 550mm x 550mm x 30mm Material type : Aluminum F40, F60, F80, F100, F130, F180
o

NOTE
1) Please refer to Section 1.2 for details about the model explanation.

Revision January 2011

11-9

Chapter 11 Specifications

Medium / Medium-High Inertia Series - 220V series


ECMA Series 30 Rated output power (kW) Rated torque (N-m) *1 Maximum torque (N-m) Rated speed (r/min) Maximum speed (r/min) Rated current (A) Maximum current (A) Power rating (kW/s) Rotor moment of inertia (Kg.m ) (without brake) Mechanical time constant (ms) Torque constant-KT (N-m/A) Voltage constant-KE (mV/(r/min)) Armature resistance (Ohm) Armature inductance (mH) Electrical time constant (ms) Insulation class Insulation resistance Insulation strength Weight (kg) (without brake) Weight (kg) (with brake) Max. radial shaft load (N) Max. thrust shaft load (N) Power rating (kW/s) (with brake) Rotor moment of inertia (Kg.m ) (with brake) Mechanical time constant (ms) (with brake) Brake holding torque [Nt-m (min)] Brake power consumption (at 20 C) [W]
o 2 2

F118 45 4.5 28.65 71.62 1500 3000 19.4 58.2 66.4 54.95 1.28 0.98 35.0 0.077 1.27 16.5 32.5 81.3 105.5 77.75 0.92 0.88 32.0 0.032 0.89 27.8 40.0 100.0 122.9 99.78 0.96 0.88 31.0 0.025 0.60 24.0 47.5 118.8 159.7 142.7 0.63 1.01 35.5 0.015 0.40 26.7 55 5.5 35.01 87.53 75 7.5 47.74 119.36

3.0 19.10 57.29

Class A (UL), Class B (CE) >100M, DC 500V 1500V AC, 60 seconds 18.5 22.5 1470 490 63.9 23.5 29 1470 490 101.8 30.5 36 1764 588 119.4 37.0 53 1764 588 156.6

57.06

80.65

102.70

145.55

1.33

0.96

0.99

0.64

25.0

25.0

25.0

25.0

20.4

20.4

20.4

20.4

11-10

Revision January 2011

Chapter 11 Specifications

ECMA Series 30 Brake release time [ms (Max)] Brake pull-in time [ms (Max)] Vibration grade (m) Operating temperature Storage temperature Operating humidity Storage humidity Vibration capacity IP Rating
o o

F118 45 10 70 15 0 C to 40 C (32 F to 104 F) -10 C to 80 C (-14 F to 176 F) 20% to 90% RH (non-condensing) 20% to 90% RH (non-condensing) 2.5G IP65 (when waterproof connectors are used, or when an oil seal is used to be fitted to the rotating shaft (an oil seal model is used))
o o o o o o

55 10 70

75 10 70

10 70

Approvals

Footnote: *1 Rate torque values are continuous permissible values at 0~40 C ambient temperature when attaching with the sizes of heatsinks listed below: ECMA-__04 / 06 / 08 : 250mm x 250mm x 6mm ECMA-__10 : 300mm x 300mm x 12mm ECMA-__13 : 400mm x 400mm x 20mm ECMA-__18 : 550mm x 550mm x 30mm Material type : Aluminum F40, F60, F80, F100, F130, F180
o

NOTE
1) Please refer to Section 1.2 for details about the model explanation.

Revision January 2011

11-11

Chapter 11 Specifications

11.2.2

ECMA 400V Series

Low / Medium Inertia Series - 400V series


ECMA Series Rated output power (kW) Rated torque (N-m) *1 Maximum torque (N-m) Rated speed (r/min) Maximum speed (r/min) Rated current (A) Maximum current (A) Power rating (kW/s) Rotor moment of inertia (Kg.m ) (without brake) Mechanical time constant (ms) Torque constant-KT (N-m/A) Voltage constant-KE (mV/(r/min)) Armature resistance (Ohm) Armature inductance (mH) Electrical time constant (ms) Insulation class Insulation resistance Insulation strength Weight (kg) (without brake) Weight (kg) (with brake) Max. radial shaft load (N) Max. thrust shaft load (N) Power rating (kW/s) (with brake) Rotor moment of inertia (Kg.m ) (with brake) Mechanical time constant (ms) (with brake) Brake holding torque [Nt-m (min)]
2 2

J108 07 0.75 2.39 7.16 3000 5000 3.07 9.5 50.4 1.13 0.66 0.78 28.24 1.22 10.68 8.75 3.52 10.56 27.1 8.41 1.80 1.35 53.2 1.47 17.79 12.04 10 1.0 4.77 14.32

K113 15 1.5 7.16 21.48 2000 3000 5.02 15.06 45.9 11.18 1.24 1.43 55 0.83 11.67 14.04 6.66 19.98 62.5 14.59 1.04 1.43 55 0.57 8.29 14.39 20 2.0 9.55 28.65

>100M, DC 500V 1800V AC, 60 seconds 3.0 3.8 245 98 48.4 7.0 8.4 490 98 24.9 7.5 8.9 490 98 43.1 7.8 9.2 490 98 59.7

1.18

9.14

11.90

15.88

0.65

1.96

1.32

1.13

2.5

10.0

10.0

10.0

11-12

Revision January 2011

Chapter 11 Specifications

ECMA Series Brake power consumption (at 20 C) [W] Brake release time [ms (Max)] Brake pull-in time [ms (Max)] Vibration grade (m) Operating temperature Storage temperature Operating humidity Storage humidity Vibration capacity IP Rating
o

J108 07 8.5 10 70 10 19.0 10 70 15

K113 15 19.0 10 70 20 19.0 10 70

0 C to 40 C (32 F to 104 F) -10 C to 80 C (-14 F to 176 F) 20% to 90% RH (non-condensing) 20% to 90% RH (non-condensing) 2.5G IP65 (when waterproof connectors are used, or when an oil seal is used to be fitted to the rotating shaft (an oil seal model is used))
o o o o

Approvals

Footnote: *1 Rate torque values are continuous permissible values at 0~40 C ambient temperature when attaching with the sizes of heatsinks listed below: ECMA-__08 : 250mm x 250mm x 6mm ECMA-__13 : 400mm x 400mm x 20mm ECMA-__18 : 550mm x 550mm x 30mm Material type : Aluminum F80, F130, F180
o

Revision January 2011

11-13

Chapter 11 Specifications

Medium-High Inertia Series - 400V series


ECMA Series 30 Rated output power (kW) Rated torque (N-m) *1 Maximum torque (N-m) Rated speed (r/min) Maximum speed (r/min) Rated current (A) Maximum current (A) Power rating (kW/s) Rotor moment of inertia (Kg.m ) (without brake) Mechanical time constant (ms) Torque constant-KT (N-m/A) Voltage constant-KE (mV/(r/min)) Armature resistance (Ohm) Armature inductance (mH) Electrical time constant (ms) Insulation class Insulation resistance Insulation strength Weight (kg) (without brake) Weight (kg) (with brake) Max. radial shaft load (N) Max. thrust shaft load (N) Power rating (kW/s) (with brake) Rotor moment of inertia (Kg.m ) (with brake) Mechanical time constant (ms) (with brake) Brake holding torque [Nt-m (min)] Brake power consumption (at 20 C) [W]
o 2 2

L118 45 4.5 28.65 71.62 1500 3000 11.9 35.7 66.4 54.95 1.11 1.66 60.54 0.19 4.8 24.7 20.0 50 105.5 77.75 0.92 1.43 55.63 0.09 2.7 30 >100M, DC 500V 1800V AC, 60 seconds 18.5 22.5 1470 490 63.9 23.5 29 1470 490 101.8 30.5 36 1764 588 119.1 40.5 46 1764 588 156.6 22.37 56 122.9 99.78 0.88 1.50 57.99 0.07 2.55 31.7 28.39 70.9 159.7 142.7 156.6 1.68 65.37 0.05 1.7 34.14 55 5.5 35.0 87.53 75 7.5 47.75 119.38

3.0 19.10 57.29

57.06

80.65

102.70

145.5

1.16

0.95

0.91

0.69

25.0

40.0

55.0

55.0

20.4

15.1

21

21

11-14

Revision January 2011

Chapter 11 Specifications

ECMA Series 30 Brake release time [ms (Max)] Brake pull-in time [ms (Max)] Vibration grade (m) Operating temperature Storage temperature Operating humidity Storage humidity Vibration capacity IP Rating Approvals
o o

L118 45 10 70 15 0 C to 40 C (32 F to 104 F) -10 C to 80 C (-14 F to 176 F) 20% to 90% RH (non-condensing) 20% to 90% RH (non-condensing) 2.5G IP65 (when waterproof connectors are used, or when an oil seal is used to be fitted to the rotating shaft (an oil seal model is used)) All models are in the process of application to CE and UL certifications.
o o o o o o

55 10 70

75 10 70

10 70

Footnote: *1 Rate torque values are continuous permissible values at 0~40 C ambient temperature when attaching with the sizes of heatsinks listed below: ECMA-__08 : 250mm x 250mm x 6mm ECMA-__13 : 400mm x 400mm x 20mm ECMA-__18 : 550mm x 550mm x 30mm Material type : Aluminum F80, F130, F180
o

Revision January 2011

11-15

Chapter 11 Specifications

11.3 Servo Motor Speed-Torque Curves (T-N Curves) 11.3.1 220V Series

11-16

Revision January 2011

Chapter 11 Specifications

11.3.2

400V Series

Revision January 2011

11-17

Chapter 11 Specifications

11.4 Overload Characteristics Overload Protection Function


Overload protection is a built-in protective function to prevent a motor from overheating.

Occasion of Overload
1. Motor was operated for several seconds under a torque exceeding 100% torque. 2. Motor had driven high inertia machine and had accelerated and decelerated at high frequency. 3. Motor UVW cable or encoder cable was not connected correctly. 4. Servo gain was not set properly and caused motor hunting. 5. Motor holding brake was not released.

Chart of load and operating time


Low Inertia Series (ECMA C1, J1 Series)

11-18

Revision January 2011

Chapter 11 Specifications

Medium and Medium-High Inertia Series (ECMA E1, F1, K1 and L1 Series)

High Inertia Series (ECMA G1 Series)

Revision January 2011

11-19

Chapter 11 Specifications

11.5 Dimensions of Servo Drive 11.5.1 220V Series

Order P/N: ASD-A2-0221; ASD-A2-0421 (100W ~ 400W)

WEIGHT 1.5 (3.3)

NOTE
1) Dimensions are in millimeters (inches); Weights are in kilograms (kg) and (pounds (lbs)). 2) Actual measured values are in metric units. Dimensions and weights in (imperial units) are for reference only. 3) Dimensions and weights of the servo drive may be revised without prior notice.

11-20

Revision January 2011

Chapter 11 Specifications

Order P/N: ASD-A2-0721; ASD-A2-1021; ASD-A2-1521 (750W ~ 1.5kW)

WEIGHT 2.0 (4.4)

NOTE
1) Dimensions are in millimeters (inches); Weights are in kilograms (kg) and (pounds (lbs)). 2) Actual measured values are in metric units. Dimensions and weights in (imperial units) are for reference only. 3) Dimensions and weights of the servo drive may be revised without prior notice.

Revision January 2011

11-21

Chapter 11 Specifications

Order P/N: ASD-A2-2023; ASD-A2-3023 (2kW ~ 3kW)

WEIGHT 3.0 (6.6)

NOTE
1) Dimensions are in millimeters (inches); Weights are in kilograms (kg) and (pounds (lbs)). 2) Actual measured values are in metric units. Dimensions and weights in (imperial units) are for reference only. 3) Dimensions and weights of the servo drive may be revised without prior notice.

11-22

Revision January 2011

Chapter 11 Specifications

Order P/N: ASD-A2-4523 (4.5kW)

WEIGHT 4.4 (10.0)

NOTE
1) Dimensions are in millimeters (inches); Weights are in kilograms (kg) and (pounds (lbs)). 2) Actual measured values are in metric units. Dimensions and weights in (imperial units) are for reference only. 3) Dimensions and weights of the servo drive may be revised without prior notice.
Revision January 2011

11-23

Chapter 11 Specifications

Order P/N: ASD-A2-5523 (5.5kW)

WEIGHT 5.5 (12.1)

NOTE
1) Dimensions are in millimeters (inches); Weights are in kilograms (kg) and (pounds (lbs)). 2) Actual measured values are in metric units. Dimensions and weights in (imperial units) are for reference only. 3) Dimensions and weights of the servo drive may be revised without prior notice. 11-24
Revision January 2011

Chapter 11 Specifications

Order P/N: ASD-A2-7523 (7.5kW)

WEIGHT 5.9 (13.0)

NOTE
1) Dimensions are in millimeters (inches); Weights are in kilograms (kg) and (pounds (lbs)). 2) Actual measured values are in metric units. Dimensions and weights in (imperial units) are for reference only. 3) Dimensions and weights of the servo drive may be revised without prior notice.

Revision January 2011

11-25

Chapter 11 Specifications

11.5.2

400V Series

Order P/N: ASD-A2-0743; ASD-A2-1043; ASD-A2-1543 (750W ~ 1.5kW)

Power 750W ~ 1.5kW

A 216 (8.50)

B 203 (7.99)

C 82 (3.23)

D 62 (2.44)

E 203 (7.99)

Weight 2.89 (6.36)

NOTE
1) Dimensions are in millimeters (inches); Weights are in kilograms (kg) and (pounds (lbs)). 2) Actual measured values are in metric units. Dimensions and weights in (imperial units) are for reference only. 3) Dimensions and weights of the servo drive may be revised without prior notice.

11-26

Revision January 2011

Chapter 11 Specifications

Order P/N: ASD-A2-2043; ASD-A2-3043, ASD-A2-4543; ASD-A2-5543 (2kW ~ 5.5kW)

Power 2kW ~ 5.5kW

A B C 245 (9.65) 205.4 (8.11) 123 (4.88)

D 107 (4.21)

E 230 (9.06)

Weight 5.5 (12.1)

NOTE
1) Dimensions are in millimeters (inches); Weights are in kilograms (kg) and (pounds (lbs)). 2) Actual measured values are in metric units. Dimensions and weights in (imperial units) are for reference only. 3) Dimensions and weights of the servo drive may be revised without prior notice.

Revision January 2011

11-27

Chapter 11 Specifications

Order P/N: ASD-A2-7543 (7.5kW)

Power 7.5kW

A B C 260 (10.24) 205.4 (8.11) 136 (8.08)

D 107 (4.21)

E 247 (9.72)

Weight 6 (13.2)

NOTE
1) Dimensions are in millimeters (inches); Weights are in kilograms (kg) and (pounds (lbs)). 2) Actual measured values are in metric units. Dimensions and weights in (imperial units) are for reference only. 3) Dimensions and weights of the servo drive may be revised without prior notice.

11-28

Revision January 2011

Chapter 11 Specifications

11.6 Dimensions of Servo Motors (ECMA Series) 11.6.1 220V Series

Motor Frame Size: 80mm and below Models - 220V series

Model LC LZ LA S LB LL (without brake) LL (with brake) LS (without oil seal) LS (with oil seal) LR LE LG LW RH WK W T TP

C10401S 40 4.5 46
0 8( 0.009 )
0 30( 0.021)

C10602S 60 5.5 70
0 14( 0.011)

C10604S 60 5.5 70
0 14( 0.011)

C10804S 80 6.6 90
0 14( 0.011)
0 70( 0.030)

C10807S 80 6.6 90
0 19( 0.013)
0 70( 0.030)

0 50( 0.025)

0 50( 0.025)

100.6 136.6 20 20 25 2.5 5 16 6.2 3 3 3 M3 Depth 8

105.5 141.6 27 24 30 3 7.5 20 11 5 5 5 M4 Depth 15

130.7 166.8 27 24 30 3 7.5 20 11 5 5 5 M4 Depth 15

112.3 152.8 27 24.5 30 3 8 20 11 5 5 5 M4 Depth 15

138.3 178 32 29.5 35 3 8 25 15.5 6 6 6 M6 Depth 20

NOTE
1) Dimensions are in millimeters. 2) Dimensions of the servo motor may be revised without prior notice. 3) The boxes () in the model names are for optional configurations. (Please refer to section 1.2 for model explanation.) 4) Actual measured values are in metric units.

Revision January 2011

11-29

Chapter 11 Specifications

Motor Frame Size: 100mm~130mm Models - 220V series

Model LC LZ LA S LB LL (without brake) LL (with brake) LS LR LE LG LW RH WK W T TP

G11303S 130 9 145


0 22( 0.013)

E11305S 130 9 145


0 22( 0.013)

G11306S 130 9 145


0 22( 0.013)

G11309S 130 9 145


0 22( 0.013)

C11010ES 100 9 115


0 22( 0.013)

0 110( 0.035)

0 110( 0.035)

0 110( 0.035)

0 110( 0.035)

0 95( 0.035)

147.5 183.5 47 55 6 11.5 36 18 8 8 7 M6 Depth 20

147.5 183.5 47 55 6 11.5 36 18 8 8 7 M6 Depth 20

147.5 183.5 47 55 6 11.5 36 18 8 8 7 M6 Depth 20

163.5 198 47 55 6 11.5 36 18 8 8 7 M6 Depth 20

153.3 192.5 37 45 5 12 32 18 8 8 7 M6 Depth 20

NOTE
1) Dimensions are in millimeters. 2) Dimensions of the servo motor may be revised without prior notice. 3) The boxes () in the model names are for optional configurations. (Please refer to section 1.2 for model explanation.) 4) Actual measured values are in metric units.

11-30

Revision January 2011

Chapter 11 Specifications

Motor Frame Size: 100mm~130mm Models - 220V series

Model LC LZ LA S LB LL (without brake) LL (with brake) LS LR LE LG LW RH WK W T TP

E11310S 130 9 145


0 22( 0.013)

E11315S 130 9 145


0 22( 0.013)

C11020S 100 9 115


0 22( 0.013)

E11320S 130 9 145


0 22( 0.013)

0 110( 0.035)

0 110( 0.035)

0 95( 0.035)

0 110( 0.035)

147.5 183.5 47 55 6 11.5 36 18 8 8 7 M6 Depth 20

167.5 202 47 55 6 11.5 36 18 8 8 7 M6 Depth 20

199 226 37 45 5 12 32 18 8 8 7 M6 Depth 20

187.5 216 47 55 6 11.5 36 18 8 8 7 M6 Depth 20

NOTE
1) Dimensions are in millimeters. 2) Dimensions of the servo motor may be revised without prior notice. 3) The boxes () in the model names are for optional configurations. (Please refer to section 1.2 for model explanation.) 4) Actual measured values are in metric units.

Revision January 2011

11-31

Chapter 11 Specifications

Motor Frame Size: 180mm and above Models - 220V series

Model LC LZ LA S LB LL (without brake) LL (with brake) LS LR LE LG LW RH WK W T TP

E11820S 180 13.5 200


0 35( 0.016)

E11830S 180 13.5 200


0 35( 0.016)

F11830S 180 13.5 200


0 35( 0.016)

0 114.3( 0.035)

0 114.3( 0.035)

0 114.3( 0.035)

169 203.1 73 79 4 20 63 30 10 10 8 M12 Depth 25

202.1 235.3 73 79 4 20 63 30 10 10 8 M12 Depth 25

202.1 235.3 73 79 4 20 63 30 10 10 8 M12 Depth 25

NOTE
1) Dimensions are in millimeters. 2) Dimensions of the servo motor may be revised without prior notice. 3) The boxes () in the model names are for optional configurations. (Please refer to section 1.2 for model explanation.) 4) Actual measured values are in metric units.

11-32

Revision January 2011

Chapter 11 Specifications

Motor Frame Size: F1845mm and above Models - 220V series

Model LC LZ LA S LB LL (without brake) LL (with brake) LS LR LE LG LW RH WK W T TP

F11845S 180 13.5 200


0 35( 0.016)

F118553 180 13.5 200


0 42( 0.016)
0 114.3( 0.035)

F118753 180 13.5 200


0 42( 0.016)
0 114.3( 0.035)

0 114.3( 0.035)

235.3 279.3 73 79 4 20 63 30 10 10 8 M12 Depth25

279.7 311.7 108.5 113 4 20 90 37 12 12 8 M16 Depth32

342.0 376.1 113 73 4 20 90 37 12 12 8 M16 Depth32

NOTE
1) Dimensions are in millimeters. 2) Dimensions of the servo motor may be revised without prior notice. 3) The boxes () in the model names are for optional configurations. (Please refer to section 1.2 for model explanation.) 4) Actual measured values are in metric units.

Revision January 2011

11-33

Chapter 11 Specifications

11.6.2

400V Series

Motor Frame Size: 80mm and below Models - 400V series

Model LC LZ LA S LB LL (Without Brake) LL (With Brake) LS (Without Oil Seal) LS (With Oil Seal) LR LE LG LW RH WK W T TP

J10807S 80 6.6 90
0 19( 0.013)
0 70( 0.030)

138.3 178 32 29.5 35 3 8 25 15.5 6 6 6 M6, Depth 20

NOTE
1) Dimensions are in millimeters. 2) Dimensions of the servo motor may be revised without prior notice. 3) The boxes () in the model names are for optional configurations. (Please refer to section 1.2 for model explanation.) 4) Actual measured values are in metric units.

11-34

Revision January 2011

Chapter 11 Specifications

Motor Frame Size: 130mm Models - 400V series

Model LC LZ LA S LB LL (Without Brake) LL (With Brake) LS LR LE LG LW RH WK W T TP

K11310S 130 9 145


0 22( 0.013)
0 110( 0.035)

K11315S 130 9 145


0 22( 0.013)
0 110( 0.035)

K11320S 130 9 145


0 22( 0.013)
0 110( 0.035)

147.5 183.5 47 55 6 11.5 36 18 8 8 7 M6, Depth 20

167.5 202 47 55 6 11.5 36 18 8 8 7 M6, Depth 20

187.5 216 47 55 6 11.5 36 18 8 8 7 M6, Depth 20

NOTE
1) Dimensions are in millimeters. 2) Dimensions of the servo motor may be revised without prior notice. 3) The boxes () in the model names are for optional configurations. (Please refer to section 1.2 for model explanation.) 4) Actual measured values are in metric units.

Revision January 2011

11-35

Chapter 11 Specifications

Motor Frame Size: 180mm and above Models - 400V series

Model LC LZ LA S LB LL (Without Brake) LL (With Brake) LS LR LE LG LW RH WK W T TP

L11830S 180 13.5 200


0 35( 0.016)

L11845S 180 13.5 200


0 35( 0.016)

L118553 180 13.5 200


0 42( 0.016)
0 114.3( 0.035)

L118753 180 13.5 200


0 42( 0.016)
0 114.3( 0.035)

0 114.3( 0.035)

0 114.3( 0.035)

202.1 235.3 73 79 4 20 63 30 10 10 8 M12, Depth 25

235.3 279.3 73 79 4 20 63 30 10 10 8 M12, Depth 25

279.7 311.7 108.5 113 4 20 90 37 12 12 8 M16, Depth 32

342.0 376.1 108.5 113 4 20 90 37 12 12 8 M16, Depth 32

NOTE
1) Dimensions are in millimeters. 2) Dimensions of the servo motor may be revised without prior notice. 3) The boxes () in the model names are for optional configurations. (Please refer to section 1.2 for model explanation.) 4) Actual measured values are in metric units.

11-36

Revision January 2011

Appendix A Accessories

Power Connectors

Delta Part Number: ASDBCAPW0000

Title Housing Terminal

Part No. C4201H00-2*2PA C4201TOP-2

Manufacturer JOWLE JOWLE

Delta Part Number: ASDBCAPW0100

Title Housing Terminal

Part No. C4201H00-2*3PA C4201TOP-2

Manufacturer JOWLE JOWLE

Delta Part Number: ASD-CAPW1000

Revision January 2011

A-1

Appendix A Accessories

Delta Part Number: ASD-CAPW2000

Delta Part Number: ASD-CAPW4000 (for 220V series 5.5kW and above models) CLAMP: WPS3057-20A

Motor Brake Connector: ASD-CNBR1000 (for 220V series 5.5kW and above models) CLAMP: WPS3106A 10SL-4S-R
10SL-4S

A-2

Revision January 2011

Appendix A Accessories

Power Cables

Delta Part Number: ASD-ABPW0003, ASD-ABPW0005

Title Housing Terminal

Part No. C4201H00-2*2PA C4201TOP-2

Manufacturer JOWLE JOWLE

Title 1 2

Part No. ASD-ABPW0003 ASD-ABPW0005

L mm 3000 100 5000 100 inch 118 4 197 4

Delta Part Number: ASD-ABPW0103, ASD-ABPW0105

Title Housing Terminal

Part No. C4201H00-2*3PA C4201TOP-2

Manufacturer JOWLE JOWLE

Title 1 2

Part No. ASD-ABPW0103 ASD-ABPW0105

L mm 3000 100 5000 100 inch 118 4 197 4

Revision January 2011

A-3

Appendix A Accessories

Delta Part Number: ASD-CAPW1003, ASD-CAPW1005


(50mm) (1.97 inch)

(80 mm) (3.15 inch)

Title 1 2

Part No. ASD-CAPW1003 ASD-CAPW1005

Straight 3106A-20-18S 3106A-20-18S

L mm 3000 100 5000 100 inch 118 4 197 4

Delta Part Number: ASD-CAPW1103, ASD-CAPW1105

(50mm) (1.97 inch)

(80 mm) (3.15 inch)

Title 1 2

Part No. ASD-CAPW1103 ASD-CAPW1105

Straight 3106A-20-18S 3106A-20-18S

L mm 3000 100 5000 100 inch 118 4 197 4

A-4

Revision January 2011

Appendix A Accessories

Delta Part Number: ASD-CAPW1203, ASD-CAPW1205

Title 1 2

Part No. ASD-CAPW1203 ASD-CAPW1205

Straight 3106A-20-18S 3106A-20-18S

L mm 3000 100 5000 100 inch 118 4 197 4

Delta Part Number: ASD-CAPW1303, ASD-CAPW1305

Title 1 2

Part No. ASD-CAPW1303 ASD-CAPW1305

Straight 3106A-20-18S 3106A-20-18S

L mm 3000 100 5000 100 inch 118 4 197 4

Revision January 2011

A-5

Appendix A Accessories

Delta Part Number: ASD-A2PW1003, ASD-A2PW1005


(50mm) (1.97 inch)

(80 mm) (3.15 inch)

Title 1 2

Part No. ASD-A2PW1003 ASD-A2PW1005

Straight 3106A-20-18S 3106A-20-18S

L mm 3000 100 5000 100 inch 118 4 197 4

Delta Part Number: ASD-A2PW1103, ASD-A2PW1105

(50mm) (1.97 inch)

(80 mm) (3.15 inch)

Title 1 2

Part No. ASD-A2PW1103 ASD-A2PW1105

Straight 3106A-20-18S 3106A-20-18S

L mm 3000 100 5000 100 inch 118 4 197 4

A-6

Revision January 2011

Appendix A Accessories

Delta Part Number: ASD-CAPW2003, ASD-CAPW2005

Title 1 2

Part No. ASD-CAPW2003 ASD-CAPW2005

Straight 3106A-24-11S 3106A-24-11S

L mm 3000 100 5000 100 inch 118 4 197 4

Delta Part Number: ASD-CAPW2103, ASD-CAPW2105

Title 1 2

Part No. ASD-CAPW2103 ASD-CAPW2105

Straight 3106A-24-11S 3106A-24-11S

L mm 3000 100 5000 100 inch 118 4 197 4

Revision January 2011

A-7

Appendix A Accessories

Delta Part Number: ASD-CAPW2203, ASD-CAPW2205


(80mm) (3.15 inch)

(100 mm) (3.94 inch)

Title 1 2

Part No. ASD-CAPW2203 ASD-CAPW2205

Straight 3106A-24-11S 3106A-24-11S

L mm 3000 100 5000 100 inch 118 4 197 4

Delta Part Number: ASD-CAPW2303, ASD-CAPW2305 (for motors with brake)

(80mm) (3.15 inch)

(100 mm) (3.94 inch)

Title 1 2

Part No. ASD-CAPW2303 ASD-CAPW2305

Straight 3106A-24-11S 3106A-24-11S

L mm 3000 100 5000 100 inch 118 4 197 4

A-8

Revision January 2011

Appendix A Accessories

Delta Part Number: ASD-CAPW3203, ASD-CAPW3205 (for 4.5kW models)

Item 1 2

Part No. ASD-CAPW3203 ASD-CAPW3205

Straight MS 3106-24-11S MS 3106-24-11S

L mm 3000 100 5000 100 inch 118 4 197 4 mm

L1 inch 122 4 201 4 3100 100 5100 100

Delta Part Number: ASD-CAPW3303, ASD-CAPW3305 (for motors with brake) (for 4.5kW models)

Item 1 2

Part No. ASD-CAPW3303 ASD-CAPW3305

Straight MS 3106-24-11S MS 3106-24-11S

L mm 3000 100 5000 100 inch 118 4 197 4 mm

L1 inch 122 4 201 4 3100 100 5100 100

Revision January 2011

A-9

Appendix A Accessories

Encoder Connectors

Delta Part Number: ASD-ABEN0000

Title Housing MOTOR SIDE Terminal CLAMP DRIVE SIDE PLUG SHELL

Part No. AMP (1-172161-9) AMP (170359-3) DELTA (34703237XX) 3M 10120-3000PE 3M 10320-52A0-008

Manufacturer AMP AMP DELTA 3M 3M

Delta Part Number: ASD-CAEN1000

Title MOTOR SIDE DRIVE SIDE PLUG SHELL

Part No. 3106A-20-29S 3M 10120-3000PE 3M 10320-52A0-008

Manufacturer 3M 3M

A-10

Revision January 2011

Appendix A Accessories

Encoder Cables

Delta Part Number: ASD-ABEN0003, ASD-ABEN0005

Title Housing MOTOR SIDE Terminal CLAMP DRIVE SIDE PLUG SHELL

Part No. AMP (1-172161-9) AMP (170359-3) DELTA (34703237XX) 3M 10120-3000PE 3M 10320-52A0-008

Manufacturer AMP AMP DELTA 3M 3M L mm inch 118 4 197 4

Title 1 2

Part No. ASD-ABEN0003 ASD-ABEN0005

3000 100 5000 100

Delta Part Number: ASD-CAEN1003, ASD-CAEN1005

Title MOTOR SIDE DRIVE SIDE PLUG SHELL

Part No. 3106A-20-29S 3M 10120-3000PE 3M 10320-52A0-008

Manufacturer 3M 3M L mm 3000 100 5000 100 inch 118 4 197 4

Title 1 2

Part No. ASD-CAEN1003 ASD-CAEN1005

Straight 3106A-20-29S 3106A-20-29S

Revision January 2011

A-11

Appendix A Accessories

I/O Signal Connector (CN1)

Delta Part Number: ASD-CNSC0050

Vendor Name 3M TAIWAN LTD 3M TAIWAN LTD

Vendor P/N 10150-3000PE 10350-52A0-008

Terminal Block Module

Delta Part Number: ASD-BM-50A

RS-232 Communication Cable

Delta Part Number: ASD-CARS0003

Title 1

Part No. ASD-CARS0003

L mm 3000 100 inch 118 4

A-12

Revision January 2011

Appendix A Accessories

Communication Cable between Drive and Computer (for PC)

Delta Part Number: DOP-CAUSBAB

Title 1

Part No. DOP-CAUSBAB

L mm 1400 30 inch 55 1.2

CANopen Communication Cable

Delta Part Number: TAP-CB03, TAP-CB04

Title 1 2

Part No. TAP-CB03 TAP-CB04

L mm 500 10 1000 10 inch 19 0.4 39 0.4

CANopen Distribution Box

Delta Part Number: TAP-CN03

Revision January 2011

A-13

Appendix A Accessories

RS-485 Connector

Delta Part Number: ASD-CNIE0B06

A-14

Revision January 2011

Appendix A Accessories

Servo Drive, Servo Motor and Accessories Combinations - 220V Series

100W Servo Drive and 100W Low Inertia Servo Motor Servo Drive Servo Motor Without Brake 3M Cable 5M 3M Power Cable ASD-ABPW0103 Encoder Cable ASD-ABEN0003 Motor Power Cable Power Cable ASD-ABPW0003 ASD-ABPW0005 Encoder Cable ASD-ABEN0003 Connector Encoder Cable ASD-ABEN0005 ASD-A2-0121- ECMA-C10401S With Brake 5M Power Cable ASD-ABPW0105 Encoder Cable ASD-ABEN0005

Power Connector ASDBCAPW0000

Power ConnectorASDBCAPW0100

Encoder Connector ASD-ABEN0000

200W Servo Drive and 200W Low Inertia Servo Motor Servo Drive Servo Motor Without Brake 3M Cable 5M 3M Power Cable ASD-ABPW0103 Encoder Cable ASD-ABEN0003 Motor Power Cable Power Cable ASD-ABPW0003 ASD-ABPW0005 Encoder Cable ASD-ABEN0003 Connector Encoder Cable ASD-ABEN0005 ASD-A2-0221- ECMA-C10602S With Brake 5M Power Cable ASD-ABPW0105 Encoder Cable ASD-ABEN0005

Power Connector ASDBCAPW0000

Power ConnectorASDBCAPW0100

Encoder Connector ASD-ABEN0000

400W Servo Drive and 400W Low Inertia Servo Motor Servo Drive Servo Motor Without Brake 3M Cable Power Cable ASD-ABPW0003 Encoder Cable ASD-ABEN0003 Connector 5M Power Cable ASD-ABPW0005 Encoder Cable ASD-ABEN0005 3M Power Cable ASD-ABPW0103 Encoder Cable ASD-ABEN0003 ASD-A2-0421- ECMA-C10604S ECMA-C108047 With Brake 5M Power Cable ASD-ABPW0105 Encoder Cable ASD-ABEN0005

Power Connector ASDBCAPW0000

Power ConnectorASDBCAPW0100

Encoder Connector ASD-ABEN0000

Revision January 2011

A-15

Appendix A Accessories

400W Servo Drive and 500W Medium Inertia Servo Motor Servo Drive Servo Motor Without Brake 3M Cable Power Cable ASD-CAPW1003 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 Connector 5M Power Cable ASD-CAPW1005 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005 3M Power Cable ASD-CAPW1103 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 ASD-A2-0421- ECMA-E11305S With Brake 5M Power Cable ASD-CAPW1105 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005

Power Connector ASD-CAPW1000 Encoder Connector ASD-CAEN1000

400W Servo Drive and 300W High Inertia Servo Motor Servo Drive Servo Motor Without Brake 3M Cable Power Cable ASD-CAPW1003 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 Connector 5M Power Cable ASD-CAPW1005 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005 3M Power Cable ASD-CAPW1103 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 ASD-A2-0421- ECMA-G11303S With Brake 5M Power Cable ASD-CAPW1105 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005

Power Connector ASD-CAPW1000 Encoder Connector ASD-CAEN1000

750W Servo Drive and 750W Low Inertia Servo Motor Servo Drive Servo Motor Without Brake 3M Cable Power Cable ASD-ABPW0003 Encoder Cable ASD-ABEN0003 Connector 5M Power Cable ASD-ABPW0005 Encoder Cable ASD-ABEN0005 3M Power Cable ASD-ABPW0103 Encoder Cable ASD-ABEN0003 ASD-A2-0721- ECMA-C10807S With Brake 5M Power Cable ASD-ABPW0105 Encoder Cable ASD-ABEN0005

Power Connector ASDBCAPW0000

Power Connector ASDBCAPW0100

Encoder Connector ASD-ABEN0000

A-16

Revision January 2011

Appendix A Accessories

750W Servo Drive and 600W High Inertia Servo Motor Servo Drive Servo Motor Without Brake 3M Cable Power Cable ASD-CAPW1003 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 Connector 5M Power Cable ASD-CAPW1005 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005 3M Power Cable ASD-CAPW1103 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 ASD-A2-0721- ECMA-G11306S With Brake 5M Power Cable ASD-CAPW1105 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005

Power Connector ASD-CAPW1000 Encoder Connector ASD-CAEN1000

1kW Servo Drive and 1kW Low Inertia Servo Motor Servo Drive Servo Motor Without Brake 3M Cable Power Cable ASD-CAPW1003 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 Connector 5M Power Cable ASD-CAPW1005 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005 3M Power Cable ASD-CAPW1103 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 ASD-A2-1021- ECMA-C11010S With Brake 5M Power Cable ASD-CAPW1105 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005

Power Connector ASD-CAPW1000 Encoder Connector ASD-CAEN1000

1kW Servo Drive and 1kW Medium Inertia Servo Motor Servo Drive Servo Motor Without Brake 3M Cable Power Cable ASD-CAPW1003 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 Connector 5M Power Cable ASD-CAPW1005 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005 3M Power Cable ASD-CAPW1103 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 ASD-A2-1021- ECMA-E11310S With Brake 5M Power Cable ASD-CAPW1105 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005

Power Connector ASD-CAPW1000 Encoder Connector ASD-CAEN1000

Revision January 2011

A-17

Appendix A Accessories

1kW Servo Drive and 900W High Inertia Servo Motor Servo Drive Servo Motor Without Brake 3M Cable Power Cable ASD-CAPW1003 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 Connector 5M Power Cable ASD-CAPW1005 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005 3M Power Cable ASD-CAPW1103 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 ASD-A2-1021- ECMA-G11309S With Brake 5M Power Cable ASD-CAPW1105 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005

Power Connector ASD-CAPW1000 Encoder Connector ASD-CAEN1000

1.5kW Servo Drive and 1.5kW Medium Inertia Servo Motor Servo Drive Servo Motor Without Brake 3M Cable Power Cable ASD-CAPW1003 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 Connector 5M Power Cable ASD-CAPW1005 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005 3M Power Cable ASD-CAPW1103 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 ASD-A2-1521- ECMA-E11315S With Brake 5M Power Cable ASD-CAPW1105 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005

Power Connector ASD-CAPW1000 Encoder Connector ASD-CAEN1000

2kW Servo Drive and 2kW Low Inertia Servo Motor Servo Drive Servo Motor Without Brake 3M Cable Power Cable ASD-A2PW1003 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 Connector 5M Power Cable ASD-A2PW1005 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005 3M Power Cable ASD-A2PW1103 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 ASD-A2-2023- ECMA-C11020S With Brake 5M Power Cable ASD-A2PW1105 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005

Power Connector ASD-CAPW1000 Encoder Connector ASD-CAEN1000

A-18

Revision January 2011

Appendix A Accessories

2kW Servo Drive and 2kW Medium Inertia Servo Motor Servo Drive Servo Motor Without Brake 3M Cable Power Cable ASD-A2PW1003 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 Connector 5M Power Cable ASD-A2PW1005 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005 3M Power Cable ASD-A2PW1103 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 ASD-A2-2023- ECMA-E11320S With Brake 5M Power Cable ASD-A2PW1105 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005

Power Connector ASD-CAPW1000 Encoder Connector ASD-CAEN1000

2kW Servo Drive and 2kW Medium Inertia Servo Motor Servo Drive Servo Motor Without Brake 3M Cable Power Cable ASD-CAPW2003 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 Connector 5M Power Cable ASD-CAPW2005 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005 3M Power Cable ASD-CAPW2103 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 ASD-A2-2023- ECMA-E11820S With Brake 5M Power Cable ASD-CAPW2105 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005

Power Connector ASD-CAPW2000 Encoder Connector ASD-CAEN1000

3kW Servo Drive and 3kW Medium Inertia Servo Motor Servo Drive Servo Motor Without Brake 3M Cable Power Cable ASD-CAPW2003 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 Connector 5M Power Cable ASD-CAPW2005 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005 3M Power Cable ASD-CAPW2103 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 ASD-A2-3023- ECMA-E11830S With Brake 5M Power Cable ASD-CAPW2105 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005

Power Connector ASD-CAPW2000 Encoder Connector ASD-CAEN1000

Revision January 2011

A-19

Appendix A Accessories

3kW Servo Drive and 3kW Medium-High Inertia Servo Motor Servo Drive Servo Motor Without Brake 3M Cable Power Cable ASD-CAPW2003 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 Connector 5M Power Cable ASD-CAPW2005 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005 3M Power Cable ASD-CAPW2103 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 ASD-A2-3023- ECMA-F11830S With Brake 5M Power Cable ASD-CAPW2105 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005

Power Connector ASD-CAPW2000 Encoder Connector ASD-CAEN1000

4.5kW Servo Drive and 4.5kW Medium-High Inertia Servo Motor Servo Drive Servo Motor Without Brake 3M Cable Power Cable ASD-CAPW3203 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 Connector 5M Power Cable ASD-CAPW3205 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005 3M Power Cable ASD-CAPW3303 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 ASD-A2-4523- ECMA-F11845S With Brake 5M Power Cable ASD-CAPW3305 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005

Power Connector ASD-CAPW2000 Encoder Connector ASD-CAEN1000

5.5kW Servo Drive and 5.5kW Medium-High Inertia Servo Motor Servo Drive Servo Motor Without Brake 3M Cable Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 Connector 5M Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005 3M Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 ASD-A2-5523- ECMA-F118553 With Brake 5M Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005

Power Connector ASD-CAPW4000 Encoder Connector ASD-CAEN1000 Brake Connector ASD-CNBR1000

A-20

Revision January 2011

Appendix A Accessories

7.5kW Servo Drive and 7.5kW Medium-High Inertia Servo Motor Servo Drive Servo Motor Without Brake 3M Cable Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 Connector 5M Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005 3M Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 ASD-A2-7523- ECMA-F118753 With Brake 5M Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005

Power Connector ASD-CAPW4000 Encoder Connector ASD-CAEN1000 Brake Connector ASD-CNBR1000

NOTE
1) The boxes () at the ends of the servo drive model names are for optional configurations (Fullclose control, CANopen, DMCNET and extension port for digital input). For the actual model name, please refer to the ordering information of the actual purchased product. 2) The boxes () in the servo motor model names are for optional configurations (keyway, brake and oil seal).

Revision January 2011

A-21

Appendix A Accessories

Servo Drive, Servo Motor and Accessories Combinations - 400V Series

750W Servo Drive and 750W Low Inertia Servo Motor Servo Drive Servo Motor Without Brake 3M Cable Power Cable ASD-ABPW0003 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 Connector 5M Power Cable ASD-ABPW0005 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005 3M Power Cable ASD-ABPW0103 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 ASD-A2-0743- ECMA-J10807S With Brake 5M Power Cable ASD-ABPW0105 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005

Power Connector ASDBCAPW0000

Power Connector ASDBCAPW0100

Encoder Connector ASD-ABEN0000

1kW Servo Drive and 1kW Medium Inertia Servo Motor Servo Drive Servo Motor Without Brake 3M Cable Power Cable ASD-CAPW1003 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 Connector 5M Power Cable ASD-CAPW1005 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005 3M Power Cable ASD-CAPW1103 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 ASD-A2-1043- ECMA-K11310S With Brake 5M Power Cable ASD-CAPW1105 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005

Power Connector ASD-CAPW1000 Encoder Connector ASD-CAEN1000

1.5kW Servo Drive and 1.5kW Medium Inertia Servo Motor Servo Drive Servo Motor Without Brake 3M Cable Power Cable ASD-CAPW1003 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 Connector 5M Power Cable ASD-CAPW1005 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005 3M Power Cable ASD-CAPW1103 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 ASD-A2-1543- ECMA-K11315S With Brake 5M Power Cable ASD-CAPW1105 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005

Power Connector ASD-CAPW1000 Encoder Connector ASD-CAEN1000

A-22

Revision January 2011

Appendix A Accessories

2kW Servo Drive and 2kW Medium Inertia Servo Motor Servo Drive Servo Motor Without Brake 3M Cable Power Cable ASD-CAPW1203 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 Connector 5M Power Cable ASD-CAPW1205 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005 3M Power Cable ASD-CAPW1303 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 ASD-A2-2043- ECMA-K11320S With Brake 5M Power Cable ASD-CAPW1305 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005

Power Connector ASD-CAPW1000 Encoder Connector ASD-CAEN1000

3kW Servo Drive and 3kW Medium-High Inertia Servo Motor Servo Drive Servo Motor Without Brake 3M Cable Power Cable ASD-CAPW2203 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 Connector 5M Power Cable ASD-CAPW2205 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005 3M Power Cable ASD-CAPW2303 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 ASD-A2-3043- ECMA-K11830S With Brake 5M Power Cable ASD-CAPW2305 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005

Power Connector ASD-CAPW2000 Encoder Connector ASD-CAEN1000

4.5kW Servo Drive and 4.5kW Medium-High Inertia Servo Motor Servo Drive Servo Motor Without Brake 3M Cable Power Cable ASD-CAPW2203 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 Connector 5M Power Cable ASD-CAPW2205 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005 3M Power Cable ASD-CAPW2303 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 ASD-A2-4543- ECMA-L11845S With Brake 5M Power Cable ASD-CAPW2305 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005

Power Connector ASD-CAPW2000 Encoder Connector ASD-CAEN1000

Revision January 2011

A-23

Appendix A Accessories

5.5kW Servo Drive and 5.5kW Medium-High Inertia Servo Motor Servo Drive Servo Motor Without Brake 3M Cable Power Cable ASD-CAPW2203 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 Connector 5M Power Cable ASD-CAPW2205 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005 3M Power Cable ASD-CAPW2303 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 ASD-A2-5543- ECMA-L118553 With Brake 5M Power Cable ASD-CAPW2305 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005

Power Connector ASD-CAPW2000 Encoder Connector ASD-CAEN1000

7.5kW Servo Drive and 7.5kW Medium-High Inertia Servo Motor Servo Drive Servo Motor Without Brake 3M Cable Power Cable ASD-CAPW3203 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 Connector 5M Power Cable ASD-CAPW3205 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005 3M Power Cable ASD-CAPW3303 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1003 ASD-A2-7543- ECMA-L118753 With Brake 5M Power Cable ASD-CAPW3305 Encoder Cable ASD-CAEN1005

Power Connector ASD-CAPW2000 Encoder Connector ASD-CAEN1000

NOTE
1) The boxes () at the ends of the servo drive model names are for optional configurations (Fullclose control, CANopen, DMCNET and extension port for digital input). For the actual model name, please refer to the ordering information of the actual purchased product. 2) The boxes () in the servo motor model names are for optional configurations (keyway, brake and oil seal).

A-24

Revision January 2011

Appendix A Accessories

Other Accessories Other Accessories (for ASDA-A2 series all models) Description 50Pin I/O signal connector (CN1) Terminal Block Module RS-232 Communication Cable Communication Cable between Drive and Computer (for PC) CANopen Communication Cable CANopen Distribution Box RS-485 Connector Regenerative Resistor 400W 40 Regenerative Resistor 1kW 20 Regenerative Resistor 3kW 10 Delta Part Number ASD-CNSC0050 ASD-BM-50A ASD-CARS0003 DOP-CAUSBAB TAP-CB03/TAP-CB04 TAP-CN03 ASD-CNIE0B06 BR400W040 BR1K0W020 BR1K5W005

Revision January 2011

A-25

Appendix A Accessories

This page intentionally left blank

A-26

Revision January 2011

Appendix B Maintenance and Inspection

Delta AC servo drives are based on solid state electronics technology. Preventive maintenance is required to operate this AC servo drives in its optimal condition, and to ensure a long life. It is recommended to perform a periodic maintenance and inspection of the AC servo drive by a qualified technician. Before any maintenance and inspection, always turn off the AC input power to the unit.

Be sure to disconnect AC power and ensure that the internal capacitors have fully discharged before performing the maintenance and inspection!

Basic Inspection
After power is in connected to the AC servo drive, the charge LED will be lit which indicates that the AC servo drive is ready. Item Content

Periodically inspect the screws of the servo drive, motor shaft, terminal block and the connection to mechanical system. Tighten screws as necessary as they may loosen due to vibration and varying temperatures. Ensure that oil, water, metallic particles or any foreign objects do not fall inside the servo drive, motor, control panel or ventilation slots and General Inspection holes. As these will cause damage. Ensure the correct installation and the control panel. It should be free from airborne dust, harmful gases or liquids. Ensure that all wiring instructions and recommendations are followed; otherwise damage to the drive and or motor may result. Inspect the servo drive and servo motor to insure they were not damaged. To avoid an electric shock, be sure to connect the ground terminal of servo drive to the ground terminal of control panel. Before making any connection, wait 10 minutes for capacitors to discharge after the power is disconnected, alternatively, use an appropriate discharge device to discharge. Inspection before Ensure that all wiring terminals are correctly insulated. operation Ensure that all wiring is correct or damage and or malfunction may (Control power is result. not applied) Visually check to ensure that there are not any unused screws, metal strips, or any conductive or inflammable materials inside the drive. Never put inflammable objects on servo drive or close to the external regenerative resistor. Make sure control switch is OFF. If the electromagnetic brake is being used, ensure that it is correctly wired.
B-1

Revision January 2011

Appendix B Maintenance and Inspection

Item

Content

Inspection before If required, use an appropriate electrical filter to eliminate noise to the servo drive. operation (Control power is Ensure that the external applied voltage to the drive is correct and matched to the controller. not applied) Ensure that the cables are not damaged, stressed excessively or loaded heavily. When the motor is running, pay close attention on the connection of the cables and notice that if they are damaged, frayed or over extended. Check for abnormal vibrations and sounds during operation. If the servo motor is vibrating or there are unusual noises while the motor is running, please contact the dealer or manufacturer for assistance. Ensure that all user-defined parameters are set correctly. Since the Inspection during characteristics of various machinery are different, in order to avoid operation accident or cause damage, do not adjust the parameter abnormally and ensure the parameter setting is not an excessive value. (Control power is applied) Ensure to reset some parameters when the servo drive is off (Please refer to Chapter 7). Otherwise, it may result in malfunction. If there is no contact sound or there be any unusual noises when the relay of the servo drive is operating, please contact your distributor for assistance or contact with Delta. Check for abnormal conditions of the power indicators and LED display. If there is any abnormal condition of the power indicators and LED display, please contact your distributor for assistance or contact with Delta.

Maintenance Use and store the product in a proper and normal environment. Periodically clean the surface and panel of servo drive and motor. Make sure the conductors or insulators are corroded and/or damaged. Do not disassemble or damage any mechanical part when performing maintenance. Clean off any dust and dirt with a vacuum cleaner. Place special emphasis on cleaning the
ventilation ports and PCBs. Always keep these areas clean, as accumulation of dust and dirt can cause unforeseen failures.

B-2

Revision January 2011

Appendix B Maintenance and Inspection

Life of Replacement Components Smooth capacitor


The characteristics of smooth capacitor would be deteriorated by ripple current affection. The life of smooth capacitor varies according to ambient temperature and operating conditions. The common guaranteed life of smooth capacitor is ten years when it is properly used in normal air-conditioned environment.

Relay
The contacts will wear and result in malfunction due to switching current. The life of relay varies according to power supply capacity. Therefore, the common guaranteed life of relay is cumulative 100,000 times of power on and power off.

Cooling fan
The cooling fan life is limited and should be changed periodically. The cooling fan will reach the end of its life in 2~3 years when it is in continuous operation. However, it also must be replaced if the cooling fan is vibrating or there are unusual noises.

Revision January 2011

B-3

Appendix B Maintenance and Inspection

This page intentionally left blank.

B-4

Revision January 2011

You might also like